4 @setfilename ../../info/org
5 @settitle The Org Manual
8 @set DATE December 2010
10 @c Use proper quote and backtick for code sections in PDF output
11 @c Cf. Texinfo manual 14.2
12 @set txicodequoteundirected
13 @set txicodequotebacktick
15 @c Version and Contact Info
16 @set MAINTAINERSITE @uref{http://orgmode.org,maintainers webpage}
17 @set AUTHOR Carsten Dominik
18 @set MAINTAINER Carsten Dominik
19 @set MAINTAINEREMAIL @email{carsten at orgmode dot org}
20 @set MAINTAINERCONTACT @uref{mailto:carsten at orgmode dot org,contact the maintainer}
25 @c -----------------------------------------------------------------------------
27 @c Macro definitions for commands and keys
28 @c =======================================
30 @c The behavior of the key/command macros will depend on the flag cmdnames
31 @c When set, commands names are shown. When clear, they are not shown.
35 @c Below we define the following macros for Org key tables:
37 @c orgkey{key} A key item
38 @c orgcmd{key,cmd} Key with command name
39 @c xorgcmd{key,cmmand} Key with command name as @itemx
40 @c orgcmdnki{key,cmd} Like orgcmd, but do not index the key
41 @c orgcmdtkc{text,key,cmd} Like orgcmd,special text instead of key
42 @c orgcmdkkc{key1,key2,cmd} Two keys with one command name, use "or"
43 @c orgcmdkxkc{key1,key2,cmd} Two keys with one command name, but
44 @c different functions, so format as @itemx
45 @c orgcmdkskc{key1,key2,cmd} Same as orgcmdkkc, but use "or short"
46 @c xorgcmdkskc{key1,key2,cmd} Same as previous, but use @itemx
47 @c orgcmdkkcc{key1,key2,cmd1,cmd2} Two keys and two commands
49 @c a key but no command
61 @c one key with a command
62 @c Inserts: @item KEY COMMAND
63 @macro orgcmd{key,command}
68 @item @kbd{\key\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
71 @item @kbd{\key\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
80 @c One key with one command, formatted using @itemx
81 @c Inserts: @itemx KEY COMMAND
82 @macro xorgcmd{key,command}
87 @itemx @kbd{\key\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
90 @itemx @kbd{\key\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
99 @c one key with a command, bit do not index the key
100 @c Inserts: @item KEY COMMAND
101 @macro orgcmdnki{key,command}
105 @item @kbd{\key\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
108 @item @kbd{\key\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
116 @c one key with a command, and special text to replace key in item
117 @c Inserts: @item TEXT COMMAND
118 @macro orgcmdtkc{text,key,command}
123 @item @kbd{\text\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
126 @item @kbd{\text\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
135 @c two keys with one command
136 @c Inserts: @item KEY1 or KEY2 COMMAND
137 @macro orgcmdkkc{key1,key2,command}
143 @item @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or} @ @kbd{\key2\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
146 @item @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or} @ @kbd{\key2\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
152 @item @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or} @ @kbd{\key2\}
156 @c Two keys with one command name, but different functions, so format as
158 @c Inserts: @item KEY1
159 @c @itemx KEY2 COMMAND
160 @macro orgcmdkxkc{key1,key2,command}
167 @itemx @kbd{\key2\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
171 @itemx @kbd{\key2\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
182 @c Same as previous, but use "or short"
183 @c Inserts: @item KEY1 or short KEY2 COMMAND
184 @macro orgcmdkskc{key1,key2,command}
190 @item @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or short} @ @kbd{\key2\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
193 @item @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or short} @ @kbd{\key2\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
199 @item @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or short} @ @kbd{\key2\}
203 @c Same as previous, but use @itemx
204 @c Inserts: @itemx KEY1 or short KEY2 COMMAND
205 @macro xorgcmdkskc{key1,key2,command}
211 @itemx @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or short} @ @kbd{\key2\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
214 @itemx @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or short} @ @kbd{\key2\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
220 @itemx @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or short} @ @kbd{\key2\}
224 @c two keys with two commands
225 @c Inserts: @item KEY1 COMMAND1
226 @c @itemx KEY2 COMMAND2
227 @macro orgcmdkkcc{key1,key2,command1,command2}
234 @item @kbd{\key1\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command1\}
235 @itemx @kbd{\key2\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command2\}
238 @item @kbd{\key1\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command1\})
239 @itemx @kbd{\key2\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command2\})
249 @c -----------------------------------------------------------------------------
252 @c @hyphenation{time-stamp time-stamps time-stamp-ing time-stamp-ed}
255 @c Subheadings inside a table.
256 @macro tsubheading{text}
258 @subsubheading \text\
266 This manual is for Org version @value{VERSION}.
268 Copyright @copyright{} 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009, 2010
269 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
272 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
273 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
274 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
275 Invariant Sections, with the Front-Cover texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
276 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below. A copy of the license
277 is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License.''
279 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have the freedom to copy and
280 modify this GNU manual. Buying copies from the FSF supports it in
281 developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
283 This document is part of a collection distributed under the GNU Free
284 Documentation License. If you want to distribute this document
285 separately from the collection, you can do so by adding a copy of the
286 license to the document, as described in section 6 of the license.
292 * Org Mode: (org). Outline-based notes management and organizer
296 @title The Org Manual
298 @subtitle Release @value{VERSION}
299 @author by Carsten Dominik
300 with contributions by David O'Toole, Bastien Guerry, Philip Rooke, Dan Davison, Eric Schulte, and Thomas Dye
302 @c The following two commands start the copyright page.
304 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
308 @c Output the table of contents at the beginning.
312 @node Top, Introduction, (dir), (dir)
319 * Introduction:: Getting started
320 * Document Structure:: A tree works like your brain
321 * Tables:: Pure magic for quick formatting
322 * Hyperlinks:: Notes in context
323 * TODO Items:: Every tree branch can be a TODO item
324 * Tags:: Tagging headlines and matching sets of tags
325 * Properties and Columns:: Storing information about an entry
326 * Dates and Times:: Making items useful for planning
327 * Capture - Refile - Archive:: The ins and outs for projects
328 * Agenda Views:: Collecting information into views
329 * Markup:: Prepare text for rich export
330 * Exporting:: Sharing and publishing of notes
331 * Publishing:: Create a web site of linked Org files
332 * Working With Source Code:: Export, evaluate, and tangle code blocks
333 * Miscellaneous:: All the rest which did not fit elsewhere
334 * Hacking:: How to hack your way around
335 * MobileOrg:: Viewing and capture on a mobile device
336 * History and Acknowledgments:: How Org came into being
337 * Main Index:: An index of Org's concepts and features
338 * Key Index:: Key bindings and where they are described
339 * Command and Function Index:: Command names and some internal functions
340 * Variable Index:: Variables mentioned in the manual
343 --- The Detailed Node Listing ---
347 * Summary:: Brief summary of what Org does
348 * Installation:: How to install a downloaded version of Org
349 * Activation:: How to activate Org for certain buffers
350 * Feedback:: Bug reports, ideas, patches etc.
351 * Conventions:: Type-setting conventions in the manual
355 * Outlines:: Org is based on Outline mode
356 * Headlines:: How to typeset Org tree headlines
357 * Visibility cycling:: Show and hide, much simplified
358 * Motion:: Jumping to other headlines
359 * Structure editing:: Changing sequence and level of headlines
360 * Sparse trees:: Matches embedded in context
361 * Plain lists:: Additional structure within an entry
362 * Drawers:: Tucking stuff away
363 * Blocks:: Folding blocks
364 * Footnotes:: How footnotes are defined in Org's syntax
365 * Orgstruct mode:: Structure editing outside Org
369 * Built-in table editor:: Simple tables
370 * Column width and alignment:: Overrule the automatic settings
371 * Column groups:: Grouping to trigger vertical lines
372 * Orgtbl mode:: The table editor as minor mode
373 * The spreadsheet:: The table editor has spreadsheet capabilities
374 * Org-Plot:: Plotting from org tables
378 * References:: How to refer to another field or range
379 * Formula syntax for Calc:: Using Calc to compute stuff
380 * Formula syntax for Lisp:: Writing formulas in Emacs Lisp
381 * Field formulas:: Formulas valid for a single field
382 * Column formulas:: Formulas valid for an entire column
383 * Editing and debugging formulas:: Fixing formulas
384 * Updating the table:: Recomputing all dependent fields
385 * Advanced features:: Field names, parameters and automatic recalc
389 * Link format:: How links in Org are formatted
390 * Internal links:: Links to other places in the current file
391 * External links:: URL-like links to the world
392 * Handling links:: Creating, inserting and following
393 * Using links outside Org:: Linking from my C source code?
394 * Link abbreviations:: Shortcuts for writing complex links
395 * Search options:: Linking to a specific location
396 * Custom searches:: When the default search is not enough
400 * Radio targets:: Make targets trigger links in plain text
404 * TODO basics:: Marking and displaying TODO entries
405 * TODO extensions:: Workflow and assignments
406 * Progress logging:: Dates and notes for progress
407 * Priorities:: Some things are more important than others
408 * Breaking down tasks:: Splitting a task into manageable pieces
409 * Checkboxes:: Tick-off lists
411 Extended use of TODO keywords
413 * Workflow states:: From TODO to DONE in steps
414 * TODO types:: I do this, Fred does the rest
415 * Multiple sets in one file:: Mixing it all, and still finding your way
416 * Fast access to TODO states:: Single letter selection of a state
417 * Per-file keywords:: Different files, different requirements
418 * Faces for TODO keywords:: Highlighting states
419 * TODO dependencies:: When one task needs to wait for others
423 * Closing items:: When was this entry marked DONE?
424 * Tracking TODO state changes:: When did the status change?
425 * Tracking your habits:: How consistent have you been?
429 * Tag inheritance:: Tags use the tree structure of the outline
430 * Setting tags:: How to assign tags to a headline
431 * Tag searches:: Searching for combinations of tags
433 Properties and columns
435 * Property syntax:: How properties are spelled out
436 * Special properties:: Access to other Org-mode features
437 * Property searches:: Matching property values
438 * Property inheritance:: Passing values down the tree
439 * Column view:: Tabular viewing and editing
440 * Property API:: Properties for Lisp programmers
444 * Defining columns:: The COLUMNS format property
445 * Using column view:: How to create and use column view
446 * Capturing column view:: A dynamic block for column view
450 * Scope of column definitions:: Where defined, where valid?
451 * Column attributes:: Appearance and content of a column
455 * Timestamps:: Assigning a time to a tree entry
456 * Creating timestamps:: Commands which insert timestamps
457 * Deadlines and scheduling:: Planning your work
458 * Clocking work time:: Tracking how long you spend on a task
459 * Effort estimates:: Planning work effort in advance
460 * Relative timer:: Notes with a running timer
461 * Countdown timer:: Starting a countdown timer for a task
465 * The date/time prompt:: How Org-mode helps you entering date and time
466 * Custom time format:: Making dates look different
468 Deadlines and scheduling
470 * Inserting deadline/schedule:: Planning items
471 * Repeated tasks:: Items that show up again and again
475 * Clocking commands:: Starting and stopping a clock
476 * The clock table:: Detailed reports
477 * Resolving idle time:: Resolving time when you've been idle
479 Capture - Refile - Archive
481 * Capture:: Capturing new stuff
482 * Attachments:: Add files to tasks
483 * RSS Feeds:: Getting input from RSS feeds
484 * Protocols:: External (e.g. Browser) access to Emacs and Org
485 * Refiling notes:: Moving a tree from one place to another
486 * Archiving:: What to do with finished projects
490 * Setting up capture:: Where notes will be stored
491 * Using capture:: Commands to invoke and terminate capture
492 * Capture templates:: Define the outline of different note types
496 * Template elements:: What is needed for a complete template entry
497 * Template expansion:: Filling in information about time and context
501 * Moving subtrees:: Moving a tree to an archive file
502 * Internal archiving:: Switch off a tree but keep it in the file
506 * Agenda files:: Files being searched for agenda information
507 * Agenda dispatcher:: Keyboard access to agenda views
508 * Built-in agenda views:: What is available out of the box?
509 * Presentation and sorting:: How agenda items are prepared for display
510 * Agenda commands:: Remote editing of Org trees
511 * Custom agenda views:: Defining special searches and views
512 * Exporting Agenda Views:: Writing a view to a file
513 * Agenda column view:: Using column view for collected entries
515 The built-in agenda views
517 * Weekly/daily agenda:: The calendar page with current tasks
518 * Global TODO list:: All unfinished action items
519 * Matching tags and properties:: Structured information with fine-tuned search
520 * Timeline:: Time-sorted view for single file
521 * Search view:: Find entries by searching for text
522 * Stuck projects:: Find projects you need to review
524 Presentation and sorting
526 * Categories:: Not all tasks are equal
527 * Time-of-day specifications:: How the agenda knows the time
528 * Sorting of agenda items:: The order of things
532 * Storing searches:: Type once, use often
533 * Block agenda:: All the stuff you need in a single buffer
534 * Setting Options:: Changing the rules
536 Markup for rich export
538 * Structural markup elements:: The basic structure as seen by the exporter
539 * Images and tables:: Tables and Images will be included
540 * Literal examples:: Source code examples with special formatting
541 * Include files:: Include additional files into a document
542 * Index entries:: Making an index
543 * Macro replacement:: Use macros to create complex output
544 * Embedded LaTeX:: LaTeX can be freely used inside Org documents
546 Structural markup elements
548 * Document title:: Where the title is taken from
549 * Headings and sections:: The document structure as seen by the exporter
550 * Table of contents:: The if and where of the table of contents
551 * Initial text:: Text before the first heading?
553 * Paragraphs:: Paragraphs
554 * Footnote markup:: Footnotes
555 * Emphasis and monospace:: Bold, italic, etc.
556 * Horizontal rules:: Make a line
557 * Comment lines:: What will *not* be exported
561 * Special symbols:: Greek letters and other symbols
562 * Subscripts and superscripts:: Simple syntax for raising/lowering text
563 * LaTeX fragments:: Complex formulas made easy
564 * Previewing LaTeX fragments:: What will this snippet look like?
565 * CDLaTeX mode:: Speed up entering of formulas
569 * Selective export:: Using tags to select and exclude trees
570 * Export options:: Per-file export settings
571 * The export dispatcher:: How to access exporter commands
572 * ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export:: Exporting to flat files with encoding
573 * HTML export:: Exporting to HTML
574 * LaTeX and PDF export:: Exporting to @LaTeX{}, and processing to PDF
575 * DocBook export:: Exporting to DocBook
576 * TaskJuggler export:: Exporting to TaskJuggler
577 * Freemind export:: Exporting to Freemind mind maps
578 * XOXO export:: Exporting to XOXO
579 * iCalendar export:: Exporting in iCalendar format
583 * HTML Export commands:: How to invoke HTML export
584 * Quoting HTML tags:: Using direct HTML in Org-mode
585 * Links in HTML export:: How links will be interpreted and formatted
586 * Tables in HTML export:: How to modify the formatting of tables
587 * Images in HTML export:: How to insert figures into HTML output
588 * Math formatting in HTML export:: Beautiful math also on the web
589 * Text areas in HTML export:: An alternative way to show an example
590 * CSS support:: Changing the appearance of the output
591 * JavaScript support:: Info and Folding in a web browser
593 @LaTeX{} and PDF export
595 * LaTeX/PDF export commands:: Which key invokes which commands
596 * Header and sectioning:: Setting up the export file structure
597 * Quoting LaTeX code:: Incorporating literal @LaTeX{} code
598 * Tables in LaTeX export:: Options for exporting tables to @LaTeX{}
599 * Images in LaTeX export:: How to insert figures into @LaTeX{} output
600 * Beamer class export:: Turning the file into a presentation
604 * DocBook export commands:: How to invoke DocBook export
605 * Quoting DocBook code:: Incorporating DocBook code in Org files
606 * Recursive sections:: Recursive sections in DocBook
607 * Tables in DocBook export:: Tables are exported as HTML tables
608 * Images in DocBook export:: How to insert figures into DocBook output
609 * Special characters:: How to handle special characters
613 * Configuration:: Defining projects
614 * Uploading files:: How to get files up on the server
615 * Sample configuration:: Example projects
616 * Triggering publication:: Publication commands
620 * Project alist:: The central configuration variable
621 * Sources and destinations:: From here to there
622 * Selecting files:: What files are part of the project?
623 * Publishing action:: Setting the function doing the publishing
624 * Publishing options:: Tweaking HTML export
625 * Publishing links:: Which links keep working after publishing?
626 * Sitemap:: Generating a list of all pages
627 * Generating an index:: An index that reaches across pages
631 * Simple example:: One-component publishing
632 * Complex example:: A multi-component publishing example
634 Working with source code
636 * Structure of code blocks:: Code block syntax described
637 * Editing source code:: Language major-mode editing
638 * Exporting code blocks:: Export contents and/or results
639 * Extracting source code:: Create pure source code files
640 * Evaluating code blocks:: Place results of evaluation in the Org-mode buffer
641 * Library of Babel:: Use and contribute to a library of useful code blocks
642 * Languages:: List of supported code block languages
643 * Header arguments:: Configure code block functionality
644 * Results of evaluation:: How evaluation results are handled
645 * Noweb reference syntax:: Literate programming in Org-mode
646 * Key bindings and useful functions:: Work quickly with code blocks
647 * Batch execution:: Call functions from the command line
651 * Using header arguments:: Different ways to set header arguments
652 * Specific header arguments:: List of header arguments
654 Using header arguments
656 * System-wide header arguments:: Set global default values
657 * Language-specific header arguments:: Set default values by language
658 * Buffer-wide header arguments:: Set default values for a specific buffer
659 * Header arguments in Org-mode properties:: Set default values for a buffer or heading
660 * Code block specific header arguments:: The most common way to set values
661 * Header arguments in function calls:: The most specific level
663 Specific header arguments
665 * var:: Pass arguments to code blocks
666 * results:: Specify the type of results and how they will
667 be collected and handled
668 * file:: Specify a path for file output
669 * dir:: Specify the default (possibly remote)
670 directory for code block execution
671 * exports:: Export code and/or results
672 * tangle:: Toggle tangling and specify file name
673 * comments:: Toggle insertion of comments in tangled
675 * no-expand:: Turn off variable assignment and noweb
676 expansion during tangling
677 * session:: Preserve the state of code evaluation
678 * noweb:: Toggle expansion of noweb references
679 * cache:: Avoid re-evaluating unchanged code blocks
680 * sep:: Specify delimiter for writing external tables
681 * hlines:: Handle horizontal lines in tables
682 * colnames:: Handle column names in tables
683 * rownames:: Handle row names in tables
684 * shebang:: Make tangled files executable
685 * eval:: Limit evaluation of specific code blocks
689 * Completion:: M-TAB knows what you need
690 * Easy Templates:: Quick insertion of structural elements
691 * Speed keys:: Electric commands at the beginning of a headline
692 * Code evaluation security:: Org mode files evaluate inline code
693 * Customization:: Adapting Org to your taste
694 * In-buffer settings:: Overview of the #+KEYWORDS
695 * The very busy C-c C-c key:: When in doubt, press C-c C-c
696 * Clean view:: Getting rid of leading stars in the outline
697 * TTY keys:: Using Org on a tty
698 * Interaction:: Other Emacs packages
700 Interaction with other packages
702 * Cooperation:: Packages Org cooperates with
703 * Conflicts:: Packages that lead to conflicts
707 * Hooks:: Who to reach into Org's internals
708 * Add-on packages:: Available extensions
709 * Adding hyperlink types:: New custom link types
710 * Context-sensitive commands:: How to add functionality to such commands
711 * Tables in arbitrary syntax:: Orgtbl for @LaTeX{} and other programs
712 * Dynamic blocks:: Automatically filled blocks
713 * Special agenda views:: Customized views
714 * Extracting agenda information:: Postprocessing of agenda information
715 * Using the property API:: Writing programs that use entry properties
716 * Using the mapping API:: Mapping over all or selected entries
718 Tables and lists in arbitrary syntax
720 * Radio tables:: Sending and receiving radio tables
721 * A LaTeX example:: Step by step, almost a tutorial
722 * Translator functions:: Copy and modify
723 * Radio lists:: Doing the same for lists
727 * Setting up the staging area:: Where to interact with the mobile device
728 * Pushing to MobileOrg:: Uploading Org files and agendas
729 * Pulling from MobileOrg:: Integrating captured and flagged items
734 @node Introduction, Document Structure, Top, Top
735 @chapter Introduction
739 * Summary:: Brief summary of what Org does
740 * Installation:: How to install a downloaded version of Org
741 * Activation:: How to activate Org for certain buffers
742 * Feedback:: Bug reports, ideas, patches etc.
743 * Conventions:: Type-setting conventions in the manual
746 @node Summary, Installation, Introduction, Introduction
750 Org is a mode for keeping notes, maintaining TODO lists, and doing
751 project planning with a fast and effective plain-text system.
753 Org develops organizational tasks around NOTES files that contain
754 lists or information about projects as plain text. Org is
755 implemented on top of Outline mode, which makes it possible to keep the
756 content of large files well structured. Visibility cycling and
757 structure editing help to work with the tree. Tables are easily created
758 with a built-in table editor. Org supports TODO items, deadlines,
759 timestamps, and scheduling. It dynamically compiles entries into an
760 agenda that utilizes and smoothly integrates much of the Emacs calendar
761 and diary. Plain text URL-like links connect to websites, emails,
762 Usenet messages, BBDB entries, and any files related to the projects.
763 For printing and sharing of notes, an Org file can be exported as a
764 structured ASCII file, as HTML, or (TODO and agenda items only) as an
765 iCalendar file. It can also serve as a publishing tool for a set of
768 As a project planning environment, Org works by adding metadata to outline
769 nodes. Based on this data, specific entries can be extracted in queries and
770 create dynamic @i{agenda views}.
772 Org mode contains the Org Babel environment which allows you to work with
773 embedded source code blocks in a file, to facilitate code evaluation,
774 documentation, and tangling.
776 Org's automatic, context-sensitive table editor with spreadsheet
777 capabilities can be integrated into any major mode by activating the
778 minor Orgtbl mode. Using a translation step, it can be used to maintain
779 tables in arbitrary file types, for example in @LaTeX{}. The structure
780 editing and list creation capabilities can be used outside Org with
781 the minor Orgstruct mode.
783 Org keeps simple things simple. When first fired up, it should
784 feel like a straightforward, easy to use outliner. Complexity is not
785 imposed, but a large amount of functionality is available when you need
786 it. Org is a toolbox and can be used in different ways and for different
790 @r{@bullet{} an outline extension with visibility cycling and structure editing}
791 @r{@bullet{} an ASCII system and table editor for taking structured notes}
792 @r{@bullet{} a TODO list editor}
793 @r{@bullet{} a full agenda and planner with deadlines and work scheduling}
794 @pindex GTD, Getting Things Done
795 @r{@bullet{} an environment in which to implement David Allen's GTD system}
796 @r{@bullet{} a simple hypertext system, with HTML and @LaTeX{} export}
797 @r{@bullet{} a publishing tool to create a set of interlinked webpages}
798 @r{@bullet{} an environment for literate programming}
803 There is a website for Org which provides links to the newest
804 version of Org, as well as additional information, frequently asked
805 questions (FAQ), links to tutorials, etc@. This page is located at
806 @uref{http://orgmode.org}.
808 @cindex print edition
809 The version 7.3 of this manual is available as a
810 @uref{http://www.network-theory.co.uk/org/manual/, paperback book from Network
816 @node Installation, Activation, Summary, Introduction
817 @section Installation
821 @b{Important:} @i{If you are using a version of Org that is part of the Emacs
822 distribution or an XEmacs package, please skip this section and go directly
823 to @ref{Activation}.}
825 If you have downloaded Org from the Web, either as a distribution @file{.zip}
826 or @file{.tar} file, or as a Git archive, you must take the following steps
827 to install it: go into the unpacked Org distribution directory and edit the
828 top section of the file @file{Makefile}. You must set the name of the Emacs
829 binary (likely either @file{emacs} or @file{xemacs}), and the paths to the
830 directories where local Lisp and Info files are kept. If you don't have
831 access to the system-wide directories, you can simply run Org directly from
832 the distribution directory by adding the @file{lisp} subdirectory to the
833 Emacs load path. To do this, add the following line to @file{.emacs}:
836 (setq load-path (cons "~/path/to/orgdir/lisp" load-path))
840 If you plan to use code from the @file{contrib} subdirectory, do a similar
841 step for this directory:
844 (setq load-path (cons "~/path/to/orgdir/contrib/lisp" load-path))
847 @noindent Now byte-compile the Lisp files with the shell command:
853 @noindent If you are running Org from the distribution directory, this is
854 all. If you want to install Org into the system directories, use (as
861 Installing Info files is system dependent, because of differences in the
862 @file{install-info} program. In Debian it copies the info files into the
863 correct directory and modifies the info directory file. In many other
864 systems, the files need to be copied to the correct directory separately, and
865 @file{install-info} then only modifies the directory file. Check your system
866 documentation to find out which of the following commands you need:
870 make install-info-debian
873 Then add the following line to @file{.emacs}. It is needed so that
874 Emacs can autoload functions that are located in files not immediately loaded
875 when Org-mode starts.
877 (require 'org-install)
880 Do not forget to activate Org as described in the following section.
883 @node Activation, Feedback, Installation, Introduction
887 @cindex global key bindings
888 @cindex key bindings, global
890 To make sure files with extension @file{.org} use Org mode, add the following
891 line to your @file{.emacs} file.
893 (add-to-list 'auto-mode-alist '("\\.org\\'" . org-mode))
895 @noindent Org mode buffers need font-lock to be turned on - this is the
896 default in Emacs@footnote{If you don't use font-lock globally, turn it on in
897 Org buffer with @code{(add-hook 'org-mode-hook 'turn-on-font-lock)}}.
899 The four Org commands @command{org-store-link}, @command{org-capture},
900 @command{org-agenda}, and @command{org-iswitchb} should be accessible through
901 global keys (i.e. anywhere in Emacs, not just in Org buffers). Here are
902 suggested bindings for these keys, please modify the keys to your own
905 (global-set-key "\C-cl" 'org-store-link)
906 (global-set-key "\C-cc" 'org-capture)
907 (global-set-key "\C-ca" 'org-agenda)
908 (global-set-key "\C-cb" 'org-iswitchb)
911 @cindex Org-mode, turning on
912 With this setup, all files with extension @samp{.org} will be put
913 into Org-mode. As an alternative, make the first line of a file look
917 MY PROJECTS -*- mode: org; -*-
920 @vindex org-insert-mode-line-in-empty-file
921 @noindent which will select Org-mode for this buffer no matter what
922 the file's name is. See also the variable
923 @code{org-insert-mode-line-in-empty-file}.
925 Many commands in Org work on the region if the region is @i{active}. To make
926 use of this, you need to have @code{transient-mark-mode}
927 (@code{zmacs-regions} in XEmacs) turned on. In Emacs 23 this is the default,
928 in Emacs 22 you need to do this yourself with
930 (transient-mark-mode 1)
932 @noindent If you do not like @code{transient-mark-mode}, you can create an
933 active region by using the mouse to select a region, or pressing
934 @kbd{C-@key{SPC}} twice before moving the cursor.
936 @node Feedback, Conventions, Activation, Introduction
943 If you find problems with Org, or if you have questions, remarks, or ideas
944 about it, please mail to the Org mailing list @email{emacs-orgmode@@gnu.org}.
945 If you are not a member of the mailing list, your mail will be passed to the
946 list after a moderator has approved it@footnote{Please consider subscribing
947 to the mailing list, in order to minimize the work the mailing list
948 moderators have to do.}.
950 For bug reports, please first try to reproduce the bug with the latest
951 version of Org available---if you are running an outdated version, it is
952 quite possible that the bug has been fixed already. If the bug persists,
953 prepare a report and provide as much information as possible, including the
954 version information of Emacs (@kbd{M-x emacs-version @key{RET}}) and Org
955 (@kbd{M-x org-version @key{RET}}), as well as the Org related setup in
956 @file{.emacs}. The easiest way to do this is to use the command
958 @kbd{M-x org-submit-bug-report}
960 @noindent which will put all this information into an Emacs mail buffer so
961 that you only need to add your description. If you re not sending the Email
962 from within Emacs, please copy and paste the content into your Email program.
964 If an error occurs, a backtrace can be very useful (see below on how to
965 create one). Often a small example file helps, along with clear information
969 @item What exactly did you do?
970 @item What did you expect to happen?
971 @item What happened instead?
973 @noindent Thank you for helping to improve this program.
975 @subsubheading How to create a useful backtrace
977 @cindex backtrace of an error
978 If working with Org produces an error with a message you don't
979 understand, you may have hit a bug. The best way to report this is by
980 providing, in addition to what was mentioned above, a @emph{backtrace}.
981 This is information from the built-in debugger about where and how the
982 error occurred. Here is how to produce a useful backtrace:
986 Reload uncompiled versions of all Org-mode Lisp files. The backtrace
987 contains much more information if it is produced with uncompiled code.
990 C-u M-x org-reload RET
993 or select @code{Org -> Refresh/Reload -> Reload Org uncompiled} from the
996 Go to the @code{Options} menu and select @code{Enter Debugger on Error}
997 (XEmacs has this option in the @code{Troubleshooting} sub-menu).
999 Do whatever you have to do to hit the error. Don't forget to
1000 document the steps you take.
1002 When you hit the error, a @file{*Backtrace*} buffer will appear on the
1003 screen. Save this buffer to a file (for example using @kbd{C-x C-w}) and
1004 attach it to your bug report.
1007 @node Conventions, , Feedback, Introduction
1008 @section Typesetting conventions used in this manual
1010 Org uses three types of keywords: TODO keywords, tags, and property
1011 names. In this manual we use the following conventions:
1016 TODO keywords are written with all capitals, even if they are
1020 User-defined tags are written in lowercase; built-in tags with special
1021 meaning are written with all capitals.
1024 User-defined properties are capitalized; built-in properties with
1025 special meaning are written with all capitals.
1028 The manual lists both the keys and the corresponding commands for accessing
1029 functionality. Org mode often uses the same key for different functions,
1030 depending on context. The command that is bound to such keys has a generic
1031 name, like @code{org-metaright}. In the manual we will, wherever possible,
1032 give the function that is internally called by the generic command. For
1033 example, in the chapter on document structure, @kbd{M-@key{right}} will be
1034 listed to call @code{org-do-demote}, while in the chapter on tables, it will
1035 be listed to call org-table-move-column-right.
1037 If you prefer, you can compile the manual without the command names by
1038 unsetting the flag @code{cmdnames} in @file{org.texi}.
1040 @node Document Structure, Tables, Introduction, Top
1041 @chapter Document structure
1042 @cindex document structure
1043 @cindex structure of document
1045 Org is based on Outline mode and provides flexible commands to
1046 edit the structure of the document.
1049 * Outlines:: Org is based on Outline mode
1050 * Headlines:: How to typeset Org tree headlines
1051 * Visibility cycling:: Show and hide, much simplified
1052 * Motion:: Jumping to other headlines
1053 * Structure editing:: Changing sequence and level of headlines
1054 * Sparse trees:: Matches embedded in context
1055 * Plain lists:: Additional structure within an entry
1056 * Drawers:: Tucking stuff away
1057 * Blocks:: Folding blocks
1058 * Footnotes:: How footnotes are defined in Org's syntax
1059 * Orgstruct mode:: Structure editing outside Org
1062 @node Outlines, Headlines, Document Structure, Document Structure
1065 @cindex Outline mode
1067 Org is implemented on top of Outline mode. Outlines allow a
1068 document to be organized in a hierarchical structure, which (at least
1069 for me) is the best representation of notes and thoughts. An overview
1070 of this structure is achieved by folding (hiding) large parts of the
1071 document to show only the general document structure and the parts
1072 currently being worked on. Org greatly simplifies the use of
1073 outlines by compressing the entire show/hide functionality into a single
1074 command, @command{org-cycle}, which is bound to the @key{TAB} key.
1076 @node Headlines, Visibility cycling, Outlines, Document Structure
1079 @cindex outline tree
1080 @vindex org-special-ctrl-a/e
1081 @vindex org-special-ctrl-k
1082 @vindex org-ctrl-k-protect-subtree
1084 Headlines define the structure of an outline tree. The headlines in Org
1085 start with one or more stars, on the left margin@footnote{See the variables
1086 @code{org-special-ctrl-a/e}, @code{org-special-ctrl-k}, and
1087 @code{org-ctrl-k-protect-subtree} to configure special behavior of @kbd{C-a},
1088 @kbd{C-e}, and @kbd{C-k} in headlines.}. For example:
1091 * Top level headline
1098 * Another top level headline
1101 @noindent Some people find the many stars too noisy and would prefer an
1102 outline that has whitespace followed by a single star as headline
1103 starters. @ref{Clean view}, describes a setup to realize this.
1105 @vindex org-cycle-separator-lines
1106 An empty line after the end of a subtree is considered part of it and
1107 will be hidden when the subtree is folded. However, if you leave at
1108 least two empty lines, one empty line will remain visible after folding
1109 the subtree, in order to structure the collapsed view. See the
1110 variable @code{org-cycle-separator-lines} to modify this behavior.
1112 @node Visibility cycling, Motion, Headlines, Document Structure
1113 @section Visibility cycling
1114 @cindex cycling, visibility
1115 @cindex visibility cycling
1116 @cindex trees, visibility
1117 @cindex show hidden text
1120 Outlines make it possible to hide parts of the text in the buffer.
1121 Org uses just two commands, bound to @key{TAB} and
1122 @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} to change the visibility in the buffer.
1124 @cindex subtree visibility states
1125 @cindex subtree cycling
1126 @cindex folded, subtree visibility state
1127 @cindex children, subtree visibility state
1128 @cindex subtree, subtree visibility state
1130 @orgcmd{@key{TAB},org-cycle}
1131 @emph{Subtree cycling}: Rotate current subtree among the states
1134 ,-> FOLDED -> CHILDREN -> SUBTREE --.
1135 '-----------------------------------'
1138 @vindex org-cycle-emulate-tab
1139 @vindex org-cycle-global-at-bob
1140 The cursor must be on a headline for this to work@footnote{see, however,
1141 the option @code{org-cycle-emulate-tab}.}. When the cursor is at the
1142 beginning of the buffer and the first line is not a headline, then
1143 @key{TAB} actually runs global cycling (see below)@footnote{see the
1144 option @code{org-cycle-global-at-bob}.}. Also when called with a prefix
1145 argument (@kbd{C-u @key{TAB}}), global cycling is invoked.
1147 @cindex global visibility states
1148 @cindex global cycling
1149 @cindex overview, global visibility state
1150 @cindex contents, global visibility state
1151 @cindex show all, global visibility state
1152 @orgcmd{S-@key{TAB},org-global-cycle}
1153 @itemx C-u @key{TAB}
1154 @emph{Global cycling}: Rotate the entire buffer among the states
1157 ,-> OVERVIEW -> CONTENTS -> SHOW ALL --.
1158 '--------------------------------------'
1161 When @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} is called with a numeric prefix argument N, the
1162 CONTENTS view up to headlines of level N will be shown. Note that inside
1163 tables, @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} jumps to the previous field.
1165 @cindex show all, command
1166 @orgcmd{C-u C-u C-u @key{TAB},show-all}
1167 Show all, including drawers.
1168 @orgcmd{C-c C-r,org-reveal}
1169 Reveal context around point, showing the current entry, the following heading
1170 and the hierarchy above. Useful for working near a location that has been
1171 exposed by a sparse tree command (@pxref{Sparse trees}) or an agenda command
1172 (@pxref{Agenda commands}). With a prefix argument show, on each
1173 level, all sibling headings. With double prefix arg, also show the entire
1174 subtree of the parent.
1175 @orgcmd{C-c C-k,show-branches}
1176 Expose all the headings of the subtree, CONTENT view for just one subtree.
1177 @orgcmd{C-c C-x b,org-tree-to-indirect-buffer}
1178 Show the current subtree in an indirect buffer@footnote{The indirect
1181 (@pxref{Indirect Buffers,,,emacs,GNU Emacs Manual})
1184 (see the Emacs manual for more information about indirect buffers)
1186 will contain the entire buffer, but will be narrowed to the current
1187 tree. Editing the indirect buffer will also change the original buffer,
1188 but without affecting visibility in that buffer.}. With a numeric
1189 prefix argument N, go up to level N and then take that tree. If N is
1190 negative then go up that many levels. With a @kbd{C-u} prefix, do not remove
1191 the previously used indirect buffer.
1194 @vindex org-startup-folded
1195 @cindex @code{overview}, STARTUP keyword
1196 @cindex @code{content}, STARTUP keyword
1197 @cindex @code{showall}, STARTUP keyword
1198 @cindex @code{showeverything}, STARTUP keyword
1200 When Emacs first visits an Org file, the global state is set to
1201 OVERVIEW, i.e. only the top level headlines are visible. This can be
1202 configured through the variable @code{org-startup-folded}, or on a
1203 per-file basis by adding one of the following lines anywhere in the
1210 #+STARTUP: showeverything
1213 @cindex property, VISIBILITY
1215 Furthermore, any entries with a @samp{VISIBILITY} property (@pxref{Properties
1216 and Columns}) will get their visibility adapted accordingly. Allowed values
1217 for this property are @code{folded}, @code{children}, @code{content}, and
1220 @orgcmd{C-u C-u @key{TAB},org-set-startup-visibility}
1221 Switch back to the startup visibility of the buffer, i.e. whatever is
1222 requested by startup options and @samp{VISIBILITY} properties in individual
1226 @node Motion, Structure editing, Visibility cycling, Document Structure
1228 @cindex motion, between headlines
1229 @cindex jumping, to headlines
1230 @cindex headline navigation
1231 The following commands jump to other headlines in the buffer.
1234 @orgcmd{C-c C-n,outline-next-visible-heading}
1236 @orgcmd{C-c C-p,outline-previous-visible-heading}
1238 @orgcmd{C-c C-f,org-forward-same-level}
1239 Next heading same level.
1240 @orgcmd{C-c C-b,org-backward-same-level}
1241 Previous heading same level.
1242 @orgcmd{C-c C-u,outline-up-heading}
1243 Backward to higher level heading.
1244 @orgcmd{C-c C-j,org-goto}
1245 Jump to a different place without changing the current outline
1246 visibility. Shows the document structure in a temporary buffer, where
1247 you can use the following keys to find your destination:
1248 @vindex org-goto-auto-isearch
1250 @key{TAB} @r{Cycle visibility.}
1251 @key{down} / @key{up} @r{Next/previous visible headline.}
1252 @key{RET} @r{Select this location.}
1253 @kbd{/} @r{Do a Sparse-tree search}
1254 @r{The following keys work if you turn off @code{org-goto-auto-isearch}}
1255 n / p @r{Next/previous visible headline.}
1256 f / b @r{Next/previous headline same level.}
1258 0-9 @r{Digit argument.}
1261 @vindex org-goto-interface
1263 See also the variable @code{org-goto-interface}.
1266 @node Structure editing, Sparse trees, Motion, Document Structure
1267 @section Structure editing
1268 @cindex structure editing
1269 @cindex headline, promotion and demotion
1270 @cindex promotion, of subtrees
1271 @cindex demotion, of subtrees
1272 @cindex subtree, cut and paste
1273 @cindex pasting, of subtrees
1274 @cindex cutting, of subtrees
1275 @cindex copying, of subtrees
1276 @cindex sorting, of subtrees
1277 @cindex subtrees, cut and paste
1280 @orgcmd{M-@key{RET},org-insert-heading}
1281 @vindex org-M-RET-may-split-line
1282 Insert new heading with same level as current. If the cursor is in a
1283 plain list item, a new item is created (@pxref{Plain lists}). To force
1284 creation of a new headline, use a prefix argument, or first press @key{RET}
1285 to get to the beginning of the next line. When this command is used in
1286 the middle of a line, the line is split and the rest of the line becomes
1287 the new headline@footnote{If you do not want the line to be split,
1288 customize the variable @code{org-M-RET-may-split-line}.}. If the
1289 command is used at the beginning of a headline, the new headline is
1290 created before the current line. If at the beginning of any other line,
1291 the content of that line is made the new heading. If the command is
1292 used at the end of a folded subtree (i.e. behind the ellipses at the end
1293 of a headline), then a headline like the current one will be inserted
1294 after the end of the subtree.
1295 @orgcmd{C-@key{RET},org-insert-heading-respect-content}
1296 Just like @kbd{M-@key{RET}}, except when adding a new heading below the
1297 current heading, the new heading is placed after the body instead of before
1298 it. This command works from anywhere in the entry.
1299 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{RET},org-insert-todo-heading}
1300 @vindex org-treat-insert-todo-heading-as-state-change
1301 Insert new TODO entry with same level as current heading. See also the
1302 variable @code{org-treat-insert-todo-heading-as-state-change}.
1303 @orgcmd{C-S-@key{RET},org-insert-todo-heading-respect-content}
1304 Insert new TODO entry with same level as current heading. Like
1305 @kbd{C-@key{RET}}, the new headline will be inserted after the current
1307 @orgcmd{@key{TAB},org-cycle}
1308 In a new entry with no text yet, the first @key{TAB} demotes the entry to
1309 become a child of the previous one. The next @key{TAB} makes it a parent,
1310 and so on, all the way to top level. Yet another @key{TAB}, and you are back
1311 to the initial level.
1312 @orgcmd{M-@key{left},org-do-promote}
1313 Promote current heading by one level.
1314 @orgcmd{M-@key{right},org-do-demote}
1315 Demote current heading by one level.
1316 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{left},org-promote-subtree}
1317 Promote the current subtree by one level.
1318 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{right},org-demote-subtree}
1319 Demote the current subtree by one level.
1320 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{up},org-move-subtree-up}
1321 Move subtree up (swap with previous subtree of same
1323 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{down},org-move-subtree-down}
1324 Move subtree down (swap with next subtree of same level).
1325 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-w,org-cut-subtree}
1326 Kill subtree, i.e. remove it from buffer but save in kill ring.
1327 With a numeric prefix argument N, kill N sequential subtrees.
1328 @orgcmd{C-c C-x M-w,org-copy-subtree}
1329 Copy subtree to kill ring. With a numeric prefix argument N, copy the N
1330 sequential subtrees.
1331 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-y,org-paste-subtree}
1332 Yank subtree from kill ring. This does modify the level of the subtree to
1333 make sure the tree fits in nicely at the yank position. The yank level can
1334 also be specified with a numeric prefix argument, or by yanking after a
1335 headline marker like @samp{****}.
1336 @orgcmd{C-y,org-yank}
1337 @vindex org-yank-adjusted-subtrees
1338 @vindex org-yank-folded-subtrees
1339 Depending on the variables @code{org-yank-adjusted-subtrees} and
1340 @code{org-yank-folded-subtrees}, Org's internal @code{yank} command will
1341 paste subtrees folded and in a clever way, using the same command as @kbd{C-c
1342 C-x C-y}. With the default settings, no level adjustment will take place,
1343 but the yanked tree will be folded unless doing so would swallow text
1344 previously visible. Any prefix argument to this command will force a normal
1345 @code{yank} to be executed, with the prefix passed along. A good way to
1346 force a normal yank is @kbd{C-u C-y}. If you use @code{yank-pop} after a
1347 yank, it will yank previous kill items plainly, without adjustment and
1349 @orgcmd{C-c C-x c,org-clone-subtree-with-time-shift}
1350 Clone a subtree by making a number of sibling copies of it. You will be
1351 prompted for the number of copies to make, and you can also specify if any
1352 timestamps in the entry should be shifted. This can be useful, for example,
1353 to create a number of tasks related to a series of lectures to prepare. For
1354 more details, see the docstring of the command
1355 @code{org-clone-subtree-with-time-shift}.
1356 @orgcmd{C-c C-w,org-refile}
1357 Refile entry or region to a different location. @xref{Refiling notes}.
1358 @orgcmd{C-c ^,org-sort-entries-or-items}
1359 Sort same-level entries. When there is an active region, all entries in the
1360 region will be sorted. Otherwise the children of the current headline are
1361 sorted. The command prompts for the sorting method, which can be
1362 alphabetically, numerically, by time (first timestamp with active preferred,
1363 creation time, scheduled time, deadline time), by priority, by TODO keyword
1364 (in the sequence the keywords have been defined in the setup) or by the value
1365 of a property. Reverse sorting is possible as well. You can also supply
1366 your own function to extract the sorting key. With a @kbd{C-u} prefix,
1367 sorting will be case-sensitive. With two @kbd{C-u C-u} prefixes, duplicate
1368 entries will also be removed.
1369 @orgcmd{C-x n s,org-narrow-to-subtree}
1370 Narrow buffer to current subtree.
1371 @orgcmd{C-x n w,widen}
1372 Widen buffer to remove narrowing.
1373 @orgcmd{C-c *,org-toggle-heading}
1374 Turn a normal line or plain list item into a headline (so that it becomes a
1375 subheading at its location). Also turn a headline into a normal line by
1376 removing the stars. If there is an active region, turn all lines in the
1377 region into headlines. If the first line in the region was an item, turn
1378 only the item lines into headlines. Finally, if the first line is a
1379 headline, remove the stars from all headlines in the region.
1382 @cindex region, active
1383 @cindex active region
1384 @cindex transient mark mode
1385 When there is an active region (Transient Mark mode), promotion and
1386 demotion work on all headlines in the region. To select a region of
1387 headlines, it is best to place both point and mark at the beginning of a
1388 line, mark at the beginning of the first headline, and point at the line
1389 just after the last headline to change. Note that when the cursor is
1390 inside a table (@pxref{Tables}), the Meta-Cursor keys have different
1394 @node Sparse trees, Plain lists, Structure editing, Document Structure
1395 @section Sparse trees
1396 @cindex sparse trees
1397 @cindex trees, sparse
1398 @cindex folding, sparse trees
1399 @cindex occur, command
1401 @vindex org-show-hierarchy-above
1402 @vindex org-show-following-heading
1403 @vindex org-show-siblings
1404 @vindex org-show-entry-below
1405 An important feature of Org-mode is the ability to construct @emph{sparse
1406 trees} for selected information in an outline tree, so that the entire
1407 document is folded as much as possible, but the selected information is made
1408 visible along with the headline structure above it@footnote{See also the
1409 variables @code{org-show-hierarchy-above}, @code{org-show-following-heading},
1410 @code{org-show-siblings}, and @code{org-show-entry-below} for detailed
1411 control on how much context is shown around each match.}. Just try it out
1412 and you will see immediately how it works.
1414 Org-mode contains several commands creating such trees, all these
1415 commands can be accessed through a dispatcher:
1418 @orgcmd{C-c /,org-sparse-tree}
1419 This prompts for an extra key to select a sparse-tree creating command.
1420 @orgcmd{C-c / r,org-occur}
1421 @vindex org-remove-highlights-with-change
1422 Occur. Prompts for a regexp and shows a sparse tree with all matches. If
1423 the match is in a headline, the headline is made visible. If the match is in
1424 the body of an entry, headline and body are made visible. In order to
1425 provide minimal context, also the full hierarchy of headlines above the match
1426 is shown, as well as the headline following the match. Each match is also
1427 highlighted; the highlights disappear when the buffer is changed by an
1428 editing command@footnote{This depends on the option
1429 @code{org-remove-highlights-with-change}}, or by pressing @kbd{C-c C-c}.
1430 When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix argument, previous highlights are kept,
1431 so several calls to this command can be stacked.
1435 @vindex org-agenda-custom-commands
1436 For frequently used sparse trees of specific search strings, you can
1437 use the variable @code{org-agenda-custom-commands} to define fast
1438 keyboard access to specific sparse trees. These commands will then be
1439 accessible through the agenda dispatcher (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}).
1443 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
1444 '(("f" occur-tree "FIXME")))
1447 @noindent will define the key @kbd{C-c a f} as a shortcut for creating
1448 a sparse tree matching the string @samp{FIXME}.
1450 The other sparse tree commands select headings based on TODO keywords,
1451 tags, or properties and will be discussed later in this manual.
1454 @cindex printing sparse trees
1455 @cindex visible text, printing
1456 To print a sparse tree, you can use the Emacs command
1457 @code{ps-print-buffer-with-faces} which does not print invisible parts
1458 of the document @footnote{This does not work under XEmacs, because
1459 XEmacs uses selective display for outlining, not text properties.}.
1460 Or you can use the command @kbd{C-c C-e v} to export only the visible
1461 part of the document and print the resulting file.
1463 @node Plain lists, Drawers, Sparse trees, Document Structure
1464 @section Plain lists
1466 @cindex lists, plain
1467 @cindex lists, ordered
1468 @cindex ordered lists
1470 Within an entry of the outline tree, hand-formatted lists can provide
1471 additional structure. They also provide a way to create lists of checkboxes
1472 (@pxref{Checkboxes}). Org supports editing such lists, and every exporter
1473 (@pxref{Exporting}) can parse and format them.
1475 Org knows ordered lists, unordered lists, and description lists.
1478 @emph{Unordered} list items start with @samp{-}, @samp{+}, or
1479 @samp{*}@footnote{When using @samp{*} as a bullet, lines must be indented or
1480 they will be seen as top-level headlines. Also, when you are hiding leading
1481 stars to get a clean outline view, plain list items starting with a star are
1482 visually indistinguishable from true headlines. In short: even though
1483 @samp{*} is supported, it may be better to not use it for plain list items.}
1486 @vindex org-plain-list-ordered-item-terminator
1487 @emph{Ordered} list items start with a numeral followed by either a period or
1488 a right parenthesis@footnote{You can filter out any of them by configuring
1489 @code{org-plain-list-ordered-item-terminator}.}, such as @samp{1.} or
1490 @samp{1)}. If you want a list to start with a different value (e.g. 20), start
1491 the text of the item with @code{[@@20]}@footnote{If there's a checkbox in the
1492 item, the cookie must be put @emph{before} the checkbox.}. Those constructs
1493 can be used in any item of the list in order to enforce a particular
1496 @emph{Description} list items are unordered list items, and contain the
1497 separator @samp{ :: } to separate the description @emph{term} from the
1501 Items belonging to the same list must have the same indentation on the first
1502 line. In particular, if an ordered list reaches number @samp{10.}, then the
1503 2--digit numbers must be written left-aligned with the other numbers in the
1506 @vindex org-list-ending-method
1507 @vindex org-list-end-regexp
1508 @vindex org-empty-line-terminates-plain-lists
1509 Two methods@footnote{To disable either of them, configure
1510 @code{org-list-ending-method}.} are provided to terminate lists. A list ends
1511 before the next line that is indented like the bullet/number or less, or it
1512 ends before two blank lines@footnote{See also
1513 @code{org-empty-line-terminates-plain-lists}.}. In both cases, all levels of
1514 the list are closed@footnote{So you cannot have a sublist, some text and then
1515 another sublist while still in the same top-level list item. This used to be
1516 possible, but it was only supported in the HTML exporter and difficult to
1517 manage with automatic indentation.}. For finer control, you can end lists
1518 with any pattern set in @code{org-list-end-regexp}. Here is an example:
1522 ** Lord of the Rings
1523 My favorite scenes are (in this order)
1524 1. The attack of the Rohirrim
1525 2. Eowyn's fight with the witch king
1526 + this was already my favorite scene in the book
1527 + I really like Miranda Otto.
1528 3. Peter Jackson being shot by Legolas
1529 He makes a really funny face when it happens.
1531 But in the end, no individual scenes matter but the film as a whole.
1532 Important actors in this film are:
1533 - @b{Elijah Wood} :: He plays Frodo
1534 - @b{Sean Austin} :: He plays Sam, Frodo's friend. I still remember
1535 him very well from his role as Mikey Walsh in @i{The Goonies}.
1539 Org supports these lists by tuning filling and wrapping commands to deal with
1540 them correctly@footnote{Org only changes the filling settings for Emacs. For
1541 XEmacs, you should use Kyle E. Jones' @file{filladapt.el}. To turn this on,
1542 put into @file{.emacs}: @code{(require 'filladapt)}}, and by exporting them
1543 properly (@pxref{Exporting}). Since indentation is what governs the
1544 structure of these lists, many structural constructs like @code{#+BEGIN_...}
1545 blocks can be indented to signal that they should be considered as a list
1548 @vindex org-list-demote-modify-bullet
1549 If you find that using a different bullet for a sub-list (than that used for
1550 the current list-level) improves readability, customize the variable
1551 @code{org-list-demote-modify-bullet}.
1553 @vindex org-list-automatic-rules
1554 The following commands act on items when the cursor is in the first line of
1555 an item (the line with the bullet or number). Some of them imply the
1556 application of automatic rules to keep list structure intact. If some of
1557 these actions get in your way, configure @code{org-list-automatic-rules}
1558 to disable them individually.
1561 @orgcmd{@key{TAB},org-cycle}
1562 @vindex org-cycle-include-plain-lists
1563 Items can be folded just like headline levels. Normally this works only if
1564 the cursor is on a plain list item. For more details, see the variable
1565 @code{org-cycle-include-plain-lists}. If this variable is set to
1566 @code{integrate}, plain list items will be treated like low-level
1567 headlines. The level of an item is then given by the
1568 indentation of the bullet/number. Items are always subordinate to real
1569 headlines, however; the hierarchies remain completely separated.
1570 @orgcmd{M-@key{RET},org-insert-heading}
1571 @vindex org-M-RET-may-split-line
1572 @vindex org-list-automatic-rules
1573 Insert new item at current level. With a prefix argument, force a new
1574 heading (@pxref{Structure editing}). If this command is used in the middle
1575 of a line, the line is @emph{split} and the rest of the line becomes the new
1576 item@footnote{If you do not want the line to be split, customize the variable
1577 @code{org-M-RET-may-split-line}.}. If this command is executed @emph{before
1578 an item's body}, the new item is created @emph{before} the current item. If the
1579 command is executed in the white space before the text that is part of an
1580 item but does not contain the bullet, a bullet is added to the current line.
1582 As a new item cannot be inserted in a structural construct (like an example
1583 or source code block) within a list, Org will instead insert it right before
1584 the structure, or return an error.
1585 @kindex M-S-@key{RET}
1587 Insert a new item with a checkbox (@pxref{Checkboxes}).
1588 @orgcmd{@key{TAB},org-cycle}
1589 In a new item with no text yet, the first @key{TAB} demotes the item to
1590 become a child of the previous one. Subsequent @key{TAB}s move the item to
1591 meaningful levels in the list and eventually get it back to its initial
1593 @kindex S-@key{down}
1596 @cindex shift-selection-mode
1597 @vindex org-support-shift-select
1598 Jump to the previous/next item in the current list, but only if
1599 @code{org-support-shift-select} is off. If not, you can still use paragraph
1600 jumping commands like @kbd{C-@key{up}} and @kbd{C-@key{down}} to quite
1602 @kindex M-S-@key{up}
1603 @kindex M-S-@key{down}
1605 @itemx M-S-@key{down}
1606 Move the item including subitems up/down (swap with previous/next item
1607 of same indentation). If the list is ordered, renumbering is
1609 @kindex M-@key{left}
1610 @kindex M-@key{right}
1612 @itemx M-@key{right}
1613 Decrease/increase the indentation of an item, leaving children alone.
1614 @kindex M-S-@key{left}
1615 @kindex M-S-@key{right}
1616 @item M-S-@key{left}
1617 @itemx M-S-@key{right}
1618 Decrease/increase the indentation of the item, including subitems.
1619 Initially, the item tree is selected based on current indentation. When
1620 these commands are executed several times in direct succession, the initially
1621 selected region is used, even if the new indentation would imply a different
1622 hierarchy. To use the new hierarchy, break the command chain with a cursor
1625 As a special case, using this command on the very first item of a list will
1626 move the whole list. This behavior can be disabled by configuring
1627 @code{org-list-automatic-rules}. The global indentation of a list has no
1628 influence on the text @emph{after} the list.
1631 If there is a checkbox (@pxref{Checkboxes}) in the item line, toggle the
1632 state of the checkbox. Also, makes sure that all the
1633 items on this list level use the same bullet and that the numbering of list
1634 items (if applicable) is correct.
1636 @vindex org-plain-list-ordered-item-terminator
1637 @vindex org-list-automatic-rules
1639 Cycle the entire list level through the different itemize/enumerate bullets
1640 (@samp{-}, @samp{+}, @samp{*}, @samp{1.}, @samp{1)}) or a subset of them,
1641 depending on @code{org-plain-list-ordered-item-terminator}, the type of list,
1642 and its position@footnote{See @code{bullet} rule in
1643 @code{org-list-automatic-rules} for more information.}. With a numeric
1644 prefix argument N, select the Nth bullet from this list. If there is an
1645 active region when calling this, all lines will be converted to list items.
1646 If the first line already was a list item, any item markers will be removed
1647 from the list. Finally, even without an active region, a normal line will be
1648 converted into a list item.
1651 Turn a plain list item into a headline (so that it becomes a subheading at
1652 its location). @xref{Structure editing}, for a detailed explanation.
1653 @kindex S-@key{left}
1654 @kindex S-@key{right}
1655 @item S-@key{left}/@key{right}
1656 @vindex org-support-shift-select
1657 This command also cycles bullet styles when the cursor in on the bullet or
1658 anywhere in an item line, details depending on
1659 @code{org-support-shift-select}.
1662 Sort the plain list. You will be prompted for the sorting method:
1663 numerically, alphabetically, by time, or by custom function.
1666 @node Drawers, Blocks, Plain lists, Document Structure
1670 @cindex visibility cycling, drawers
1673 Sometimes you want to keep information associated with an entry, but you
1674 normally don't want to see it. For this, Org-mode has @emph{drawers}.
1675 Drawers need to be configured with the variable
1676 @code{org-drawers}@footnote{You can define drawers on a per-file basis
1677 with a line like @code{#+DRAWERS: HIDDEN PROPERTIES STATE}}. Drawers
1681 ** This is a headline
1682 Still outside the drawer
1684 This is inside the drawer.
1689 Visibility cycling (@pxref{Visibility cycling}) on the headline will hide and
1690 show the entry, but keep the drawer collapsed to a single line. In order to
1691 look inside the drawer, you need to move the cursor to the drawer line and
1692 press @key{TAB} there. Org-mode uses the @code{PROPERTIES} drawer for
1693 storing properties (@pxref{Properties and Columns}), and you can also arrange
1694 for state change notes (@pxref{Tracking TODO state changes}) and clock times
1695 (@pxref{Clocking work time}) to be stored in a drawer @code{LOGBOOK}. If you
1696 want to store a quick note in the LOGBOOK drawer, in a similar way to state changes, use
1701 Add a time-stamped note to the LOGBOOK drawer.
1704 @node Blocks, Footnotes, Drawers, Document Structure
1707 @vindex org-hide-block-startup
1708 @cindex blocks, folding
1709 Org-mode uses begin...end blocks for various purposes from including source
1710 code examples (@pxref{Literal examples}) to capturing time logging
1711 information (@pxref{Clocking work time}). These blocks can be folded and
1712 unfolded by pressing TAB in the begin line. You can also get all blocks
1713 folded at startup by configuring the variable @code{org-hide-block-startup}
1714 or on a per-file basis by using
1716 @cindex @code{hideblocks}, STARTUP keyword
1717 @cindex @code{nohideblocks}, STARTUP keyword
1719 #+STARTUP: hideblocks
1720 #+STARTUP: nohideblocks
1723 @node Footnotes, Orgstruct mode, Blocks, Document Structure
1727 Org-mode supports the creation of footnotes. In contrast to the
1728 @file{footnote.el} package, Org-mode's footnotes are designed for work on a
1729 larger document, not only for one-off documents like emails. The basic
1730 syntax is similar to the one used by @file{footnote.el}, i.e. a footnote is
1731 defined in a paragraph that is started by a footnote marker in square
1732 brackets in column 0, no indentation allowed. If you need a paragraph break
1733 inside a footnote, use the @LaTeX{} idiom @samp{\par}. The footnote reference
1734 is simply the marker in square brackets, inside text. For example:
1737 The Org homepage[fn:1] now looks a lot better than it used to.
1739 [fn:1] The link is: http://orgmode.org
1742 Org-mode extends the number-based syntax to @emph{named} footnotes and
1743 optional inline definition. Using plain numbers as markers (as
1744 @file{footnote.el} does) is supported for backward compatibility, but not
1745 encouraged because of possible conflicts with @LaTeX{} snippets (@pxref{Embedded
1746 LaTeX}). Here are the valid references:
1750 A plain numeric footnote marker. Compatible with @file{footnote.el}, but not
1751 recommended because something like @samp{[1]} could easily be part of a code
1754 A named footnote reference, where @code{name} is a unique label word, or, for
1755 simplicity of automatic creation, a number.
1756 @item [fn:: This is the inline definition of this footnote]
1757 A @LaTeX{}-like anonymous footnote where the definition is given directly at the
1759 @item [fn:name: a definition]
1760 An inline definition of a footnote, which also specifies a name for the note.
1761 Since Org allows multiple references to the same note, you can then use
1762 @code{[fn:name]} to create additional references.
1765 @vindex org-footnote-auto-label
1766 Footnote labels can be created automatically, or you can create names yourself.
1767 This is handled by the variable @code{org-footnote-auto-label} and its
1768 corresponding @code{#+STARTUP} keywords. See the docstring of that variable
1771 @noindent The following command handles footnotes:
1776 The footnote action command.
1778 When the cursor is on a footnote reference, jump to the definition. When it
1779 is at a definition, jump to the (first) reference.
1781 @vindex org-footnote-define-inline
1782 @vindex org-footnote-section
1783 @vindex org-footnote-auto-adjust
1784 Otherwise, create a new footnote. Depending on the variable
1785 @code{org-footnote-define-inline}@footnote{The corresponding in-buffer
1786 setting is: @code{#+STARTUP: fninline} or @code{#+STARTUP: nofninline}}, the
1787 definition will be placed right into the text as part of the reference, or
1788 separately into the location determined by the variable
1789 @code{org-footnote-section}.
1791 When this command is called with a prefix argument, a menu of additional
1794 s @r{Sort the footnote definitions by reference sequence. During editing,}
1795 @r{Org makes no effort to sort footnote definitions into a particular}
1796 @r{sequence. If you want them sorted, use this command, which will}
1797 @r{also move entries according to @code{org-footnote-section}. Automatic}
1798 @r{sorting after each insertion/deletion can be configured using the}
1799 @r{variable @code{org-footnote-auto-adjust}.}
1800 r @r{Renumber the simple @code{fn:N} footnotes. Automatic renumbering}
1801 @r{after each insertion/deletion can be configured using the variable}
1802 @r{@code{org-footnote-auto-adjust}.}
1803 S @r{Short for first @code{r}, then @code{s} action.}
1804 n @r{Normalize the footnotes by collecting all definitions (including}
1805 @r{inline definitions) into a special section, and then numbering them}
1806 @r{in sequence. The references will then also be numbers. This is}
1807 @r{meant to be the final step before finishing a document (e.g. sending}
1808 @r{off an email). The exporters do this automatically, and so could}
1809 @r{something like @code{message-send-hook}.}
1810 d @r{Delete the footnote at point, and all definitions of and references}
1813 Depending on the variable @code{org-footnote-auto-adjust}@footnote{the
1814 corresponding in-buffer options are @code{fnadjust} and @code{nofnadjust}.},
1815 renumbering and sorting footnotes can be automatic after each insertion or
1820 If the cursor is on a footnote reference, jump to the definition. If it is a
1821 the definition, jump back to the reference. When called at a footnote
1822 location with a prefix argument, offer the same menu as @kbd{C-c C-x f}.
1826 @item C-c C-o @r{or} mouse-1/2
1827 Footnote labels are also links to the corresponding definition/reference, and
1828 you can use the usual commands to follow these links.
1831 @node Orgstruct mode, , Footnotes, Document Structure
1832 @section The Orgstruct minor mode
1833 @cindex Orgstruct mode
1834 @cindex minor mode for structure editing
1836 If you like the intuitive way the Org-mode structure editing and list
1837 formatting works, you might want to use these commands in other modes like
1838 Text mode or Mail mode as well. The minor mode @code{orgstruct-mode} makes
1839 this possible. Toggle the mode with @kbd{M-x orgstruct-mode}, or
1840 turn it on by default, for example in Mail mode, with one of:
1843 (add-hook 'mail-mode-hook 'turn-on-orgstruct)
1844 (add-hook 'mail-mode-hook 'turn-on-orgstruct++)
1847 When this mode is active and the cursor is on a line that looks to Org like a
1848 headline or the first line of a list item, most structure editing commands
1849 will work, even if the same keys normally have different functionality in the
1850 major mode you are using. If the cursor is not in one of those special
1851 lines, Orgstruct mode lurks silently in the shadows. When you use
1852 @code{orgstruct++-mode}, Org will also export indentation and autofill
1853 settings into that mode, and detect item context after the first line of an
1856 @node Tables, Hyperlinks, Document Structure, Top
1859 @cindex editing tables
1861 Org comes with a fast and intuitive table editor. Spreadsheet-like
1862 calculations are supported using the Emacs @file{calc} package
1864 (@pxref{Top,Calc,,Calc,Gnu Emacs Calculator Manual}).
1867 (see the Emacs Calculator manual for more information about the Emacs
1872 * Built-in table editor:: Simple tables
1873 * Column width and alignment:: Overrule the automatic settings
1874 * Column groups:: Grouping to trigger vertical lines
1875 * Orgtbl mode:: The table editor as minor mode
1876 * The spreadsheet:: The table editor has spreadsheet capabilities
1877 * Org-Plot:: Plotting from org tables
1880 @node Built-in table editor, Column width and alignment, Tables, Tables
1881 @section The built-in table editor
1882 @cindex table editor, built-in
1884 Org makes it easy to format tables in plain ASCII. Any line with
1885 @samp{|} as the first non-whitespace character is considered part of a
1886 table. @samp{|} is also the column separator. A table might look like
1890 | Name | Phone | Age |
1891 |-------+-------+-----|
1892 | Peter | 1234 | 17 |
1893 | Anna | 4321 | 25 |
1896 A table is re-aligned automatically each time you press @key{TAB} or
1897 @key{RET} or @kbd{C-c C-c} inside the table. @key{TAB} also moves to
1898 the next field (@key{RET} to the next row) and creates new table rows
1899 at the end of the table or before horizontal lines. The indentation
1900 of the table is set by the first line. Any line starting with
1901 @samp{|-} is considered as a horizontal separator line and will be
1902 expanded on the next re-align to span the whole table width. So, to
1903 create the above table, you would only type
1910 @noindent and then press @key{TAB} to align the table and start filling in
1911 fields. Even faster would be to type @code{|Name|Phone|Age} followed by
1912 @kbd{C-c @key{RET}}.
1914 @vindex org-enable-table-editor
1915 @vindex org-table-auto-blank-field
1916 When typing text into a field, Org treats @key{DEL},
1917 @key{Backspace}, and all character keys in a special way, so that
1918 inserting and deleting avoids shifting other fields. Also, when
1919 typing @emph{immediately after the cursor was moved into a new field
1920 with @kbd{@key{TAB}}, @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} or @kbd{@key{RET}}}, the
1921 field is automatically made blank. If this behavior is too
1922 unpredictable for you, configure the variables
1923 @code{org-enable-table-editor} and @code{org-table-auto-blank-field}.
1926 @tsubheading{Creation and conversion}
1927 @orgcmd{C-c |,org-table-create-or-convert-from-region}
1928 Convert the active region to table. If every line contains at least one
1929 TAB character, the function assumes that the material is tab separated.
1930 If every line contains a comma, comma-separated values (CSV) are assumed.
1931 If not, lines are split at whitespace into fields. You can use a prefix
1932 argument to force a specific separator: @kbd{C-u} forces CSV, @kbd{C-u
1933 C-u} forces TAB, and a numeric argument N indicates that at least N
1934 consecutive spaces, or alternatively a TAB will be the separator.
1936 If there is no active region, this command creates an empty Org
1937 table. But it's easier just to start typing, like
1938 @kbd{|Name|Phone|Age @key{RET} |- @key{TAB}}.
1940 @tsubheading{Re-aligning and field motion}
1941 @orgcmd{C-c C-c,org-table-align}
1942 Re-align the table without moving the cursor.
1944 @orgcmd{<TAB>,org-table-next-field}
1945 Re-align the table, move to the next field. Creates a new row if
1948 @orgcmd{S-@key{TAB},org-table-previous-field}
1949 Re-align, move to previous field.
1951 @orgcmd{@key{RET},org-table-next-row}
1952 Re-align the table and move down to next row. Creates a new row if
1953 necessary. At the beginning or end of a line, @key{RET} still does
1954 NEWLINE, so it can be used to split a table.
1956 @orgcmd{M-a,org-table-beginning-of-field}
1957 Move to beginning of the current table field, or on to the previous field.
1958 @orgcmd{M-e,org-table-end-of-field}
1959 Move to end of the current table field, or on to the next field.
1961 @tsubheading{Column and row editing}
1962 @orgcmdkkcc{M-@key{left},M-@key{right},org-table-move-column-left,org-table-move-column-right}
1963 Move the current column left/right.
1965 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{left},org-table-delete-column}
1966 Kill the current column.
1968 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{right},org-table-insert-column}
1969 Insert a new column to the left of the cursor position.
1971 @orgcmdkkcc{M-@key{up},M-@key{down},org-table-move-row-up,org-table-move-row-down}
1972 Move the current row up/down.
1974 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{up},org-table-kill-row}
1975 Kill the current row or horizontal line.
1977 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{down},org-table-insert-row}
1978 Insert a new row above the current row. With a prefix argument, the line is
1979 created below the current one.
1981 @orgcmd{C-c -,org-table-insert-hline}
1982 Insert a horizontal line below current row. With a prefix argument, the line
1983 is created above the current line.
1985 @orgcmd{C-c @key{RET},org-table-hline-and-move}
1986 Insert a horizontal line below current row, and move the cursor into the row
1989 @orgcmd{C-c ^,org-table-sort-lines}
1990 Sort the table lines in the region. The position of point indicates the
1991 column to be used for sorting, and the range of lines is the range
1992 between the nearest horizontal separator lines, or the entire table. If
1993 point is before the first column, you will be prompted for the sorting
1994 column. If there is an active region, the mark specifies the first line
1995 and the sorting column, while point should be in the last line to be
1996 included into the sorting. The command prompts for the sorting type
1997 (alphabetically, numerically, or by time). When called with a prefix
1998 argument, alphabetic sorting will be case-sensitive.
2000 @tsubheading{Regions}
2001 @orgcmd{C-c C-x M-w,org-table-copy-region}
2002 Copy a rectangular region from a table to a special clipboard. Point and
2003 mark determine edge fields of the rectangle. If there is no active region,
2004 copy just the current field. The process ignores horizontal separator lines.
2006 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-w,org-table-cut-region}
2007 Copy a rectangular region from a table to a special clipboard, and
2008 blank all fields in the rectangle. So this is the ``cut'' operation.
2010 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-y,org-table-paste-rectangle}
2011 Paste a rectangular region into a table.
2012 The upper left corner ends up in the current field. All involved fields
2013 will be overwritten. If the rectangle does not fit into the present table,
2014 the table is enlarged as needed. The process ignores horizontal separator
2017 @orgcmd{M-@key{RET},org-table-wrap-region}
2018 Split the current field at the cursor position and move the rest to the line
2019 below. If there is an active region, and both point and mark are in the same
2020 column, the text in the column is wrapped to minimum width for the given
2021 number of lines. A numeric prefix argument may be used to change the number
2022 of desired lines. If there is no region, but you specify a prefix argument,
2023 the current field is made blank, and the content is appended to the field
2026 @tsubheading{Calculations}
2027 @cindex formula, in tables
2028 @cindex calculations, in tables
2029 @cindex region, active
2030 @cindex active region
2031 @cindex transient mark mode
2032 @orgcmd{C-c +,org-table-sum}
2033 Sum the numbers in the current column, or in the rectangle defined by
2034 the active region. The result is shown in the echo area and can
2035 be inserted with @kbd{C-y}.
2037 @orgcmd{S-@key{RET},org-table-copy-down}
2038 @vindex org-table-copy-increment
2039 When current field is empty, copy from first non-empty field above. When not
2040 empty, copy current field down to next row and move cursor along with it.
2041 Depending on the variable @code{org-table-copy-increment}, integer field
2042 values will be incremented during copy. Integers that are too large will not
2043 be incremented. Also, a @code{0} prefix argument temporarily disables the
2044 increment. This key is also used by shift-selection and related modes
2045 (@pxref{Conflicts}).
2047 @tsubheading{Miscellaneous}
2048 @orgcmd{C-c `,org-table-edit-field}
2049 Edit the current field in a separate window. This is useful for fields that
2050 are not fully visible (@pxref{Column width and alignment}). When called with
2051 a @kbd{C-u} prefix, just make the full field visible, so that it can be
2054 @item M-x org-table-import
2055 Import a file as a table. The table should be TAB or whitespace
2056 separated. Use, for example, to import a spreadsheet table or data
2057 from a database, because these programs generally can write
2058 TAB-separated text files. This command works by inserting the file into
2059 the buffer and then converting the region to a table. Any prefix
2060 argument is passed on to the converter, which uses it to determine the
2062 @orgcmd{C-c |,org-table-create-or-convert-from-region}
2063 Tables can also be imported by pasting tabular text into the Org
2064 buffer, selecting the pasted text with @kbd{C-x C-x} and then using the
2065 @kbd{C-c |} command (see above under @i{Creation and conversion}).
2067 @item M-x org-table-export
2068 @findex org-table-export
2069 @vindex org-table-export-default-format
2070 Export the table, by default as a TAB-separated file. Use for data
2071 exchange with, for example, spreadsheet or database programs. The format
2072 used to export the file can be configured in the variable
2073 @code{org-table-export-default-format}. You may also use properties
2074 @code{TABLE_EXPORT_FILE} and @code{TABLE_EXPORT_FORMAT} to specify the file
2075 name and the format for table export in a subtree. Org supports quite
2076 general formats for exported tables. The exporter format is the same as the
2077 format used by Orgtbl radio tables, see @ref{Translator functions}, for a
2078 detailed description.
2081 If you don't like the automatic table editor because it gets in your
2082 way on lines which you would like to start with @samp{|}, you can turn
2086 (setq org-enable-table-editor nil)
2089 @noindent Then the only table command that still works is
2090 @kbd{C-c C-c} to do a manual re-align.
2092 @node Column width and alignment, Column groups, Built-in table editor, Tables
2093 @section Column width and alignment
2094 @cindex narrow columns in tables
2095 @cindex alignment in tables
2097 The width of columns is automatically determined by the table editor. And
2098 also the alignment of a column is determined automatically from the fraction
2099 of number-like versus non-number fields in the column.
2101 Sometimes a single field or a few fields need to carry more text, leading to
2102 inconveniently wide columns. Or maybe you want to make a table with several
2103 columns having a fixed width, regardless of content. To set@footnote{This
2104 feature does not work on XEmacs.} the width of a column, one field anywhere
2105 in the column may contain just the string @samp{<N>} where @samp{N} is an
2106 integer specifying the width of the column in characters. The next re-align
2107 will then set the width of this column to this value.
2111 |---+------------------------------| |---+--------|
2113 | 1 | one | | 1 | one |
2114 | 2 | two | ----\ | 2 | two |
2115 | 3 | This is a long chunk of text | ----/ | 3 | This=> |
2116 | 4 | four | | 4 | four |
2117 |---+------------------------------| |---+--------|
2122 Fields that are wider become clipped and end in the string @samp{=>}.
2123 Note that the full text is still in the buffer but is hidden.
2124 To see the full text, hold the mouse over the field---a tool-tip window
2125 will show the full content. To edit such a field, use the command
2126 @kbd{C-c `} (that is @kbd{C-c} followed by the backquote). This will
2127 open a new window with the full field. Edit it and finish with @kbd{C-c
2130 @vindex org-startup-align-all-tables
2131 When visiting a file containing a table with narrowed columns, the
2132 necessary character hiding has not yet happened, and the table needs to
2133 be aligned before it looks nice. Setting the option
2134 @code{org-startup-align-all-tables} will realign all tables in a file
2135 upon visiting, but also slow down startup. You can also set this option
2136 on a per-file basis with:
2143 If you would like to overrule the automatic alignment of number-rich columns
2144 to the right and of string-rich column to the left, you can use @samp{<r>},
2145 @samp{c}@footnote{Centering does not work inside Emacs, but it does have an
2146 effect when exporting to HTML.} or @samp{<l>} in a similar fashion. You may
2147 also combine alignment and field width like this: @samp{<l10>}.
2149 Lines which only contain these formatting cookies will be removed
2150 automatically when exporting the document.
2152 @node Column groups, Orgtbl mode, Column width and alignment, Tables
2153 @section Column groups
2154 @cindex grouping columns in tables
2156 When Org exports tables, it does so by default without vertical
2157 lines because that is visually more satisfying in general. Occasionally
2158 however, vertical lines can be useful to structure a table into groups
2159 of columns, much like horizontal lines can do for groups of rows. In
2160 order to specify column groups, you can use a special row where the
2161 first field contains only @samp{/}. The further fields can either
2162 contain @samp{<} to indicate that this column should start a group,
2163 @samp{>} to indicate the end of a column, or @samp{<>} to make a column
2164 a group of its own. Boundaries between column groups will upon export be
2165 marked with vertical lines. Here is an example:
2168 | N | N^2 | N^3 | N^4 | sqrt(n) | sqrt[4](N) |
2169 |---+-----+-----+-----+---------+------------|
2170 | / | < | | > | < | > |
2171 | 1 | 1 | 1 | 1 | 1 | 1 |
2172 | 2 | 4 | 8 | 16 | 1.4142 | 1.1892 |
2173 | 3 | 9 | 27 | 81 | 1.7321 | 1.3161 |
2174 |---+-----+-----+-----+---------+------------|
2175 #+TBLFM: $2=$1^2::$3=$1^3::$4=$1^4::$5=sqrt($1)::$6=sqrt(sqrt(($1)))
2178 It is also sufficient to just insert the column group starters after
2179 every vertical line you would like to have:
2182 | N | N^2 | N^3 | N^4 | sqrt(n) | sqrt[4](N) |
2183 |----+-----+-----+-----+---------+------------|
2187 @node Orgtbl mode, The spreadsheet, Column groups, Tables
2188 @section The Orgtbl minor mode
2190 @cindex minor mode for tables
2192 If you like the intuitive way the Org table editor works, you
2193 might also want to use it in other modes like Text mode or Mail mode.
2194 The minor mode Orgtbl mode makes this possible. You can always toggle
2195 the mode with @kbd{M-x orgtbl-mode}. To turn it on by default, for
2196 example in mail mode, use
2199 (add-hook 'mail-mode-hook 'turn-on-orgtbl)
2202 Furthermore, with some special setup, it is possible to maintain tables
2203 in arbitrary syntax with Orgtbl mode. For example, it is possible to
2204 construct @LaTeX{} tables with the underlying ease and power of
2205 Orgtbl mode, including spreadsheet capabilities. For details, see
2206 @ref{Tables in arbitrary syntax}.
2208 @node The spreadsheet, Org-Plot, Orgtbl mode, Tables
2209 @section The spreadsheet
2210 @cindex calculations, in tables
2211 @cindex spreadsheet capabilities
2212 @cindex @file{calc} package
2214 The table editor makes use of the Emacs @file{calc} package to implement
2215 spreadsheet-like capabilities. It can also evaluate Emacs Lisp forms to
2216 derive fields from other fields. While fully featured, Org's implementation
2217 is not identical to other spreadsheets. For example, Org knows the concept
2218 of a @emph{column formula} that will be applied to all non-header fields in a
2219 column without having to copy the formula to each relevant field. There is
2220 also a formula debugger, and a formula editor with features for highlighting
2221 fields in the table corresponding to the references at the point in the
2222 formula, moving these references by arrow keys
2225 * References:: How to refer to another field or range
2226 * Formula syntax for Calc:: Using Calc to compute stuff
2227 * Formula syntax for Lisp:: Writing formulas in Emacs Lisp
2228 * Field formulas:: Formulas valid for a single field
2229 * Column formulas:: Formulas valid for an entire column
2230 * Editing and debugging formulas:: Fixing formulas
2231 * Updating the table:: Recomputing all dependent fields
2232 * Advanced features:: Field names, parameters and automatic recalc
2235 @node References, Formula syntax for Calc, The spreadsheet, The spreadsheet
2236 @subsection References
2239 To compute fields in the table from other fields, formulas must
2240 reference other fields or ranges. In Org, fields can be referenced
2241 by name, by absolute coordinates, and by relative coordinates. To find
2242 out what the coordinates of a field are, press @kbd{C-c ?} in that
2243 field, or press @kbd{C-c @}} to toggle the display of a grid.
2245 @subsubheading Field references
2246 @cindex field references
2247 @cindex references, to fields
2249 Formulas can reference the value of another field in two ways. Like in
2250 any other spreadsheet, you may reference fields with a letter/number
2251 combination like @code{B3}, meaning the 2nd field in the 3rd row.
2252 @c Such references are always fixed to that field, they don't change
2253 @c when you copy and paste a formula to a different field. So
2254 @c Org's @code{B3} behaves like @code{$B$3} in other spreadsheets.
2257 Org also uses another, more general operator that looks like this:
2259 @@@var{row}$@var{column}
2263 Column references can be absolute like @samp{1}, @samp{2},...@samp{@var{N}},
2264 or relative to the current column like @samp{+1} or @samp{-2}.
2266 The row specification only counts data lines and ignores horizontal
2267 separator lines (hlines). You can use absolute row numbers
2268 @samp{1}...@samp{@var{N}}, and row numbers relative to the current row like
2269 @samp{+3} or @samp{-1}. Or specify the row relative to one of the
2270 hlines: @samp{I} refers to the first hline@footnote{Note that only
2271 hlines are counted that @emph{separate} table lines. If the table
2272 starts with a hline above the header, it does not count.}, @samp{II} to
2273 the second, etc@. @samp{-I} refers to the first such line above the
2274 current line, @samp{+I} to the first such line below the current line.
2275 You can also write @samp{III+2} which is the second data line after the
2276 third hline in the table.
2278 @samp{0} refers to the current row and column. Also, if you omit
2279 either the column or the row part of the reference, the current
2280 row/column is implied.
2282 Org's references with @emph{unsigned} numbers are fixed references
2283 in the sense that if you use the same reference in the formula for two
2284 different fields, the same field will be referenced each time.
2285 Org's references with @emph{signed} numbers are floating
2286 references because the same reference operator can reference different
2287 fields depending on the field being calculated by the formula.
2289 As a special case, references like @samp{$LR5} and @samp{$LR12} can be used
2290 to refer in a stable way to the 5th and 12th field in the last row of the
2293 Here are a few examples:
2296 @@2$3 @r{2nd row, 3rd column}
2297 C2 @r{same as previous}
2298 $5 @r{column 5 in the current row}
2299 E& @r{same as previous}
2300 @@2 @r{current column, row 2}
2301 @@-1$-3 @r{the field one row up, three columns to the left}
2302 @@-I$2 @r{field just under hline above current row, column 2}
2305 @subsubheading Range references
2306 @cindex range references
2307 @cindex references, to ranges
2309 You may reference a rectangular range of fields by specifying two field
2310 references connected by two dots @samp{..}. If both fields are in the
2311 current row, you may simply use @samp{$2..$7}, but if at least one field
2312 is in a different row, you need to use the general @code{@@row$column}
2313 format at least for the first field (i.e the reference must start with
2314 @samp{@@} in order to be interpreted correctly). Examples:
2317 $1..$3 @r{First three fields in the current row.}
2318 $P..$Q @r{Range, using column names (see under Advanced)}
2319 @@2$1..@@4$3 @r{6 fields between these two fields.}
2320 A2..C4 @r{Same as above.}
2321 @@-1$-2..@@-1 @r{3 numbers from the column to the left, 2 up to current row}
2324 @noindent Range references return a vector of values that can be fed
2325 into Calc vector functions. Empty fields in ranges are normally
2326 suppressed, so that the vector contains only the non-empty fields (but
2327 see the @samp{E} mode switch below). If there are no non-empty fields,
2328 @samp{[0]} is returned to avoid syntax errors in formulas.
2330 @subsubheading Field coordinates in formulas
2331 @cindex field coordinates
2332 @cindex coordinates, of field
2333 @cindex row, of field coordinates
2334 @cindex column, of field coordinates
2336 For Calc formulas and Lisp formulas @code{@@#} and @code{$#} can be used to
2337 get the row or column number of the field where the formula result goes.
2338 The traditional Lisp formula equivalents are @code{org-table-current-dline}
2339 and @code{org-table-current-column}. Examples:
2342 if(@@# % 2, $#, string("")) @r{column number on odd lines only}
2343 $3 = remote(FOO, @@@@#$2) @r{copy column 2 from table FOO into}
2344 @r{column 3 of the current table}
2347 @noindent For the second example, table FOO must have at least as many rows
2348 as the current table. Inefficient@footnote{The computation time scales as
2349 O(N^2) because table FOO is parsed for each field to be copied.} for large
2352 @subsubheading Named references
2353 @cindex named references
2354 @cindex references, named
2355 @cindex name, of column or field
2356 @cindex constants, in calculations
2359 @vindex org-table-formula-constants
2360 @samp{$name} is interpreted as the name of a column, parameter or
2361 constant. Constants are defined globally through the variable
2362 @code{org-table-formula-constants}, and locally (for the file) through a
2366 #+CONSTANTS: c=299792458. pi=3.14 eps=2.4e-6
2370 @vindex constants-unit-system
2371 @pindex constants.el
2372 Also properties (@pxref{Properties and Columns}) can be used as
2373 constants in table formulas: for a property @samp{:Xyz:} use the name
2374 @samp{$PROP_Xyz}, and the property will be searched in the current
2375 outline entry and in the hierarchy above it. If you have the
2376 @file{constants.el} package, it will also be used to resolve constants,
2377 including natural constants like @samp{$h} for Planck's constant, and
2378 units like @samp{$km} for kilometers@footnote{@file{constants.el} can
2379 supply the values of constants in two different unit systems, @code{SI}
2380 and @code{cgs}. Which one is used depends on the value of the variable
2381 @code{constants-unit-system}. You can use the @code{#+STARTUP} options
2382 @code{constSI} and @code{constcgs} to set this value for the current
2383 buffer.}. Column names and parameters can be specified in special table
2384 lines. These are described below, see @ref{Advanced features}. All
2385 names must start with a letter, and further consist of letters and
2388 @subsubheading Remote references
2389 @cindex remote references
2390 @cindex references, remote
2391 @cindex references, to a different table
2392 @cindex name, of column or field
2393 @cindex constants, in calculations
2396 You may also reference constants, fields and ranges from a different table,
2397 either in the current file or even in a different file. The syntax is
2400 remote(NAME-OR-ID,REF)
2404 where NAME can be the name of a table in the current file as set by a
2405 @code{#+TBLNAME: NAME} line before the table. It can also be the ID of an
2406 entry, even in a different file, and the reference then refers to the first
2407 table in that entry. REF is an absolute field or range reference as
2408 described above for example @code{@@3$3} or @code{$somename}, valid in the
2411 @node Formula syntax for Calc, Formula syntax for Lisp, References, The spreadsheet
2412 @subsection Formula syntax for Calc
2413 @cindex formula syntax, Calc
2414 @cindex syntax, of formulas
2416 A formula can be any algebraic expression understood by the Emacs
2417 @file{Calc} package. @b{Note that @file{calc} has the
2418 non-standard convention that @samp{/} has lower precedence than
2419 @samp{*}, so that @samp{a/b*c} is interpreted as @samp{a/(b*c)}.} Before
2420 evaluation by @code{calc-eval} (@pxref{Calling Calc from
2421 Your Programs,calc-eval,Calling Calc from Your Lisp Programs,Calc,GNU
2422 Emacs Calc Manual}),
2423 @c FIXME: The link to the Calc manual in HTML does not work.
2424 variable substitution takes place according to the rules described above.
2425 @cindex vectors, in table calculations
2426 The range vectors can be directly fed into the Calc vector functions
2427 like @samp{vmean} and @samp{vsum}.
2429 @cindex format specifier
2430 @cindex mode, for @file{calc}
2431 @vindex org-calc-default-modes
2432 A formula can contain an optional mode string after a semicolon. This
2433 string consists of flags to influence Calc and other modes during
2434 execution. By default, Org uses the standard Calc modes (precision
2435 12, angular units degrees, fraction and symbolic modes off). The display
2436 format, however, has been changed to @code{(float 8)} to keep tables
2437 compact. The default settings can be configured using the variable
2438 @code{org-calc-default-modes}.
2441 p20 @r{set the internal Calc calculation precision to 20 digits}
2442 n3 s3 e2 f4 @r{Normal, scientific, engineering, or fixed}
2443 @r{format of the result of Calc passed back to Org.}
2444 @r{Calc formatting is unlimited in precision as}
2445 @r{long as the Calc calculation precision is greater.}
2446 D R @r{angle modes: degrees, radians}
2447 F S @r{fraction and symbolic modes}
2448 N @r{interpret all fields as numbers, use 0 for non-numbers}
2449 T @r{force text interpretation}
2450 E @r{keep empty fields in ranges}
2455 Unless you use large integer numbers or high-precision-calculation
2456 and -display for floating point numbers you may alternatively provide a
2457 @code{printf} format specifier to reformat the Calc result after it has been
2458 passed back to Org instead of letting Calc already do the
2459 formatting@footnote{The @code{printf} reformatting is limited in precision
2460 because the value passed to it is converted into an @code{integer} or
2461 @code{double}. The @code{integer} is limited in size by truncating the
2462 signed value to 32 bits. The @code{double} is limited in precision to 64
2463 bits overall which leaves approximately 16 significant decimal digits.}.
2467 $1+$2 @r{Sum of first and second field}
2468 $1+$2;%.2f @r{Same, format result to two decimals}
2469 exp($2)+exp($1) @r{Math functions can be used}
2470 $0;%.1f @r{Reformat current cell to 1 decimal}
2471 ($3-32)*5/9 @r{Degrees F -> C conversion}
2472 $c/$1/$cm @r{Hz -> cm conversion, using @file{constants.el}}
2473 tan($1);Dp3s1 @r{Compute in degrees, precision 3, display SCI 1}
2474 sin($1);Dp3%.1e @r{Same, but use printf specifier for display}
2475 vmean($2..$7) @r{Compute column range mean, using vector function}
2476 vmean($2..$7);EN @r{Same, but treat empty fields as 0}
2477 taylor($3,x=7,2) @r{Taylor series of $3, at x=7, second degree}
2480 Calc also contains a complete set of logical operations. For example
2483 if($1<20,teen,string("")) @r{``teen'' if age $1 less than 20, else empty}
2486 @node Formula syntax for Lisp, Field formulas, Formula syntax for Calc, The spreadsheet
2487 @subsection Emacs Lisp forms as formulas
2488 @cindex Lisp forms, as table formulas
2490 It is also possible to write a formula in Emacs Lisp; this can be useful for
2491 string manipulation and control structures, if Calc's functionality is not
2492 enough. If a formula starts with a single-quote followed by an opening
2493 parenthesis, then it is evaluated as a Lisp form. The evaluation should
2494 return either a string or a number. Just as with @file{calc} formulas, you
2495 can specify modes and a printf format after a semicolon. With Emacs Lisp
2496 forms, you need to be conscious about the way field references are
2497 interpolated into the form. By default, a reference will be interpolated as
2498 a Lisp string (in double-quotes) containing the field. If you provide the
2499 @samp{N} mode switch, all referenced elements will be numbers (non-number
2500 fields will be zero) and interpolated as Lisp numbers, without quotes. If
2501 you provide the @samp{L} flag, all fields will be interpolated literally,
2502 without quotes. I.e., if you want a reference to be interpreted as a string
2503 by the Lisp form, enclose the reference operator itself in double-quotes,
2504 like @code{"$3"}. Ranges are inserted as space-separated fields, so you can
2505 +embed them in list or vector syntax. Here are a few examples---note how the
2506 @samp{N} mode is used when we do computations in Lisp:
2509 @r{Swap the first two characters of the content of column 1}
2510 '(concat (substring $1 1 2) (substring $1 0 1) (substring $1 2))
2511 @r{Add columns 1 and 2, equivalent to Calc's @code{$1+$2}}
2513 @r{Compute the sum of columns 1-4, like Calc's @code{vsum($1..$4)}}
2514 '(apply '+ '($1..$4));N
2517 @node Field formulas, Column formulas, Formula syntax for Lisp, The spreadsheet
2518 @subsection Field formulas
2519 @cindex field formula
2520 @cindex formula, for individual table field
2522 To assign a formula to a particular field, type it directly into the
2523 field, preceded by @samp{:=}, for example @samp{:=$1+$2}. When you
2524 press @key{TAB} or @key{RET} or @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor still in
2525 the field, the formula will be stored as the formula for this field,
2526 evaluated, and the current field replaced with the result.
2529 Formulas are stored in a special line starting with @samp{#+TBLFM:}
2530 directly below the table. If you type the equation in the 4th field of
2531 the 3rd data line in the table, the formula will look like
2532 @samp{@@3$4=$1+$2}. When inserting/deleting/swapping column and rows
2533 with the appropriate commands, @i{absolute references} (but not relative
2534 ones) in stored formulas are modified in order to still reference the
2535 same field. Of course this is not true if you edit the table structure
2536 with normal editing commands---then you must fix the equations yourself.
2537 The left-hand side of a formula may also be a named field (@pxref{Advanced
2538 features}), or a last-row reference like @samp{$LR3}.
2540 Instead of typing an equation into the field, you may also use the
2544 @orgcmd{C-u C-c =,org-table-eval-formula}
2545 Install a new formula for the current field. The command prompts for a
2546 formula with default taken from the @samp{#+TBLFM:} line, applies
2547 it to the current field, and stores it.
2550 @node Column formulas, Editing and debugging formulas, Field formulas, The spreadsheet
2551 @subsection Column formulas
2552 @cindex column formula
2553 @cindex formula, for table column
2555 Often in a table, the same formula should be used for all fields in a
2556 particular column. Instead of having to copy the formula to all fields
2557 in that column, Org allows you to assign a single formula to an entire
2558 column. If the table contains horizontal separator hlines, everything
2559 before the first such line is considered part of the table @emph{header}
2560 and will not be modified by column formulas.
2562 To assign a formula to a column, type it directly into any field in the
2563 column, preceded by an equal sign, like @samp{=$1+$2}. When you press
2564 @key{TAB} or @key{RET} or @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor still in the field,
2565 the formula will be stored as the formula for the current column, evaluated
2566 and the current field replaced with the result. If the field contains only
2567 @samp{=}, the previously stored formula for this column is used. For each
2568 column, Org will only remember the most recently used formula. In the
2569 @samp{#+TBLFM:} line, column formulas will look like @samp{$4=$1+$2}. The left-hand
2570 side of a column formula cannot currently be the name of column, it
2571 must be the numeric column reference.
2573 Instead of typing an equation into the field, you may also use the
2577 @orgcmd{C-c =,org-table-eval-formula}
2578 Install a new formula for the current column and replace current field with
2579 the result of the formula. The command prompts for a formula, with default
2580 taken from the @samp{#+TBLFM} line, applies it to the current field and
2581 stores it. With a numeric prefix argument(e.g. @kbd{C-5 C-c =}) the command
2582 will apply it to that many consecutive fields in the current column.
2585 @node Editing and debugging formulas, Updating the table, Column formulas, The spreadsheet
2586 @subsection Editing and debugging formulas
2587 @cindex formula editing
2588 @cindex editing, of table formulas
2590 @vindex org-table-use-standard-references
2591 You can edit individual formulas in the minibuffer or directly in the
2592 field. Org can also prepare a special buffer with all active
2593 formulas of a table. When offering a formula for editing, Org
2594 converts references to the standard format (like @code{B3} or @code{D&})
2595 if possible. If you prefer to only work with the internal format (like
2596 @code{@@3$2} or @code{$4}), configure the variable
2597 @code{org-table-use-standard-references}.
2600 @orgcmdkkc{C-c =,C-u C-c =,org-table-eval-formula}
2601 Edit the formula associated with the current column/field in the
2602 minibuffer. See @ref{Column formulas}, and @ref{Field formulas}.
2603 @orgcmd{C-u C-u C-c =,org-table-eval-formula}
2604 Re-insert the active formula (either a
2605 field formula, or a column formula) into the current field, so that you
2606 can edit it directly in the field. The advantage over editing in the
2607 minibuffer is that you can use the command @kbd{C-c ?}.
2608 @orgcmd{C-c ?,org-table-field-info}
2609 While editing a formula in a table field, highlight the field(s)
2610 referenced by the reference at the cursor position in the formula.
2612 @findex org-table-toggle-coordinate-overlays
2614 Toggle the display of row and column numbers for a table, using overlays
2615 (@command{org-table-toggle-coordinate-overlays}). These are updated each
2616 time the table is aligned; you can force it with @kbd{C-c C-c}.
2618 @findex org-table-toggle-formula-debugger
2620 Toggle the formula debugger on and off
2621 (@command{org-table-toggle-formula-debugger}). See below.
2622 @orgcmd{C-c ',org-table-edit-formulas}
2623 Edit all formulas for the current table in a special buffer, where the
2624 formulas will be displayed one per line. If the current field has an
2625 active formula, the cursor in the formula editor will mark it.
2626 While inside the special buffer, Org will automatically highlight
2627 any field or range reference at the cursor position. You may edit,
2628 remove and add formulas, and use the following commands:
2630 @orgcmdkkc{C-c C-c,C-x C-s,org-table-fedit-finish}
2631 Exit the formula editor and store the modified formulas. With @kbd{C-u}
2632 prefix, also apply the new formulas to the entire table.
2633 @orgcmd{C-c C-q,org-table-fedit-abort}
2634 Exit the formula editor without installing changes.
2635 @orgcmd{C-c C-r,org-table-fedit-toggle-ref-type}
2636 Toggle all references in the formula editor between standard (like
2637 @code{B3}) and internal (like @code{@@3$2}).
2638 @orgcmd{@key{TAB},org-table-fedit-lisp-indent}
2639 Pretty-print or indent Lisp formula at point. When in a line containing
2640 a Lisp formula, format the formula according to Emacs Lisp rules.
2641 Another @key{TAB} collapses the formula back again. In the open
2642 formula, @key{TAB} re-indents just like in Emacs Lisp mode.
2643 @orgcmd{M-@key{TAB},lisp-complete-symbol}
2644 Complete Lisp symbols, just like in Emacs Lisp mode.
2646 @kindex S-@key{down}
2647 @kindex S-@key{left}
2648 @kindex S-@key{right}
2649 @findex org-table-fedit-ref-up
2650 @findex org-table-fedit-ref-down
2651 @findex org-table-fedit-ref-left
2652 @findex org-table-fedit-ref-right
2653 @item S-@key{up}/@key{down}/@key{left}/@key{right}
2654 Shift the reference at point. For example, if the reference is
2655 @code{B3} and you press @kbd{S-@key{right}}, it will become @code{C3}.
2656 This also works for relative references and for hline references.
2657 @orgcmdkkcc{M-S-@key{up},M-S-@key{down},org-table-fedit-line-up,org-table-fedit-line-down}
2658 Move the test line for column formulas in the Org buffer up and
2660 @orgcmdkkcc{M-@key{up},M-@key{down},org-table-fedit-scroll-down,org-table-fedit-scroll-up}
2661 Scroll the window displaying the table.
2663 @findex org-table-toggle-coordinate-overlays
2665 Turn the coordinate grid in the table on and off.
2669 Making a table field blank does not remove the formula associated with
2670 the field, because that is stored in a different line (the @samp{#+TBLFM}
2671 line)---during the next recalculation the field will be filled again.
2672 To remove a formula from a field, you have to give an empty reply when
2673 prompted for the formula, or to edit the @samp{#+TBLFM} line.
2676 You may edit the @samp{#+TBLFM} directly and re-apply the changed
2677 equations with @kbd{C-c C-c} in that line or with the normal
2678 recalculation commands in the table.
2680 @subsubheading Debugging formulas
2681 @cindex formula debugging
2682 @cindex debugging, of table formulas
2683 When the evaluation of a formula leads to an error, the field content
2684 becomes the string @samp{#ERROR}. If you would like see what is going
2685 on during variable substitution and calculation in order to find a bug,
2686 turn on formula debugging in the @code{Tbl} menu and repeat the
2687 calculation, for example by pressing @kbd{C-u C-u C-c = @key{RET}} in a
2688 field. Detailed information will be displayed.
2690 @node Updating the table, Advanced features, Editing and debugging formulas, The spreadsheet
2691 @subsection Updating the table
2692 @cindex recomputing table fields
2693 @cindex updating, table
2695 Recalculation of a table is normally not automatic, but needs to be
2696 triggered by a command. See @ref{Advanced features}, for a way to make
2697 recalculation at least semi-automatic.
2699 In order to recalculate a line of a table or the entire table, use the
2703 @orgcmd{C-c *,org-table-recalculate}
2704 Recalculate the current row by first applying the stored column formulas
2705 from left to right, and all field formulas in the current row.
2711 Recompute the entire table, line by line. Any lines before the first
2712 hline are left alone, assuming that these are part of the table header.
2714 @orgcmdkkc{C-u C-u C-c *,C-u C-u C-c C-c,org-table-iterate}
2715 Iterate the table by recomputing it until no further changes occur.
2716 This may be necessary if some computed fields use the value of other
2717 fields that are computed @i{later} in the calculation sequence.
2718 @item M-x org-table-recalculate-buffer-tables
2719 @findex org-table-recalculate-buffer-tables
2720 Recompute all tables in the current buffer.
2721 @item M-x org-table-iterate-buffer-tables
2722 @findex org-table-iterate-buffer-tables
2723 Iterate all tables in the current buffer, in order to converge table-to-table
2727 @node Advanced features, , Updating the table, The spreadsheet
2728 @subsection Advanced features
2730 If you want the recalculation of fields to happen automatically, or if
2731 you want to be able to assign @i{names} to fields and columns, you need
2732 to reserve the first column of the table for special marking characters.
2734 @orgcmd{C-#,org-table-rotate-recalc-marks}
2735 Rotate the calculation mark in first column through the states @samp{ },
2736 @samp{#}, @samp{*}, @samp{!}, @samp{$}. When there is an active region,
2737 change all marks in the region.
2740 Here is an example of a table that collects exam results of students and
2741 makes use of these features:
2745 |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
2746 | | Student | Prob 1 | Prob 2 | Prob 3 | Total | Note |
2747 |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
2748 | ! | | P1 | P2 | P3 | Tot | |
2749 | # | Maximum | 10 | 15 | 25 | 50 | 10.0 |
2750 | ^ | | m1 | m2 | m3 | mt | |
2751 |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
2752 | # | Peter | 10 | 8 | 23 | 41 | 8.2 |
2753 | # | Sam | 2 | 4 | 3 | 9 | 1.8 |
2754 |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
2755 | | Average | | | | 29.7 | |
2756 | ^ | | | | | at | |
2757 | $ | max=50 | | | | | |
2758 |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
2759 #+TBLFM: $6=vsum($P1..$P3)::$7=10*$Tot/$max;%.1f::$at=vmean(@@-II..@@-I);%.1f
2763 @noindent @b{Important}: please note that for these special tables,
2764 recalculating the table with @kbd{C-u C-c *} will only affect rows that
2765 are marked @samp{#} or @samp{*}, and fields that have a formula assigned
2766 to the field itself. The column formulas are not applied in rows with
2769 @cindex marking characters, tables
2770 The marking characters have the following meaning:
2773 The fields in this line define names for the columns, so that you may
2774 refer to a column as @samp{$Tot} instead of @samp{$6}.
2776 This row defines names for the fields @emph{above} the row. With such
2777 a definition, any formula in the table may use @samp{$m1} to refer to
2778 the value @samp{10}. Also, if you assign a formula to a names field, it
2779 will be stored as @samp{$name=...}.
2781 Similar to @samp{^}, but defines names for the fields in the row
2784 Fields in this row can define @emph{parameters} for formulas. For
2785 example, if a field in a @samp{$} row contains @samp{max=50}, then
2786 formulas in this table can refer to the value 50 using @samp{$max}.
2787 Parameters work exactly like constants, only that they can be defined on
2790 Fields in this row are automatically recalculated when pressing
2791 @key{TAB} or @key{RET} or @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} in this row. Also, this row
2792 is selected for a global recalculation with @kbd{C-u C-c *}. Unmarked
2793 lines will be left alone by this command.
2795 Selects this line for global recalculation with @kbd{C-u C-c *}, but
2796 not for automatic recalculation. Use this when automatic
2797 recalculation slows down editing too much.
2799 Unmarked lines are exempt from recalculation with @kbd{C-u C-c *}.
2800 All lines that should be recalculated should be marked with @samp{#}
2803 Do not export this line. Useful for lines that contain the narrowing
2804 @samp{<N>} markers or column group markers.
2807 Finally, just to whet your appetite for what can be done with the
2808 fantastic @file{calc.el} package, here is a table that computes the Taylor
2809 series of degree @code{n} at location @code{x} for a couple of
2814 |---+-------------+---+-----+--------------------------------------|
2815 | | Func | n | x | Result |
2816 |---+-------------+---+-----+--------------------------------------|
2817 | # | exp(x) | 1 | x | 1 + x |
2818 | # | exp(x) | 2 | x | 1 + x + x^2 / 2 |
2819 | # | exp(x) | 3 | x | 1 + x + x^2 / 2 + x^3 / 6 |
2820 | # | x^2+sqrt(x) | 2 | x=0 | x*(0.5 / 0) + x^2 (2 - 0.25 / 0) / 2 |
2821 | # | x^2+sqrt(x) | 2 | x=1 | 2 + 2.5 x - 2.5 + 0.875 (x - 1)^2 |
2822 | * | tan(x) | 3 | x | 0.0175 x + 1.77e-6 x^3 |
2823 |---+-------------+---+-----+--------------------------------------|
2824 #+TBLFM: $5=taylor($2,$4,$3);n3
2828 @node Org-Plot, , The spreadsheet, Tables
2830 @cindex graph, in tables
2831 @cindex plot tables using Gnuplot
2834 Org-Plot can produce 2D and 3D graphs of information stored in org tables
2835 using @file{Gnuplot} @uref{http://www.gnuplot.info/} and @file{gnuplot-mode}
2836 @uref{http://cars9.uchicago.edu/~ravel/software/gnuplot-mode.html}. To see
2837 this in action, ensure that you have both Gnuplot and Gnuplot mode installed
2838 on your system, then call @code{org-plot/gnuplot} on the following table.
2842 #+PLOT: title:"Citas" ind:1 deps:(3) type:2d with:histograms set:"yrange [0:]"
2843 | Sede | Max cites | H-index |
2844 |-----------+-----------+---------|
2845 | Chile | 257.72 | 21.39 |
2846 | Leeds | 165.77 | 19.68 |
2847 | Sao Paolo | 71.00 | 11.50 |
2848 | Stockholm | 134.19 | 14.33 |
2849 | Morelia | 257.56 | 17.67 |
2853 Notice that Org Plot is smart enough to apply the table's headers as labels.
2854 Further control over the labels, type, content, and appearance of plots can
2855 be exercised through the @code{#+PLOT:} lines preceding a table. See below
2856 for a complete list of Org-plot options. For more information and examples
2857 see the Org-plot tutorial at
2858 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-tutorials/org-plot.php}.
2860 @subsubheading Plot Options
2864 Specify any @command{gnuplot} option to be set when graphing.
2867 Specify the title of the plot.
2870 Specify which column of the table to use as the @code{x} axis.
2873 Specify the columns to graph as a Lisp style list, surrounded by parentheses
2874 and separated by spaces for example @code{dep:(3 4)} to graph the third and
2875 fourth columns (defaults to graphing all other columns aside from the @code{ind}
2879 Specify whether the plot will be @code{2d}, @code{3d}, or @code{grid}.
2882 Specify a @code{with} option to be inserted for every col being plotted
2883 (e.g. @code{lines}, @code{points}, @code{boxes}, @code{impulses}, etc...).
2884 Defaults to @code{lines}.
2887 If you want to plot to a file, specify @code{"@var{path/to/desired/output-file}"}.
2890 List of labels to be used for the @code{deps} (defaults to the column headers
2894 Specify an entire line to be inserted in the Gnuplot script.
2897 When plotting @code{3d} or @code{grid} types, set this to @code{t} to graph a
2898 flat mapping rather than a @code{3d} slope.
2901 Specify format of Org-mode timestamps as they will be parsed by Gnuplot.
2902 Defaults to @samp{%Y-%m-%d-%H:%M:%S}.
2905 If you want total control, you can specify a script file (place the file name
2906 between double-quotes) which will be used to plot. Before plotting, every
2907 instance of @code{$datafile} in the specified script will be replaced with
2908 the path to the generated data file. Note: even if you set this option, you
2909 may still want to specify the plot type, as that can impact the content of
2913 @node Hyperlinks, TODO Items, Tables, Top
2917 Like HTML, Org provides links inside a file, external links to
2918 other files, Usenet articles, emails, and much more.
2921 * Link format:: How links in Org are formatted
2922 * Internal links:: Links to other places in the current file
2923 * External links:: URL-like links to the world
2924 * Handling links:: Creating, inserting and following
2925 * Using links outside Org:: Linking from my C source code?
2926 * Link abbreviations:: Shortcuts for writing complex links
2927 * Search options:: Linking to a specific location
2928 * Custom searches:: When the default search is not enough
2931 @node Link format, Internal links, Hyperlinks, Hyperlinks
2932 @section Link format
2934 @cindex format, of links
2936 Org will recognize plain URL-like links and activate them as
2937 clickable links. The general link format, however, looks like this:
2940 [[link][description]] @r{or alternatively} [[link]]
2944 Once a link in the buffer is complete (all brackets present), Org
2945 will change the display so that @samp{description} is displayed instead
2946 of @samp{[[link][description]]} and @samp{link} is displayed instead of
2947 @samp{[[link]]}. Links will be highlighted in the face @code{org-link},
2948 which by default is an underlined face. You can directly edit the
2949 visible part of a link. Note that this can be either the @samp{link}
2950 part (if there is no description) or the @samp{description} part. To
2951 edit also the invisible @samp{link} part, use @kbd{C-c C-l} with the
2954 If you place the cursor at the beginning or just behind the end of the
2955 displayed text and press @key{BACKSPACE}, you will remove the
2956 (invisible) bracket at that location. This makes the link incomplete
2957 and the internals are again displayed as plain text. Inserting the
2958 missing bracket hides the link internals again. To show the
2959 internal structure of all links, use the menu entry
2960 @code{Org->Hyperlinks->Literal links}.
2962 @node Internal links, External links, Link format, Hyperlinks
2963 @section Internal links
2964 @cindex internal links
2965 @cindex links, internal
2966 @cindex targets, for links
2968 @cindex property, CUSTOM_ID
2969 If the link does not look like a URL, it is considered to be internal in the
2970 current file. The most important case is a link like
2971 @samp{[[#my-custom-id]]} which will link to the entry with the
2972 @code{CUSTOM_ID} property @samp{my-custom-id}. Such custom IDs are very good
2973 for HTML export (@pxref{HTML export}) where they produce pretty section
2974 links. You are responsible yourself to make sure these custom IDs are unique
2977 Links such as @samp{[[My Target]]} or @samp{[[My Target][Find my target]]}
2978 lead to a text search in the current file.
2980 The link can be followed with @kbd{C-c C-o} when the cursor is on the link,
2981 or with a mouse click (@pxref{Handling links}). Links to custom IDs will
2982 point to the corresponding headline. The preferred match for a text link is
2983 a @i{dedicated target}: the same string in double angular brackets. Targets
2984 may be located anywhere; sometimes it is convenient to put them into a
2985 comment line. For example
2991 @noindent In HTML export (@pxref{HTML export}), such targets will become
2992 named anchors for direct access through @samp{http} links@footnote{Note that
2993 text before the first headline is usually not exported, so the first such
2994 target should be after the first headline, or in the line directly before the
2997 If no dedicated target exists, Org will search for a headline that is exactly
2998 the link text but may also include a TODO keyword and tags@footnote{To insert
2999 a link targeting a headline, in-buffer completion can be used. Just type a
3000 star followed by a few optional letters into the buffer and press
3001 @kbd{M-@key{TAB}}. All headlines in the current buffer will be offered as
3002 completions.}. In non-Org files, the search will look for the words in the
3003 link text. In the above example the search would be for @samp{my target}.
3005 Following a link pushes a mark onto Org's own mark ring. You can
3006 return to the previous position with @kbd{C-c &}. Using this command
3007 several times in direct succession goes back to positions recorded
3011 * Radio targets:: Make targets trigger links in plain text
3014 @node Radio targets, , Internal links, Internal links
3015 @subsection Radio targets
3016 @cindex radio targets
3017 @cindex targets, radio
3018 @cindex links, radio targets
3020 Org can automatically turn any occurrences of certain target names
3021 in normal text into a link. So without explicitly creating a link, the
3022 text connects to the target radioing its position. Radio targets are
3023 enclosed by triple angular brackets. For example, a target @samp{<<<My
3024 Target>>>} causes each occurrence of @samp{my target} in normal text to
3025 become activated as a link. The Org file is scanned automatically
3026 for radio targets only when the file is first loaded into Emacs. To
3027 update the target list during editing, press @kbd{C-c C-c} with the
3028 cursor on or at a target.
3030 @node External links, Handling links, Internal links, Hyperlinks
3031 @section External links
3032 @cindex links, external
3033 @cindex external links
3034 @cindex links, external
3042 @cindex WANDERLUST links
3044 @cindex USENET links
3049 Org supports links to files, websites, Usenet and email messages,
3050 BBDB database entries and links to both IRC conversations and their
3051 logs. External links are URL-like locators. They start with a short
3052 identifying string followed by a colon. There can be no space after
3053 the colon. The following list shows examples for each link type.
3056 http://www.astro.uva.nl/~dominik @r{on the web}
3057 doi:10.1000/182 @r{DOI for an electronic resource}
3058 file:/home/dominik/images/jupiter.jpg @r{file, absolute path}
3059 /home/dominik/images/jupiter.jpg @r{same as above}
3060 file:papers/last.pdf @r{file, relative path}
3061 ./papers/last.pdf @r{same as above}
3062 file:/myself@@some.where:papers/last.pdf @r{file, path on remote machine}
3063 /myself@@some.where:papers/last.pdf @r{same as above}
3064 file:sometextfile::NNN @r{file with line number to jump to}
3065 file:projects.org @r{another Org file}
3066 file:projects.org::some words @r{text search in Org file}
3067 file:projects.org::*task title @r{heading search in Org file}
3068 docview:papers/last.pdf::NNN @r{open file in doc-view mode at page NNN}
3069 id:B7423F4D-2E8A-471B-8810-C40F074717E9 @r{Link to heading by ID}
3070 news:comp.emacs @r{Usenet link}
3071 mailto:adent@@galaxy.net @r{Mail link}
3072 vm:folder @r{VM folder link}
3073 vm:folder#id @r{VM message link}
3074 vm://myself@@some.where.org/folder#id @r{VM on remote machine}
3075 wl:folder @r{WANDERLUST folder link}
3076 wl:folder#id @r{WANDERLUST message link}
3077 mhe:folder @r{MH-E folder link}
3078 mhe:folder#id @r{MH-E message link}
3079 rmail:folder @r{RMAIL folder link}
3080 rmail:folder#id @r{RMAIL message link}
3081 gnus:group @r{Gnus group link}
3082 gnus:group#id @r{Gnus article link}
3083 bbdb:R.*Stallman @r{BBDB link (with regexp)}
3084 irc:/irc.com/#emacs/bob @r{IRC link}
3085 info:org:External%20links @r{Info node link (with encoded space)}
3086 shell:ls *.org @r{A shell command}
3087 elisp:org-agenda @r{Interactive Elisp command}
3088 elisp:(find-file-other-frame "Elisp.org") @r{Elisp form to evaluate}
3091 A link should be enclosed in double brackets and may contain a
3092 descriptive text to be displayed instead of the URL (@pxref{Link
3093 format}), for example:
3096 [[http://www.gnu.org/software/emacs/][GNU Emacs]]
3100 If the description is a file name or URL that points to an image, HTML
3101 export (@pxref{HTML export}) will inline the image as a clickable
3102 button. If there is no description at all and the link points to an
3104 that image will be inlined into the exported HTML file.
3106 @cindex square brackets, around links
3107 @cindex plain text external links
3108 Org also finds external links in the normal text and activates them
3109 as links. If spaces must be part of the link (for example in
3110 @samp{bbdb:Richard Stallman}), or if you need to remove ambiguities
3111 about the end of the link, enclose them in square brackets.
3113 @node Handling links, Using links outside Org, External links, Hyperlinks
3114 @section Handling links
3115 @cindex links, handling
3117 Org provides methods to create a link in the correct syntax, to
3118 insert it into an Org file, and to follow the link.
3121 @orgcmd{C-c l,org-store-link}
3122 @cindex storing links
3123 Store a link to the current location. This is a @emph{global} command (you
3124 must create the key binding yourself) which can be used in any buffer to
3125 create a link. The link will be stored for later insertion into an Org
3126 buffer (see below). What kind of link will be created depends on the current
3129 @b{Org-mode buffers}@*
3130 For Org files, if there is a @samp{<<target>>} at the cursor, the link points
3131 to the target. Otherwise it points to the current headline, which will also
3134 @vindex org-link-to-org-use-id
3135 @cindex property, CUSTOM_ID
3136 @cindex property, ID
3137 If the headline has a @code{CUSTOM_ID} property, a link to this custom ID
3138 will be stored. In addition or alternatively (depending on the value of
3139 @code{org-link-to-org-use-id}), a globally unique @code{ID} property will be
3140 created and/or used to construct a link. So using this command in Org
3141 buffers will potentially create two links: a human-readable from the custom
3142 ID, and one that is globally unique and works even if the entry is moved from
3143 file to file. Later, when inserting the link, you need to decide which one
3146 @b{Email/News clients: VM, Rmail, Wanderlust, MH-E, Gnus}@*
3147 Pretty much all Emacs mail clients are supported. The link will point to the
3148 current article, or, in some GNUS buffers, to the group. The description is
3149 constructed from the author and the subject.
3151 @b{Web browsers: W3 and W3M}@*
3152 Here the link will be the current URL, with the page title as description.
3154 @b{Contacts: BBDB}@*
3155 Links created in a BBDB buffer will point to the current entry.
3158 @vindex org-irc-link-to-logs
3159 For IRC links, if you set the variable @code{org-irc-link-to-logs} to
3160 @code{t}, a @samp{file:/} style link to the relevant point in the logs for
3161 the current conversation is created. Otherwise an @samp{irc:/} style link to
3162 the user/channel/server under the point will be stored.
3165 For any other files, the link will point to the file, with a search string
3166 (@pxref{Search options}) pointing to the contents of the current line. If
3167 there is an active region, the selected words will form the basis of the
3168 search string. If the automatically created link is not working correctly or
3169 accurately enough, you can write custom functions to select the search string
3170 and to do the search for particular file types---see @ref{Custom searches}.
3171 The key binding @kbd{C-c l} is only a suggestion---see @ref{Installation}.
3174 When the cursor is in an agenda view, the created link points to the
3175 entry referenced by the current line.
3178 @orgcmd{C-c C-l,org-insert-link}
3179 @cindex link completion
3180 @cindex completion, of links
3181 @cindex inserting links
3182 @vindex org-keep-stored-link-after-insertion
3183 Insert a link@footnote{ Note that you don't have to use this command to
3184 insert a link. Links in Org are plain text, and you can type or paste them
3185 straight into the buffer. By using this command, the links are automatically
3186 enclosed in double brackets, and you will be asked for the optional
3187 descriptive text.}. This prompts for a link to be inserted into the buffer.
3188 You can just type a link, using text for an internal link, or one of the link
3189 type prefixes mentioned in the examples above. The link will be inserted
3190 into the buffer@footnote{After insertion of a stored link, the link will be
3191 removed from the list of stored links. To keep it in the list later use, use
3192 a triple @kbd{C-u} prefix argument to @kbd{C-c C-l}, or configure the option
3193 @code{org-keep-stored-link-after-insertion}.}, along with a descriptive text.
3194 If some text was selected when this command is called, the selected text
3195 becomes the default description.
3197 @b{Inserting stored links}@*
3198 All links stored during the
3199 current session are part of the history for this prompt, so you can access
3200 them with @key{up} and @key{down} (or @kbd{M-p/n}).
3202 @b{Completion support}@* Completion with @key{TAB} will help you to insert
3203 valid link prefixes like @samp{http:} or @samp{ftp:}, including the prefixes
3204 defined through link abbreviations (@pxref{Link abbreviations}). If you
3205 press @key{RET} after inserting only the @var{prefix}, Org will offer
3206 specific completion support for some link types@footnote{This works by
3207 calling a special function @code{org-PREFIX-complete-link}.} For
3208 example, if you type @kbd{file @key{RET}}, file name completion (alternative
3209 access: @kbd{C-u C-c C-l}, see below) will be offered, and after @kbd{bbdb
3210 @key{RET}} you can complete contact names.
3212 @cindex file name completion
3213 @cindex completion, of file names
3214 When @kbd{C-c C-l} is called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix argument, a link to
3215 a file will be inserted and you may use file name completion to select
3216 the name of the file. The path to the file is inserted relative to the
3217 directory of the current Org file, if the linked file is in the current
3218 directory or in a sub-directory of it, or if the path is written relative
3219 to the current directory using @samp{../}. Otherwise an absolute path
3220 is used, if possible with @samp{~/} for your home directory. You can
3221 force an absolute path with two @kbd{C-u} prefixes.
3223 @item C-c C-l @ @r{(with cursor on existing link)}
3224 When the cursor is on an existing link, @kbd{C-c C-l} allows you to edit the
3225 link and description parts of the link.
3227 @cindex following links
3228 @orgcmd{C-c C-o,org-open-at-point}
3229 @vindex org-file-apps
3230 Open link at point. This will launch a web browser for URLs (using
3231 @command{browse-url-at-point}), run VM/MH-E/Wanderlust/Rmail/Gnus/BBDB for
3232 the corresponding links, and execute the command in a shell link. When the
3233 cursor is on an internal link, this command runs the corresponding search.
3234 When the cursor is on a TAG list in a headline, it creates the corresponding
3235 TAGS view. If the cursor is on a timestamp, it compiles the agenda for that
3236 date. Furthermore, it will visit text and remote files in @samp{file:} links
3237 with Emacs and select a suitable application for local non-text files.
3238 Classification of files is based on file extension only. See option
3239 @code{org-file-apps}. If you want to override the default application and
3240 visit the file with Emacs, use a @kbd{C-u} prefix. If you want to avoid
3241 opening in Emacs, use a @kbd{C-u C-u} prefix.@*
3242 If the cursor is on a headline, but not on a link, offer all links in the
3243 headline and entry text.
3245 @vindex org-return-follows-link
3246 When @code{org-return-follows-link} is set, @kbd{@key{RET}} will also follow
3253 On links, @kbd{mouse-2} will open the link just as @kbd{C-c C-o}
3254 would. Under Emacs 22 and later, @kbd{mouse-1} will also follow a link.
3258 @vindex org-display-internal-link-with-indirect-buffer
3259 Like @kbd{mouse-2}, but force file links to be opened with Emacs, and
3260 internal links to be displayed in another window@footnote{See the
3261 variable @code{org-display-internal-link-with-indirect-buffer}}.
3263 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-v,org-toggle-inline-images}
3264 @cindex inlining images
3265 @cindex images, inlining
3266 @vindex org-startup-with-inline-images
3267 @cindex @code{inlineimages}, STARTUP keyword
3268 @cindex @code{noinlineimages}, STARTUP keyword
3269 Toggle the inline display of linked images. Normally this will only inline
3270 images that have no description part in the link, i.e. images that will also
3271 be inlined during export. When called with a prefix argument, also display
3272 images that do have a link description. You can ask for inline images to be
3273 displayed at startup by configuring the variable
3274 @code{org-startup-with-inline-images}@footnote{with corresponding
3275 @code{#+STARTUP} keywords @code{inlineimages} and @code{inlineimages}}.
3276 @orgcmd{C-c %,org-mark-ring-push}
3278 Push the current position onto the mark ring, to be able to return
3279 easily. Commands following an internal link do this automatically.
3281 @orgcmd{C-c &,org-mark-ring-goto}
3282 @cindex links, returning to
3283 Jump back to a recorded position. A position is recorded by the
3284 commands following internal links, and by @kbd{C-c %}. Using this
3285 command several times in direct succession moves through a ring of
3286 previously recorded positions.
3288 @orgcmdkkcc{C-c C-x C-n,C-c C-x C-p,org-next-link,org-previous-link}
3289 @cindex links, finding next/previous
3290 Move forward/backward to the next link in the buffer. At the limit of
3291 the buffer, the search fails once, and then wraps around. The key
3292 bindings for this are really too long; you might want to bind this also
3293 to @kbd{C-n} and @kbd{C-p}
3295 (add-hook 'org-load-hook
3297 (define-key 'org-mode-map "\C-n" 'org-next-link)
3298 (define-key 'org-mode-map "\C-p" 'org-previous-link)))
3302 @node Using links outside Org, Link abbreviations, Handling links, Hyperlinks
3303 @section Using links outside Org
3305 You can insert and follow links that have Org syntax not only in
3306 Org, but in any Emacs buffer. For this, you should create two
3307 global commands, like this (please select suitable global keys
3311 (global-set-key "\C-c L" 'org-insert-link-global)
3312 (global-set-key "\C-c o" 'org-open-at-point-global)
3315 @node Link abbreviations, Search options, Using links outside Org, Hyperlinks
3316 @section Link abbreviations
3317 @cindex link abbreviations
3318 @cindex abbreviation, links
3320 Long URLs can be cumbersome to type, and often many similar links are
3321 needed in a document. For this you can use link abbreviations. An
3322 abbreviated link looks like this
3325 [[linkword:tag][description]]
3329 @vindex org-link-abbrev-alist
3330 where the tag is optional.
3331 The @i{linkword} must be a word, starting with a letter, followed by
3332 letters, numbers, @samp{-}, and @samp{_}. Abbreviations are resolved
3333 according to the information in the variable @code{org-link-abbrev-alist}
3334 that relates the linkwords to replacement text. Here is an example:
3338 (setq org-link-abbrev-alist
3339 '(("bugzilla" . "http://10.1.2.9/bugzilla/show_bug.cgi?id=")
3340 ("google" . "http://www.google.com/search?q=")
3341 ("gmap" . "http://maps.google.com/maps?q=%s")
3342 ("omap" . "http://nominatim.openstreetmap.org/search?q=%s&polygon=1")
3343 ("ads" . "http://adsabs.harvard.edu/cgi-bin/nph-abs_connect?author=%s&db_key=AST")))
3347 If the replacement text contains the string @samp{%s}, it will be
3348 replaced with the tag. Otherwise the tag will be appended to the string
3349 in order to create the link. You may also specify a function that will
3350 be called with the tag as the only argument to create the link.
3352 With the above setting, you could link to a specific bug with
3353 @code{[[bugzilla:129]]}, search the web for @samp{OrgMode} with
3354 @code{[[google:OrgMode]]}, show the map location of the Free Software
3355 Foundation @code{[[gmap:51 Franklin Street, Boston]]} or of Carsten office
3356 @code{[[omap:Science Park 904, Amsterdam, The Netherlands]]} and find out
3357 what the Org author is doing besides Emacs hacking with
3358 @code{[[ads:Dominik,C]]}.
3360 If you need special abbreviations just for a single Org buffer, you
3361 can define them in the file with
3365 #+LINK: bugzilla http://10.1.2.9/bugzilla/show_bug.cgi?id=
3366 #+LINK: google http://www.google.com/search?q=%s
3370 In-buffer completion (@pxref{Completion}) can be used after @samp{[} to
3371 complete link abbreviations. You may also define a function
3372 @code{org-PREFIX-complete-link} that implements special (e.g. completion)
3373 support for inserting such a link with @kbd{C-c C-l}. Such a function should
3374 not accept any arguments, and return the full link with prefix.
3376 @node Search options, Custom searches, Link abbreviations, Hyperlinks
3377 @section Search options in file links
3378 @cindex search option in file links
3379 @cindex file links, searching
3381 File links can contain additional information to make Emacs jump to a
3382 particular location in the file when following a link. This can be a
3383 line number or a search option after a double@footnote{For backward
3384 compatibility, line numbers can also follow a single colon.} colon. For
3385 example, when the command @kbd{C-c l} creates a link (@pxref{Handling
3386 links}) to a file, it encodes the words in the current line as a search
3387 string that can be used to find this line back later when following the
3388 link with @kbd{C-c C-o}.
3390 Here is the syntax of the different ways to attach a search to a file
3391 link, together with an explanation:
3394 [[file:~/code/main.c::255]]
3395 [[file:~/xx.org::My Target]]
3396 [[file:~/xx.org::*My Target]]
3397 [[file:~/xx.org::#my-custom-id]]
3398 [[file:~/xx.org::/regexp/]]
3405 Search for a link target @samp{<<My Target>>}, or do a text search for
3406 @samp{my target}, similar to the search in internal links, see
3407 @ref{Internal links}. In HTML export (@pxref{HTML export}), such a file
3408 link will become an HTML reference to the corresponding named anchor in
3411 In an Org file, restrict search to headlines.
3413 Link to a heading with a @code{CUSTOM_ID} property
3415 Do a regular expression search for @code{regexp}. This uses the Emacs
3416 command @code{occur} to list all matches in a separate window. If the
3417 target file is in Org-mode, @code{org-occur} is used to create a
3418 sparse tree with the matches.
3419 @c If the target file is a directory,
3420 @c @code{grep} will be used to search all files in the directory.
3423 As a degenerate case, a file link with an empty file name can be used
3424 to search the current file. For example, @code{[[file:::find me]]} does
3425 a search for @samp{find me} in the current file, just as
3426 @samp{[[find me]]} would.
3428 @node Custom searches, , Search options, Hyperlinks
3429 @section Custom Searches
3430 @cindex custom search strings
3431 @cindex search strings, custom
3433 The default mechanism for creating search strings and for doing the
3434 actual search related to a file link may not work correctly in all
3435 cases. For example, Bib@TeX{} database files have many entries like
3436 @samp{year="1993"} which would not result in good search strings,
3437 because the only unique identification for a Bib@TeX{} entry is the
3440 @vindex org-create-file-search-functions
3441 @vindex org-execute-file-search-functions
3442 If you come across such a problem, you can write custom functions to set
3443 the right search string for a particular file type, and to do the search
3444 for the string in the file. Using @code{add-hook}, these functions need
3445 to be added to the hook variables
3446 @code{org-create-file-search-functions} and
3447 @code{org-execute-file-search-functions}. See the docstring for these
3448 variables for more information. Org actually uses this mechanism
3449 for Bib@TeX{} database files, and you can use the corresponding code as
3450 an implementation example. See the file @file{org-bibtex.el}.
3452 @node TODO Items, Tags, Hyperlinks, Top
3456 Org-mode does not maintain TODO lists as separate documents@footnote{Of
3457 course, you can make a document that contains only long lists of TODO items,
3458 but this is not required.}. Instead, TODO items are an integral part of the
3459 notes file, because TODO items usually come up while taking notes! With Org
3460 mode, simply mark any entry in a tree as being a TODO item. In this way,
3461 information is not duplicated, and the entire context from which the TODO
3462 item emerged is always present.
3464 Of course, this technique for managing TODO items scatters them
3465 throughout your notes file. Org-mode compensates for this by providing
3466 methods to give you an overview of all the things that you have to do.
3469 * TODO basics:: Marking and displaying TODO entries
3470 * TODO extensions:: Workflow and assignments
3471 * Progress logging:: Dates and notes for progress
3472 * Priorities:: Some things are more important than others
3473 * Breaking down tasks:: Splitting a task into manageable pieces
3474 * Checkboxes:: Tick-off lists
3477 @node TODO basics, TODO extensions, TODO Items, TODO Items
3478 @section Basic TODO functionality
3480 Any headline becomes a TODO item when it starts with the word
3481 @samp{TODO}, for example:
3484 *** TODO Write letter to Sam Fortune
3488 The most important commands to work with TODO entries are:
3491 @orgcmd{C-c C-t,org-todo}
3492 @cindex cycling, of TODO states
3493 Rotate the TODO state of the current item among
3496 ,-> (unmarked) -> TODO -> DONE --.
3497 '--------------------------------'
3500 The same rotation can also be done ``remotely'' from the timeline and
3501 agenda buffers with the @kbd{t} command key (@pxref{Agenda commands}).
3503 @orgkey{C-u C-c C-t}
3504 Select a specific keyword using completion or (if it has been set up)
3505 the fast selection interface. For the latter, you need to assign keys
3506 to TODO states, see @ref{Per-file keywords}, and @ref{Setting tags}, for
3509 @kindex S-@key{right}
3510 @kindex S-@key{left}
3511 @item S-@key{right} @ @r{/} @ S-@key{left}
3512 @vindex org-treat-S-cursor-todo-selection-as-state-change
3513 Select the following/preceding TODO state, similar to cycling. Useful
3514 mostly if more than two TODO states are possible (@pxref{TODO
3515 extensions}). See also @ref{Conflicts}, for a discussion of the interaction
3516 with @code{shift-selection-mode}. See also the variable
3517 @code{org-treat-S-cursor-todo-selection-as-state-change}.
3518 @orgcmd{C-c / t,org-show-todo-key}
3519 @cindex sparse tree, for TODO
3520 @vindex org-todo-keywords
3521 View TODO items in a @emph{sparse tree} (@pxref{Sparse trees}). Folds the
3522 entire buffer, but shows all TODO items (with not-DONE state) and the
3523 headings hierarchy above them. With a prefix argument (or by using @kbd{C-c
3524 / T}), search for a specific TODO. You will be prompted for the keyword, and
3525 you can also give a list of keywords like @code{KWD1|KWD2|...} to list
3526 entries that match any one of these keywords. With numeric prefix argument
3527 N, show the tree for the Nth keyword in the variable
3528 @code{org-todo-keywords}. With two prefix arguments, find all TODO states,
3529 both un-done and done.
3530 @orgcmd{C-c a t,org-todo-list}
3531 Show the global TODO list. Collects the TODO items (with not-DONE states)
3532 from all agenda files (@pxref{Agenda Views}) into a single buffer. The new
3533 buffer will be in @code{agenda-mode}, which provides commands to examine and
3534 manipulate the TODO entries from the new buffer (@pxref{Agenda commands}).
3535 @xref{Global TODO list}, for more information.
3536 @orgcmd{S-M-@key{RET},org-insert-todo-heading}
3537 Insert a new TODO entry below the current one.
3541 @vindex org-todo-state-tags-triggers
3542 Changing a TODO state can also trigger tag changes. See the docstring of the
3543 option @code{org-todo-state-tags-triggers} for details.
3545 @node TODO extensions, Progress logging, TODO basics, TODO Items
3546 @section Extended use of TODO keywords
3547 @cindex extended TODO keywords
3549 @vindex org-todo-keywords
3550 By default, marked TODO entries have one of only two states: TODO and
3551 DONE. Org-mode allows you to classify TODO items in more complex ways
3552 with @emph{TODO keywords} (stored in @code{org-todo-keywords}). With
3553 special setup, the TODO keyword system can work differently in different
3556 Note that @i{tags} are another way to classify headlines in general and
3557 TODO items in particular (@pxref{Tags}).
3560 * Workflow states:: From TODO to DONE in steps
3561 * TODO types:: I do this, Fred does the rest
3562 * Multiple sets in one file:: Mixing it all, and still finding your way
3563 * Fast access to TODO states:: Single letter selection of a state
3564 * Per-file keywords:: Different files, different requirements
3565 * Faces for TODO keywords:: Highlighting states
3566 * TODO dependencies:: When one task needs to wait for others
3569 @node Workflow states, TODO types, TODO extensions, TODO extensions
3570 @subsection TODO keywords as workflow states
3571 @cindex TODO workflow
3572 @cindex workflow states as TODO keywords
3574 You can use TODO keywords to indicate different @emph{sequential} states
3575 in the process of working on an item, for example@footnote{Changing
3576 this variable only becomes effective after restarting Org-mode in a
3580 (setq org-todo-keywords
3581 '((sequence "TODO" "FEEDBACK" "VERIFY" "|" "DONE" "DELEGATED")))
3584 The vertical bar separates the TODO keywords (states that @emph{need
3585 action}) from the DONE states (which need @emph{no further action}). If
3586 you don't provide the separator bar, the last state is used as the DONE
3588 @cindex completion, of TODO keywords
3589 With this setup, the command @kbd{C-c C-t} will cycle an entry from TODO
3590 to FEEDBACK, then to VERIFY, and finally to DONE and DELEGATED. You may
3591 also use a numeric prefix argument to quickly select a specific state. For
3592 example @kbd{C-3 C-c C-t} will change the state immediately to VERIFY.
3593 Or you can use @kbd{S-@key{left}} to go backward through the sequence. If you
3594 define many keywords, you can use in-buffer completion
3595 (@pxref{Completion}) or even a special one-key selection scheme
3596 (@pxref{Fast access to TODO states}) to insert these words into the
3597 buffer. Changing a TODO state can be logged with a timestamp, see
3598 @ref{Tracking TODO state changes}, for more information.
3600 @node TODO types, Multiple sets in one file, Workflow states, TODO extensions
3601 @subsection TODO keywords as types
3603 @cindex names as TODO keywords
3604 @cindex types as TODO keywords
3606 The second possibility is to use TODO keywords to indicate different
3607 @emph{types} of action items. For example, you might want to indicate
3608 that items are for ``work'' or ``home''. Or, when you work with several
3609 people on a single project, you might want to assign action items
3610 directly to persons, by using their names as TODO keywords. This would
3611 be set up like this:
3614 (setq org-todo-keywords '((type "Fred" "Sara" "Lucy" "|" "DONE")))
3617 In this case, different keywords do not indicate a sequence, but rather
3618 different types. So the normal work flow would be to assign a task to a
3619 person, and later to mark it DONE. Org-mode supports this style by adapting
3620 the workings of the command @kbd{C-c C-t}@footnote{This is also true for the
3621 @kbd{t} command in the timeline and agenda buffers.}. When used several
3622 times in succession, it will still cycle through all names, in order to first
3623 select the right type for a task. But when you return to the item after some
3624 time and execute @kbd{C-c C-t} again, it will switch from any name directly
3625 to DONE. Use prefix arguments or completion to quickly select a specific
3626 name. You can also review the items of a specific TODO type in a sparse tree
3627 by using a numeric prefix to @kbd{C-c / t}. For example, to see all things
3628 Lucy has to do, you would use @kbd{C-3 C-c / t}. To collect Lucy's items
3629 from all agenda files into a single buffer, you would use the numeric prefix
3630 argument as well when creating the global TODO list: @kbd{C-3 C-c a t}.
3632 @node Multiple sets in one file, Fast access to TODO states, TODO types, TODO extensions
3633 @subsection Multiple keyword sets in one file
3634 @cindex TODO keyword sets
3636 Sometimes you may want to use different sets of TODO keywords in
3637 parallel. For example, you may want to have the basic
3638 @code{TODO}/@code{DONE}, but also a workflow for bug fixing, and a
3639 separate state indicating that an item has been canceled (so it is not
3640 DONE, but also does not require action). Your setup would then look
3644 (setq org-todo-keywords
3645 '((sequence "TODO" "|" "DONE")
3646 (sequence "REPORT" "BUG" "KNOWNCAUSE" "|" "FIXED")
3647 (sequence "|" "CANCELED")))
3650 The keywords should all be different, this helps Org-mode to keep track
3651 of which subsequence should be used for a given entry. In this setup,
3652 @kbd{C-c C-t} only operates within a subsequence, so it switches from
3653 @code{DONE} to (nothing) to @code{TODO}, and from @code{FIXED} to
3654 (nothing) to @code{REPORT}. Therefore you need a mechanism to initially
3655 select the correct sequence. Besides the obvious ways like typing a
3656 keyword or using completion, you may also apply the following commands:
3659 @kindex C-S-@key{right}
3660 @kindex C-S-@key{left}
3661 @kindex C-u C-u C-c C-t
3662 @item C-u C-u C-c C-t
3663 @itemx C-S-@key{right}
3664 @itemx C-S-@key{left}
3665 These keys jump from one TODO subset to the next. In the above example,
3666 @kbd{C-u C-u C-c C-t} or @kbd{C-S-@key{right}} would jump from @code{TODO} or
3667 @code{DONE} to @code{REPORT}, and any of the words in the second row to
3668 @code{CANCELED}. Note that the @kbd{C-S-} key binding conflict with
3669 @code{shift-selection-mode} (@pxref{Conflicts}).
3670 @kindex S-@key{right}
3671 @kindex S-@key{left}
3674 @kbd{S-@key{<left>}} and @kbd{S-@key{<right>}} and walk through @emph{all}
3675 keywords from all sets, so for example @kbd{S-@key{<right>}} would switch
3676 from @code{DONE} to @code{REPORT} in the example above. See also
3677 @ref{Conflicts}, for a discussion of the interaction with
3678 @code{shift-selection-mode}.
3681 @node Fast access to TODO states, Per-file keywords, Multiple sets in one file, TODO extensions
3682 @subsection Fast access to TODO states
3684 If you would like to quickly change an entry to an arbitrary TODO state
3685 instead of cycling through the states, you can set up keys for
3686 single-letter access to the states. This is done by adding the section
3687 key after each keyword, in parentheses. For example:
3690 (setq org-todo-keywords
3691 '((sequence "TODO(t)" "|" "DONE(d)")
3692 (sequence "REPORT(r)" "BUG(b)" "KNOWNCAUSE(k)" "|" "FIXED(f)")
3693 (sequence "|" "CANCELED(c)")))
3696 @vindex org-fast-tag-selection-include-todo
3697 If you then press @code{C-c C-t} followed by the selection key, the entry
3698 will be switched to this state. @key{SPC} can be used to remove any TODO
3699 keyword from an entry.@footnote{Check also the variable
3700 @code{org-fast-tag-selection-include-todo}, it allows you to change the TODO
3701 state through the tags interface (@pxref{Setting tags}), in case you like to
3702 mingle the two concepts. Note that this means you need to come up with
3703 unique keys across both sets of keywords.}
3705 @node Per-file keywords, Faces for TODO keywords, Fast access to TODO states, TODO extensions
3706 @subsection Setting up keywords for individual files
3707 @cindex keyword options
3708 @cindex per-file keywords
3713 It can be very useful to use different aspects of the TODO mechanism in
3714 different files. For file-local settings, you need to add special lines
3715 to the file which set the keywords and interpretation for that file
3716 only. For example, to set one of the two examples discussed above, you
3717 need one of the following lines, starting in column zero anywhere in the
3721 #+TODO: TODO FEEDBACK VERIFY | DONE CANCELED
3723 @noindent (you may also write @code{#+SEQ_TODO} to be explicit about the
3724 interpretation, but it means the same as @code{#+TODO}), or
3726 #+TYP_TODO: Fred Sara Lucy Mike | DONE
3729 A setup for using several sets in parallel would be:
3733 #+TODO: REPORT BUG KNOWNCAUSE | FIXED
3737 @cindex completion, of option keywords
3739 @noindent To make sure you are using the correct keyword, type
3740 @samp{#+} into the buffer and then use @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} completion.
3742 @cindex DONE, final TODO keyword
3743 Remember that the keywords after the vertical bar (or the last keyword
3744 if no bar is there) must always mean that the item is DONE (although you
3745 may use a different word). After changing one of these lines, use
3746 @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor still in the line to make the changes
3747 known to Org-mode@footnote{Org-mode parses these lines only when
3748 Org-mode is activated after visiting a file. @kbd{C-c C-c} with the
3749 cursor in a line starting with @samp{#+} is simply restarting Org-mode
3750 for the current buffer.}.
3752 @node Faces for TODO keywords, TODO dependencies, Per-file keywords, TODO extensions
3753 @subsection Faces for TODO keywords
3754 @cindex faces, for TODO keywords
3756 @vindex org-todo @r{(face)}
3757 @vindex org-done @r{(face)}
3758 @vindex org-todo-keyword-faces
3759 Org-mode highlights TODO keywords with special faces: @code{org-todo}
3760 for keywords indicating that an item still has to be acted upon, and
3761 @code{org-done} for keywords indicating that an item is finished. If
3762 you are using more than 2 different states, you might want to use
3763 special faces for some of them. This can be done using the variable
3764 @code{org-todo-keyword-faces}. For example:
3768 (setq org-todo-keyword-faces
3769 '(("TODO" . org-warning) ("STARTED" . "yellow")
3770 ("CANCELED" . (:foreground "blue" :weight bold))))
3774 While using a list with face properties as shown for CANCELED @emph{should}
3775 work, this does not aways seem to be the case. If necessary, define a
3776 special face and use that. A string is interpreted as a color. The variable
3777 @code{org-faces-easy-properties} determines if that color is interpreted as a
3778 foreground or a background color.
3780 @node TODO dependencies, , Faces for TODO keywords, TODO extensions
3781 @subsection TODO dependencies
3782 @cindex TODO dependencies
3783 @cindex dependencies, of TODO states
3785 @vindex org-enforce-todo-dependencies
3786 @cindex property, ORDERED
3787 The structure of Org files (hierarchy and lists) makes it easy to define TODO
3788 dependencies. Usually, a parent TODO task should not be marked DONE until
3789 all subtasks (defined as children tasks) are marked as DONE. And sometimes
3790 there is a logical sequence to a number of (sub)tasks, so that one task
3791 cannot be acted upon before all siblings above it are done. If you customize
3792 the variable @code{org-enforce-todo-dependencies}, Org will block entries
3793 from changing state to DONE while they have children that are not DONE.
3794 Furthermore, if an entry has a property @code{ORDERED}, each of its children
3795 will be blocked until all earlier siblings are marked DONE. Here is an
3799 * TODO Blocked until (two) is done
3808 ** TODO b, needs to wait for (a)
3809 ** TODO c, needs to wait for (a) and (b)
3813 @orgcmd{C-c C-x o,org-toggle-ordered-property}
3814 @vindex org-track-ordered-property-with-tag
3815 @cindex property, ORDERED
3816 Toggle the @code{ORDERED} property of the current entry. A property is used
3817 for this behavior because this should be local to the current entry, not
3818 inherited like a tag. However, if you would like to @i{track} the value of
3819 this property with a tag for better visibility, customize the variable
3820 @code{org-track-ordered-property-with-tag}.
3821 @orgkey{C-u C-u C-u C-c C-t}
3822 Change TODO state, circumventing any state blocking.
3825 @vindex org-agenda-dim-blocked-tasks
3826 If you set the variable @code{org-agenda-dim-blocked-tasks}, TODO entries
3827 that cannot be closed because of such dependencies will be shown in a dimmed
3828 font or even made invisible in agenda views (@pxref{Agenda Views}).
3830 @cindex checkboxes and TODO dependencies
3831 @vindex org-enforce-todo-dependencies
3832 You can also block changes of TODO states by looking at checkboxes
3833 (@pxref{Checkboxes}). If you set the variable
3834 @code{org-enforce-todo-checkbox-dependencies}, an entry that has unchecked
3835 checkboxes will be blocked from switching to DONE.
3837 If you need more complex dependency structures, for example dependencies
3838 between entries in different trees or files, check out the contributed
3839 module @file{org-depend.el}.
3842 @node Progress logging, Priorities, TODO extensions, TODO Items
3843 @section Progress logging
3844 @cindex progress logging
3845 @cindex logging, of progress
3847 Org-mode can automatically record a timestamp and possibly a note when
3848 you mark a TODO item as DONE, or even each time you change the state of
3849 a TODO item. This system is highly configurable, settings can be on a
3850 per-keyword basis and can be localized to a file or even a subtree. For
3851 information on how to clock working time for a task, see @ref{Clocking
3855 * Closing items:: When was this entry marked DONE?
3856 * Tracking TODO state changes:: When did the status change?
3857 * Tracking your habits:: How consistent have you been?
3860 @node Closing items, Tracking TODO state changes, Progress logging, Progress logging
3861 @subsection Closing items
3863 The most basic logging is to keep track of @emph{when} a certain TODO
3864 item was finished. This is achieved with@footnote{The corresponding
3865 in-buffer setting is: @code{#+STARTUP: logdone}}
3868 (setq org-log-done 'time)
3872 Then each time you turn an entry from a TODO (not-done) state into any
3873 of the DONE states, a line @samp{CLOSED: [timestamp]} will be inserted
3874 just after the headline. If you turn the entry back into a TODO item
3875 through further state cycling, that line will be removed again. If you
3876 want to record a note along with the timestamp, use@footnote{The
3877 corresponding in-buffer setting is: @code{#+STARTUP: lognotedone}}
3880 (setq org-log-done 'note)
3884 You will then be prompted for a note, and that note will be stored below
3885 the entry with a @samp{Closing Note} heading.
3887 In the timeline (@pxref{Timeline}) and in the agenda
3888 (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}), you can then use the @kbd{l} key to
3889 display the TODO items with a @samp{CLOSED} timestamp on each day,
3890 giving you an overview of what has been done.
3892 @node Tracking TODO state changes, Tracking your habits, Closing items, Progress logging
3893 @subsection Tracking TODO state changes
3894 @cindex drawer, for state change recording
3896 @vindex org-log-states-order-reversed
3897 @vindex org-log-into-drawer
3898 @cindex property, LOG_INTO_DRAWER
3899 When TODO keywords are used as workflow states (@pxref{Workflow states}), you
3900 might want to keep track of when a state change occurred and maybe take a
3901 note about this change. You can either record just a timestamp, or a
3902 time-stamped note for a change. These records will be inserted after the
3903 headline as an itemized list, newest first@footnote{See the variable
3904 @code{org-log-states-order-reversed}}. When taking a lot of notes, you might
3905 want to get the notes out of the way into a drawer (@pxref{Drawers}).
3906 Customize the variable @code{org-log-into-drawer} to get this
3907 behavior---the recommended drawer for this is called @code{LOGBOOK}. You can
3908 also overrule the setting of this variable for a subtree by setting a
3909 @code{LOG_INTO_DRAWER} property.
3911 Since it is normally too much to record a note for every state, Org-mode
3912 expects configuration on a per-keyword basis for this. This is achieved by
3913 adding special markers @samp{!} (for a timestamp) and @samp{@@} (for a note)
3914 in parentheses after each keyword. For example, with the setting
3917 (setq org-todo-keywords
3918 '((sequence "TODO(t)" "WAIT(w@@/!)" "|" "DONE(d!)" "CANCELED(c@@)")))
3922 @vindex org-log-done
3923 you not only define global TODO keywords and fast access keys, but also
3924 request that a time is recorded when the entry is set to
3925 DONE@footnote{It is possible that Org-mode will record two timestamps
3926 when you are using both @code{org-log-done} and state change logging.
3927 However, it will never prompt for two notes---if you have configured
3928 both, the state change recording note will take precedence and cancel
3929 the @samp{Closing Note}.}, and that a note is recorded when switching to
3930 WAIT or CANCELED. The setting for WAIT is even more special: the
3931 @samp{!} after the slash means that in addition to the note taken when
3932 entering the state, a timestamp should be recorded when @i{leaving} the
3933 WAIT state, if and only if the @i{target} state does not configure
3934 logging for entering it. So it has no effect when switching from WAIT
3935 to DONE, because DONE is configured to record a timestamp only. But
3936 when switching from WAIT back to TODO, the @samp{/!} in the WAIT
3937 setting now triggers a timestamp even though TODO has no logging
3940 You can use the exact same syntax for setting logging preferences local
3943 #+TODO: TODO(t) WAIT(w@@/!) | DONE(d!) CANCELED(c@@)
3946 @cindex property, LOGGING
3947 In order to define logging settings that are local to a subtree or a
3948 single item, define a LOGGING property in this entry. Any non-empty
3949 LOGGING property resets all logging settings to nil. You may then turn
3950 on logging for this specific tree using STARTUP keywords like
3951 @code{lognotedone} or @code{logrepeat}, as well as adding state specific
3952 settings like @code{TODO(!)}. For example
3955 * TODO Log each state with only a time
3957 :LOGGING: TODO(!) WAIT(!) DONE(!) CANCELED(!)
3959 * TODO Only log when switching to WAIT, and when repeating
3961 :LOGGING: WAIT(@@) logrepeat
3963 * TODO No logging at all
3969 @node Tracking your habits, , Tracking TODO state changes, Progress logging
3970 @subsection Tracking your habits
3973 Org has the ability to track the consistency of a special category of TODOs,
3974 called ``habits''. A habit has the following properties:
3978 You have enabled the @code{habits} module by customizing the variable
3981 The habit is a TODO, with a TODO keyword representing an open state.
3983 The property @code{STYLE} is set to the value @code{habit}.
3985 The TODO has a scheduled date, usually with a @code{.+} style repeat
3986 interval. A @code{++} style may be appropriate for habits with time
3987 constraints, e.g., must be done on weekends, or a @code{+} style for an
3988 unusual habit that can have a backlog, e.g., weekly reports.
3990 The TODO may also have minimum and maximum ranges specified by using the
3991 syntax @samp{.+2d/3d}, which says that you want to do the task at least every
3992 three days, but at most every two days.
3994 You must also have state logging for the @code{DONE} state enabled, in order
3995 for historical data to be represented in the consistency graph. If it's not
3996 enabled it's not an error, but the consistency graphs will be largely
4000 To give you an idea of what the above rules look like in action, here's an
4001 actual habit with some history:
4005 SCHEDULED: <2009-10-17 Sat .+2d/4d>
4006 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-15 Thu]
4007 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-12 Mon]
4008 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-10 Sat]
4009 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-04 Sun]
4010 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-02 Fri]
4011 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-29 Tue]
4012 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-25 Fri]
4013 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-19 Sat]
4014 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-16 Wed]
4015 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-12 Sat]
4018 :LAST_REPEAT: [2009-10-19 Mon 00:36]
4022 What this habit says is: I want to shave at most every 2 days (given by the
4023 @code{SCHEDULED} date and repeat interval) and at least every 4 days. If
4024 today is the 15th, then the habit first appears in the agenda on Oct 17,
4025 after the minimum of 2 days has elapsed, and will appear overdue on Oct 19,
4026 after four days have elapsed.
4028 What's really useful about habits is that they are displayed along with a
4029 consistency graph, to show how consistent you've been at getting that task
4030 done in the past. This graph shows every day that the task was done over the
4031 past three weeks, with colors for each day. The colors used are:
4035 If the task wasn't to be done yet on that day.
4037 If the task could have been done on that day.
4039 If the task was going to be overdue the next day.
4041 If the task was overdue on that day.
4044 In addition to coloring each day, the day is also marked with an asterisk if
4045 the task was actually done that day, and an exclamation mark to show where
4046 the current day falls in the graph.
4048 There are several configuration variables that can be used to change the way
4049 habits are displayed in the agenda.
4052 @item org-habit-graph-column
4053 The buffer column at which the consistency graph should be drawn. This will
4054 overwrite any text in that column, so it's a good idea to keep your habits'
4055 titles brief and to the point.
4056 @item org-habit-preceding-days
4057 The amount of history, in days before today, to appear in consistency graphs.
4058 @item org-habit-following-days
4059 The number of days after today that will appear in consistency graphs.
4060 @item org-habit-show-habits-only-for-today
4061 If non-nil, only show habits in today's agenda view. This is set to true by
4065 Lastly, pressing @kbd{K} in the agenda buffer will cause habits to
4066 temporarily be disabled and they won't appear at all. Press @kbd{K} again to
4067 bring them back. They are also subject to tag filtering, if you have habits
4068 which should only be done in certain contexts, for example.
4070 @node Priorities, Breaking down tasks, Progress logging, TODO Items
4074 If you use Org-mode extensively, you may end up with enough TODO items that
4075 it starts to make sense to prioritize them. Prioritizing can be done by
4076 placing a @emph{priority cookie} into the headline of a TODO item, like this
4079 *** TODO [#A] Write letter to Sam Fortune
4083 @vindex org-priority-faces
4084 By default, Org-mode supports three priorities: @samp{A}, @samp{B}, and
4085 @samp{C}. @samp{A} is the highest priority. An entry without a cookie is
4086 treated just like priority @samp{B}. Priorities make a difference only for
4087 sorting in the agenda (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}); outside the agenda, they
4088 have no inherent meaning to Org-mode. The cookies can be highlighted with
4089 special faces by customizing the variable @code{org-priority-faces}.
4091 Priorities can be attached to any outline node; they do not need to be TODO
4097 @findex org-priority
4098 Set the priority of the current headline (@command{org-priority}). The
4099 command prompts for a priority character @samp{A}, @samp{B} or @samp{C}.
4100 When you press @key{SPC} instead, the priority cookie is removed from the
4101 headline. The priorities can also be changed ``remotely'' from the timeline
4102 and agenda buffer with the @kbd{,} command (@pxref{Agenda commands}).
4104 @orgcmdkkcc{S-@key{up},S-@key{down},org-priority-up,org-priority-down}
4105 @vindex org-priority-start-cycle-with-default
4106 Increase/decrease priority of current headline@footnote{See also the option
4107 @code{org-priority-start-cycle-with-default}.}. Note that these keys are
4108 also used to modify timestamps (@pxref{Creating timestamps}). See also
4109 @ref{Conflicts}, for a discussion of the interaction with
4110 @code{shift-selection-mode}.
4113 @vindex org-highest-priority
4114 @vindex org-lowest-priority
4115 @vindex org-default-priority
4116 You can change the range of allowed priorities by setting the variables
4117 @code{org-highest-priority}, @code{org-lowest-priority}, and
4118 @code{org-default-priority}. For an individual buffer, you may set
4119 these values (highest, lowest, default) like this (please make sure that
4120 the highest priority is earlier in the alphabet than the lowest
4123 @cindex #+PRIORITIES
4128 @node Breaking down tasks, Checkboxes, Priorities, TODO Items
4129 @section Breaking tasks down into subtasks
4130 @cindex tasks, breaking down
4131 @cindex statistics, for TODO items
4133 @vindex org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels
4134 It is often advisable to break down large tasks into smaller, manageable
4135 subtasks. You can do this by creating an outline tree below a TODO item,
4136 with detailed subtasks on the tree@footnote{To keep subtasks out of the
4137 global TODO list, see the @code{org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels}.}. To keep
4138 the overview over the fraction of subtasks that are already completed, insert
4139 either @samp{[/]} or @samp{[%]} anywhere in the headline. These cookies will
4140 be updated each time the TODO status of a child changes, or when pressing
4141 @kbd{C-c C-c} on the cookie. For example:
4144 * Organize Party [33%]
4145 ** TODO Call people [1/2]
4149 ** DONE Talk to neighbor
4152 @cindex property, COOKIE_DATA
4153 If a heading has both checkboxes and TODO children below it, the meaning of
4154 the statistics cookie become ambiguous. Set the property
4155 @code{COOKIE_DATA} to either @samp{checkbox} or @samp{todo} to resolve
4158 @vindex org-hierarchical-todo-statistics
4159 If you would like to have the statistics cookie count any TODO entries in the
4160 subtree (not just direct children), configure the variable
4161 @code{org-hierarchical-todo-statistics}. To do this for a single subtree,
4162 include the word @samp{recursive} into the value of the @code{COOKIE_DATA}
4166 * Parent capturing statistics [2/20]
4168 :COOKIE_DATA: todo recursive
4172 If you would like a TODO entry to automatically change to DONE
4173 when all children are done, you can use the following setup:
4176 (defun org-summary-todo (n-done n-not-done)
4177 "Switch entry to DONE when all subentries are done, to TODO otherwise."
4178 (let (org-log-done org-log-states) ; turn off logging
4179 (org-todo (if (= n-not-done 0) "DONE" "TODO"))))
4181 (add-hook 'org-after-todo-statistics-hook 'org-summary-todo)
4185 Another possibility is the use of checkboxes to identify (a hierarchy of) a
4186 large number of subtasks (@pxref{Checkboxes}).
4189 @node Checkboxes, , Breaking down tasks, TODO Items
4193 @vindex org-list-automatic-rules
4194 Every item in a plain list@footnote{With the exception of description
4195 lists. But you can allow it by modifying @code{org-list-automatic-rules}
4196 accordingly.} (@pxref{Plain lists}) can be made into a checkbox by starting
4197 it with the string @samp{[ ]}. This feature is similar to TODO items
4198 (@pxref{TODO Items}), but is more lightweight. Checkboxes are not included
4199 into the global TODO list, so they are often great to split a task into a
4200 number of simple steps. Or you can use them in a shopping list. To toggle a
4201 checkbox, use @kbd{C-c C-c}, or use the mouse (thanks to Piotr Zielinski's
4202 @file{org-mouse.el}).
4204 Here is an example of a checkbox list.
4207 * TODO Organize party [2/4]
4208 - [-] call people [1/3]
4213 - [ ] think about what music to play
4214 - [X] talk to the neighbors
4217 Checkboxes work hierarchically, so if a checkbox item has children that
4218 are checkboxes, toggling one of the children checkboxes will make the
4219 parent checkbox reflect if none, some, or all of the children are
4222 @cindex statistics, for checkboxes
4223 @cindex checkbox statistics
4224 @cindex property, COOKIE_DATA
4225 @vindex org-hierarchical-checkbox-statistics
4226 The @samp{[2/4]} and @samp{[1/3]} in the first and second line are cookies
4227 indicating how many checkboxes present in this entry have been checked off,
4228 and the total number of checkboxes present. This can give you an idea on how
4229 many checkboxes remain, even without opening a folded entry. The cookies can
4230 be placed into a headline or into (the first line of) a plain list item.
4231 Each cookie covers checkboxes of direct children structurally below the
4232 headline/item on which the cookie appears@footnote{Set the variable
4233 @code{org-hierarchical-checkbox-statistics} if you want such cookies to
4234 represent the all checkboxes below the cookie, not just the direct
4235 children.}. You have to insert the cookie yourself by typing either
4236 @samp{[/]} or @samp{[%]}. With @samp{[/]} you get an @samp{n out of m}
4237 result, as in the examples above. With @samp{[%]} you get information about
4238 the percentage of checkboxes checked (in the above example, this would be
4239 @samp{[50%]} and @samp{[33%]}, respectively). In a headline, a cookie can
4240 count either checkboxes below the heading or TODO states of children, and it
4241 will display whatever was changed last. Set the property @code{COOKIE_DATA}
4242 to either @samp{checkbox} or @samp{todo} to resolve this issue.
4244 @cindex blocking, of checkboxes
4245 @cindex checkbox blocking
4246 @cindex property, ORDERED
4247 If the current outline node has an @code{ORDERED} property, checkboxes must
4248 be checked off in sequence, and an error will be thrown if you try to check
4249 off a box while there are unchecked boxes above it.
4251 @noindent The following commands work with checkboxes:
4254 @orgcmd{C-c C-c,org-toggle-checkbox}
4255 Toggle checkbox status or (with prefix arg) checkbox presence at point. With
4256 double prefix argument, set it to @samp{[-]}, which is considered to be an
4258 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-b,org-toggle-checkbox}
4259 Toggle checkbox status or (with prefix arg) checkbox presence at point. With
4260 double prefix argument, set it to @samp{[-]}, which is considered to be an
4264 If there is an active region, toggle the first checkbox in the region
4265 and set all remaining boxes to the same status as the first. With a prefix
4266 arg, add or remove the checkbox for all items in the region.
4268 If the cursor is in a headline, toggle checkboxes in the region between
4269 this headline and the next (so @emph{not} the entire subtree).
4271 If there is no active region, just toggle the checkbox at point.
4273 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{RET},org-insert-todo-heading}
4274 Insert a new item with a checkbox.
4275 This works only if the cursor is already in a plain list item
4276 (@pxref{Plain lists}).
4277 @orgcmd{C-c C-x o,org-toggle-ordered-property}
4278 @vindex org-track-ordered-property-with-tag
4279 @cindex property, ORDERED
4280 Toggle the @code{ORDERED} property of the entry, to toggle if checkboxes must
4281 be checked off in sequence. A property is used for this behavior because
4282 this should be local to the current entry, not inherited like a tag.
4283 However, if you would like to @i{track} the value of this property with a tag
4284 for better visibility, customize the variable
4285 @code{org-track-ordered-property-with-tag}.
4286 @orgcmd{C-c #,org-update-statistics-cookies}
4287 Update the statistics cookie in the current outline entry. When called with
4288 a @kbd{C-u} prefix, update the entire file. Checkbox statistic cookies are
4289 updated automatically if you toggle checkboxes with @kbd{C-c C-c} and make
4290 new ones with @kbd{M-S-@key{RET}}. TODO statistics cookies update when
4291 changing TODO states. If you delete boxes/entries or add/change them by
4292 hand, use this command to get things back into sync. Or simply toggle any
4293 entry twice (checkboxes with @kbd{C-c C-c}).
4296 @node Tags, Properties and Columns, TODO Items, Top
4299 @cindex headline tagging
4300 @cindex matching, tags
4301 @cindex sparse tree, tag based
4303 An excellent way to implement labels and contexts for cross-correlating
4304 information is to assign @i{tags} to headlines. Org-mode has extensive
4307 @vindex org-tag-faces
4308 Every headline can contain a list of tags; they occur at the end of the
4309 headline. Tags are normal words containing letters, numbers, @samp{_}, and
4310 @samp{@@}. Tags must be preceded and followed by a single colon, e.g.,
4311 @samp{:work:}. Several tags can be specified, as in @samp{:work:urgent:}.
4312 Tags will by default be in bold face with the same color as the headline.
4313 You may specify special faces for specific tags using the variable
4314 @code{org-tag-faces}, in much the same way as you can for TODO keywords
4315 (@pxref{Faces for TODO keywords}).
4318 * Tag inheritance:: Tags use the tree structure of the outline
4319 * Setting tags:: How to assign tags to a headline
4320 * Tag searches:: Searching for combinations of tags
4323 @node Tag inheritance, Setting tags, Tags, Tags
4324 @section Tag inheritance
4325 @cindex tag inheritance
4326 @cindex inheritance, of tags
4327 @cindex sublevels, inclusion into tags match
4329 @i{Tags} make use of the hierarchical structure of outline trees. If a
4330 heading has a certain tag, all subheadings will inherit the tag as
4331 well. For example, in the list
4334 * Meeting with the French group :work:
4335 ** Summary by Frank :boss:notes:
4336 *** TODO Prepare slides for him :action:
4340 the final heading will have the tags @samp{:work:}, @samp{:boss:},
4341 @samp{:notes:}, and @samp{:action:} even though the final heading is not
4342 explicitly marked with those tags. You can also set tags that all entries in
4343 a file should inherit just as if these tags were defined in a hypothetical
4344 level zero that surrounds the entire file. Use a line like this@footnote{As
4345 with all these in-buffer settings, pressing @kbd{C-c C-c} activates any
4346 changes in the line.}:
4350 #+FILETAGS: :Peter:Boss:Secret:
4354 @vindex org-use-tag-inheritance
4355 @vindex org-tags-exclude-from-inheritance
4356 To limit tag inheritance to specific tags, or to turn it off entirely, use
4357 the variables @code{org-use-tag-inheritance} and
4358 @code{org-tags-exclude-from-inheritance}.
4360 @vindex org-tags-match-list-sublevels
4361 When a headline matches during a tags search while tag inheritance is turned
4362 on, all the sublevels in the same tree will (for a simple match form) match
4363 as well@footnote{This is only true if the search does not involve more
4364 complex tests including properties (@pxref{Property searches}).}. The list
4365 of matches may then become very long. If you only want to see the first tags
4366 match in a subtree, configure the variable
4367 @code{org-tags-match-list-sublevels} (not recommended).
4369 @node Setting tags, Tag searches, Tag inheritance, Tags
4370 @section Setting tags
4371 @cindex setting tags
4372 @cindex tags, setting
4375 Tags can simply be typed into the buffer at the end of a headline.
4376 After a colon, @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} offers completion on tags. There is
4377 also a special command for inserting tags:
4380 @orgcmd{C-c C-q,org-set-tags-command}
4381 @cindex completion, of tags
4382 @vindex org-tags-column
4383 Enter new tags for the current headline. Org-mode will either offer
4384 completion or a special single-key interface for setting tags, see
4385 below. After pressing @key{RET}, the tags will be inserted and aligned
4386 to @code{org-tags-column}. When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix, all
4387 tags in the current buffer will be aligned to that column, just to make
4388 things look nice. TAGS are automatically realigned after promotion,
4389 demotion, and TODO state changes (@pxref{TODO basics}).
4390 @orgcmd{C-c C-c,org-set-tags-command}
4391 When the cursor is in a headline, this does the same as @kbd{C-c C-q}.
4394 @vindex org-tag-alist
4395 Org will support tag insertion based on a @emph{list of tags}. By
4396 default this list is constructed dynamically, containing all tags
4397 currently used in the buffer. You may also globally specify a hard list
4398 of tags with the variable @code{org-tag-alist}. Finally you can set
4399 the default tags for a given file with lines like
4403 #+TAGS: @@work @@home @@tennisclub
4404 #+TAGS: laptop car pc sailboat
4407 If you have globally defined your preferred set of tags using the
4408 variable @code{org-tag-alist}, but would like to use a dynamic tag list
4409 in a specific file, add an empty TAGS option line to that file:
4415 @vindex org-tag-persistent-alist
4416 If you have a preferred set of tags that you would like to use in every file,
4417 in addition to those defined on a per-file basis by TAGS option lines, then
4418 you may specify a list of tags with the variable
4419 @code{org-tag-persistent-alist}. You may turn this off on a per-file basis
4420 by adding a STARTUP option line to that file:
4426 By default Org-mode uses the standard minibuffer completion facilities for
4427 entering tags. However, it also implements another, quicker, tag selection
4428 method called @emph{fast tag selection}. This allows you to select and
4429 deselect tags with just a single key press. For this to work well you should
4430 assign unique letters to most of your commonly used tags. You can do this
4431 globally by configuring the variable @code{org-tag-alist} in your
4432 @file{.emacs} file. For example, you may find the need to tag many items in
4433 different files with @samp{:@@home:}. In this case you can set something
4437 (setq org-tag-alist '(("@@work" . ?w) ("@@home" . ?h) ("laptop" . ?l)))
4440 @noindent If the tag is only relevant to the file you are working on, then you
4441 can instead set the TAGS option line as:
4444 #+TAGS: @@work(w) @@home(h) @@tennisclub(t) laptop(l) pc(p)
4447 @noindent The tags interface will show the available tags in a splash
4448 window. If you want to start a new line after a specific tag, insert
4449 @samp{\n} into the tag list
4452 #+TAGS: @@work(w) @@home(h) @@tennisclub(t) \n laptop(l) pc(p)
4455 @noindent or write them in two lines:
4458 #+TAGS: @@work(w) @@home(h) @@tennisclub(t)
4459 #+TAGS: laptop(l) pc(p)
4463 You can also group together tags that are mutually exclusive by using
4467 #+TAGS: @{ @@work(w) @@home(h) @@tennisclub(t) @} laptop(l) pc(p)
4470 @noindent you indicate that at most one of @samp{@@work}, @samp{@@home},
4471 and @samp{@@tennisclub} should be selected. Multiple such groups are allowed.
4473 @noindent Don't forget to press @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor in one of
4474 these lines to activate any changes.
4477 To set these mutually exclusive groups in the variable @code{org-tags-alist},
4478 you must use the dummy tags @code{:startgroup} and @code{:endgroup} instead
4479 of the braces. Similarly, you can use @code{:newline} to indicate a line
4480 break. The previous example would be set globally by the following
4484 (setq org-tag-alist '((:startgroup . nil)
4485 ("@@work" . ?w) ("@@home" . ?h)
4486 ("@@tennisclub" . ?t)
4488 ("laptop" . ?l) ("pc" . ?p)))
4491 If at least one tag has a selection key then pressing @kbd{C-c C-c} will
4492 automatically present you with a special interface, listing inherited tags,
4493 the tags of the current headline, and a list of all valid tags with
4494 corresponding keys@footnote{Keys will automatically be assigned to tags which
4495 have no configured keys.}. In this interface, you can use the following
4500 Pressing keys assigned to tags will add or remove them from the list of
4501 tags in the current line. Selecting a tag in a group of mutually
4502 exclusive tags will turn off any other tags from that group.
4505 Enter a tag in the minibuffer, even if the tag is not in the predefined
4506 list. You will be able to complete on all tags present in the buffer.
4509 Clear all tags for this line.
4512 Accept the modified set.
4514 Abort without installing changes.
4516 If @kbd{q} is not assigned to a tag, it aborts like @kbd{C-g}.
4518 Turn off groups of mutually exclusive tags. Use this to (as an
4519 exception) assign several tags from such a group.
4521 Toggle auto-exit after the next change (see below).
4522 If you are using expert mode, the first @kbd{C-c} will display the
4527 This method lets you assign tags to a headline with very few keys. With
4528 the above setup, you could clear the current tags and set @samp{@@home},
4529 @samp{laptop} and @samp{pc} tags with just the following keys: @kbd{C-c
4530 C-c @key{SPC} h l p @key{RET}}. Switching from @samp{@@home} to
4531 @samp{@@work} would be done with @kbd{C-c C-c w @key{RET}} or
4532 alternatively with @kbd{C-c C-c C-c w}. Adding the non-predefined tag
4533 @samp{Sarah} could be done with @kbd{C-c C-c @key{TAB} S a r a h
4534 @key{RET} @key{RET}}.
4536 @vindex org-fast-tag-selection-single-key
4537 If you find that most of the time you need only a single key press to
4538 modify your list of tags, set the variable
4539 @code{org-fast-tag-selection-single-key}. Then you no longer have to
4540 press @key{RET} to exit fast tag selection---it will immediately exit
4541 after the first change. If you then occasionally need more keys, press
4542 @kbd{C-c} to turn off auto-exit for the current tag selection process
4543 (in effect: start selection with @kbd{C-c C-c C-c} instead of @kbd{C-c
4544 C-c}). If you set the variable to the value @code{expert}, the special
4545 window is not even shown for single-key tag selection, it comes up only
4546 when you press an extra @kbd{C-c}.
4548 @node Tag searches, , Setting tags, Tags
4549 @section Tag searches
4550 @cindex tag searches
4551 @cindex searching for tags
4553 Once a system of tags has been set up, it can be used to collect related
4554 information into special lists.
4557 @orgcmdkkc{C-c / m,C-c \,org-match-sparse-tree}
4558 Create a sparse tree with all headlines matching a tags search. With a
4559 @kbd{C-u} prefix argument, ignore headlines that are not a TODO line.
4560 @orgcmd{C-c a m,org-tags-view}
4561 Create a global list of tag matches from all agenda files.
4562 @xref{Matching tags and properties}.
4563 @orgcmd{C-c a M,org-tags-view}
4564 @vindex org-tags-match-list-sublevels
4565 Create a global list of tag matches from all agenda files, but check
4566 only TODO items and force checking subitems (see variable
4567 @code{org-tags-match-list-sublevels}).
4570 These commands all prompt for a match string which allows basic Boolean logic
4571 like @samp{+boss+urgent-project1}, to find entries with tags @samp{boss} and
4572 @samp{urgent}, but not @samp{project1}, or @samp{Kathy|Sally} to find entries
4573 which are tagged, like @samp{Kathy} or @samp{Sally}. The full syntax of the search
4574 string is rich and allows also matching against TODO keywords, entry levels
4575 and properties. For a complete description with many examples, see
4576 @ref{Matching tags and properties}.
4579 @node Properties and Columns, Dates and Times, Tags, Top
4580 @chapter Properties and columns
4583 Properties are a set of key-value pairs associated with an entry. There
4584 are two main applications for properties in Org-mode. First, properties
4585 are like tags, but with a value. Second, you can use properties to
4586 implement (very basic) database capabilities in an Org buffer. For
4587 an example of the first application, imagine maintaining a file where
4588 you document bugs and plan releases for a piece of software. Instead of
4589 using tags like @code{:release_1:}, @code{:release_2:}, one can use a
4590 property, say @code{:Release:}, that in different subtrees has different
4591 values, such as @code{1.0} or @code{2.0}. For an example of the second
4592 application of properties, imagine keeping track of your music CDs,
4593 where properties could be things such as the album, artist, date of
4594 release, number of tracks, and so on.
4596 Properties can be conveniently edited and viewed in column view
4597 (@pxref{Column view}).
4600 * Property syntax:: How properties are spelled out
4601 * Special properties:: Access to other Org-mode features
4602 * Property searches:: Matching property values
4603 * Property inheritance:: Passing values down the tree
4604 * Column view:: Tabular viewing and editing
4605 * Property API:: Properties for Lisp programmers
4608 @node Property syntax, Special properties, Properties and Columns, Properties and Columns
4609 @section Property syntax
4610 @cindex property syntax
4611 @cindex drawer, for properties
4613 Properties are key-value pairs. They need to be inserted into a special
4614 drawer (@pxref{Drawers}) with the name @code{PROPERTIES}. Each property
4615 is specified on a single line, with the key (surrounded by colons)
4616 first, and the value after it. Here is an example:
4621 *** Goldberg Variations
4623 :Title: Goldberg Variations
4624 :Composer: J.S. Bach
4626 :Publisher: Deutsche Grammophon
4631 You may define the allowed values for a particular property @samp{:Xyz:}
4632 by setting a property @samp{:Xyz_ALL:}. This special property is
4633 @emph{inherited}, so if you set it in a level 1 entry, it will apply to
4634 the entire tree. When allowed values are defined, setting the
4635 corresponding property becomes easier and is less prone to typing
4636 errors. For the example with the CD collection, we can predefine
4637 publishers and the number of disks in a box like this:
4642 :NDisks_ALL: 1 2 3 4
4643 :Publisher_ALL: "Deutsche Grammophon" Philips EMI
4647 If you want to set properties that can be inherited by any entry in a
4648 file, use a line like
4649 @cindex property, _ALL
4652 #+PROPERTY: NDisks_ALL 1 2 3 4
4655 @vindex org-global-properties
4656 Property values set with the global variable
4657 @code{org-global-properties} can be inherited by all entries in all
4661 The following commands help to work with properties:
4664 @orgcmd{M-@key{TAB},org-complete}
4665 After an initial colon in a line, complete property keys. All keys used
4666 in the current file will be offered as possible completions.
4667 @orgcmd{C-c C-x p,org-set-property}
4668 Set a property. This prompts for a property name and a value. If
4669 necessary, the property drawer is created as well.
4670 @item M-x org-insert-property-drawer
4671 @findex org-insert-property-drawer
4672 Insert a property drawer into the current entry. The drawer will be
4673 inserted early in the entry, but after the lines with planning
4674 information like deadlines.
4675 @orgcmd{C-c C-c,org-property-action}
4676 With the cursor in a property drawer, this executes property commands.
4677 @orgcmd{C-c C-c s,org-set-property}
4678 Set a property in the current entry. Both the property and the value
4679 can be inserted using completion.
4680 @orgcmdkkcc{S-@key{right},S-@key{left},org-property-next-allowed-value,org-property-previous-allowed-value}
4681 Switch property at point to the next/previous allowed value.
4682 @orgcmd{C-c C-c d,org-delete-property}
4683 Remove a property from the current entry.
4684 @orgcmd{C-c C-c D,org-delete-property-globally}
4685 Globally remove a property, from all entries in the current file.
4686 @orgcmd{C-c C-c c,org-compute-property-at-point}
4687 Compute the property at point, using the operator and scope from the
4688 nearest column format definition.
4691 @node Special properties, Property searches, Property syntax, Properties and Columns
4692 @section Special properties
4693 @cindex properties, special
4695 Special properties provide an alternative access method to Org-mode
4696 features, like the TODO state or the priority of an entry, discussed in the
4697 previous chapters. This interface exists so that you can include
4698 these states in a column view (@pxref{Column view}), or to use them in
4699 queries. The following property names are special and should not be
4700 used as keys in the properties drawer:
4702 @cindex property, special, TODO
4703 @cindex property, special, TAGS
4704 @cindex property, special, ALLTAGS
4705 @cindex property, special, CATEGORY
4706 @cindex property, special, PRIORITY
4707 @cindex property, special, DEADLINE
4708 @cindex property, special, SCHEDULED
4709 @cindex property, special, CLOSED
4710 @cindex property, special, TIMESTAMP
4711 @cindex property, special, TIMESTAMP_IA
4712 @cindex property, special, CLOCKSUM
4713 @cindex property, special, BLOCKED
4714 @c guessing that ITEM is needed in this area; also, should this list be sorted?
4715 @cindex property, special, ITEM
4716 @cindex property, special, FILE
4718 TODO @r{The TODO keyword of the entry.}
4719 TAGS @r{The tags defined directly in the headline.}
4720 ALLTAGS @r{All tags, including inherited ones.}
4721 CATEGORY @r{The category of an entry.}
4722 PRIORITY @r{The priority of the entry, a string with a single letter.}
4723 DEADLINE @r{The deadline time string, without the angular brackets.}
4724 SCHEDULED @r{The scheduling timestamp, without the angular brackets.}
4725 CLOSED @r{When was this entry closed?}
4726 TIMESTAMP @r{The first keyword-less timestamp in the entry.}
4727 TIMESTAMP_IA @r{The first inactive timestamp in the entry.}
4728 CLOCKSUM @r{The sum of CLOCK intervals in the subtree. @code{org-clock-sum}}
4729 @r{must be run first to compute the values.}
4730 BLOCKED @r{"t" if task is currently blocked by children or siblings}
4731 ITEM @r{The content of the entry.}
4732 FILE @r{The filename the entry is located in.}
4735 @node Property searches, Property inheritance, Special properties, Properties and Columns
4736 @section Property searches
4737 @cindex properties, searching
4738 @cindex searching, of properties
4740 To create sparse trees and special lists with selection based on properties,
4741 the same commands are used as for tag searches (@pxref{Tag searches}).
4743 @orgcmdkkc{C-c / m,C-c \,org-match-sparse-tree}
4744 Create a sparse tree with all matching entries. With a
4745 @kbd{C-u} prefix argument, ignore headlines that are not a TODO line.
4746 @orgcmd{C-c a m,org-tags-view}
4747 Create a global list of tag/property matches from all agenda files.
4748 @xref{Matching tags and properties}.
4749 @orgcmd{C-c a M,org-tags-view}
4750 @vindex org-tags-match-list-sublevels
4751 Create a global list of tag matches from all agenda files, but check
4752 only TODO items and force checking of subitems (see variable
4753 @code{org-tags-match-list-sublevels}).
4756 The syntax for the search string is described in @ref{Matching tags and
4759 There is also a special command for creating sparse trees based on a
4764 Create a sparse tree based on the value of a property. This first
4765 prompts for the name of a property, and then for a value. A sparse tree
4766 is created with all entries that define this property with the given
4767 value. If you enclose the value in curly braces, it is interpreted as
4768 a regular expression and matched against the property values.
4771 @node Property inheritance, Column view, Property searches, Properties and Columns
4772 @section Property Inheritance
4773 @cindex properties, inheritance
4774 @cindex inheritance, of properties
4776 @vindex org-use-property-inheritance
4777 The outline structure of Org-mode documents lends itself to an
4778 inheritance model of properties: if the parent in a tree has a certain
4779 property, the children can inherit this property. Org-mode does not
4780 turn this on by default, because it can slow down property searches
4781 significantly and is often not needed. However, if you find inheritance
4782 useful, you can turn it on by setting the variable
4783 @code{org-use-property-inheritance}. It may be set to @code{t} to make
4784 all properties inherited from the parent, to a list of properties
4785 that should be inherited, or to a regular expression that matches
4786 inherited properties. If a property has the value @samp{nil}, this is
4787 interpreted as an explicit undefine of the property, so that inheritance
4788 search will stop at this value and return @code{nil}.
4790 Org-mode has a few properties for which inheritance is hard-coded, at
4791 least for the special applications for which they are used:
4793 @cindex property, COLUMNS
4796 The @code{:COLUMNS:} property defines the format of column view
4797 (@pxref{Column view}). It is inherited in the sense that the level
4798 where a @code{:COLUMNS:} property is defined is used as the starting
4799 point for a column view table, independently of the location in the
4800 subtree from where columns view is turned on.
4802 @cindex property, CATEGORY
4803 For agenda view, a category set through a @code{:CATEGORY:} property
4804 applies to the entire subtree.
4806 @cindex property, ARCHIVE
4807 For archiving, the @code{:ARCHIVE:} property may define the archive
4808 location for the entire subtree (@pxref{Moving subtrees}).
4810 @cindex property, LOGGING
4811 The LOGGING property may define logging settings for an entry or a
4812 subtree (@pxref{Tracking TODO state changes}).
4815 @node Column view, Property API, Property inheritance, Properties and Columns
4816 @section Column view
4818 A great way to view and edit properties in an outline tree is
4819 @emph{column view}. In column view, each outline node is turned into a
4820 table row. Columns in this table provide access to properties of the
4821 entries. Org-mode implements columns by overlaying a tabular structure
4822 over the headline of each item. While the headlines have been turned
4823 into a table row, you can still change the visibility of the outline
4824 tree. For example, you get a compact table by switching to CONTENTS
4825 view (@kbd{S-@key{TAB} S-@key{TAB}}, or simply @kbd{c} while column view
4826 is active), but you can still open, read, and edit the entry below each
4827 headline. Or, you can switch to column view after executing a sparse
4828 tree command and in this way get a table only for the selected items.
4829 Column view also works in agenda buffers (@pxref{Agenda Views}) where
4830 queries have collected selected items, possibly from a number of files.
4833 * Defining columns:: The COLUMNS format property
4834 * Using column view:: How to create and use column view
4835 * Capturing column view:: A dynamic block for column view
4838 @node Defining columns, Using column view, Column view, Column view
4839 @subsection Defining columns
4840 @cindex column view, for properties
4841 @cindex properties, column view
4843 Setting up a column view first requires defining the columns. This is
4844 done by defining a column format line.
4847 * Scope of column definitions:: Where defined, where valid?
4848 * Column attributes:: Appearance and content of a column
4851 @node Scope of column definitions, Column attributes, Defining columns, Defining columns
4852 @subsubsection Scope of column definitions
4854 To define a column format for an entire file, use a line like
4858 #+COLUMNS: %25ITEM %TAGS %PRIORITY %TODO
4861 To specify a format that only applies to a specific tree, add a
4862 @code{:COLUMNS:} property to the top node of that tree, for example:
4865 ** Top node for columns view
4867 :COLUMNS: %25ITEM %TAGS %PRIORITY %TODO
4871 If a @code{:COLUMNS:} property is present in an entry, it defines columns
4872 for the entry itself, and for the entire subtree below it. Since the
4873 column definition is part of the hierarchical structure of the document,
4874 you can define columns on level 1 that are general enough for all
4875 sublevels, and more specific columns further down, when you edit a
4876 deeper part of the tree.
4878 @node Column attributes, , Scope of column definitions, Defining columns
4879 @subsubsection Column attributes
4880 A column definition sets the attributes of a column. The general
4881 definition looks like this:
4884 %[@var{width}]@var{property}[(@var{title})][@{@var{summary-type}@}]
4888 Except for the percent sign and the property name, all items are
4889 optional. The individual parts have the following meaning:
4892 @var{width} @r{An integer specifying the width of the column in characters.}
4893 @r{If omitted, the width will be determined automatically.}
4894 @var{property} @r{The property that should be edited in this column.}
4895 @r{Special properties representing meta data are allowed here}
4896 @r{as well (@pxref{Special properties})}
4897 @var{title} @r{The header text for the column. If omitted, the property}
4899 @{@var{summary-type}@} @r{The summary type. If specified, the column values for}
4900 @r{parent nodes are computed from the children.}
4901 @r{Supported summary types are:}
4902 @{+@} @r{Sum numbers in this column.}
4903 @{+;%.1f@} @r{Like @samp{+}, but format result with @samp{%.1f}.}
4904 @{$@} @r{Currency, short for @samp{+;%.2f}.}
4905 @{:@} @r{Sum times, HH:MM, plain numbers are hours.}
4906 @{X@} @r{Checkbox status, @samp{[X]} if all children are @samp{[X]}.}
4907 @{X/@} @r{Checkbox status, @samp{[n/m]}.}
4908 @{X%@} @r{Checkbox status, @samp{[n%]}.}
4909 @{min@} @r{Smallest number in column.}
4910 @{max@} @r{Largest number.}
4911 @{mean@} @r{Arithmetic mean of numbers.}
4912 @{:min@} @r{Smallest time value in column.}
4913 @{:max@} @r{Largest time value.}
4914 @{:mean@} @r{Arithmetic mean of time values.}
4915 @{@@min@} @r{Minimum age (in days/hours/mins/seconds).}
4916 @{@@max@} @r{Maximum age (in days/hours/mins/seconds).}
4917 @{@@mean@} @r{Arithmetic mean of ages (in days/hours/mins/seconds).}
4918 @{est+@} @r{Add low-high estimates.}
4922 Be aware that you can only have one summary type for any property you
4923 include. Subsequent columns referencing the same property will all display the
4924 same summary information.
4926 The @code{est+} summary type requires further explanation. It is used for
4927 combining estimates, expressed as low-high ranges. For example, instead
4928 of estimating a particular task will take 5 days, you might estimate it as
4929 5-6 days if you're fairly confident you know how much work is required, or
4930 1-10 days if you don't really know what needs to be done. Both ranges
4931 average at 5.5 days, but the first represents a more predictable delivery.
4933 When combining a set of such estimates, simply adding the lows and highs
4934 produces an unrealistically wide result. Instead, @code{est+} adds the
4935 statistical mean and variance of the sub-tasks, generating a final estimate
4936 from the sum. For example, suppose you had ten tasks, each of which was
4937 estimated at 0.5 to 2 days of work. Straight addition produces an estimate
4938 of 5 to 20 days, representing what to expect if everything goes either
4939 extremely well or extremely poorly. In contrast, @code{est+} estimates the
4940 full job more realistically, at 10-15 days.
4942 Here is an example for a complete columns definition, along with allowed
4946 :COLUMNS: %25ITEM %9Approved(Approved?)@{X@} %Owner %11Status \@footnote{Please note that the COLUMNS definition must be on a single line---it is wrapped here only because of formatting constraints.}
4947 %10Time_Estimate@{:@} %CLOCKSUM
4948 :Owner_ALL: Tammy Mark Karl Lisa Don
4949 :Status_ALL: "In progress" "Not started yet" "Finished" ""
4950 :Approved_ALL: "[ ]" "[X]"
4954 The first column, @samp{%25ITEM}, means the first 25 characters of the
4955 item itself, i.e. of the headline. You probably always should start the
4956 column definition with the @samp{ITEM} specifier. The other specifiers
4957 create columns @samp{Owner} with a list of names as allowed values, for
4958 @samp{Status} with four different possible values, and for a checkbox
4959 field @samp{Approved}. When no width is given after the @samp{%}
4960 character, the column will be exactly as wide as it needs to be in order
4961 to fully display all values. The @samp{Approved} column does have a
4962 modified title (@samp{Approved?}, with a question mark). Summaries will
4963 be created for the @samp{Time_Estimate} column by adding time duration
4964 expressions like HH:MM, and for the @samp{Approved} column, by providing
4965 an @samp{[X]} status if all children have been checked. The
4966 @samp{CLOCKSUM} column is special, it lists the sum of CLOCK intervals
4969 @node Using column view, Capturing column view, Defining columns, Column view
4970 @subsection Using column view
4973 @tsubheading{Turning column view on and off}
4974 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-c,org-columns}
4975 @vindex org-columns-default-format
4976 Turn on column view. If the cursor is before the first headline in the file,
4977 column view is turned on for the entire file, using the @code{#+COLUMNS}
4978 definition. If the cursor is somewhere inside the outline, this command
4979 searches the hierarchy, up from point, for a @code{:COLUMNS:} property that
4980 defines a format. When one is found, the column view table is established
4981 for the tree starting at the entry that contains the @code{:COLUMNS:}
4982 property. If no such property is found, the format is taken from the
4983 @code{#+COLUMNS} line or from the variable @code{org-columns-default-format},
4984 and column view is established for the current entry and its subtree.
4985 @orgcmd{r,org-columns-redo}
4986 Recreate the column view, to include recent changes made in the buffer.
4987 @orgcmd{g,org-columns-redo}
4989 @orgcmd{q,org-columns-quit}
4991 @tsubheading{Editing values}
4992 @item @key{left} @key{right} @key{up} @key{down}
4993 Move through the column view from field to field.
4994 @kindex S-@key{left}
4995 @kindex S-@key{right}
4996 @item S-@key{left}/@key{right}
4997 Switch to the next/previous allowed value of the field. For this, you
4998 have to have specified allowed values for a property.
5000 Directly select the Nth allowed value, @kbd{0} selects the 10th value.
5001 @orgcmdkkcc{n,p,org-columns-next-allowed-value,org-columns-previous-allowed-value}
5002 Same as @kbd{S-@key{left}/@key{right}}
5003 @orgcmd{e,org-columns-edit-value}
5004 Edit the property at point. For the special properties, this will
5005 invoke the same interface that you normally use to change that
5006 property. For example, when editing a TAGS property, the tag completion
5007 or fast selection interface will pop up.
5008 @orgcmd{C-c C-c,org-columns-set-tags-or-toggle}
5009 When there is a checkbox at point, toggle it.
5010 @orgcmd{v,org-columns-show-value}
5011 View the full value of this property. This is useful if the width of
5012 the column is smaller than that of the value.
5013 @orgcmd{a,org-columns-edit-allowed}
5014 Edit the list of allowed values for this property. If the list is found
5015 in the hierarchy, the modified values is stored there. If no list is
5016 found, the new value is stored in the first entry that is part of the
5017 current column view.
5018 @tsubheading{Modifying the table structure}
5019 @orgcmdkkcc{<,>,org-columns-narrow,org-columns-widen}
5020 Make the column narrower/wider by one character.
5021 @orgcmd{S-M-@key{right},org-columns-new}
5022 Insert a new column, to the left of the current column.
5023 @orgcmd{S-M-@key{left},org-columns-delete}
5024 Delete the current column.
5027 @node Capturing column view, , Using column view, Column view
5028 @subsection Capturing column view
5030 Since column view is just an overlay over a buffer, it cannot be
5031 exported or printed directly. If you want to capture a column view, use
5032 a @code{columnview} dynamic block (@pxref{Dynamic blocks}). The frame
5033 of this block looks like this:
5035 @cindex #+BEGIN, columnview
5038 #+BEGIN: columnview :hlines 1 :id "label"
5043 @noindent This dynamic block has the following parameters:
5047 This is the most important parameter. Column view is a feature that is
5048 often localized to a certain (sub)tree, and the capture block might be
5049 at a different location in the file. To identify the tree whose view to
5050 capture, you can use 4 values:
5051 @cindex property, ID
5053 local @r{use the tree in which the capture block is located}
5054 global @r{make a global view, including all headings in the file}
5055 "file:@var{path-to-file}"
5056 @r{run column view at the top of this file}
5057 "@var{ID}" @r{call column view in the tree that has an @code{:ID:}}
5058 @r{property with the value @i{label}. You can use}
5059 @r{@kbd{M-x org-id-copy} to create a globally unique ID for}
5060 @r{the current entry and copy it to the kill-ring.}
5063 When @code{t}, insert an hline after every line. When a number @var{N}, insert
5064 an hline before each headline with level @code{<= @var{N}}.
5066 When set to @code{t}, force column groups to get vertical lines.
5068 When set to a number, don't capture entries below this level.
5069 @item :skip-empty-rows
5070 When set to @code{t}, skip rows where the only non-empty specifier of the
5071 column view is @code{ITEM}.
5076 The following commands insert or update the dynamic block:
5079 @orgcmd{C-c C-x i,org-insert-columns-dblock}
5080 Insert a dynamic block capturing a column view. You will be prompted
5081 for the scope or ID of the view.
5082 @orgcmdkkc{C-c C-c,C-c C-x C-u,org-dblock-update}
5083 Update dynamic block at point. The cursor needs to be in the
5084 @code{#+BEGIN} line of the dynamic block.
5085 @orgcmd{C-u C-c C-x C-u,org-update-all-dblocks}
5086 Update all dynamic blocks (@pxref{Dynamic blocks}). This is useful if
5087 you have several clock table blocks, column-capturing blocks or other dynamic
5091 You can add formulas to the column view table and you may add plotting
5092 instructions in front of the table---these will survive an update of the
5093 block. If there is a @code{#+TBLFM:} after the table, the table will
5094 actually be recalculated automatically after an update.
5096 An alternative way to capture and process property values into a table is
5097 provided by Eric Schulte's @file{org-collector.el} which is a contributed
5098 package@footnote{Contributed packages are not part of Emacs, but are
5099 distributed with the main distribution of Org (visit
5100 @uref{http://orgmode.org}).}. It provides a general API to collect
5101 properties from entries in a certain scope, and arbitrary Lisp expressions to
5102 process these values before inserting them into a table or a dynamic block.
5104 @node Property API, , Column view, Properties and Columns
5105 @section The Property API
5106 @cindex properties, API
5107 @cindex API, for properties
5109 There is a full API for accessing and changing properties. This API can
5110 be used by Emacs Lisp programs to work with properties and to implement
5111 features based on them. For more information see @ref{Using the
5114 @node Dates and Times, Capture - Refile - Archive, Properties and Columns, Top
5115 @chapter Dates and times
5121 To assist project planning, TODO items can be labeled with a date and/or
5122 a time. The specially formatted string carrying the date and time
5123 information is called a @emph{timestamp} in Org-mode. This may be a
5124 little confusing because timestamp is often used as indicating when
5125 something was created or last changed. However, in Org-mode this term
5126 is used in a much wider sense.
5129 * Timestamps:: Assigning a time to a tree entry
5130 * Creating timestamps:: Commands which insert timestamps
5131 * Deadlines and scheduling:: Planning your work
5132 * Clocking work time:: Tracking how long you spend on a task
5133 * Effort estimates:: Planning work effort in advance
5134 * Relative timer:: Notes with a running timer
5135 * Countdown timer:: Starting a countdown timer for a task
5139 @node Timestamps, Creating timestamps, Dates and Times, Dates and Times
5140 @section Timestamps, deadlines, and scheduling
5142 @cindex ranges, time
5147 A timestamp is a specification of a date (possibly with a time or a range of
5148 times) in a special format, either @samp{<2003-09-16 Tue>} or
5149 @samp{<2003-09-16 Tue 09:39>} or @samp{<2003-09-16 Tue
5150 12:00-12:30>}@footnote{This is inspired by the standard ISO 8601 date/time
5151 format. To use an alternative format, see @ref{Custom time format}.}. A
5152 timestamp can appear anywhere in the headline or body of an Org tree entry.
5153 Its presence causes entries to be shown on specific dates in the agenda
5154 (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}). We distinguish:
5157 @item Plain timestamp; Event; Appointment
5159 A simple timestamp just assigns a date/time to an item. This is just
5160 like writing down an appointment or event in a paper agenda. In the
5161 timeline and agenda displays, the headline of an entry associated with a
5162 plain timestamp will be shown exactly on that date.
5165 * Meet Peter at the movies <2006-11-01 Wed 19:15>
5166 * Discussion on climate change <2006-11-02 Thu 20:00-22:00>
5169 @item Timestamp with repeater interval
5170 @cindex timestamp, with repeater interval
5171 A timestamp may contain a @emph{repeater interval}, indicating that it
5172 applies not only on the given date, but again and again after a certain
5173 interval of N days (d), weeks (w), months (m), or years (y). The
5174 following will show up in the agenda every Wednesday:
5177 * Pick up Sam at school <2007-05-16 Wed 12:30 +1w>
5180 @item Diary-style sexp entries
5181 For more complex date specifications, Org-mode supports using the
5182 special sexp diary entries implemented in the Emacs calendar/diary
5183 package. For example
5186 * The nerd meeting on every 2nd Thursday of the month
5187 <%%(diary-float t 4 2)>
5190 @item Time/Date range
5193 Two timestamps connected by @samp{--} denote a range. The headline
5194 will be shown on the first and last day of the range, and on any dates
5195 that are displayed and fall in the range. Here is an example:
5198 ** Meeting in Amsterdam
5199 <2004-08-23 Mon>--<2004-08-26 Thu>
5202 @item Inactive timestamp
5203 @cindex timestamp, inactive
5204 @cindex inactive timestamp
5205 Just like a plain timestamp, but with square brackets instead of
5206 angular ones. These timestamps are inactive in the sense that they do
5207 @emph{not} trigger an entry to show up in the agenda.
5210 * Gillian comes late for the fifth time [2006-11-01 Wed]
5215 @node Creating timestamps, Deadlines and scheduling, Timestamps, Dates and Times
5216 @section Creating timestamps
5217 @cindex creating timestamps
5218 @cindex timestamps, creating
5220 For Org-mode to recognize timestamps, they need to be in the specific
5221 format. All commands listed below produce timestamps in the correct
5225 @orgcmd{C-c .,org-time-stamp}
5226 Prompt for a date and insert a corresponding timestamp. When the cursor is
5227 at an existing timestamp in the buffer, the command is used to modify this
5228 timestamp instead of inserting a new one. When this command is used twice in
5229 succession, a time range is inserted.
5231 @orgcmd{C-c !,org-time-stamp-inactive}
5232 Like @kbd{C-c .}, but insert an inactive timestamp that will not cause
5239 @vindex org-time-stamp-rounding-minutes
5240 Like @kbd{C-c .} and @kbd{C-c !}, but use the alternative format which
5241 contains date and time. The default time can be rounded to multiples of 5
5242 minutes, see the option @code{org-time-stamp-rounding-minutes}.
5244 @orgcmd{C-c <,org-date-from-calendar}
5245 Insert a timestamp corresponding to the cursor date in the Calendar.
5247 @orgcmd{C-c >,org-goto-calendar}
5248 Access the Emacs calendar for the current date. If there is a
5249 timestamp in the current line, go to the corresponding date
5252 @orgcmd{C-c C-o,org-open-at-point}
5253 Access the agenda for the date given by the timestamp or -range at
5254 point (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}).
5256 @orgcmdkkcc{S-@key{left},S-@key{right},org-timestamp-down-day,org-timestamp-up-day}
5257 Change date at cursor by one day. These key bindings conflict with
5258 shift-selection and related modes (@pxref{Conflicts}).
5260 @orgcmdkkcc{S-@key{up},S-@key{down},org-timestamp-up,org-timestamp-down-down}
5261 Change the item under the cursor in a timestamp. The cursor can be on a
5262 year, month, day, hour or minute. When the timestamp contains a time range
5263 like @samp{15:30-16:30}, modifying the first time will also shift the second,
5264 shifting the time block with constant length. To change the length, modify
5265 the second time. Note that if the cursor is in a headline and not at a
5266 timestamp, these same keys modify the priority of an item.
5267 (@pxref{Priorities}). The key bindings also conflict with shift-selection and
5268 related modes (@pxref{Conflicts}).
5270 @orgcmd{C-c C-y,org-evaluate-time-range}
5271 @cindex evaluate time range
5272 Evaluate a time range by computing the difference between start and end.
5273 With a prefix argument, insert result after the time range (in a table: into
5274 the following column).
5279 * The date/time prompt:: How Org-mode helps you entering date and time
5280 * Custom time format:: Making dates look different
5283 @node The date/time prompt, Custom time format, Creating timestamps, Creating timestamps
5284 @subsection The date/time prompt
5285 @cindex date, reading in minibuffer
5286 @cindex time, reading in minibuffer
5288 @vindex org-read-date-prefer-future
5289 When Org-mode prompts for a date/time, the default is shown in default
5290 date/time format, and the prompt therefore seems to ask for a specific
5291 format. But it will in fact accept any string containing some date and/or
5292 time information, and it is really smart about interpreting your input. You
5293 can, for example, use @kbd{C-y} to paste a (possibly multi-line) string
5294 copied from an email message. Org-mode will find whatever information is in
5295 there and derive anything you have not specified from the @emph{default date
5296 and time}. The default is usually the current date and time, but when
5297 modifying an existing timestamp, or when entering the second stamp of a
5298 range, it is taken from the stamp in the buffer. When filling in
5299 information, Org-mode assumes that most of the time you will want to enter a
5300 date in the future: if you omit the month/year and the given day/month is
5301 @i{before} today, it will assume that you mean a future date@footnote{See the
5302 variable @code{org-read-date-prefer-future}. You may set that variable to
5303 the symbol @code{time} to even make a time before now shift the date to
5304 tomorrow.}. If the date has been automatically shifted into the future, the
5305 time prompt will show this with @samp{(=>F).}
5307 For example, let's assume that today is @b{June 13, 2006}. Here is how
5308 various inputs will be interpreted, the items filled in by Org-mode are
5312 3-2-5 --> 2003-02-05
5313 2/5/3 --> 2003-02-05
5314 14 --> @b{2006}-@b{06}-14
5315 12 --> @b{2006}-@b{07}-12
5316 2/5 --> @b{2007}-02-05
5317 Fri --> nearest Friday (default date or later)
5318 sep 15 --> @b{2006}-09-15
5319 feb 15 --> @b{2007}-02-15
5320 sep 12 9 --> 2009-09-12
5321 12:45 --> @b{2006}-@b{06}-@b{13} 12:45
5322 22 sept 0:34 --> @b{2006}-09-22 0:34
5323 w4 --> ISO week for of the current year @b{2006}
5324 2012 w4 fri --> Friday of ISO week 4 in 2012
5325 2012-w04-5 --> Same as above
5328 Furthermore you can specify a relative date by giving, as the
5329 @emph{first} thing in the input: a plus/minus sign, a number and a
5330 letter ([dwmy]) to indicate change in days, weeks, months, or years. With a
5331 single plus or minus, the date is always relative to today. With a
5332 double plus or minus, it is relative to the default date. If instead of
5333 a single letter, you use the abbreviation of day name, the date will be
5334 the Nth such day. E.g.
5339 +4d --> four days from today
5340 +4 --> same as above
5341 +2w --> two weeks from today
5342 ++5 --> five days from default date
5343 +2tue --> second Tuesday from now.
5346 @vindex parse-time-months
5347 @vindex parse-time-weekdays
5348 The function understands English month and weekday abbreviations. If
5349 you want to use unabbreviated names and/or other languages, configure
5350 the variables @code{parse-time-months} and @code{parse-time-weekdays}.
5352 You can specify a time range by giving start and end times or by giving a
5353 start time and a duration (in HH:MM format). Use `-' or `-@{@}-' as the separator
5354 in the former case and use '+' as the separator in the latter case. E.g.
5357 11am-1:15pm --> 11:00-13:15
5358 11am--1:15pm --> same as above
5359 11am+2:15 --> same as above
5362 @cindex calendar, for selecting date
5363 @vindex org-popup-calendar-for-date-prompt
5364 Parallel to the minibuffer prompt, a calendar is popped up@footnote{If
5365 you don't need/want the calendar, configure the variable
5366 @code{org-popup-calendar-for-date-prompt}.}. When you exit the date
5367 prompt, either by clicking on a date in the calendar, or by pressing
5368 @key{RET}, the date selected in the calendar will be combined with the
5369 information entered at the prompt. You can control the calendar fully
5370 from the minibuffer:
5377 @kindex S-@key{right}
5378 @kindex S-@key{left}
5379 @kindex S-@key{down}
5381 @kindex M-S-@key{right}
5382 @kindex M-S-@key{left}
5385 @key{RET} @r{Choose date at cursor in calendar.}
5386 mouse-1 @r{Select date by clicking on it.}
5387 S-@key{right}/@key{left} @r{One day forward/backward.}
5388 S-@key{down}/@key{up} @r{One week forward/backward.}
5389 M-S-@key{right}/@key{left} @r{One month forward/backward.}
5390 > / < @r{Scroll calendar forward/backward by one month.}
5391 M-v / C-v @r{Scroll calendar forward/backward by 3 months.}
5394 @vindex org-read-date-display-live
5395 The actions of the date/time prompt may seem complex, but I assure you they
5396 will grow on you, and you will start getting annoyed by pretty much any other
5397 way of entering a date/time out there. To help you understand what is going
5398 on, the current interpretation of your input will be displayed live in the
5399 minibuffer@footnote{If you find this distracting, turn the display of with
5400 @code{org-read-date-display-live}.}.
5402 @node Custom time format, , The date/time prompt, Creating timestamps
5403 @subsection Custom time format
5404 @cindex custom date/time format
5405 @cindex time format, custom
5406 @cindex date format, custom
5408 @vindex org-display-custom-times
5409 @vindex org-time-stamp-custom-formats
5410 Org-mode uses the standard ISO notation for dates and times as it is
5411 defined in ISO 8601. If you cannot get used to this and require another
5412 representation of date and time to keep you happy, you can get it by
5413 customizing the variables @code{org-display-custom-times} and
5414 @code{org-time-stamp-custom-formats}.
5417 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-t,org-toggle-time-stamp-overlays}
5418 Toggle the display of custom formats for dates and times.
5422 Org-mode needs the default format for scanning, so the custom date/time
5423 format does not @emph{replace} the default format---instead it is put
5424 @emph{over} the default format using text properties. This has the
5425 following consequences:
5428 You cannot place the cursor onto a timestamp anymore, only before or
5431 The @kbd{S-@key{up}/@key{down}} keys can no longer be used to adjust
5432 each component of a timestamp. If the cursor is at the beginning of
5433 the stamp, @kbd{S-@key{up}/@key{down}} will change the stamp by one day,
5434 just like @kbd{S-@key{left}/@key{right}}. At the end of the stamp, the
5435 time will be changed by one minute.
5437 If the timestamp contains a range of clock times or a repeater, these
5438 will not be overlaid, but remain in the buffer as they were.
5440 When you delete a timestamp character-by-character, it will only
5441 disappear from the buffer after @emph{all} (invisible) characters
5442 belonging to the ISO timestamp have been removed.
5444 If the custom timestamp format is longer than the default and you are
5445 using dates in tables, table alignment will be messed up. If the custom
5446 format is shorter, things do work as expected.
5450 @node Deadlines and scheduling, Clocking work time, Creating timestamps, Dates and Times
5451 @section Deadlines and scheduling
5453 A timestamp may be preceded by special keywords to facilitate planning:
5457 @cindex DEADLINE keyword
5459 Meaning: the task (most likely a TODO item, though not necessarily) is supposed
5460 to be finished on that date.
5462 @vindex org-deadline-warning-days
5463 On the deadline date, the task will be listed in the agenda. In
5464 addition, the agenda for @emph{today} will carry a warning about the
5465 approaching or missed deadline, starting
5466 @code{org-deadline-warning-days} before the due date, and continuing
5467 until the entry is marked DONE. An example:
5470 *** TODO write article about the Earth for the Guide
5471 The editor in charge is [[bbdb:Ford Prefect]]
5472 DEADLINE: <2004-02-29 Sun>
5475 You can specify a different lead time for warnings for a specific
5476 deadlines using the following syntax. Here is an example with a warning
5477 period of 5 days @code{DEADLINE: <2004-02-29 Sun -5d>}.
5480 @cindex SCHEDULED keyword
5482 Meaning: you are planning to start working on that task on the given
5485 @vindex org-agenda-skip-scheduled-if-done
5486 The headline will be listed under the given date@footnote{It will still
5487 be listed on that date after it has been marked DONE. If you don't like
5488 this, set the variable @code{org-agenda-skip-scheduled-if-done}.}. In
5489 addition, a reminder that the scheduled date has passed will be present
5490 in the compilation for @emph{today}, until the entry is marked DONE, i.e.
5491 the task will automatically be forwarded until completed.
5494 *** TODO Call Trillian for a date on New Years Eve.
5495 SCHEDULED: <2004-12-25 Sat>
5499 @b{Important:} Scheduling an item in Org-mode should @i{not} be
5500 understood in the same way that we understand @i{scheduling a meeting}.
5501 Setting a date for a meeting is just a simple appointment, you should
5502 mark this entry with a simple plain timestamp, to get this item shown
5503 on the date where it applies. This is a frequent misunderstanding by
5504 Org users. In Org-mode, @i{scheduling} means setting a date when you
5505 want to start working on an action item.
5508 You may use timestamps with repeaters in scheduling and deadline
5509 entries. Org-mode will issue early and late warnings based on the
5510 assumption that the timestamp represents the @i{nearest instance} of
5511 the repeater. However, the use of diary sexp entries like
5513 @code{<%%(diary-float t 42)>}
5515 in scheduling and deadline timestamps is limited. Org-mode does not
5516 know enough about the internals of each sexp function to issue early and
5517 late warnings. However, it will show the item on each day where the
5521 * Inserting deadline/schedule:: Planning items
5522 * Repeated tasks:: Items that show up again and again
5525 @node Inserting deadline/schedule, Repeated tasks, Deadlines and scheduling, Deadlines and scheduling
5526 @subsection Inserting deadlines or schedules
5528 The following commands allow you to quickly insert a deadline or to schedule
5533 @orgcmd{C-c C-d,org-deadline}
5534 Insert @samp{DEADLINE} keyword along with a stamp. The insertion will happen
5535 in the line directly following the headline. When called with a prefix arg,
5536 an existing deadline will be removed from the entry. Depending on the
5537 variable @code{org-log-redeadline}@footnote{with corresponding
5538 @code{#+STARTUP} keywords @code{logredeadline}, @code{lognoteredeadline},
5539 and @code{nologredeadline}}, a note will be taken when changing an existing
5541 @c FIXME Any CLOSED timestamp will be removed.????????
5543 @orgcmd{C-c C-s,org-schedule}
5544 Insert @samp{SCHEDULED} keyword along with a stamp. The insertion will
5545 happen in the line directly following the headline. Any CLOSED timestamp
5546 will be removed. When called with a prefix argument, remove the scheduling
5547 date from the entry. Depending on the variable
5548 @code{org-log-reschedule}@footnote{with corresponding @code{#+STARTUP}
5549 keywords @code{logredeadline}, @code{lognoteredeadline}, and
5550 @code{nologredeadline}}, a note will be taken when changing an existing
5553 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-k,org-mark-entry-for-agenda-action}
5556 Mark the current entry for agenda action. After you have marked the entry
5557 like this, you can open the agenda or the calendar to find an appropriate
5558 date. With the cursor on the selected date, press @kbd{k s} or @kbd{k d} to
5559 schedule the marked item.
5561 @orgcmd{C-c / d,org-check-deadlines}
5562 @cindex sparse tree, for deadlines
5563 @vindex org-deadline-warning-days
5564 Create a sparse tree with all deadlines that are either past-due, or
5565 which will become due within @code{org-deadline-warning-days}.
5566 With @kbd{C-u} prefix, show all deadlines in the file. With a numeric
5567 prefix, check that many days. For example, @kbd{C-1 C-c / d} shows
5568 all deadlines due tomorrow.
5570 @orgcmd{C-c / b,org-check-before-date}
5571 Sparse tree for deadlines and scheduled items before a given date.
5573 @orgcmd{C-c / a,org-check-after-date}
5574 Sparse tree for deadlines and scheduled items after a given date.
5577 @node Repeated tasks, , Inserting deadline/schedule, Deadlines and scheduling
5578 @subsection Repeated tasks
5579 @cindex tasks, repeated
5580 @cindex repeated tasks
5582 Some tasks need to be repeated again and again. Org-mode helps to
5583 organize such tasks using a so-called repeater in a DEADLINE, SCHEDULED,
5584 or plain timestamp. In the following example
5586 ** TODO Pay the rent
5587 DEADLINE: <2005-10-01 Sat +1m>
5590 the @code{+1m} is a repeater; the intended interpretation is that the task
5591 has a deadline on <2005-10-01> and repeats itself every (one) month starting
5592 from that time. If you need both a repeater and a special warning period in
5593 a deadline entry, the repeater should come first and the warning period last:
5594 @code{DEADLINE: <2005-10-01 Sat +1m -3d>}.
5596 @vindex org-todo-repeat-to-state
5597 Deadlines and scheduled items produce entries in the agenda when they are
5598 over-due, so it is important to be able to mark such an entry as completed
5599 once you have done so. When you mark a DEADLINE or a SCHEDULE with the TODO
5600 keyword DONE, it will no longer produce entries in the agenda. The problem
5601 with this is, however, that then also the @emph{next} instance of the
5602 repeated entry will not be active. Org-mode deals with this in the following
5603 way: When you try to mark such an entry DONE (using @kbd{C-c C-t}), it will
5604 shift the base date of the repeating timestamp by the repeater interval, and
5605 immediately set the entry state back to TODO@footnote{In fact, the target
5606 state is taken from, in this sequence, the @code{REPEAT_TO_STATE} property or
5607 the variable @code{org-todo-repeat-to-state}. If neither of these is
5608 specified, the target state defaults to the first state of the TODO state
5609 sequence.}. In the example above, setting the state to DONE would actually
5610 switch the date like this:
5613 ** TODO Pay the rent
5614 DEADLINE: <2005-11-01 Tue +1m>
5617 @vindex org-log-repeat
5618 A timestamp@footnote{You can change this using the option
5619 @code{org-log-repeat}, or the @code{#+STARTUP} options @code{logrepeat},
5620 @code{lognoterepeat}, and @code{nologrepeat}. With @code{lognoterepeat}, you
5621 will also be prompted for a note.} will be added under the deadline, to keep
5622 a record that you actually acted on the previous instance of this deadline.
5624 As a consequence of shifting the base date, this entry will no longer be
5625 visible in the agenda when checking past dates, but all future instances
5628 With the @samp{+1m} cookie, the date shift will always be exactly one
5629 month. So if you have not paid the rent for three months, marking this
5630 entry DONE will still keep it as an overdue deadline. Depending on the
5631 task, this may not be the best way to handle it. For example, if you
5632 forgot to call your father for 3 weeks, it does not make sense to call
5633 him 3 times in a single day to make up for it. Finally, there are tasks
5634 like changing batteries which should always repeat a certain time
5635 @i{after} the last time you did it. For these tasks, Org-mode has
5636 special repeaters @samp{++} and @samp{.+}. For example:
5640 DEADLINE: <2008-02-10 Sun ++1w>
5641 Marking this DONE will shift the date by at least one week,
5642 but also by as many weeks as it takes to get this date into
5643 the future. However, it stays on a Sunday, even if you called
5644 and marked it done on Saturday.
5645 ** TODO Check the batteries in the smoke detectors
5646 DEADLINE: <2005-11-01 Tue .+1m>
5647 Marking this DONE will shift the date to one month after
5651 You may have both scheduling and deadline information for a specific
5652 task---just make sure that the repeater intervals on both are the same.
5654 An alternative to using a repeater is to create a number of copies of a task
5655 subtree, with dates shifted in each copy. The command @kbd{C-c C-x c} was
5656 created for this purpose, it is described in @ref{Structure editing}.
5659 @node Clocking work time, Effort estimates, Deadlines and scheduling, Dates and Times
5660 @section Clocking work time
5661 @cindex clocking time
5662 @cindex time clocking
5664 Org-mode allows you to clock the time you spend on specific tasks in a
5665 project. When you start working on an item, you can start the clock.
5666 When you stop working on that task, or when you mark the task done, the
5667 clock is stopped and the corresponding time interval is recorded. It
5668 also computes the total time spent on each subtree of a project. And it
5669 remembers a history or tasks recently clocked, to that you can jump quickly
5670 between a number of tasks absorbing your time.
5672 To save the clock history across Emacs sessions, use
5674 (setq org-clock-persist 'history)
5675 (org-clock-persistence-insinuate)
5677 When you clock into a new task after resuming Emacs, the incomplete
5678 clock@footnote{To resume the clock under the assumption that you have worked
5679 on this task while outside Emacs, use @code{(setq org-clock-persist t)}.}
5680 will be found (@pxref{Resolving idle time}) and you will be prompted about
5684 * Clocking commands:: Starting and stopping a clock
5685 * The clock table:: Detailed reports
5686 * Resolving idle time:: Resolving time when you've been idle
5689 @node Clocking commands, The clock table, Clocking work time, Clocking work time
5690 @subsection Clocking commands
5693 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-i,org-clock-in}
5694 @vindex org-clock-into-drawer
5695 Start the clock on the current item (clock-in). This inserts the CLOCK
5696 keyword together with a timestamp. If this is not the first clocking of
5697 this item, the multiple CLOCK lines will be wrapped into a
5698 @code{:LOGBOOK:} drawer (see also the variable
5699 @code{org-clock-into-drawer}). When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix argument,
5700 select the task from a list of recently clocked tasks. With two @kbd{C-u
5701 C-u} prefixes, clock into the task at point and mark it as the default task.
5702 The default task will always be available when selecting a clocking task,
5703 with letter @kbd{d}.@*
5704 @cindex property: CLOCK_MODELINE_TOTAL
5705 @cindex property: LAST_REPEAT
5706 @vindex org-clock-modeline-total
5707 While the clock is running, the current clocking time is shown in the mode
5708 line, along with the title of the task. The clock time shown will be all
5709 time ever clocked for this task and its children. If the task has an effort
5710 estimate (@pxref{Effort estimates}), the mode line displays the current
5711 clocking time against it@footnote{To add an effort estimate ``on the fly'',
5712 hook a function doing this to @code{org-clock-in-prepare-hook}.} If the task
5713 is a repeating one (@pxref{Repeated tasks}), only the time since the last
5714 reset of the task @footnote{as recorded by the @code{LAST_REPEAT} property}
5715 will be shown. More control over what time is shown can be exercised with
5716 the @code{CLOCK_MODELINE_TOTAL} property. It may have the values
5717 @code{current} to show only the current clocking instance, @code{today} to
5718 show all time clocked on this tasks today (see also the variable
5719 @code{org-extend-today-until}), @code{all} to include all time, or
5720 @code{auto} which is the default@footnote{See also the variable
5721 @code{org-clock-modeline-total}.}.@* Clicking with @kbd{mouse-1} onto the
5722 mode line entry will pop up a menu with clocking options.
5724 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-o,org-clock-out}
5725 @vindex org-log-note-clock-out
5726 Stop the clock (clock-out). This inserts another timestamp at the same
5727 location where the clock was last started. It also directly computes
5728 the resulting time in inserts it after the time range as @samp{=>
5729 HH:MM}. See the variable @code{org-log-note-clock-out} for the
5730 possibility to record an additional note together with the clock-out
5731 timestamp@footnote{The corresponding in-buffer setting is:
5732 @code{#+STARTUP: lognoteclock-out}}.
5733 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-e,org-clock-modify-effort-estimate}
5734 Update the effort estimate for the current clock task.
5737 @orgcmdkkc{C-c C-c,C-c C-y,org-evaluate-time-range}
5738 Recompute the time interval after changing one of the timestamps. This
5739 is only necessary if you edit the timestamps directly. If you change
5740 them with @kbd{S-@key{cursor}} keys, the update is automatic.
5741 @orgcmd{C-c C-t,org-todo}
5742 Changing the TODO state of an item to DONE automatically stops the clock
5743 if it is running in this same item.
5744 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-x,org-clock-cancel}
5745 Cancel the current clock. This is useful if a clock was started by
5746 mistake, or if you ended up working on something else.
5747 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-j,org-clock-goto}
5748 Jump to the headline of the currently clocked in task. With a @kbd{C-u}
5749 prefix arg, select the target task from a list of recently clocked tasks.
5750 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-d,org-clock-display}
5751 @vindex org-remove-highlights-with-change
5752 Display time summaries for each subtree in the current buffer. This
5753 puts overlays at the end of each headline, showing the total time
5754 recorded under that heading, including the time of any subheadings. You
5755 can use visibility cycling to study the tree, but the overlays disappear
5756 when you change the buffer (see variable
5757 @code{org-remove-highlights-with-change}) or press @kbd{C-c C-c}.
5760 The @kbd{l} key may be used in the timeline (@pxref{Timeline}) and in
5761 the agenda (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}) to show which tasks have been
5762 worked on or closed during a day.
5764 @node The clock table, Resolving idle time, Clocking commands, Clocking work time
5765 @subsection The clock table
5766 @cindex clocktable, dynamic block
5767 @cindex report, of clocked time
5769 Org mode can produce quite complex reports based on the time clocking
5770 information. Such a report is called a @emph{clock table}, because it is
5771 formatted as one or several Org tables.
5774 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-r,org-clock-report}
5775 Insert a dynamic block (@pxref{Dynamic blocks}) containing a clock
5776 report as an Org-mode table into the current file. When the cursor is
5777 at an existing clock table, just update it. When called with a prefix
5778 argument, jump to the first clock report in the current document and
5780 @orgcmdkkc{C-c C-c,C-c C-x C-u,org-dblock-update}
5781 Update dynamic block at point. The cursor needs to be in the
5782 @code{#+BEGIN} line of the dynamic block.
5783 @orgkey{C-u C-c C-x C-u}
5784 Update all dynamic blocks (@pxref{Dynamic blocks}). This is useful if
5785 you have several clock table blocks in a buffer.
5786 @orgcmdkxkc{S-@key{left},S-@key{right},org-clocktable-try-shift}
5787 Shift the current @code{:block} interval and update the table. The cursor
5788 needs to be in the @code{#+BEGIN: clocktable} line for this command. If
5789 @code{:block} is @code{today}, it will be shifted to @code{today-1} etc.
5793 Here is an example of the frame for a clock table as it is inserted into the
5794 buffer with the @kbd{C-c C-x C-r} command:
5796 @cindex #+BEGIN, clocktable
5798 #+BEGIN: clocktable :maxlevel 2 :emphasize nil :scope file
5802 @vindex org-clocktable-defaults
5803 The @samp{BEGIN} line and specify a number of options to define the scope,
5804 structure, and formatting of the report. Defaults for all these options can
5805 be configured in the variable @code{org-clocktable-defaults}.
5807 @noindent First there are options that determine which clock entries are to
5810 :maxlevel @r{Maximum level depth to which times are listed in the table.}
5811 @r{Clocks at deeper levels will be summed into the upper level.}
5812 :scope @r{The scope to consider. This can be any of the following:}
5813 nil @r{the current buffer or narrowed region}
5814 file @r{the full current buffer}
5815 subtree @r{the subtree where the clocktable is located}
5816 tree@var{N} @r{the surrounding level @var{N} tree, for example @code{tree3}}
5817 tree @r{the surrounding level 1 tree}
5818 agenda @r{all agenda files}
5819 ("file"..) @r{scan these files}
5820 file-with-archives @r{current file and its archives}
5821 agenda-with-archives @r{all agenda files, including archives}
5822 :block @r{The time block to consider. This block is specified either}
5823 @r{absolute, or relative to the current time and may be any of}
5825 2007-12-31 @r{New year eve 2007}
5826 2007-12 @r{December 2007}
5827 2007-W50 @r{ISO-week 50 in 2007}
5828 2007-Q2 @r{2nd quarter in 2007}
5829 2007 @r{the year 2007}
5830 today, yesterday, today-@var{N} @r{a relative day}
5831 thisweek, lastweek, thisweek-@var{N} @r{a relative week}
5832 thismonth, lastmonth, thismonth-@var{N} @r{a relative month}
5833 thisyear, lastyear, thisyear-@var{N} @r{a relative year}
5834 @r{Use @kbd{S-@key{left}/@key{right}} keys to shift the time interval.}
5835 :tstart @r{A time string specifying when to start considering times.}
5836 :tend @r{A time string specifying when to stop considering times.}
5837 :step @r{@code{week} or @code{day}, to split the table into chunks.}
5838 @r{To use this, @code{:block} or @code{:tstart}, @code{:tend} are needed.}
5839 :stepskip0 @r{Do not show steps that have zero time.}
5840 :fileskip0 @r{Do not show table sections from files which did not contribute.}
5841 :tags @r{A tags match to select entries that should contribute}.
5844 Then there are options which determine the formatting of the table. There
5845 options are interpreted by the function @code{org-clocktable-write-default},
5846 but you can specify your own function using the @code{:formatter} parameter.
5848 :emphasize @r{When @code{t}, emphasize level one and level two items.}
5849 :link @r{Link the item headlines in the table to their origins.}
5850 :narrow @r{An integer to limit the width of the headline column in}
5851 @r{the org table. If you write it like @samp{50!}, then the}
5852 @r{headline will also be shortened in export.}
5853 :indent @r{Indent each headline field according to its level.}
5854 :tcolumns @r{Number of columns to be used for times. If this is smaller}
5855 @r{than @code{:maxlevel}, lower levels will be lumped into one column.}
5856 :level @r{Should a level number column be included?}
5857 :compact @r{Abbreviation for @code{:level nil :indent t :narrow 40! :tcolumns 1}}
5858 @r{All are overwritten except if there is an explicit @code{:narrow}}
5859 :timestamp @r{A timestamp for the entry, when available. Look for SCHEDULED,}
5860 @r{DEADLINE, TIMESTAMP and TIMESTAMP_IA, in this order.}
5861 :formula @r{Content of a @code{#+TBLFM} line to be added and evaluated.}
5862 @r{As a special case, @samp{:formula %} adds a column with % time.}
5863 @r{If you do not specify a formula here, any existing formula}
5864 @r{below the clock table will survive updates and be evaluated.}
5865 :formatter @r{A function to format clock data and insert it into the buffer.}
5867 To get a clock summary of the current level 1 tree, for the current
5868 day, you could write
5870 #+BEGIN: clocktable :maxlevel 2 :block today :scope tree1 :link t
5874 and to use a specific time range you could write@footnote{Note that all
5875 parameters must be specified in a single line---the line is broken here
5876 only to fit it into the manual.}
5878 #+BEGIN: clocktable :tstart "<2006-08-10 Thu 10:00>"
5879 :tend "<2006-08-10 Thu 12:00>"
5882 A summary of the current subtree with % times would be
5884 #+BEGIN: clocktable :scope subtree :link t :formula %
5887 A horizontally compact representation of everything clocked during last week
5890 #+BEGIN: clocktable :scope agenda :block lastweek :compact t
5894 @node Resolving idle time, , The clock table, Clocking work time
5895 @subsection Resolving idle time
5896 @cindex resolve idle time
5898 @cindex idle, resolve, dangling
5899 If you clock in on a work item, and then walk away from your
5900 computer---perhaps to take a phone call---you often need to ``resolve'' the
5901 time you were away by either subtracting it from the current clock, or
5902 applying it to another one.
5904 @vindex org-clock-idle-time
5905 By customizing the variable @code{org-clock-idle-time} to some integer, such
5906 as 10 or 15, Emacs can alert you when you get back to your computer after
5907 being idle for that many minutes@footnote{On computers using Mac OS X,
5908 idleness is based on actual user idleness, not just Emacs' idle time. For
5909 X11, you can install a utility program @file{x11idle.c}, available in the
5910 UTILITIES directory of the Org git distribution, to get the same general
5911 treatment of idleness. On other systems, idle time refers to Emacs idle time
5912 only.}, and ask what you want to do with the idle time. There will be a
5913 question waiting for you when you get back, indicating how much idle time has
5914 passed (constantly updated with the current amount), as well as a set of
5915 choices to correct the discrepancy:
5919 To keep some or all of the minutes and stay clocked in, press @kbd{k}. Org
5920 will ask how many of the minutes to keep. Press @key{RET} to keep them all,
5921 effectively changing nothing, or enter a number to keep that many minutes.
5923 If you use the shift key and press @kbd{K}, it will keep however many minutes
5924 you request and then immediately clock out of that task. If you keep all of
5925 the minutes, this is the same as just clocking out of the current task.
5927 To keep none of the minutes, use @kbd{s} to subtract all the away time from
5928 the clock, and then check back in from the moment you returned.
5930 To keep none of the minutes and just clock out at the start of the away time,
5931 use the shift key and press @kbd{S}. Remember that using shift will always
5932 leave you clocked out, no matter which option you choose.
5934 To cancel the clock altogether, use @kbd{C}. Note that if instead of
5935 canceling you subtract the away time, and the resulting clock amount is less
5936 than a minute, the clock will still be canceled rather than clutter up the
5937 log with an empty entry.
5940 What if you subtracted those away minutes from the current clock, and now
5941 want to apply them to a new clock? Simply clock in to any task immediately
5942 after the subtraction. Org will notice that you have subtracted time ``on
5943 the books'', so to speak, and will ask if you want to apply those minutes to
5944 the next task you clock in on.
5946 There is one other instance when this clock resolution magic occurs. Say you
5947 were clocked in and hacking away, and suddenly your cat chased a mouse who
5948 scared a hamster that crashed into your UPS's power button! You suddenly
5949 lose all your buffers, but thanks to auto-save you still have your recent Org
5950 mode changes, including your last clock in.
5952 If you restart Emacs and clock into any task, Org will notice that you have a
5953 dangling clock which was never clocked out from your last session. Using
5954 that clock's starting time as the beginning of the unaccounted-for period,
5955 Org will ask how you want to resolve that time. The logic and behavior is
5956 identical to dealing with away time due to idleness; it's just happening due
5957 to a recovery event rather than a set amount of idle time.
5959 You can also check all the files visited by your Org agenda for dangling
5960 clocks at any time using @kbd{M-x org-resolve-clocks}.
5962 @node Effort estimates, Relative timer, Clocking work time, Dates and Times
5963 @section Effort estimates
5964 @cindex effort estimates
5966 @cindex property, Effort
5967 @vindex org-effort-property
5968 If you want to plan your work in a very detailed way, or if you need to
5969 produce offers with quotations of the estimated work effort, you may want to
5970 assign effort estimates to entries. If you are also clocking your work, you
5971 may later want to compare the planned effort with the actual working time, a
5972 great way to improve planning estimates. Effort estimates are stored in a
5973 special property @samp{Effort}@footnote{You may change the property being
5974 used with the variable @code{org-effort-property}.}. You can set the effort
5975 for an entry with the following commands:
5978 @orgcmd{C-c C-x e,org-set-effort}
5979 Set the effort estimate for the current entry. With a numeric prefix
5980 argument, set it to the Nth allowed value (see below). This command is also
5981 accessible from the agenda with the @kbd{e} key.
5982 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-e,org-clock-modify-effort-estimate}
5983 Modify the effort estimate of the item currently being clocked.
5986 Clearly the best way to work with effort estimates is through column view
5987 (@pxref{Column view}). You should start by setting up discrete values for
5988 effort estimates, and a @code{COLUMNS} format that displays these values
5989 together with clock sums (if you want to clock your time). For a specific
5993 #+PROPERTY: Effort_ALL 0 0:10 0:30 1:00 2:00 3:00 4:00 5:00 6:00 7:00 8:00
5994 #+COLUMNS: %40ITEM(Task) %17Effort(Estimated Effort)@{:@} %CLOCKSUM
5998 @vindex org-global-properties
5999 @vindex org-columns-default-format
6000 or, even better, you can set up these values globally by customizing the
6001 variables @code{org-global-properties} and @code{org-columns-default-format}.
6002 In particular if you want to use this setup also in the agenda, a global
6003 setup may be advised.
6005 The way to assign estimates to individual items is then to switch to column
6006 mode, and to use @kbd{S-@key{right}} and @kbd{S-@key{left}} to change the
6007 value. The values you enter will immediately be summed up in the hierarchy.
6008 In the column next to it, any clocked time will be displayed.
6010 @vindex org-agenda-columns-add-appointments-to-effort-sum
6011 If you switch to column view in the daily/weekly agenda, the effort column
6012 will summarize the estimated work effort for each day@footnote{Please note
6013 the pitfalls of summing hierarchical data in a flat list (@pxref{Agenda
6014 column view}).}, and you can use this to find space in your schedule. To get
6015 an overview of the entire part of the day that is committed, you can set the
6016 option @code{org-agenda-columns-add-appointments-to-effort-sum}. The
6017 appointments on a day that take place over a specified time interval will
6018 then also be added to the load estimate of the day.
6020 Effort estimates can be used in secondary agenda filtering that is triggered
6021 with the @kbd{/} key in the agenda (@pxref{Agenda commands}). If you have
6022 these estimates defined consistently, two or three key presses will narrow
6023 down the list to stuff that fits into an available time slot.
6025 @node Relative timer, Countdown timer, Effort estimates, Dates and Times
6026 @section Taking notes with a relative timer
6027 @cindex relative timer
6029 When taking notes during, for example, a meeting or a video viewing, it can
6030 be useful to have access to times relative to a starting time. Org provides
6031 such a relative timer and make it easy to create timed notes.
6034 @orgcmd{C-c C-x .,org-timer}
6035 Insert a relative time into the buffer. The first time you use this, the
6036 timer will be started. When called with a prefix argument, the timer is
6038 @orgcmd{C-c C-x -,org-timer-item}
6039 Insert a description list item with the current relative time. With a prefix
6040 argument, first reset the timer to 0.
6041 @orgcmd{M-@key{RET},org-insert-heading}
6042 Once the timer list is started, you can also use @kbd{M-@key{RET}} to insert
6044 @c for key sequences with a comma, command name macros fail :(
6047 Pause the timer, or continue it if it is already paused
6048 (@command{org-timer-pause-or-continue}).
6049 @c removed the sentence because it is redundant to the following item
6050 @kindex C-u C-c C-x ,
6052 Stop the timer. After this, you can only start a new timer, not continue the
6053 old one. This command also removes the timer from the mode line.
6054 @orgcmd{C-c C-x 0,org-timer-start}
6055 Reset the timer without inserting anything into the buffer. By default, the
6056 timer is reset to 0. When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix, reset the timer to
6057 specific starting offset. The user is prompted for the offset, with a
6058 default taken from a timer string at point, if any, So this can be used to
6059 restart taking notes after a break in the process. When called with a double
6060 prefix argument @kbd{C-u C-u}, change all timer strings in the active region
6061 by a certain amount. This can be used to fix timer strings if the timer was
6062 not started at exactly the right moment.
6065 @node Countdown timer, , Relative timer, Dates and Times
6066 @section Countdown timer
6067 @cindex Countdown timer
6071 Calling @code{org-timer-set-timer} from an Org-mode buffer runs a countdown
6072 timer. Use @key{;} from agenda buffers, @key{C-c C-x ;} everwhere else.
6074 @code{org-timer-set-timer} prompts the user for a duration and displays a
6075 countdown timer in the modeline. @code{org-timer-default-timer} sets the
6076 default countdown value. Giving a prefix numeric argument overrides this
6079 @node Capture - Refile - Archive, Agenda Views, Dates and Times, Top
6080 @chapter Capture - Refile - Archive
6083 An important part of any organization system is the ability to quickly
6084 capture new ideas and tasks, and to associate reference material with them.
6085 Org does this using a process called @i{capture}. It also can store files
6086 related to a task (@i{attachments}) in a special directory. Once in the
6087 system, tasks and projects need to be moved around. Moving completed project
6088 trees to an archive file keeps the system compact and fast.
6091 * Capture:: Capturing new stuff
6092 * Attachments:: Add files to tasks
6093 * RSS Feeds:: Getting input from RSS feeds
6094 * Protocols:: External (e.g. Browser) access to Emacs and Org
6095 * Refiling notes:: Moving a tree from one place to another
6096 * Archiving:: What to do with finished projects
6099 @node Capture, Attachments, Capture - Refile - Archive, Capture - Refile - Archive
6103 Org's method for capturing new items is heavily inspired by John Wiegley
6104 excellent remember package. Up to version 6.36 Org used a special setup
6105 for @file{remember.el}. @file{org-remember.el} is still part of Org-mode for
6106 backward compatibility with existing setups. You can find the documentation
6107 for org-remember at @url{http://orgmode.org/org-remember.pdf}.
6109 The new capturing setup described here is preferred and should be used by new
6110 users. To convert your @code{org-remember-templates}, run the command
6112 @kbd{M-x org-capture-import-remember-templates @key{RET}}
6114 @noindent and then customize the new variable with @kbd{M-x
6115 customize-variable org-capture-templates}, check the result, and save the
6116 customization. You can then use both remember and capture until
6117 you are familiar with the new mechanism.
6119 Capture lets you quickly store notes with little interruption of your work
6120 flow. The basic process of capturing is very similar to remember, but Org
6121 does enhance it with templates and more.
6124 * Setting up capture:: Where notes will be stored
6125 * Using capture:: Commands to invoke and terminate capture
6126 * Capture templates:: Define the outline of different note types
6129 @node Setting up capture, Using capture, Capture, Capture
6130 @subsection Setting up capture
6132 The following customization sets a default target file for notes, and defines
6133 a global key@footnote{Please select your own key, @kbd{C-c c} is only a
6134 suggestion.} for capturing new material.
6136 @vindex org-default-notes-file
6138 (setq org-default-notes-file (concat org-directory "/notes.org"))
6139 (define-key global-map "\C-cc" 'org-capture)
6142 @node Using capture, Capture templates, Setting up capture, Capture
6143 @subsection Using capture
6146 @orgcmd{C-c c,org-capture}
6147 Call the command @code{org-capture}. Note that this keybinding is global and
6148 not active by default - you need to install it. If you have templates
6149 defined @pxref{Capture templates}, it will offer these templates for
6150 selection or use a new Org outline node as the default template. It will
6151 insert the template into the target file and switch to an indirect buffer
6152 narrowed to this new node. You may then insert the information you want.
6154 @orgcmd{C-c C-c,org-capture-finalize}
6155 Once you have finished entering information into the capture buffer, @kbd{C-c
6156 C-c} will return you to the window configuration before the capture process,
6157 so that you can resume your work without further distraction. When called
6158 with a prefix arg, finalize and then jump to the captured item.
6160 @orgcmd{C-c C-w,org-capture-refile}
6161 Finalize the capture process by refiling (@pxref{Refiling notes}) the note to
6162 a different place. Please realize that this is a normal refiling command
6163 that will be executed---so the cursor position at the moment you run this
6164 command is important. If you have inserted a tree with a parent and
6165 children, first move the cursor back to the parent. Any prefix argument
6166 given to this command will be passed on to the @code{org-refile} command.
6168 @orgcmd{C-c C-k,org-capture-kill}
6169 Abort the capture process and return to the previous state.
6173 You can also call @code{org-capture} in a special way from the agenda, using
6174 the @kbd{k c} key combination. With this access, any timestamps inserted by
6175 the selected capture template will default to the cursor date in the agenda,
6176 rather than to the current date.
6178 To find the locations of the last stored capture, use @code{org-capture} with
6183 Visit the target location of a cpature template. You get to select the
6184 template in the usual way.
6185 @orgkey{C-u C-u C-c c}
6186 Visit the last stored capture item in its buffer.
6189 @node Capture templates, , Using capture, Capture
6190 @subsection Capture templates
6191 @cindex templates, for Capture
6193 You can use templates for different types of capture items, and
6194 for different target locations. The easiest way to create such templates is
6195 through the customize interface.
6199 Customize the variable @code{org-capture-templates}.
6202 Before we give the formal description of template definitions, let's look at
6203 an example. Say you would like to use one template to create general TODO
6204 entries, and you want to put these entries under the heading @samp{Tasks} in
6205 your file @file{~/org/gtd.org}. Also, a date tree in the file
6206 @file{journal.org} should capture journal entries. A possible configuration
6210 (setq org-capture-templates
6211 '(("t" "Todo" entry (file+headline "~/org/gtd.org" "Tasks")
6212 "* TODO %?\n %i\n %a")
6213 ("j" "Journal" entry (file+datetree "~/org/journal.org")
6214 "* %?\nEntered on %U\n %i\n %a")))
6217 @noindent If you then press @kbd{C-c c t}, Org will prepare the template
6221 [[file:@var{link to where you initiated capture}]]
6225 During expansion of the template, @code{%a} has been replaced by a link to
6226 the location from where you called the capture command. This can be
6227 extremely useful for deriving tasks from emails, for example. You fill in
6228 the task definition, press @code{C-c C-c} and Org returns you to the same
6229 place where you started the capture process.
6231 To define special keys to capture to a particular template without going
6232 through the interactive template selection, you can create your key binding
6236 (define-key global-map "\C-c c"
6237 (lambda () (interactive) (org-capture "t")))
6241 * Template elements:: What is needed for a complete template entry
6242 * Template expansion:: Filling in information about time and context
6245 @node Template elements, Template expansion, Capture templates, Capture templates
6246 @subsubsection Template elements
6248 Now lets look at the elements of a template definition. Each entry in
6249 @code{org-capture-templates} is a list with the following items:
6253 The keys that will select the template, as a string, characters
6254 only, for example @code{"a"} for a template to be selected with a
6255 single key, or @code{"bt"} for selection with two keys. When using
6256 several keys, keys using the same prefix key must be sequential
6257 in the list and preceded by a 2-element entry explaining the
6258 prefix key, for example
6260 ("b" "Templates for marking stuff to buy")
6262 @noindent If you do not define a template for the @kbd{C} key, this key will
6263 be used to open the customize buffer for this complex variable.
6266 A short string describing the template, which will be shown during
6270 The type of entry, a symbol. Valid values are:
6273 An Org-mode node, with a headline. Will be filed as the child of the
6274 target entry or as a top-level entry. The target file should be an Org-mode
6277 A plain list item, placed in the first plain list at the target
6278 location. Again the target file should be an Org file.
6280 A checkbox item. This only differs from the plain list item by the
6283 a new line in the first table at the target location. Where exactly the
6284 line will be inserted depends on the properties @code{:prepend} and
6285 @code{:table-line-pos} (see below).
6287 Text to be inserted as it is.
6291 @vindex org-default-notes-file
6292 Specification of where the captured item should be placed. In Org-mode
6293 files, targets usually define a node. Entries will become children of this
6294 node. Other types will be added to the table or list in the body of this
6295 node. Most target specifications contain a file name. If that file name is
6296 the empty string, it defaults to @code{org-default-notes-file}.
6300 @item (file "path/to/file")
6301 Text will be placed at the beginning or end of that file.
6303 @item (id "id of existing org entry")
6304 Filing as child of this entry, or in the body of the entry.
6306 @item (file+headline "path/to/file" "node headline")
6307 Fast configuration if the target heading is unique in the file.
6309 @item (file+olp "path/to/file" "Level 1 heading" "Level 2" ...)
6310 For non-unique headings, the full path is safer.
6312 @item (file+regexp "path/to/file" "regexp to find location")
6313 Use a regular expression to position the cursor.
6315 @item (file+datetree "path/to/file")
6316 Will create a heading in a date tree for today's date.
6318 @item (file+datetree+prompt "path/to/file")
6319 Will create a heading in a date tree, but will prompt for the date.
6321 @item (file+function "path/to/file" function-finding-location)
6322 A function to find the right location in the file.
6325 File to the entry that is currently being clocked.
6327 @item (function function-finding-location)
6328 Most general way, write your own function to find both
6333 The template for creating the capture item. If you leave this empty, an
6334 appropriate default template will be used. Otherwise this is a string with
6335 escape codes, which will be replaced depending on time and context of the
6336 capture call. The string with escapes may be loaded from a template file,
6337 using the special syntax @code{(file "path/to/template")}. See below for
6341 The rest of the entry is a property list of additional options.
6342 Recognized properties are:
6345 Normally new captured information will be appended at
6346 the target location (last child, last table line, last list item...).
6347 Setting this property will change that.
6349 @item :immediate-finish
6350 When set, do not offer to edit the information, just
6351 file it away immediately. This makes sense if the template only needs
6352 information that can be added automatically.
6355 Set this to the number of lines to insert
6356 before and after the new item. Default 0, only common other value is 1.
6359 Start the clock in this item.
6362 If starting the capture interrupted a clock, restart that clock when finished
6366 Do not narrow the target buffer, simply show the full buffer. Default is to
6367 narrow it so that you only see the new material.
6370 If the target file was not yet visited when capture was invoked, kill the
6371 buffer again after capture is completed.
6375 @node Template expansion, , Template elements, Capture templates
6376 @subsubsection Template expansion
6378 In the template itself, special @kbd{%}-escapes@footnote{If you need one of
6379 these sequences literally, escape the @kbd{%} with a backslash.} allow
6380 dynamic insertion of content:
6382 @comment SJE: should these sentences terminate in period?
6384 %^@{@var{prompt}@} @r{prompt the user for a string and replace this sequence with it.}
6385 @r{You may specify a default value and a completion table with}
6386 @r{%^@{prompt|default|completion2|completion3...@}}
6387 @r{The arrow keys access a prompt-specific history.}
6388 %a @r{annotation, normally the link created with @code{org-store-link}}
6389 %A @r{like @code{%a}, but prompt for the description part}
6390 %i @r{initial content, the region when capture is called while the}
6391 @r{region is active.}
6392 @r{The entire text will be indented like @code{%i} itself.}
6393 %t @r{timestamp, date only}
6394 %T @r{timestamp with date and time}
6395 %u, %U @r{like the above, but inactive timestamps}
6396 %^t @r{like @code{%t}, but prompt for date. Similarly @code{%^T}, @code{%^u}, @code{%^U}}
6397 @r{You may define a prompt like @code{%^@{Birthday@}t}}
6398 %n @r{user name (taken from @code{user-full-name})}
6399 %c @r{Current kill ring head.}
6400 %x @r{Content of the X clipboard.}
6401 %^C @r{Interactive selection of which kill or clip to use.}
6402 %^L @r{Like @code{%^C}, but insert as link.}
6403 %k @r{title of the currently clocked task}
6404 %K @r{link to the currently clocked task}
6405 %^g @r{prompt for tags, with completion on tags in target file.}
6406 %^G @r{prompt for tags, with completion all tags in all agenda files.}
6407 %^@{@var{prop}@}p @r{Prompt the user for a value for property @var{prop}}
6408 %:keyword @r{specific information for certain link types, see below}
6409 %[@var{file}] @r{insert the contents of the file given by @var{file}}
6410 %(@var{sexp}) @r{evaluate Elisp @var{sexp} and replace with the result}
6414 For specific link types, the following keywords will be
6415 defined@footnote{If you define your own link types (@pxref{Adding
6416 hyperlink types}), any property you store with
6417 @code{org-store-link-props} can be accessed in capture templates in a
6420 @vindex org-from-is-user-regexp
6422 Link type | Available keywords
6423 -------------------+----------------------------------------------
6424 bbdb | %:name %:company
6425 irc | %:server %:port %:nick
6426 vm, wl, mh, mew, rmail | %:type %:subject %:message-id
6427 | %:from %:fromname %:fromaddress
6428 | %:to %:toname %:toaddress
6429 | %:date @r{(message date header field)}
6430 | %:date-timestamp @r{(date as active timestamp)}
6431 | %:date-timestamp-inactive @r{(date as inactive timestamp)}
6432 | %:fromto @r{(either "to NAME" or "from NAME")@footnote{This will always be the other, not the user. See the variable @code{org-from-is-user-regexp}.}}
6433 gnus | %:group, @r{for messages also all email fields}
6435 info | %:file %:node
6440 To place the cursor after template expansion use:
6443 %? @r{After completing the template, position cursor here.}
6447 @node Attachments, RSS Feeds, Capture, Capture - Refile - Archive
6448 @section Attachments
6451 @vindex org-attach-directory
6452 It is often useful to associate reference material with an outline node/task.
6453 Small chunks of plain text can simply be stored in the subtree of a project.
6454 Hyperlinks (@pxref{Hyperlinks}) can establish associations with
6455 files that live elsewhere on your computer or in the cloud, like emails or
6456 source code files belonging to a project. Another method is @i{attachments},
6457 which are files located in a directory belonging to an outline node. Org
6458 uses directories named by the unique ID of each entry. These directories are
6459 located in the @file{data} directory which lives in the same directory where
6460 your Org file lives@footnote{If you move entries or Org files from one
6461 directory to another, you may want to configure @code{org-attach-directory}
6462 to contain an absolute path.}. If you initialize this directory with
6463 @code{git init}, Org will automatically commit changes when it sees them.
6464 The attachment system has been contributed to Org by John Wiegley.
6466 In cases where it seems better to do so, you can also attach a directory of your
6467 choice to an entry. You can also make children inherit the attachment
6468 directory from a parent, so that an entire subtree uses the same attached
6471 @noindent The following commands deal with attachments:
6475 @orgcmd{C-c C-a,org-attach}
6476 The dispatcher for commands related to the attachment system. After these
6477 keys, a list of commands is displayed and you must press an additional key
6478 to select a command:
6481 @orgcmdtkc{a,C-c C-a a,org-attach-attach}
6482 @vindex org-attach-method
6483 Select a file and move it into the task's attachment directory. The file
6484 will be copied, moved, or linked, depending on @code{org-attach-method}.
6485 Note that hard links are not supported on all systems.
6491 Attach a file using the copy/move/link method.
6492 Note that hard links are not supported on all systems.
6494 @orgcmdtkc{n,C-c C-a n,org-attach-new}
6495 Create a new attachment as an Emacs buffer.
6497 @orgcmdtkc{z,C-c C-a z,org-attach-sync}
6498 Synchronize the current task with its attachment directory, in case you added
6499 attachments yourself.
6501 @orgcmdtkc{p,C-c C-a o,org-attach-open}
6502 @vindex org-file-apps
6503 Open current task's attachment. If there is more than one, prompt for a
6504 file name first. Opening will follow the rules set by @code{org-file-apps}.
6505 For more details, see the information on following hyperlinks
6506 (@pxref{Handling links}).
6508 @orgcmdtkc{O,C-c C-a O,org-attach-open-in-emacs}
6509 Also open the attachment, but force opening the file in Emacs.
6511 @orgcmdtkc{f,C-c C-a f,org-attach-reveal}
6512 Open the current task's attachment directory.
6514 @orgcmdtkc{F,C-c C-a F,org-attach-reveal-in-emacs}
6515 Also open the directory, but force using @command{dired} in Emacs.
6517 @orgcmdtkc{d,C-c C-a d,org-attach-delete-one}
6518 Select and delete a single attachment.
6520 @orgcmdtkc{D,C-c C-a D,org-attach-delete-all}
6521 Delete all of a task's attachments. A safer way is to open the directory in
6522 @command{dired} and delete from there.
6524 @orgcmdtkc{s,C-c C-a s,org-attach-set-directory}
6525 @cindex property, ATTACH_DIR
6526 Set a specific directory as the entry's attachment directory. This works by
6527 putting the directory path into the @code{ATTACH_DIR} property.
6529 @orgcmdtkc{i,C-c C-a i,org-attach-set-inherit}
6530 @cindex property, ATTACH_DIR_INHERIT
6531 Set the @code{ATTACH_DIR_INHERIT} property, so that children will use the
6532 same directory for attachments as the parent does.
6536 @node RSS Feeds, Protocols, Attachments, Capture - Refile - Archive
6541 Org can add and change entries based on information found in RSS feeds and
6542 Atom feeds. You could use this to make a task out of each new podcast in a
6543 podcast feed. Or you could use a phone-based note-creating service on the
6544 web to import tasks into Org. To access feeds, configure the variable
6545 @code{org-feed-alist}. The docstring of this variable has detailed
6546 information. Here is just an example:
6549 (setq org-feed-alist
6551 "http://rss.slashdot.org/Slashdot/slashdot"
6552 "~/txt/org/feeds.org" "Slashdot Entries")))
6556 will configure that new items from the feed provided by
6557 @code{rss.slashdot.org} will result in new entries in the file
6558 @file{~/org/feeds.org} under the heading @samp{Slashdot Entries}, whenever
6559 the following command is used:
6562 @orgcmd{C-c C-x g,org-feed-update-all}
6564 Collect items from the feeds configured in @code{org-feed-alist} and act upon
6566 @orgcmd{C-c C-x G,org-feed-goto-inbox}
6567 Prompt for a feed name and go to the inbox configured for this feed.
6570 Under the same headline, Org will create a drawer @samp{FEEDSTATUS} in which
6571 it will store information about the status of items in the feed, to avoid
6572 adding the same item several times. You should add @samp{FEEDSTATUS} to the
6573 list of drawers in that file:
6576 #+DRAWERS: LOGBOOK PROPERTIES FEEDSTATUS
6579 For more information, including how to read atom feeds, see
6580 @file{org-feed.el} and the docstring of @code{org-feed-alist}.
6582 @node Protocols, Refiling notes, RSS Feeds, Capture - Refile - Archive
6583 @section Protocols for external access
6584 @cindex protocols, for external access
6587 You can set up Org for handling protocol calls from outside applications that
6588 are passed to Emacs through the @file{emacsserver}. For example, you can
6589 configure bookmarks in your web browser to send a link to the current page to
6590 Org and create a note from it using capture (@pxref{Capture}). Or you
6591 could create a bookmark that will tell Emacs to open the local source file of
6592 a remote website you are looking at with the browser. See
6593 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-contrib/org-protocol.php} for detailed
6594 documentation and setup instructions.
6596 @node Refiling notes, Archiving, Protocols, Capture - Refile - Archive
6597 @section Refiling notes
6598 @cindex refiling notes
6600 When reviewing the captured data, you may want to refile some of the entries
6601 into a different list, for example into a project. Cutting, finding the
6602 right location, and then pasting the note is cumbersome. To simplify this
6603 process, you can use the following special command:
6606 @orgcmd{C-c C-w,org-refile}
6607 @vindex org-reverse-note-order
6608 @vindex org-refile-targets
6609 @vindex org-refile-use-outline-path
6610 @vindex org-outline-path-complete-in-steps
6611 @vindex org-refile-allow-creating-parent-nodes
6612 @vindex org-log-refile
6613 @vindex org-refile-use-cache
6614 Refile the entry or region at point. This command offers possible locations
6615 for refiling the entry and lets you select one with completion. The item (or
6616 all items in the region) is filed below the target heading as a subitem.
6617 Depending on @code{org-reverse-note-order}, it will be either the first or
6619 By default, all level 1 headlines in the current buffer are considered to be
6620 targets, but you can have more complex definitions across a number of files.
6621 See the variable @code{org-refile-targets} for details. If you would like to
6622 select a location via a file-path-like completion along the outline path, see
6623 the variables @code{org-refile-use-outline-path} and
6624 @code{org-outline-path-complete-in-steps}. If you would like to be able to
6625 create new nodes as new parents for refiling on the fly, check the
6626 variable @code{org-refile-allow-creating-parent-nodes}.
6627 When the variable @code{org-log-refile}@footnote{with corresponding
6628 @code{#+STARTUP} keywords @code{logrefile}, @code{lognoterefile},
6629 and @code{nologrefile}} is set, a time stamp or a note will be
6630 recorded when an entry has been refiled.
6631 @orgkey{C-u C-c C-w}
6632 Use the refile interface to jump to a heading.
6633 @orgcmd{C-u C-u C-c C-w,org-refile-goto-last-stored}
6634 Jump to the location where @code{org-refile} last moved a tree to.
6636 Refile as the child of the item currently being clocked.
6637 @item C-0 C-c C-w @ @r{or} @ C-u C-u C-u C-c C-w
6639 @orgcmdtkc{C-0 C-c C-w @ @r{or} @ C-u C-u C-u C-c C-w,C-0 C-c C-w,org-refile-cache-clear}
6641 Clear the target cache. Caching of refile targets can be turned on by
6642 setting @code{org-refile-use-cache}. To make the command see new possible
6643 targets, you have to clear the cache with this command.
6646 @node Archiving, , Refiling notes, Capture - Refile - Archive
6650 When a project represented by a (sub)tree is finished, you may want
6651 to move the tree out of the way and to stop it from contributing to the
6652 agenda. Archiving is important to keep your working files compact and global
6653 searches like the construction of agenda views fast.
6656 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-a,org-archive-subtree-default}
6657 @vindex org-archive-default-command
6658 Archive the current entry using the command specified in the variable
6659 @code{org-archive-default-command}.
6663 * Moving subtrees:: Moving a tree to an archive file
6664 * Internal archiving:: Switch off a tree but keep it in the file
6667 @node Moving subtrees, Internal archiving, Archiving, Archiving
6668 @subsection Moving a tree to the archive file
6669 @cindex external archiving
6671 The most common archiving action is to move a project tree to another file,
6675 @orgcmdkskc{C-c C-x C-s,C-c $,org-archive-subtree}
6676 @vindex org-archive-location
6677 Archive the subtree starting at the cursor position to the location
6678 given by @code{org-archive-location}.
6679 @orgkey{C-u C-c C-x C-s}
6680 Check if any direct children of the current headline could be moved to
6681 the archive. To do this, each subtree is checked for open TODO entries.
6682 If none are found, the command offers to move it to the archive
6683 location. If the cursor is @emph{not} on a headline when this command
6684 is invoked, the level 1 trees will be checked.
6687 @cindex archive locations
6688 The default archive location is a file in the same directory as the
6689 current file, with the name derived by appending @file{_archive} to the
6690 current file name. For information and examples on how to change this,
6691 see the documentation string of the variable
6692 @code{org-archive-location}. There is also an in-buffer option for
6693 setting this variable, for example@footnote{For backward compatibility,
6694 the following also works: If there are several such lines in a file,
6695 each specifies the archive location for the text below it. The first
6696 such line also applies to any text before its definition. However,
6697 using this method is @emph{strongly} deprecated as it is incompatible
6698 with the outline structure of the document. The correct method for
6699 setting multiple archive locations in a buffer is using properties.}:
6703 #+ARCHIVE: %s_done::
6706 @cindex property, ARCHIVE
6708 If you would like to have a special ARCHIVE location for a single entry
6709 or a (sub)tree, give the entry an @code{:ARCHIVE:} property with the
6710 location as the value (@pxref{Properties and Columns}).
6712 @vindex org-archive-save-context-info
6713 When a subtree is moved, it receives a number of special properties that
6714 record context information like the file from where the entry came, its
6715 outline path the archiving time etc. Configure the variable
6716 @code{org-archive-save-context-info} to adjust the amount of information
6720 @node Internal archiving, , Moving subtrees, Archiving
6721 @subsection Internal archiving
6723 If you want to just switch off (for agenda views) certain subtrees without
6724 moving them to a different file, you can use the @code{ARCHIVE tag}.
6726 A headline that is marked with the ARCHIVE tag (@pxref{Tags}) stays at
6727 its location in the outline tree, but behaves in the following way:
6730 @vindex org-cycle-open-archived-trees
6731 It does not open when you attempt to do so with a visibility cycling
6732 command (@pxref{Visibility cycling}). You can force cycling archived
6733 subtrees with @kbd{C-@key{TAB}}, or by setting the option
6734 @code{org-cycle-open-archived-trees}. Also normal outline commands like
6735 @code{show-all} will open archived subtrees.
6737 @vindex org-sparse-tree-open-archived-trees
6738 During sparse tree construction (@pxref{Sparse trees}), matches in
6739 archived subtrees are not exposed, unless you configure the option
6740 @code{org-sparse-tree-open-archived-trees}.
6742 @vindex org-agenda-skip-archived-trees
6743 During agenda view construction (@pxref{Agenda Views}), the content of
6744 archived trees is ignored unless you configure the option
6745 @code{org-agenda-skip-archived-trees}, in which case these trees will always
6746 be included. In the agenda you can press @kbd{v a} to get archives
6747 temporarily included.
6749 @vindex org-export-with-archived-trees
6750 Archived trees are not exported (@pxref{Exporting}), only the headline
6751 is. Configure the details using the variable
6752 @code{org-export-with-archived-trees}.
6754 @vindex org-columns-skip-archived-trees
6755 Archived trees are excluded from column view unless the variable
6756 @code{org-columns-skip-archived-trees} is configured to @code{nil}.
6759 The following commands help manage the ARCHIVE tag:
6762 @orgcmd{C-c C-x a,org-toggle-archive-tag}
6763 Toggle the ARCHIVE tag for the current headline. When the tag is set,
6764 the headline changes to a shadowed face, and the subtree below it is
6766 @orgkey{C-u C-c C-x a}
6767 Check if any direct children of the current headline should be archived.
6768 To do this, each subtree is checked for open TODO entries. If none are
6769 found, the command offers to set the ARCHIVE tag for the child. If the
6770 cursor is @emph{not} on a headline when this command is invoked, the
6771 level 1 trees will be checked.
6772 @orgcmd{C-@kbd{TAB},org-force-cycle-archived}
6773 Cycle a tree even if it is tagged with ARCHIVE.
6774 @orgcmd{C-c C-x A,org-archive-to-archive-sibling}
6775 Move the current entry to the @emph{Archive Sibling}. This is a sibling of
6776 the entry with the heading @samp{Archive} and the tag @samp{ARCHIVE}. The
6777 entry becomes a child of that sibling and in this way retains a lot of its
6778 original context, including inherited tags and approximate position in the
6783 @node Agenda Views, Markup, Capture - Refile - Archive, Top
6784 @chapter Agenda views
6785 @cindex agenda views
6787 Due to the way Org works, TODO items, time-stamped items, and
6788 tagged headlines can be scattered throughout a file or even a number of
6789 files. To get an overview of open action items, or of events that are
6790 important for a particular date, this information must be collected,
6791 sorted and displayed in an organized way.
6793 Org can select items based on various criteria and display them
6794 in a separate buffer. Seven different view types are provided:
6798 an @emph{agenda} that is like a calendar and shows information
6801 a @emph{TODO list} that covers all unfinished
6804 a @emph{match view}, showings headlines based on the tags, properties, and
6805 TODO state associated with them,
6807 a @emph{timeline view} that shows all events in a single Org file,
6808 in time-sorted view,
6810 a @emph{text search view} that shows all entries from multiple files
6811 that contain specified keywords,
6813 a @emph{stuck projects view} showing projects that currently don't move
6816 @emph{custom views} that are special searches and combinations of different
6821 The extracted information is displayed in a special @emph{agenda
6822 buffer}. This buffer is read-only, but provides commands to visit the
6823 corresponding locations in the original Org files, and even to
6824 edit these files remotely.
6826 @vindex org-agenda-window-setup
6827 @vindex org-agenda-restore-windows-after-quit
6828 Two variables control how the agenda buffer is displayed and whether the
6829 window configuration is restored when the agenda exits:
6830 @code{org-agenda-window-setup} and
6831 @code{org-agenda-restore-windows-after-quit}.
6834 * Agenda files:: Files being searched for agenda information
6835 * Agenda dispatcher:: Keyboard access to agenda views
6836 * Built-in agenda views:: What is available out of the box?
6837 * Presentation and sorting:: How agenda items are prepared for display
6838 * Agenda commands:: Remote editing of Org trees
6839 * Custom agenda views:: Defining special searches and views
6840 * Exporting Agenda Views:: Writing a view to a file
6841 * Agenda column view:: Using column view for collected entries
6844 @node Agenda files, Agenda dispatcher, Agenda Views, Agenda Views
6845 @section Agenda files
6846 @cindex agenda files
6847 @cindex files for agenda
6849 @vindex org-agenda-files
6850 The information to be shown is normally collected from all @emph{agenda
6851 files}, the files listed in the variable
6852 @code{org-agenda-files}@footnote{If the value of that variable is not a
6853 list, but a single file name, then the list of agenda files will be
6854 maintained in that external file.}. If a directory is part of this list,
6855 all files with the extension @file{.org} in this directory will be part
6858 Thus, even if you only work with a single Org file, that file should
6859 be put into the list@footnote{When using the dispatcher, pressing
6860 @kbd{<} before selecting a command will actually limit the command to
6861 the current file, and ignore @code{org-agenda-files} until the next
6862 dispatcher command.}. You can customize @code{org-agenda-files}, but
6863 the easiest way to maintain it is through the following commands
6865 @cindex files, adding to agenda list
6867 @orgcmd{C-c [,org-agenda-to-front}
6868 Add current file to the list of agenda files. The file is added to
6869 the front of the list. If it was already in the list, it is moved to
6870 the front. With a prefix argument, file is added/moved to the end.
6871 @orgcmd{C-c ],org-remove-file}
6872 Remove current file from the list of agenda files.
6874 @orgcmd{C-',org-cycle-agenda-files}
6876 Cycle through agenda file list, visiting one file after the other.
6877 @kindex M-x org-iswitchb
6878 @item M-x org-iswitchb
6879 Command to use an @code{iswitchb}-like interface to switch to and between Org
6884 The Org menu contains the current list of files and can be used
6885 to visit any of them.
6887 If you would like to focus the agenda temporarily on a file not in
6888 this list, or on just one file in the list, or even on only a subtree in a
6889 file, then this can be done in different ways. For a single agenda command,
6890 you may press @kbd{<} once or several times in the dispatcher
6891 (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}). To restrict the agenda scope for an
6892 extended period, use the following commands:
6895 @orgcmd{C-c C-x <,org-agenda-set-restriction-lock}
6896 Permanently restrict the agenda to the current subtree. When with a
6897 prefix argument, or with the cursor before the first headline in a file,
6898 the agenda scope is set to the entire file. This restriction remains in
6899 effect until removed with @kbd{C-c C-x >}, or by typing either @kbd{<}
6900 or @kbd{>} in the agenda dispatcher. If there is a window displaying an
6901 agenda view, the new restriction takes effect immediately.
6902 @orgcmd{C-c C-x >,org-agenda-remove-restriction-lock}
6903 Remove the permanent restriction created by @kbd{C-c C-x <}.
6907 When working with @file{speedbar.el}, you can use the following commands in
6910 @orgcmdtkc{< @r{in the speedbar frame},<,org-speedbar-set-agenda-restriction}
6911 Permanently restrict the agenda to the item---either an Org file or a subtree
6912 in such a file---at the cursor in the Speedbar frame.
6913 If there is a window displaying an agenda view, the new restriction takes
6915 @orgcmdtkc{> @r{in the speedbar frame},>,org-agenda-remove-restriction-lock}
6916 Lift the restriction.
6919 @node Agenda dispatcher, Built-in agenda views, Agenda files, Agenda Views
6920 @section The agenda dispatcher
6921 @cindex agenda dispatcher
6922 @cindex dispatching agenda commands
6923 The views are created through a dispatcher, which should be bound to a
6924 global key---for example @kbd{C-c a} (@pxref{Installation}). In the
6925 following we will assume that @kbd{C-c a} is indeed how the dispatcher
6926 is accessed and list keyboard access to commands accordingly. After
6927 pressing @kbd{C-c a}, an additional letter is required to execute a
6928 command. The dispatcher offers the following default commands:
6931 Create the calendar-like agenda (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}).
6933 Create a list of all TODO items (@pxref{Global TODO list}).
6935 Create a list of headlines matching a TAGS expression (@pxref{Matching
6936 tags and properties}).
6938 Create the timeline view for the current buffer (@pxref{Timeline}).
6940 Create a list of entries selected by a boolean expression of keywords
6941 and/or regular expressions that must or must not occur in the entry.
6943 @vindex org-agenda-text-search-extra-files
6944 Search for a regular expression in all agenda files and additionally in
6945 the files listed in @code{org-agenda-text-search-extra-files}. This
6946 uses the Emacs command @code{multi-occur}. A prefix argument can be
6947 used to specify the number of context lines for each match, default is
6950 Create a list of stuck projects (@pxref{Stuck projects}).
6952 Restrict an agenda command to the current buffer@footnote{For backward
6953 compatibility, you can also press @kbd{1} to restrict to the current
6954 buffer.}. After pressing @kbd{<}, you still need to press the character
6955 selecting the command.
6957 If there is an active region, restrict the following agenda command to
6958 the region. Otherwise, restrict it to the current subtree@footnote{For
6959 backward compatibility, you can also press @kbd{0} to restrict to the
6960 current region/subtree.}. After pressing @kbd{< <}, you still need to press the
6961 character selecting the command.
6964 You can also define custom commands that will be accessible through the
6965 dispatcher, just like the default commands. This includes the
6966 possibility to create extended agenda buffers that contain several
6967 blocks together, for example the weekly agenda, the global TODO list and
6968 a number of special tags matches. @xref{Custom agenda views}.
6970 @node Built-in agenda views, Presentation and sorting, Agenda dispatcher, Agenda Views
6971 @section The built-in agenda views
6973 In this section we describe the built-in views.
6976 * Weekly/daily agenda:: The calendar page with current tasks
6977 * Global TODO list:: All unfinished action items
6978 * Matching tags and properties:: Structured information with fine-tuned search
6979 * Timeline:: Time-sorted view for single file
6980 * Search view:: Find entries by searching for text
6981 * Stuck projects:: Find projects you need to review
6984 @node Weekly/daily agenda, Global TODO list, Built-in agenda views, Built-in agenda views
6985 @subsection The weekly/daily agenda
6987 @cindex weekly agenda
6988 @cindex daily agenda
6990 The purpose of the weekly/daily @emph{agenda} is to act like a page of a
6991 paper agenda, showing all the tasks for the current week or day.
6994 @cindex org-agenda, command
6995 @orgcmd{C-c a a,org-agenda-list}
6996 Compile an agenda for the current week from a list of Org files. The agenda
6997 shows the entries for each day. With a numeric prefix@footnote{For backward
6998 compatibility, the universal prefix @kbd{C-u} causes all TODO entries to be
6999 listed before the agenda. This feature is deprecated, use the dedicated TODO
7000 list, or a block agenda instead (@pxref{Block agenda}).} (like @kbd{C-u 2 1
7001 C-c a a}) you may set the number of days to be displayed.
7004 @vindex org-agenda-span
7005 @vindex org-agenda-ndays
7006 The default number of days displayed in the agenda is set by the variable
7007 @code{org-agenda-span} (or the obsolete @code{org-agenda-ndays}). This
7008 variable can be set to any number of days you want to see by default in the
7009 agenda, or to a span name, such a @code{day}, @code{week}, @code{month} or
7012 Remote editing from the agenda buffer means, for example, that you can
7013 change the dates of deadlines and appointments from the agenda buffer.
7014 The commands available in the Agenda buffer are listed in @ref{Agenda
7017 @subsubheading Calendar/Diary integration
7018 @cindex calendar integration
7019 @cindex diary integration
7021 Emacs contains the calendar and diary by Edward M. Reingold. The
7022 calendar displays a three-month calendar with holidays from different
7023 countries and cultures. The diary allows you to keep track of
7024 anniversaries, lunar phases, sunrise/set, recurrent appointments
7025 (weekly, monthly) and more. In this way, it is quite complementary to
7026 Org. It can be very useful to combine output from Org with
7029 In order to include entries from the Emacs diary into Org-mode's
7030 agenda, you only need to customize the variable
7033 (setq org-agenda-include-diary t)
7036 @noindent After that, everything will happen automatically. All diary
7037 entries including holidays, anniversaries, etc., will be included in the
7038 agenda buffer created by Org-mode. @key{SPC}, @key{TAB}, and
7039 @key{RET} can be used from the agenda buffer to jump to the diary
7040 file in order to edit existing diary entries. The @kbd{i} command to
7041 insert new entries for the current date works in the agenda buffer, as
7042 well as the commands @kbd{S}, @kbd{M}, and @kbd{C} to display
7043 Sunrise/Sunset times, show lunar phases and to convert to other
7044 calendars, respectively. @kbd{c} can be used to switch back and forth
7045 between calendar and agenda.
7047 If you are using the diary only for sexp entries and holidays, it is
7048 faster to not use the above setting, but instead to copy or even move
7049 the entries into an Org file. Org-mode evaluates diary-style sexp
7050 entries, and does it faster because there is no overhead for first
7051 creating the diary display. Note that the sexp entries must start at
7052 the left margin, no whitespace is allowed before them. For example,
7053 the following segment of an Org file will be processed and entries
7054 will be made in the agenda:
7057 * Birthdays and similar stuff
7059 %%(org-calendar-holiday) ; special function for holiday names
7061 %%(diary-anniversary 5 14 1956)@footnote{Note that the order of the arguments (month, day, year) depends on the setting of @code{calendar-date-style}.} Arthur Dent is %d years old
7062 %%(diary-anniversary 10 2 1869) Mahatma Gandhi would be %d years old
7065 @subsubheading Anniversaries from BBDB
7066 @cindex BBDB, anniversaries
7067 @cindex anniversaries, from BBDB
7069 If you are using the Big Brothers Database to store your contacts, you will
7070 very likely prefer to store anniversaries in BBDB rather than in a
7071 separate Org or diary file. Org supports this and will show BBDB
7072 anniversaries as part of the agenda. All you need to do is to add the
7073 following to one your your agenda files:
7080 %%(org-bbdb-anniversaries)
7083 You can then go ahead and define anniversaries for a BBDB record. Basically,
7084 you need to press @kbd{C-o anniversary @key{RET}} with the cursor in a BBDB
7085 record and then add the date in the format @code{YYYY-MM-DD}, followed by a
7086 space and the class of the anniversary (@samp{birthday} or @samp{wedding}, or
7087 a format string). If you omit the class, it will default to @samp{birthday}.
7088 Here are a few examples, the header for the file @file{org-bbdb.el} contains
7089 more detailed information.
7094 2008-04-14 %s released version 6.01 of org-mode, %d years ago
7097 After a change to BBDB, or for the first agenda display during an Emacs
7098 session, the agenda display will suffer a short delay as Org updates its
7099 hash with anniversaries. However, from then on things will be very fast---much
7100 faster in fact than a long list of @samp{%%(diary-anniversary)} entries
7101 in an Org or Diary file.
7103 @subsubheading Appointment reminders
7104 @cindex @file{appt.el}
7105 @cindex appointment reminders
7107 Org can interact with Emacs appointments notification facility. To add all
7108 the appointments of your agenda files, use the command
7109 @code{org-agenda-to-appt}. This command also lets you filter through the
7110 list of your appointments and add only those belonging to a specific category
7111 or matching a regular expression. See the docstring for details.
7113 @node Global TODO list, Matching tags and properties, Weekly/daily agenda, Built-in agenda views
7114 @subsection The global TODO list
7115 @cindex global TODO list
7116 @cindex TODO list, global
7118 The global TODO list contains all unfinished TODO items formatted and
7119 collected into a single place.
7122 @orgcmd{C-c a t,org-todo-list}
7123 Show the global TODO list. This collects the TODO items from all agenda
7124 files (@pxref{Agenda Views}) into a single buffer. By default, this lists
7125 items with a state the is not a DONE state. The buffer is in
7126 @code{agenda-mode}, so there are commands to examine and manipulate the TODO
7127 entries directly from that buffer (@pxref{Agenda commands}).
7128 @orgcmd{C-c a T,org-todo-list}
7129 @cindex TODO keyword matching
7130 @vindex org-todo-keywords
7131 Like the above, but allows selection of a specific TODO keyword. You can
7132 also do this by specifying a prefix argument to @kbd{C-c a t}. You are
7133 prompted for a keyword, and you may also specify several keywords by
7134 separating them with @samp{|} as the boolean OR operator. With a numeric
7135 prefix, the Nth keyword in @code{org-todo-keywords} is selected.
7137 The @kbd{r} key in the agenda buffer regenerates it, and you can give
7138 a prefix argument to this command to change the selected TODO keyword,
7139 for example @kbd{3 r}. If you often need a search for a specific
7140 keyword, define a custom command for it (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}).@*
7141 Matching specific TODO keywords can also be done as part of a tags
7142 search (@pxref{Tag searches}).
7145 Remote editing of TODO items means that you can change the state of a
7146 TODO entry with a single key press. The commands available in the
7147 TODO list are described in @ref{Agenda commands}.
7149 @cindex sublevels, inclusion into TODO list
7150 Normally the global TODO list simply shows all headlines with TODO
7151 keywords. This list can become very long. There are two ways to keep
7155 @vindex org-agenda-todo-ignore-scheduled
7156 @vindex org-agenda-todo-ignore-deadlines
7157 @vindex org-agenda-todo-ignore-timestamp
7158 @vindex org-agenda-todo-ignore-with-date
7159 Some people view a TODO item that has been @emph{scheduled} for execution or
7160 have a @emph{deadline} (@pxref{Timestamps}) as no longer @emph{open}.
7161 Configure the variables @code{org-agenda-todo-ignore-scheduled},
7162 @code{org-agenda-todo-ignore-deadlines},
7163 @code{org-agenda-todo-ignore-timestamp} and/or
7164 @code{org-agenda-todo-ignore-with-date} to exclude such items from the global
7167 @vindex org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels
7168 TODO items may have sublevels to break up the task into subtasks. In
7169 such cases it may be enough to list only the highest level TODO headline
7170 and omit the sublevels from the global list. Configure the variable
7171 @code{org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels} to get this behavior.
7174 @node Matching tags and properties, Timeline, Global TODO list, Built-in agenda views
7175 @subsection Matching tags and properties
7176 @cindex matching, of tags
7177 @cindex matching, of properties
7181 If headlines in the agenda files are marked with @emph{tags} (@pxref{Tags}),
7182 or have properties (@pxref{Properties and Columns}), you can select headlines
7183 based on this metadata and collect them into an agenda buffer. The match
7184 syntax described here also applies when creating sparse trees with @kbd{C-c /
7188 @orgcmd{C-c a m,org-tags-view}
7189 Produce a list of all headlines that match a given set of tags. The
7190 command prompts for a selection criterion, which is a boolean logic
7191 expression with tags, like @samp{+work+urgent-withboss} or
7192 @samp{work|home} (@pxref{Tags}). If you often need a specific search,
7193 define a custom command for it (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}).
7194 @orgcmd{C-c a M,org-tags-view}
7195 @vindex org-tags-match-list-sublevels
7196 @vindex org-agenda-tags-todo-honor-ignore-options
7197 Like @kbd{C-c a m}, but only select headlines that are also TODO items in a
7198 not-DONE state and force checking subitems (see variable
7199 @code{org-tags-match-list-sublevels}). To exclude scheduled/deadline items,
7200 see the variable @code{org-agenda-tags-todo-honor-ignore-options}. Matching
7201 specific TODO keywords together with a tags match is also possible, see
7205 The commands available in the tags list are described in @ref{Agenda
7208 @subsubheading Match syntax
7210 @cindex Boolean logic, for tag/property searches
7211 A search string can use Boolean operators @samp{&} for AND and @samp{|} for
7212 OR. @samp{&} binds more strongly than @samp{|}. Parentheses are currently
7213 not implemented. Each element in the search is either a tag, a regular
7214 expression matching tags, or an expression like @code{PROPERTY OPERATOR
7215 VALUE} with a comparison operator, accessing a property value. Each element
7216 may be preceded by @samp{-}, to select against it, and @samp{+} is syntactic
7217 sugar for positive selection. The AND operator @samp{&} is optional when
7218 @samp{+} or @samp{-} is present. Here are some examples, using only tags.
7222 Select headlines tagged @samp{:work:}, but discard those also tagged
7225 Selects lines tagged @samp{:work:} or @samp{:laptop:}.
7226 @item work|laptop+night
7227 Like before, but require the @samp{:laptop:} lines to be tagged also
7231 @cindex regular expressions, with tags search
7232 Instead of a tag, you may also specify a regular expression enclosed in curly
7233 braces. For example,
7234 @samp{work+@{^boss.*@}} matches headlines that contain the tag
7235 @samp{:work:} and any tag @i{starting} with @samp{boss}.
7237 @cindex TODO keyword matching, with tags search
7238 @cindex level, require for tags/property match
7239 @cindex category, require for tags/property match
7240 @vindex org-odd-levels-only
7241 You may also test for properties (@pxref{Properties and Columns}) at the same
7242 time as matching tags. The properties may be real properties, or special
7243 properties that represent other metadata (@pxref{Special properties}). For
7244 example, the ``property'' @code{TODO} represents the TODO keyword of the
7245 entry. Or, the ``property'' @code{LEVEL} represents the level of an entry.
7246 So a search @samp{+LEVEL=3+boss-TODO="DONE"} lists all level three headlines
7247 that have the tag @samp{boss} and are @emph{not} marked with the TODO keyword
7248 DONE. In buffers with @code{org-odd-levels-only} set, @samp{LEVEL} does not
7249 count the number of stars, but @samp{LEVEL=2} will correspond to 3 stars etc.
7251 Here are more examples:
7253 @item work+TODO="WAITING"
7254 Select @samp{:work:}-tagged TODO lines with the specific TODO
7255 keyword @samp{WAITING}.
7256 @item work+TODO="WAITING"|home+TODO="WAITING"
7257 Waiting tasks both at work and at home.
7260 When matching properties, a number of different operators can be used to test
7261 the value of a property. Here is a complex example:
7264 +work-boss+PRIORITY="A"+Coffee="unlimited"+Effort<2 \
7265 +With=@{Sarah\|Denny@}+SCHEDULED>="<2008-10-11>"
7269 The type of comparison will depend on how the comparison value is written:
7272 If the comparison value is a plain number, a numerical comparison is done,
7273 and the allowed operators are @samp{<}, @samp{=}, @samp{>}, @samp{<=},
7274 @samp{>=}, and @samp{<>}.
7276 If the comparison value is enclosed in double-quotes,
7277 a string comparison is done, and the same operators are allowed.
7279 If the comparison value is enclosed in double-quotes @emph{and} angular
7280 brackets (like @samp{DEADLINE<="<2008-12-24 18:30>"}), both values are
7281 assumed to be date/time specifications in the standard Org way, and the
7282 comparison will be done accordingly. Special values that will be recognized
7283 are @code{"<now>"} for now (including time), and @code{"<today>"}, and
7284 @code{"<tomorrow>"} for these days at 0:00 hours, i.e. without a time
7285 specification. Also strings like @code{"<+5d>"} or @code{"<-2m>"} with units
7286 @code{d}, @code{w}, @code{m}, and @code{y} for day, week, month, and year,
7287 respectively, can be used.
7289 If the comparison value is enclosed
7290 in curly braces, a regexp match is performed, with @samp{=} meaning that the
7291 regexp matches the property value, and @samp{<>} meaning that it does not
7295 So the search string in the example finds entries tagged @samp{:work:} but
7296 not @samp{:boss:}, which also have a priority value @samp{A}, a
7297 @samp{:Coffee:} property with the value @samp{unlimited}, an @samp{Effort}
7298 property that is numerically smaller than 2, a @samp{:With:} property that is
7299 matched by the regular expression @samp{Sarah\|Denny}, and that are scheduled
7300 on or after October 11, 2008.
7302 Accessing TODO, LEVEL, and CATEGORY during a search is fast. Accessing any
7303 other properties will slow down the search. However, once you have paid the
7304 price by accessing one property, testing additional properties is cheap
7307 You can configure Org-mode to use property inheritance during a search, but
7308 beware that this can slow down searches considerably. See @ref{Property
7309 inheritance}, for details.
7311 For backward compatibility, and also for typing speed, there is also a
7312 different way to test TODO states in a search. For this, terminate the
7313 tags/property part of the search string (which may include several terms
7314 connected with @samp{|}) with a @samp{/} and then specify a Boolean
7315 expression just for TODO keywords. The syntax is then similar to that for
7316 tags, but should be applied with care: for example, a positive selection on
7317 several TODO keywords cannot meaningfully be combined with boolean AND.
7318 However, @emph{negative selection} combined with AND can be meaningful. To
7319 make sure that only lines are checked that actually have any TODO keyword
7320 (resulting in a speed-up), use @kbd{C-c a M}, or equivalently start the TODO
7321 part after the slash with @samp{!}. Using @kbd{C-c a M} or @samp{/!} will
7322 not match TODO keywords in a DONE state. Examples:
7326 Same as @samp{work+TODO="WAITING"}
7327 @item work/!-WAITING-NEXT
7328 Select @samp{:work:}-tagged TODO lines that are neither @samp{WAITING}
7330 @item work/!+WAITING|+NEXT
7331 Select @samp{:work:}-tagged TODO lines that are either @samp{WAITING} or
7335 @node Timeline, Search view, Matching tags and properties, Built-in agenda views
7336 @subsection Timeline for a single file
7337 @cindex timeline, single file
7338 @cindex time-sorted view
7340 The timeline summarizes all time-stamped items from a single Org-mode
7341 file in a @emph{time-sorted view}. The main purpose of this command is
7342 to give an overview over events in a project.
7345 @orgcmd{C-c a L,org-timeline}
7346 Show a time-sorted view of the Org file, with all time-stamped items.
7347 When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix, all unfinished TODO entries
7348 (scheduled or not) are also listed under the current date.
7352 The commands available in the timeline buffer are listed in
7353 @ref{Agenda commands}.
7355 @node Search view, Stuck projects, Timeline, Built-in agenda views
7356 @subsection Search view
7359 @cindex searching, for text
7361 This agenda view is a general text search facility for Org-mode entries.
7362 It is particularly useful to find notes.
7365 @orgcmd{C-c a s,org-search-view}
7366 This is a special search that lets you select entries by matching a substring
7367 or specific words using a boolean logic.
7369 For example, the search string @samp{computer equipment} will find entries
7370 that contain @samp{computer equipment} as a substring. If the two words are
7371 separated by more space or a line break, the search will still match.
7372 Search view can also search for specific keywords in the entry, using Boolean
7373 logic. The search string @samp{+computer +wifi -ethernet -@{8\.11[bg]@}}
7374 will search for note entries that contain the keywords @code{computer}
7375 and @code{wifi}, but not the keyword @code{ethernet}, and which are also
7376 not matched by the regular expression @code{8\.11[bg]}, meaning to
7377 exclude both 8.11b and 8.11g. The first @samp{+} is necessary to turn on
7378 word search, other @samp{+} characters are optional. For more details, see
7379 the docstring of the command @code{org-search-view}.
7381 @vindex org-agenda-text-search-extra-files
7382 Note that in addition to the agenda files, this command will also search
7383 the files listed in @code{org-agenda-text-search-extra-files}.
7385 @node Stuck projects, , Search view, Built-in agenda views
7386 @subsection Stuck projects
7388 If you are following a system like David Allen's GTD to organize your
7389 work, one of the ``duties'' you have is a regular review to make sure
7390 that all projects move along. A @emph{stuck} project is a project that
7391 has no defined next actions, so it will never show up in the TODO lists
7392 Org-mode produces. During the review, you need to identify such
7393 projects and define next actions for them.
7396 @orgcmd{C-c a #,org-agenda-list-stuck-projects}
7397 List projects that are stuck.
7400 @vindex org-stuck-projects
7401 Customize the variable @code{org-stuck-projects} to define what a stuck
7402 project is and how to find it.
7405 You almost certainly will have to configure this view before it will
7406 work for you. The built-in default assumes that all your projects are
7407 level-2 headlines, and that a project is not stuck if it has at least
7408 one entry marked with a TODO keyword TODO or NEXT or NEXTACTION.
7410 Let's assume that you, in your own way of using Org-mode, identify
7411 projects with a tag PROJECT, and that you use a TODO keyword MAYBE to
7412 indicate a project that should not be considered yet. Let's further
7413 assume that the TODO keyword DONE marks finished projects, and that NEXT
7414 and TODO indicate next actions. The tag @@SHOP indicates shopping and
7415 is a next action even without the NEXT tag. Finally, if the project
7416 contains the special word IGNORE anywhere, it should not be listed
7417 either. In this case you would start by identifying eligible projects
7418 with a tags/todo match@footnote{@xref{Tag searches}.}
7419 @samp{+PROJECT/-MAYBE-DONE}, and then check for TODO, NEXT, @@SHOP, and
7420 IGNORE in the subtree to identify projects that are not stuck. The
7421 correct customization for this is
7424 (setq org-stuck-projects
7425 '("+PROJECT/-MAYBE-DONE" ("NEXT" "TODO") ("@@SHOP")
7429 Note that if a project is identified as non-stuck, the subtree of this entry
7430 will still be searched for stuck projects.
7432 @node Presentation and sorting, Agenda commands, Built-in agenda views, Agenda Views
7433 @section Presentation and sorting
7434 @cindex presentation, of agenda items
7436 @vindex org-agenda-prefix-format
7437 Before displaying items in an agenda view, Org-mode visually prepares
7438 the items and sorts them. Each item occupies a single line. The line
7439 starts with a @emph{prefix} that contains the @emph{category}
7440 (@pxref{Categories}) of the item and other important information. You can
7441 customize the prefix using the option @code{org-agenda-prefix-format}.
7442 The prefix is followed by a cleaned-up version of the outline headline
7443 associated with the item.
7446 * Categories:: Not all tasks are equal
7447 * Time-of-day specifications:: How the agenda knows the time
7448 * Sorting of agenda items:: The order of things
7451 @node Categories, Time-of-day specifications, Presentation and sorting, Presentation and sorting
7452 @subsection Categories
7456 The category is a broad label assigned to each agenda item. By default,
7457 the category is simply derived from the file name, but you can also
7458 specify it with a special line in the buffer, like this@footnote{For
7459 backward compatibility, the following also works: if there are several
7460 such lines in a file, each specifies the category for the text below it.
7461 The first category also applies to any text before the first CATEGORY
7462 line. However, using this method is @emph{strongly} deprecated as it is
7463 incompatible with the outline structure of the document. The correct
7464 method for setting multiple categories in a buffer is using a
7472 @cindex property, CATEGORY
7473 If you would like to have a special CATEGORY for a single entry or a
7474 (sub)tree, give the entry a @code{:CATEGORY:} property with the
7475 special category you want to apply as the value.
7478 The display in the agenda buffer looks best if the category is not
7479 longer than 10 characters.
7482 You can set up icons for category by customizing the
7483 @code{org-agenda-category-icon-alist} variable.
7485 @node Time-of-day specifications, Sorting of agenda items, Categories, Presentation and sorting
7486 @subsection Time-of-day specifications
7487 @cindex time-of-day specification
7489 Org-mode checks each agenda item for a time-of-day specification. The
7490 time can be part of the timestamp that triggered inclusion into the
7491 agenda, for example as in @w{@samp{<2005-05-10 Tue 19:00>}}. Time
7492 ranges can be specified with two timestamps, like
7494 @w{@samp{<2005-05-10 Tue 20:30>--<2005-05-10 Tue 22:15>}}.
7496 In the headline of the entry itself, a time(range) may also appear as
7497 plain text (like @samp{12:45} or a @samp{8:30-1pm}). If the agenda
7498 integrates the Emacs diary (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}), time
7499 specifications in diary entries are recognized as well.
7501 For agenda display, Org-mode extracts the time and displays it in a
7502 standard 24 hour format as part of the prefix. The example times in
7503 the previous paragraphs would end up in the agenda like this:
7506 8:30-13:00 Arthur Dent lies in front of the bulldozer
7507 12:45...... Ford Prefect arrives and takes Arthur to the pub
7508 19:00...... The Vogon reads his poem
7509 20:30-22:15 Marvin escorts the Hitchhikers to the bridge
7513 If the agenda is in single-day mode, or for the display of today, the
7514 timed entries are embedded in a time grid, like
7517 8:00...... ------------------
7518 8:30-13:00 Arthur Dent lies in front of the bulldozer
7519 10:00...... ------------------
7520 12:00...... ------------------
7521 12:45...... Ford Prefect arrives and takes Arthur to the pub
7522 14:00...... ------------------
7523 16:00...... ------------------
7524 18:00...... ------------------
7525 19:00...... The Vogon reads his poem
7526 20:00...... ------------------
7527 20:30-22:15 Marvin escorts the Hitchhikers to the bridge
7530 @vindex org-agenda-use-time-grid
7531 @vindex org-agenda-time-grid
7532 The time grid can be turned on and off with the variable
7533 @code{org-agenda-use-time-grid}, and can be configured with
7534 @code{org-agenda-time-grid}.
7536 @node Sorting of agenda items, , Time-of-day specifications, Presentation and sorting
7537 @subsection Sorting of agenda items
7538 @cindex sorting, of agenda items
7539 @cindex priorities, of agenda items
7540 Before being inserted into a view, the items are sorted. How this is
7541 done depends on the type of view.
7544 @vindex org-agenda-files
7545 For the daily/weekly agenda, the items for each day are sorted. The
7546 default order is to first collect all items containing an explicit
7547 time-of-day specification. These entries will be shown at the beginning
7548 of the list, as a @emph{schedule} for the day. After that, items remain
7549 grouped in categories, in the sequence given by @code{org-agenda-files}.
7550 Within each category, items are sorted by priority (@pxref{Priorities}),
7551 which is composed of the base priority (2000 for priority @samp{A}, 1000
7552 for @samp{B}, and 0 for @samp{C}), plus additional increments for
7553 overdue scheduled or deadline items.
7555 For the TODO list, items remain in the order of categories, but within
7556 each category, sorting takes place according to priority
7557 (@pxref{Priorities}). The priority used for sorting derives from the
7558 priority cookie, with additions depending on how close an item is to its due
7561 For tags matches, items are not sorted at all, but just appear in the
7562 sequence in which they are found in the agenda files.
7565 @vindex org-agenda-sorting-strategy
7566 Sorting can be customized using the variable
7567 @code{org-agenda-sorting-strategy}, and may also include criteria based on
7568 the estimated effort of an entry (@pxref{Effort estimates}).
7570 @node Agenda commands, Custom agenda views, Presentation and sorting, Agenda Views
7571 @section Commands in the agenda buffer
7572 @cindex commands, in agenda buffer
7574 Entries in the agenda buffer are linked back to the Org file or diary
7575 file where they originate. You are not allowed to edit the agenda
7576 buffer itself, but commands are provided to show and jump to the
7577 original entry location, and to edit the Org files ``remotely'' from
7578 the agenda buffer. In this way, all information is stored only once,
7579 removing the risk that your agenda and note files may diverge.
7581 Some commands can be executed with mouse clicks on agenda lines. For
7582 the other commands, the cursor needs to be in the desired line.
7585 @tsubheading{Motion}
7586 @cindex motion commands in agenda
7587 @orgcmd{n,org-agenda-next-line}
7588 Next line (same as @key{up} and @kbd{C-p}).
7589 @orgcmd{p,org-agenda-previous-line}
7590 Previous line (same as @key{down} and @kbd{C-n}).
7591 @tsubheading{View/Go to Org file}
7592 @orgcmdkkc{@key{SPC},mouse-3,org-agenda-show-and-scroll-up}
7593 Display the original location of the item in another window.
7594 With prefix arg, make sure that the entire entry is made visible in the
7595 outline, not only the heading.
7597 @orgcmd{L,org-agenda-recenter}
7598 Display original location and recenter that window.
7600 @orgcmdkkc{@key{TAB},mouse-2,org-agenda-goto}
7601 Go to the original location of the item in another window.
7603 @orgcmd{@key{RET},org-agenda-switch-to}
7604 Go to the original location of the item and delete other windows.
7606 @orgcmd{F,org-agenda-follow-mode}
7607 @vindex org-agenda-start-with-follow-mode
7608 Toggle Follow mode. In Follow mode, as you move the cursor through
7609 the agenda buffer, the other window always shows the corresponding
7610 location in the Org file. The initial setting for this mode in new
7611 agenda buffers can be set with the variable
7612 @code{org-agenda-start-with-follow-mode}.
7614 @orgcmd{C-c C-x b,org-agenda-tree-to-indirect-buffer}
7615 Display the entire subtree of the current item in an indirect buffer. With a
7616 numeric prefix argument N, go up to level N and then take that tree. If N is
7617 negative, go up that many levels. With a @kbd{C-u} prefix, do not remove the
7618 previously used indirect buffer.
7620 @orgcmd{C-c C-o,org-agenda-open-link}
7621 Follow a link in the entry. This will offer a selection of any links in the
7622 text belonging to the referenced Org node. If there is only one link, it
7623 will be followed without a selection prompt.
7625 @tsubheading{Change display}
7626 @cindex display changing, in agenda
7629 Delete other windows.
7637 @c @item v d @ @r{or short} @ d
7638 @c @itemx v w @ @r{or short} @ w
7641 @orgcmdkskc{v d,d,org-aganda-day-view}
7642 @xorgcmdkskc{v w,w,org-aganda-day-view}
7643 @xorgcmd{v m,org-agenda-month-view}
7644 @xorgcmd{v y,org-agenda-month-year}
7645 Switch to day/week/month/year view. When switching to day or week view,
7646 this setting becomes the default for subsequent agenda commands. Since
7647 month and year views are slow to create, they do not become the default.
7648 A numeric prefix argument may be used to jump directly to a specific day
7649 of the year, ISO week, month, or year, respectively. For example,
7650 @kbd{32 d} jumps to February 1st, @kbd{9 w} to ISO week number 9. When
7651 setting day, week, or month view, a year may be encoded in the prefix
7652 argument as well. For example, @kbd{200712 w} will jump to week 12 in
7653 2007. If such a year specification has only one or two digits, it will
7654 be mapped to the interval 1938-2037.
7656 @orgcmd{f,org-agenda-later}
7657 Go forward in time to display the following @code{org-agenda-current-span} days.
7658 For example, if the display covers a week, switch to the following week.
7659 With prefix arg, go forward that many times @code{org-agenda-current-span} days.
7661 @orgcmd{b,org-agenda-earlier}
7662 Go backward in time to display earlier dates.
7664 @orgcmd{.,org-agenda-goto-today}
7667 @orgcmd{j,org-agenda-goto-date}
7668 Prompt for a date and go there.
7670 @orgcmd{J,org-agenda-clock-goto}
7671 Go to the currently clocked-in task @i{in the agenda buffer}.
7673 @orgcmd{D,org-agenda-toggle-diary}
7674 Toggle the inclusion of diary entries. See @ref{Weekly/daily agenda}.
7676 @orgcmdkskc{v l,l,org-agenda-log-mode}
7678 @vindex org-log-done
7679 @vindex org-agenda-log-mode-items
7680 Toggle Logbook mode. In Logbook mode, entries that were marked DONE while
7681 logging was on (variable @code{org-log-done}) are shown in the agenda, as are
7682 entries that have been clocked on that day. You can configure the entry
7683 types that should be included in log mode using the variable
7684 @code{org-agenda-log-mode-items}. When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix, show
7685 all possible logbook entries, including state changes. When called with two
7686 prefix args @kbd{C-u C-u}, show only logging information, nothing else.
7687 @kbd{v L} is equivalent to @kbd{C-u v l}.
7689 @orgcmdkskc{v [,[,org-agenda-manipulate-query-add}
7690 Include inactive timestamps into the current view. Only for weekly/daily
7691 agenda and timeline views.
7693 @orgcmd{v a,org-agenda-archives-mode}
7694 @xorgcmd{v A,org-agenda-archives-mode 'files}
7695 Toggle Archives mode. In Archives mode, trees that are marked
7696 @code{ARCHIVED} are also scanned when producing the agenda. When you use the
7697 capital @kbd{A}, even all archive files are included. To exit archives mode,
7698 press @kbd{v a} again.
7700 @orgcmdkskc{v R,R,org-agenda-clockreport-mode}
7701 @vindex org-agenda-start-with-clockreport-mode
7702 Toggle Clockreport mode. In Clockreport mode, the daily/weekly agenda will
7703 always show a table with the clocked times for the timespan and file scope
7704 covered by the current agenda view. The initial setting for this mode in new
7705 agenda buffers can be set with the variable
7706 @code{org-agenda-start-with-clockreport-mode}. By using a prefix argument
7707 when toggling this mode (i.e. @kbd{C-u R}), the clock table will not show
7708 contributions from entries that are hidden by agenda filtering@footnote{Only
7709 tags filtering will be respected here, effort filtering is ignored.}.
7711 @orgcmdkskc{v E,E,org-agenda-entry-text-mode}
7712 @vindex org-agenda-start-with-entry-text-mode
7713 @vindex org-agenda-entry-text-maxlines
7714 Toggle entry text mode. In entry text mode, a number of lines from the Org
7715 outline node referenced by an agenda line will be displayed below the line.
7716 The maximum number of lines is given by the variable
7717 @code{org-agenda-entry-text-maxlines}. Calling this command with a numeric
7718 prefix argument will temporarily modify that number to the prefix value.
7720 @orgcmd{G,org-agenda-toggle-time-grid}
7721 @vindex org-agenda-use-time-grid
7722 @vindex org-agenda-time-grid
7723 Toggle the time grid on and off. See also the variables
7724 @code{org-agenda-use-time-grid} and @code{org-agenda-time-grid}.
7726 @orgcmd{r,org-agenda-rodo}
7727 Recreate the agenda buffer, for example to reflect the changes after
7728 modification of the timestamps of items with @kbd{S-@key{left}} and
7729 @kbd{S-@key{right}}. When the buffer is the global TODO list, a prefix
7730 argument is interpreted to create a selective list for a specific TODO
7732 @orgcmd{g,org-agenda-rodo}
7735 @orgcmdkskc{C-x C-s,s,org-save-all-org-buffers}
7736 Save all Org buffers in the current Emacs session, and also the locations of
7739 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-c,org-agenda-columns}
7740 @vindex org-columns-default-format
7741 Invoke column view (@pxref{Column view}) in the agenda buffer. The column
7742 view format is taken from the entry at point, or (if there is no entry at
7743 point), from the first entry in the agenda view. So whatever the format for
7744 that entry would be in the original buffer (taken from a property, from a
7745 @code{#+COLUMNS} line, or from the default variable
7746 @code{org-columns-default-format}), will be used in the agenda.
7748 @orgcmd{C-c C-x >,org-agenda-remove-restriction-lock}
7749 Remove the restriction lock on the agenda, if it is currently restricted to a
7750 file or subtree (@pxref{Agenda files}).
7752 @tsubheading{Secondary filtering and query editing}
7753 @cindex filtering, by tag and effort, in agenda
7754 @cindex tag filtering, in agenda
7755 @cindex effort filtering, in agenda
7756 @cindex query editing, in agenda
7758 @orgcmd{/,org-agenda-filter-by-tag}
7759 @vindex org-agenda-filter-preset
7760 Filter the current agenda view with respect to a tag and/or effort estimates.
7761 The difference between this and a custom agenda command is that filtering is
7762 very fast, so that you can switch quickly between different filters without
7763 having to recreate the agenda.@footnote{Custom commands can preset a filter by
7764 binding the variable @code{org-agenda-filter-preset} as an option. This
7765 filter will then be applied to the view and persist as a basic filter through
7766 refreshes and more secondary filtering. The filter is a global property of
7767 the entire agenda view---in a block agenda, you should only set this in the
7768 global options section, not in the section of an individual block.}
7770 You will be prompted for a tag selection letter; @key{SPC} will mean any tag at
7771 all. Pressing @key{TAB} at that prompt will offer use completion to select a
7772 tag (including any tags that do not have a selection character). The command
7773 then hides all entries that do not contain or inherit this tag. When called
7774 with prefix arg, remove the entries that @emph{do} have the tag. A second
7775 @kbd{/} at the prompt will turn off the filter and unhide any hidden entries.
7776 If the first key you press is either @kbd{+} or @kbd{-}, the previous filter
7777 will be narrowed by requiring or forbidding the selected additional tag.
7778 Instead of pressing @kbd{+} or @kbd{-} after @kbd{/}, you can also
7779 immediately use the @kbd{\} command.
7781 @vindex org-sort-agenda-noeffort-is-high
7782 In order to filter for effort estimates, you should set up allowed
7783 efforts globally, for example
7785 (setq org-global-properties
7786 '(("Effort_ALL". "0 0:10 0:30 1:00 2:00 3:00 4:00")))
7788 You can then filter for an effort by first typing an operator, one of
7789 @kbd{<}, @kbd{>}, and @kbd{=}, and then the one-digit index of an effort
7790 estimate in your array of allowed values, where @kbd{0} means the 10th value.
7791 The filter will then restrict to entries with effort smaller-or-equal, equal,
7792 or larger-or-equal than the selected value. If the digits 0-9 are not used
7793 as fast access keys to tags, you can also simply press the index digit
7794 directly without an operator. In this case, @kbd{<} will be assumed. For
7795 application of the operator, entries without a defined effort will be treated
7796 according to the value of @code{org-sort-agenda-noeffort-is-high}. To filter
7797 for tasks without effort definition, press @kbd{?} as the operator.
7799 Org also supports automatic, context-aware tag filtering. If the variable
7800 @code{org-agenda-auto-exclude-function} is set to a user-defined function,
7801 that function can decide which tags should be excluded from the agenda
7802 automatically. Once this is set, the @kbd{/} command then accepts @kbd{RET}
7803 as a sub-option key and runs the auto exclusion logic. For example, let's
7804 say you use a @code{Net} tag to identify tasks which need network access, an
7805 @code{Errand} tag for errands in town, and a @code{Call} tag for making phone
7806 calls. You could auto-exclude these tags based on the availability of the
7807 Internet, and outside of business hours, with something like this:
7811 (defun org-my-auto-exclude-function (tag)
7813 ((string= tag "Net")
7814 (/= 0 (call-process "/sbin/ping" nil nil nil
7815 "-c1" "-q" "-t1" "mail.gnu.org")))
7816 ((or (string= tag "Errand") (string= tag "Call"))
7817 (let ((hour (nth 2 (decode-time))))
7818 (or (< hour 8) (> hour 21)))))
7821 (setq org-agenda-auto-exclude-function 'org-my-auto-exclude-function)
7825 @orgcmd{\,org-agenda-filter-by-tag-refine}
7826 Narrow the current agenda filter by an additional condition. When called with
7827 prefix arg, remove the entries that @emph{do} have the tag, or that do match
7828 the effort criterion. You can achieve the same effect by pressing @kbd{+} or
7829 @kbd{-} as the first key after the @kbd{/} command.
7838 @item @r{in} search view
7839 add new search words (@kbd{[} and @kbd{]}) or new regular expressions
7840 (@kbd{@{} and @kbd{@}}) to the query string. The opening bracket/brace will
7841 add a positive search term prefixed by @samp{+}, indicating that this search
7842 term @i{must} occur/match in the entry. The closing bracket/brace will add a
7843 negative search term which @i{must not} occur/match in the entry for it to be
7847 @tsubheading{Remote editing}
7848 @cindex remote editing, from agenda
7853 @cindex undoing remote-editing events
7854 @cindex remote editing, undo
7855 @orgcmd{C-_,org-agenda-undo}
7856 Undo a change due to a remote editing command. The change is undone
7857 both in the agenda buffer and in the remote buffer.
7859 @orgcmd{t,org-agenda-todo}
7860 Change the TODO state of the item, both in the agenda and in the
7863 @orgcmd{C-S-@key{right},org-agenda-todo-nextset}
7864 @orgcmd{C-S-@key{left},org-agenda-todo-previousset}
7865 Switch to the next/previous set of TODO keywords.
7867 @orgcmd{C-k,org-agenda-kill}
7868 @vindex org-agenda-confirm-kill
7869 Delete the current agenda item along with the entire subtree belonging
7870 to it in the original Org file. If the text to be deleted remotely
7871 is longer than one line, the kill needs to be confirmed by the user. See
7872 variable @code{org-agenda-confirm-kill}.
7874 @orgcmd{C-c C-w,org-agenda-refile}
7875 Refile the entry at point.
7877 @orgcmdkskc{C-c C-x C-a,a,org-agenda-archive-default-with-confirmation}
7878 @vindex org-archive-default-command
7879 Archive the subtree corresponding to the entry at point using the default
7880 archiving command set in @code{org-archive-default-command}. When using the
7881 @code{a} key, confirmation will be required.
7883 @orgcmd{C-c C-x a,org-agenda-toggle-archive-tag}
7884 Toggle the ARCHIVE tag for the current headline.
7886 @orgcmd{C-c C-x A,org-agenda-archive-to-archive-sibling}
7887 Move the subtree corresponding to the current entry to its @emph{archive
7890 @orgcmdkskc{C-c C-x C-s,$,org-agenda-archive}
7891 Archive the subtree corresponding to the current headline. This means the
7892 entry will be moved to the configured archive location, most likely a
7895 @orgcmd{T,org-agenda-show-tags}
7896 @vindex org-agenda-show-inherited-tags
7897 Show all tags associated with the current item. This is useful if you have
7898 turned off @code{org-agenda-show-inherited-tags}, but still want to see all
7899 tags of a headline occasionally.
7901 @orgcmd{:,org-agenda-set-tags}
7902 Set tags for the current headline. If there is an active region in the
7903 agenda, change a tag for all headings in the region.
7907 Set the priority for the current item (@command{org-agenda-priority}).
7908 Org-mode prompts for the priority character. If you reply with @key{SPC}, the
7909 priority cookie is removed from the entry.
7911 @orgcmd{P,org-agenda-show-priority}
7912 Display weighted priority of current item.
7914 @orgcmdkkc{+,S-@key{up},org-agenda-priority-up}
7915 Increase the priority of the current item. The priority is changed in
7916 the original buffer, but the agenda is not resorted. Use the @kbd{r}
7919 @orgcmdkkc{-,S-@key{down},org-agenda-priority-down}
7920 Decrease the priority of the current item.
7922 @orgcmdkkc{z,C-c C-z,org-agenda-add-note}
7923 @vindex org-log-into-drawer
7924 Add a note to the entry. This note will be recorded, and then filed to the
7925 same location where state change notes are put. Depending on
7926 @code{org-log-into-drawer}, this may be inside a drawer.
7928 @orgcmd{C-c C-a,org-attach}
7929 Dispatcher for all command related to attachments.
7931 @orgcmd{C-c C-s,org-agenda-schedule}
7932 Schedule this item. With prefix arg remove the scheduling timestamp
7934 @orgcmd{C-c C-d,org-agenda-deadline}
7935 Set a deadline for this item. With prefix arg remove the deadline.
7937 @orgcmd{k,org-agenda-action}
7938 Agenda actions, to set dates for selected items to the cursor date.
7939 This command also works in the calendar! The command prompts for an
7942 m @r{Mark the entry at point for action. You can also make entries}
7943 @r{in Org files with @kbd{C-c C-x C-k}.}
7944 d @r{Set the deadline of the marked entry to the date at point.}
7945 s @r{Schedule the marked entry at the date at point.}
7946 r @r{Call @code{org-capture} with the cursor date as default date.}
7949 Press @kbd{r} afterward to refresh the agenda and see the effect of the
7952 @orgcmd{S-@key{right},org-agenda-do-date-later}
7953 Change the timestamp associated with the current line by one day into the
7954 future. With a numeric prefix argument, change it by that many days. For
7955 example, @kbd{3 6 5 S-@key{right}} will change it by a year. With a
7956 @kbd{C-u} prefix, change the time by one hour. If you immediately repeat the
7957 command, it will continue to change hours even without the prefix arg. With
7958 a double @kbd{C-u C-u} prefix, do the same for changing minutes. The stamp
7959 is changed in the original Org file, but the change is not directly reflected
7960 in the agenda buffer. Use @kbd{r} or @kbd{g} to update the buffer.
7962 @orgcmd{S-@key{left},org-agenda-do-date-earlier}
7963 Change the timestamp associated with the current line by one day
7966 @orgcmd{>,org-agenda-date-prompt}
7967 Change the timestamp associated with the current line. The key @kbd{>} has
7968 been chosen, because it is the same as @kbd{S-.} on my keyboard.
7970 @orgcmd{I,org-agenda-clock-in}
7971 Start the clock on the current item. If a clock is running already, it
7974 @orgcmd{O,org-agenda-clock-out}
7975 Stop the previously started clock.
7977 @orgcmd{X,org-agenda-clock-cancel}
7978 Cancel the currently running clock.
7980 @orgcmd{J,org-agenda-clock-goto}
7981 Jump to the running clock in another window.
7983 @tsubheading{Bulk remote editing selected entries}
7984 @cindex remote editing, bulk, from agenda
7986 @orgcmd{m,org-agenda-bulk-mark}
7987 Mark the entry at point for bulk action. With prefix arg, mark that many
7990 @orgcmd{u,org-agenda-bulk-unmark}
7991 Unmark entry for bulk action.
7993 @orgcmd{U,org-agenda-bulk-remove-all-marks}
7994 Unmark all marked entries for bulk action.
7996 @orgcmd{B,org-agenda-bulk-action}
7997 Bulk action: act on all marked entries in the agenda. This will prompt for
7998 another key to select the action to be applied. The prefix arg to @kbd{B}
7999 will be passed through to the @kbd{s} and @kbd{d} commands, to bulk-remove
8000 these special timestamps.
8002 r @r{Prompt for a single refile target and move all entries. The entries}
8003 @r{will no longer be in the agenda; refresh (@kbd{g}) to bring them back.}
8004 $ @r{Archive all selected entries.}
8005 A @r{Archive entries by moving them to their respective archive siblings.}
8006 t @r{Change TODO state. This prompts for a single TODO keyword and}
8007 @r{changes the state of all selected entries, bypassing blocking and}
8008 @r{suppressing logging notes (but not time stamps).}
8009 + @r{Add a tag to all selected entries.}
8010 - @r{Remove a tag from all selected entries.}
8011 s @r{Schedule all items to a new date. To shift existing schedule dates}
8012 @r{by a fixed number of days, use something starting with double plus}
8013 @r{at the prompt, for example @samp{++8d} or @samp{++2w}.}
8014 S @r{Reschedule randomly by N days. N will be prompted for. With prefix}
8015 @r{arg (@kbd{C-u B S}), scatter only accross weekdays.}
8016 d @r{Set deadline to a specific date.}
8020 @tsubheading{Calendar commands}
8021 @cindex calendar commands, from agenda
8023 @orgcmd{c,org-agenda-goto-calendar}
8024 Open the Emacs calendar and move to the date at the agenda cursor.
8026 @orgcmd{c,org-calendar-goto-agenda}
8027 When in the calendar, compute and show the Org-mode agenda for the
8030 @cindex diary entries, creating from agenda
8031 @orgcmd{i,org-agenda-diary-entry}
8032 @vindex org-agenda-diary-file
8033 Insert a new entry into the diary, using the date at the cursor and (for
8034 block entries) the date at the mark. This will add to the Emacs diary
8035 file@footnote{This file is parsed for the agenda when
8036 @code{org-agenda-include-diary} is set.}, in a way similar to the @kbd{i}
8037 command in the calendar. The diary file will pop up in another window, where
8038 you can add the entry.
8040 If you configure @code{org-agenda-diary-file} to point to an Org-mode file,
8041 Org will create entries (in org-mode syntax) in that file instead. Most
8042 entries will be stored in a date-based outline tree that will later make it
8043 easy to archive appointments from previous months/years. The tree will be
8044 built under an entry with a @code{DATE_TREE} property, or else with years as
8045 top-level entries. Emacs will prompt you for the entry text---if you specify
8046 it, the entry will be created in @code{org-agenda-diary-file} without further
8047 interaction. If you directly press @key{RET} at the prompt without typing
8048 text, the target file will be shown in another window for you to finish the
8049 entry there. See also the @kbd{k r} command.
8051 @orgcmd{M,org-agenda-phases-of-moon}
8052 Show the phases of the moon for the three months around current date.
8054 @orgcmd{S,org-agenda-sunrise-sunset}
8055 Show sunrise and sunset times. The geographical location must be set
8056 with calendar variables, see the documentation for the Emacs calendar.
8058 @orgcmd{C,org-agenda-convert-date}
8059 Convert the date at cursor into many other cultural and historic
8062 @orgcmd{H,org-agenda-holidays}
8063 Show holidays for three months around the cursor date.
8065 @item M-x org-export-icalendar-combine-agenda-files
8066 Export a single iCalendar file containing entries from all agenda files.
8067 This is a globally available command, and also available in the agenda menu.
8069 @tsubheading{Exporting to a file}
8070 @orgcmd{C-x C-w,org-write-agenda}
8071 @cindex exporting agenda views
8072 @cindex agenda views, exporting
8073 @vindex org-agenda-exporter-settings
8074 Write the agenda view to a file. Depending on the extension of the selected
8075 file name, the view will be exported as HTML (extension @file{.html} or
8076 @file{.htm}), Postscript (extension @file{.ps}), PDF (extension @file{.pdf}),
8077 and plain text (any other extension). When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix
8078 argument, immediately open the newly created file. Use the variable
8079 @code{org-agenda-exporter-settings} to set options for @file{ps-print} and
8080 for @file{htmlize} to be used during export.
8082 @tsubheading{Quit and Exit}
8083 @orgcmd{q,org-agenda-quit}
8084 Quit agenda, remove the agenda buffer.
8086 @cindex agenda files, removing buffers
8087 @orgcmd{x,org-agenda-exit}
8088 Exit agenda, remove the agenda buffer and all buffers loaded by Emacs
8089 for the compilation of the agenda. Buffers created by the user to
8090 visit Org files will not be removed.
8094 @node Custom agenda views, Exporting Agenda Views, Agenda commands, Agenda Views
8095 @section Custom agenda views
8096 @cindex custom agenda views
8097 @cindex agenda views, custom
8099 Custom agenda commands serve two purposes: to store and quickly access
8100 frequently used TODO and tags searches, and to create special composite
8101 agenda buffers. Custom agenda commands will be accessible through the
8102 dispatcher (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}), just like the default commands.
8105 * Storing searches:: Type once, use often
8106 * Block agenda:: All the stuff you need in a single buffer
8107 * Setting Options:: Changing the rules
8110 @node Storing searches, Block agenda, Custom agenda views, Custom agenda views
8111 @subsection Storing searches
8113 The first application of custom searches is the definition of keyboard
8114 shortcuts for frequently used searches, either creating an agenda
8115 buffer, or a sparse tree (the latter covering of course only the current
8118 @vindex org-agenda-custom-commands
8119 Custom commands are configured in the variable
8120 @code{org-agenda-custom-commands}. You can customize this variable, for
8121 example by pressing @kbd{C-c a C}. You can also directly set it with
8122 Emacs Lisp in @file{.emacs}. The following example contains all valid
8127 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
8128 '(("w" todo "WAITING")
8129 ("W" todo-tree "WAITING")
8130 ("u" tags "+boss-urgent")
8131 ("v" tags-todo "+boss-urgent")
8132 ("U" tags-tree "+boss-urgent")
8133 ("f" occur-tree "\\<FIXME\\>")
8134 ("h" . "HOME+Name tags searches") ; description for "h" prefix
8135 ("hl" tags "+home+Lisa")
8136 ("hp" tags "+home+Peter")
8137 ("hk" tags "+home+Kim")))
8142 The initial string in each entry defines the keys you have to press
8143 after the dispatcher command @kbd{C-c a} in order to access the command.
8144 Usually this will be just a single character, but if you have many
8145 similar commands, you can also define two-letter combinations where the
8146 first character is the same in several combinations and serves as a
8147 prefix key@footnote{You can provide a description for a prefix key by
8148 inserting a cons cell with the prefix and the description.}. The second
8149 parameter is the search type, followed by the string or regular
8150 expression to be used for the matching. The example above will
8155 as a global search for TODO entries with @samp{WAITING} as the TODO
8158 as the same search, but only in the current buffer and displaying the
8159 results as a sparse tree
8161 as a global tags search for headlines marked @samp{:boss:} but not
8164 as the same search as @kbd{C-c a u}, but limiting the search to
8165 headlines that are also TODO items
8167 as the same search as @kbd{C-c a u}, but only in the current buffer and
8168 displaying the result as a sparse tree
8170 to create a sparse tree (again: current buffer only) with all entries
8171 containing the word @samp{FIXME}
8173 as a prefix command for a HOME tags search where you have to press an
8174 additional key (@kbd{l}, @kbd{p} or @kbd{k}) to select a name (Lisa,
8175 Peter, or Kim) as additional tag to match.
8178 @node Block agenda, Setting Options, Storing searches, Custom agenda views
8179 @subsection Block agenda
8180 @cindex block agenda
8181 @cindex agenda, with block views
8183 Another possibility is the construction of agenda views that comprise
8184 the results of @emph{several} commands, each of which creates a block in
8185 the agenda buffer. The available commands include @code{agenda} for the
8186 daily or weekly agenda (as created with @kbd{C-c a a}), @code{alltodo}
8187 for the global TODO list (as constructed with @kbd{C-c a t}), and the
8188 matching commands discussed above: @code{todo}, @code{tags}, and
8189 @code{tags-todo}. Here are two examples:
8193 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
8194 '(("h" "Agenda and Home-related tasks"
8198 ("o" "Agenda and Office-related tasks"
8206 This will define @kbd{C-c a h} to create a multi-block view for stuff
8207 you need to attend to at home. The resulting agenda buffer will contain
8208 your agenda for the current week, all TODO items that carry the tag
8209 @samp{home}, and also all lines tagged with @samp{garden}. Finally the
8210 command @kbd{C-c a o} provides a similar view for office tasks.
8212 @node Setting Options, , Block agenda, Custom agenda views
8213 @subsection Setting options for custom commands
8214 @cindex options, for custom agenda views
8216 @vindex org-agenda-custom-commands
8217 Org-mode contains a number of variables regulating agenda construction
8218 and display. The global variables define the behavior for all agenda
8219 commands, including the custom commands. However, if you want to change
8220 some settings just for a single custom view, you can do so. Setting
8221 options requires inserting a list of variable names and values at the
8222 right spot in @code{org-agenda-custom-commands}. For example:
8226 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
8227 '(("w" todo "WAITING"
8228 ((org-agenda-sorting-strategy '(priority-down))
8229 (org-agenda-prefix-format " Mixed: ")))
8230 ("U" tags-tree "+boss-urgent"
8231 ((org-show-following-heading nil)
8232 (org-show-hierarchy-above nil)))
8234 ((org-agenda-files '("~org/notes.org"))
8235 (org-agenda-text-search-extra-files nil)))))
8240 Now the @kbd{C-c a w} command will sort the collected entries only by
8241 priority, and the prefix format is modified to just say @samp{ Mixed: }
8242 instead of giving the category of the entry. The sparse tags tree of
8243 @kbd{C-c a U} will now turn out ultra-compact, because neither the
8244 headline hierarchy above the match, nor the headline following the match
8245 will be shown. The command @kbd{C-c a N} will do a text search limited
8246 to only a single file.
8248 @vindex org-agenda-custom-commands
8249 For command sets creating a block agenda,
8250 @code{org-agenda-custom-commands} has two separate spots for setting
8251 options. You can add options that should be valid for just a single
8252 command in the set, and options that should be valid for all commands in
8253 the set. The former are just added to the command entry; the latter
8254 must come after the list of command entries. Going back to the block
8255 agenda example (@pxref{Block agenda}), let's change the sorting strategy
8256 for the @kbd{C-c a h} commands to @code{priority-down}, but let's sort
8257 the results for GARDEN tags query in the opposite order,
8258 @code{priority-up}. This would look like this:
8262 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
8263 '(("h" "Agenda and Home-related tasks"
8267 ((org-agenda-sorting-strategy '(priority-up)))))
8268 ((org-agenda-sorting-strategy '(priority-down))))
8269 ("o" "Agenda and Office-related tasks"
8276 As you see, the values and parentheses setting is a little complex.
8277 When in doubt, use the customize interface to set this variable---it
8278 fully supports its structure. Just one caveat: when setting options in
8279 this interface, the @emph{values} are just Lisp expressions. So if the
8280 value is a string, you need to add the double-quotes around the value
8284 @node Exporting Agenda Views, Agenda column view, Custom agenda views, Agenda Views
8285 @section Exporting Agenda Views
8286 @cindex agenda views, exporting
8288 If you are away from your computer, it can be very useful to have a printed
8289 version of some agenda views to carry around. Org-mode can export custom
8290 agenda views as plain text, HTML@footnote{You need to install Hrvoje Niksic's
8291 @file{htmlize.el}.}, Postscript, PDF@footnote{To create PDF output, the
8292 ghostscript @file{ps2pdf} utility must be installed on the system. Selecting
8293 a PDF file with also create the postscript file.}, and iCalendar files. If
8294 you want to do this only occasionally, use the command
8297 @orgcmd{C-x C-w,org-write-agenda}
8298 @cindex exporting agenda views
8299 @cindex agenda views, exporting
8300 @vindex org-agenda-exporter-settings
8301 Write the agenda view to a file. Depending on the extension of the selected
8302 file name, the view will be exported as HTML (extension @file{.html} or
8303 @file{.htm}), Postscript (extension @file{.ps}), iCalendar (extension
8304 @file{.ics}), or plain text (any other extension). Use the variable
8305 @code{org-agenda-exporter-settings} to set options for @file{ps-print} and
8306 for @file{htmlize} to be used during export, for example
8308 @vindex org-agenda-add-entry-text-maxlines
8309 @vindex htmlize-output-type
8310 @vindex ps-number-of-columns
8311 @vindex ps-landscape-mode
8313 (setq org-agenda-exporter-settings
8314 '((ps-number-of-columns 2)
8315 (ps-landscape-mode t)
8316 (org-agenda-add-entry-text-maxlines 5)
8317 (htmlize-output-type 'css)))
8321 If you need to export certain agenda views frequently, you can associate
8322 any custom agenda command with a list of output file names
8323 @footnote{If you want to store standard views like the weekly agenda
8324 or the global TODO list as well, you need to define custom commands for
8325 them in order to be able to specify file names.}. Here is an example
8326 that first defines custom commands for the agenda and the global
8327 TODO list, together with a number of files to which to export them.
8328 Then we define two block agenda commands and specify file names for them
8329 as well. File names can be relative to the current working directory,
8334 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
8335 '(("X" agenda "" nil ("agenda.html" "agenda.ps"))
8336 ("Y" alltodo "" nil ("todo.html" "todo.txt" "todo.ps"))
8337 ("h" "Agenda and Home-related tasks"
8342 ("~/views/home.html"))
8343 ("o" "Agenda and Office-related tasks"
8348 ("~/views/office.ps" "~/calendars/office.ics"))))
8352 The extension of the file name determines the type of export. If it is
8353 @file{.html}, Org-mode will use the @file{htmlize.el} package to convert
8354 the buffer to HTML and save it to this file name. If the extension is
8355 @file{.ps}, @code{ps-print-buffer-with-faces} is used to produce
8356 Postscript output. If the extension is @file{.ics}, iCalendar export is
8357 run export over all files that were used to construct the agenda, and
8358 limit the export to entries listed in the agenda. Any other
8359 extension produces a plain ASCII file.
8361 The export files are @emph{not} created when you use one of those
8362 commands interactively because this might use too much overhead.
8363 Instead, there is a special command to produce @emph{all} specified
8367 @orgcmd{C-c a e,org-store-agenda-views}
8368 Export all agenda views that have export file names associated with
8372 You can use the options section of the custom agenda commands to also
8373 set options for the export commands. For example:
8376 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
8378 ((ps-number-of-columns 2)
8379 (ps-landscape-mode t)
8380 (org-agenda-prefix-format " [ ] ")
8381 (org-agenda-with-colors nil)
8382 (org-agenda-remove-tags t))
8387 This command sets two options for the Postscript exporter, to make it
8388 print in two columns in landscape format---the resulting page can be cut
8389 in two and then used in a paper agenda. The remaining settings modify
8390 the agenda prefix to omit category and scheduling information, and
8391 instead include a checkbox to check off items. We also remove the tags
8392 to make the lines compact, and we don't want to use colors for the
8393 black-and-white printer. Settings specified in
8394 @code{org-agenda-exporter-settings} will also apply, but the settings
8395 in @code{org-agenda-custom-commands} take precedence.
8398 From the command line you may also use
8400 emacs -f org-batch-store-agenda-views -kill
8403 or, if you need to modify some parameters@footnote{Quoting depends on the
8404 system you use, please check the FAQ for examples.}
8406 emacs -eval '(org-batch-store-agenda-views \
8407 org-agenda-span month \
8408 org-agenda-start-day "2007-11-01" \
8409 org-agenda-include-diary nil \
8410 org-agenda-files (quote ("~/org/project.org")))' \
8414 which will create the agenda views restricted to the file
8415 @file{~/org/project.org}, without diary entries and with a 30-day
8418 You can also extract agenda information in a way that allows further
8419 processing by other programs. See @ref{Extracting agenda information}, for
8423 @node Agenda column view, , Exporting Agenda Views, Agenda Views
8424 @section Using column view in the agenda
8425 @cindex column view, in agenda
8426 @cindex agenda, column view
8428 Column view (@pxref{Column view}) is normally used to view and edit
8429 properties embedded in the hierarchical structure of an Org file. It can be
8430 quite useful to use column view also from the agenda, where entries are
8431 collected by certain criteria.
8434 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-c,org-agenda-columns}
8435 Turn on column view in the agenda.
8438 To understand how to use this properly, it is important to realize that the
8439 entries in the agenda are no longer in their proper outline environment.
8440 This causes the following issues:
8444 @vindex org-columns-default-format
8445 @vindex org-overriding-columns-format
8446 Org needs to make a decision which @code{COLUMNS} format to use. Since the
8447 entries in the agenda are collected from different files, and different files
8448 may have different @code{COLUMNS} formats, this is a non-trivial problem.
8449 Org first checks if the variable @code{org-overriding-columns-format} is
8450 currently set, and if so, takes the format from there. Otherwise it takes
8451 the format associated with the first item in the agenda, or, if that item
8452 does not have a specific format (defined in a property, or in its file), it
8453 uses @code{org-columns-default-format}.
8455 @cindex property, special, CLOCKSUM
8456 If any of the columns has a summary type defined (@pxref{Column attributes}),
8457 turning on column view in the agenda will visit all relevant agenda files and
8458 make sure that the computations of this property are up to date. This is
8459 also true for the special @code{CLOCKSUM} property. Org will then sum the
8460 values displayed in the agenda. In the daily/weekly agenda, the sums will
8461 cover a single day; in all other views they cover the entire block. It is
8462 vital to realize that the agenda may show the same entry @emph{twice} (for
8463 example as scheduled and as a deadline), and it may show two entries from the
8464 same hierarchy (for example a @emph{parent} and its @emph{child}). In these
8465 cases, the summation in the agenda will lead to incorrect results because
8466 some values will count double.
8468 When the column view in the agenda shows the @code{CLOCKSUM}, that is always
8469 the entire clocked time for this item. So even in the daily/weekly agenda,
8470 the clocksum listed in column view may originate from times outside the
8471 current view. This has the advantage that you can compare these values with
8472 a column listing the planned total effort for a task---one of the major
8473 applications for column view in the agenda. If you want information about
8474 clocked time in the displayed period use clock table mode (press @kbd{R} in
8479 @node Markup, Exporting, Agenda Views, Top
8480 @chapter Markup for rich export
8482 When exporting Org-mode documents, the exporter tries to reflect the
8483 structure of the document as accurately as possible in the backend. Since
8484 export targets like HTML, @LaTeX{}, or DocBook allow much richer formatting,
8485 Org-mode has rules on how to prepare text for rich export. This section
8486 summarizes the markup rules used in an Org-mode buffer.
8489 * Structural markup elements:: The basic structure as seen by the exporter
8490 * Images and tables:: Tables and Images will be included
8491 * Literal examples:: Source code examples with special formatting
8492 * Include files:: Include additional files into a document
8493 * Index entries:: Making an index
8494 * Macro replacement:: Use macros to create complex output
8495 * Embedded LaTeX:: LaTeX can be freely used inside Org documents
8498 @node Structural markup elements, Images and tables, Markup, Markup
8499 @section Structural markup elements
8502 * Document title:: Where the title is taken from
8503 * Headings and sections:: The document structure as seen by the exporter
8504 * Table of contents:: The if and where of the table of contents
8505 * Initial text:: Text before the first heading?
8507 * Paragraphs:: Paragraphs
8508 * Footnote markup:: Footnotes
8509 * Emphasis and monospace:: Bold, italic, etc.
8510 * Horizontal rules:: Make a line
8511 * Comment lines:: What will *not* be exported
8514 @node Document title, Headings and sections, Structural markup elements, Structural markup elements
8515 @subheading Document title
8516 @cindex document title, markup rules
8519 The title of the exported document is taken from the special line
8523 #+TITLE: This is the title of the document
8527 If this line does not exist, the title is derived from the first non-empty,
8528 non-comment line in the buffer. If no such line exists, or if you have
8529 turned off exporting of the text before the first headline (see below), the
8530 title will be the file name without extension.
8532 @cindex property, EXPORT_TITLE
8533 If you are exporting only a subtree by marking is as the region, the heading
8534 of the subtree will become the title of the document. If the subtree has a
8535 property @code{EXPORT_TITLE}, that will take precedence.
8537 @node Headings and sections, Table of contents, Document title, Structural markup elements
8538 @subheading Headings and sections
8539 @cindex headings and sections, markup rules
8541 @vindex org-export-headline-levels
8542 The outline structure of the document as described in @ref{Document
8543 Structure}, forms the basis for defining sections of the exported document.
8544 However, since the outline structure is also used for (for example) lists of
8545 tasks, only the first three outline levels will be used as headings. Deeper
8546 levels will become itemized lists. You can change the location of this
8547 switch globally by setting the variable @code{org-export-headline-levels}, or on a
8548 per-file basis with a line
8555 @node Table of contents, Initial text, Headings and sections, Structural markup elements
8556 @subheading Table of contents
8557 @cindex table of contents, markup rules
8559 @vindex org-export-with-toc
8560 The table of contents is normally inserted directly before the first headline
8561 of the file. If you would like to get it to a different location, insert the
8562 string @code{[TABLE-OF-CONTENTS]} on a line by itself at the desired
8563 location. The depth of the table of contents is by default the same as the
8564 number of headline levels, but you can choose a smaller number, or turn off
8565 the table of contents entirely, by configuring the variable
8566 @code{org-export-with-toc}, or on a per-file basis with a line like
8569 #+OPTIONS: toc:2 (only to two levels in TOC)
8570 #+OPTIONS: toc:nil (no TOC at all)
8573 @node Initial text, Lists, Table of contents, Structural markup elements
8574 @subheading Text before the first headline
8575 @cindex text before first headline, markup rules
8578 Org-mode normally exports the text before the first headline, and even uses
8579 the first line as the document title. The text will be fully marked up. If
8580 you need to include literal HTML, @LaTeX{}, or DocBook code, use the special
8581 constructs described below in the sections for the individual exporters.
8583 @vindex org-export-skip-text-before-1st-heading
8584 Some people like to use the space before the first headline for setup and
8585 internal links and therefore would like to control the exported text before
8586 the first headline in a different way. You can do so by setting the variable
8587 @code{org-export-skip-text-before-1st-heading} to @code{t}. On a per-file
8588 basis, you can get the same effect with @samp{#+OPTIONS: skip:t}.
8591 If you still want to have some text before the first headline, use the
8592 @code{#+TEXT} construct:
8596 #+TEXT: This text will go before the *first* headline.
8597 #+TEXT: [TABLE-OF-CONTENTS]
8598 #+TEXT: This goes between the table of contents and the first headline
8601 @node Lists, Paragraphs, Initial text, Structural markup elements
8603 @cindex lists, markup rules
8605 Plain lists as described in @ref{Plain lists}, are translated to the backend's
8606 syntax for such lists. Most backends support unordered, ordered, and
8609 @node Paragraphs, Footnote markup, Lists, Structural markup elements
8610 @subheading Paragraphs, line breaks, and quoting
8611 @cindex paragraphs, markup rules
8613 Paragraphs are separated by at least one empty line. If you need to enforce
8614 a line break within a paragraph, use @samp{\\} at the end of a line.
8616 To keep the line breaks in a region, but otherwise use normal formatting, you
8617 can use this construct, which can also be used to format poetry.
8619 @cindex #+BEGIN_VERSE
8622 Great clouds overhead
8623 Tiny black birds rise and fall
8630 When quoting a passage from another document, it is customary to format this
8631 as a paragraph that is indented on both the left and the right margin. You
8632 can include quotations in Org-mode documents like this:
8634 @cindex #+BEGIN_QUOTE
8637 Everything should be made as simple as possible,
8638 but not any simpler -- Albert Einstein
8642 If you would like to center some text, do it like this:
8643 @cindex #+BEGIN_CENTER
8646 Everything should be made as simple as possible, \\
8652 @node Footnote markup, Emphasis and monospace, Paragraphs, Structural markup elements
8653 @subheading Footnote markup
8654 @cindex footnotes, markup rules
8655 @cindex @file{footnote.el}
8657 Footnotes defined in the way described in @ref{Footnotes}, will be exported by
8658 all backends. Org allows multiple references to the same note, and
8659 different backends support this to varying degrees.
8661 @node Emphasis and monospace, Horizontal rules, Footnote markup, Structural markup elements
8662 @subheading Emphasis and monospace
8664 @cindex underlined text, markup rules
8665 @cindex bold text, markup rules
8666 @cindex italic text, markup rules
8667 @cindex verbatim text, markup rules
8668 @cindex code text, markup rules
8669 @cindex strike-through text, markup rules
8670 You can make words @b{*bold*}, @i{/italic/}, _underlined_, @code{=code=}
8671 and @code{~verbatim~}, and, if you must, @samp{+strike-through+}. Text
8672 in the code and verbatim string is not processed for Org-mode specific
8673 syntax; it is exported verbatim.
8675 @node Horizontal rules, Comment lines, Emphasis and monospace, Structural markup elements
8676 @subheading Horizontal rules
8677 @cindex horizontal rules, markup rules
8678 A line consisting of only dashes, and at least 5 of them, will be
8679 exported as a horizontal line (@samp{<hr/>} in HTML).
8681 @node Comment lines, , Horizontal rules, Structural markup elements
8682 @subheading Comment lines
8683 @cindex comment lines
8684 @cindex exporting, not
8685 @cindex #+BEGIN_COMMENT
8687 Lines starting with @samp{#} in column zero are treated as comments and will
8688 never be exported. If you want an indented line to be treated as a comment,
8689 start it with @samp{#+ }. Also entire subtrees starting with the word
8690 @samp{COMMENT} will never be exported. Finally, regions surrounded by
8691 @samp{#+BEGIN_COMMENT} ... @samp{#+END_COMMENT} will not be exported.
8696 Toggle the COMMENT keyword at the beginning of an entry.
8700 @node Images and tables, Literal examples, Structural markup elements, Markup
8701 @section Images and Tables
8703 @cindex tables, markup rules
8706 Both the native Org-mode tables (@pxref{Tables}) and tables formatted with
8707 the @file{table.el} package will be exported properly. For Org-mode tables,
8708 the lines before the first horizontal separator line will become table header
8709 lines. You can use the following lines somewhere before the table to assign
8710 a caption and a label for cross references, and in the text you can refer to
8711 the object with @code{\ref@{tab:basic-data@}}:
8714 #+CAPTION: This is the caption for the next table (or link)
8715 #+LABEL: tbl:basic-data
8720 @cindex inlined images, markup rules
8721 Some backends (HTML, @LaTeX{}, and DocBook) allow you to directly include
8722 images into the exported document. Org does this, if a link to an image
8723 files does not have a description part, for example @code{[[./img/a.jpg]]}.
8724 If you wish to define a caption for the image and maybe a label for internal
8725 cross references, make sure that the link is on a line by itself and precede
8726 it with @code{#+CAPTION} and @code{#+LABEL} as follows:
8729 #+CAPTION: This is the caption for the next figure link (or table)
8730 #+LABEL: fig:SED-HR4049
8734 You may also define additional attributes for the figure. As this is
8735 backend-specific, see the sections about the individual backends for more
8738 @xref{Handling links,the discussion of image links}.
8740 @node Literal examples, Include files, Images and tables, Markup
8741 @section Literal examples
8742 @cindex literal examples, markup rules
8743 @cindex code line references, markup rules
8745 You can include literal examples that should not be subjected to
8746 markup. Such examples will be typeset in monospace, so this is well suited
8747 for source code and similar examples.
8748 @cindex #+BEGIN_EXAMPLE
8752 Some example from a text file.
8756 Note that such blocks may be @i{indented} in order to align nicely with
8757 indented text and in particular with plain list structure (@pxref{Plain
8758 lists}). For simplicity when using small examples, you can also start the
8759 example lines with a colon followed by a space. There may also be additional
8760 whitespace before the colon:
8764 : Some example from a text file.
8767 @cindex formatting source code, markup rules
8768 If the example is source code from a programming language, or any other text
8769 that can be marked up by font-lock in Emacs, you can ask for the example to
8770 look like the fontified Emacs buffer@footnote{This works automatically for
8771 the HTML backend (it requires version 1.34 of the @file{htmlize.el} package,
8772 which is distributed with Org). Fontified code chunks in LaTeX can be
8773 achieved using either the listings or the
8774 @url{http://code.google.com/p/minted, minted,} package. To use listings, turn
8775 on the variable @code{org-export-latex-listings} and ensure that the listings
8776 package is included by the LaTeX header (e.g. by configuring
8777 @code{org-export-latex-packages-alist}). See the listings documentation for
8778 configuration options, including obtaining colored output. For minted it is
8779 necessary to install the program @url{http://pygments.org, pygments}, in
8780 addition to setting @code{org-export-latex-minted}, ensuring that the minted
8781 package is included by the LaTeX header, and ensuring that the
8782 @code{-shell-escape} option is passed to @file{pdflatex} (see
8783 @code{org-latex-to-pdf-process}). See the documentation of the variables
8784 @code{org-export-latex-listings} and @code{org-export-latex-minted} for
8785 further details.}. This is done with the @samp{src} block, where you also
8786 need to specify the name of the major mode that should be used to fontify the
8791 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp
8792 (defun org-xor (a b)
8798 Both in @code{example} and in @code{src} snippets, you can add a @code{-n}
8799 switch to the end of the @code{BEGIN} line, to get the lines of the example
8800 numbered. If you use a @code{+n} switch, the numbering from the previous
8801 numbered snippet will be continued in the current one. In literal examples,
8802 Org will interpret strings like @samp{(ref:name)} as labels, and use them as
8803 targets for special hyperlinks like @code{[[(name)]]} (i.e. the reference name
8804 enclosed in single parenthesis). In HTML, hovering the mouse over such a
8805 link will remote-highlight the corresponding code line, which is kind of
8808 You can also add a @code{-r} switch which @i{removes} the labels from the
8809 source code@footnote{Adding @code{-k} to @code{-n -r} will @i{keep} the
8810 labels in the source code while using line numbers for the links, which might
8811 be useful to explain those in an org-mode example code.}. With the @code{-n}
8812 switch, links to these references will be labeled by the line numbers from
8813 the code listing, otherwise links will use the labels with no parentheses.
8817 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp -n -r
8818 (save-excursion (ref:sc)
8819 (goto-char (point-min)) (ref:jump)
8821 In line [[(sc)]] we remember the current position. [[(jump)][Line (jump)]]
8825 @vindex org-coderef-label-format
8826 If the syntax for the label format conflicts with the language syntax, use a
8827 @code{-l} switch to change the format, for example @samp{#+BEGIN_SRC pascal
8828 -n -r -l "((%s))"}. See also the variable @code{org-coderef-label-format}.
8830 HTML export also allows examples to be published as text areas, @xref{Text
8831 areas in HTML export}.
8836 Edit the source code example at point in its native mode. This works by
8837 switching to a temporary buffer with the source code. You need to exit by
8838 pressing @kbd{C-c '} again@footnote{Upon exit, lines starting with @samp{*}
8839 or @samp{#} will get a comma prepended, to keep them from being interpreted
8840 by Org as outline nodes or special comments. These commas will be stripped
8841 for editing with @kbd{C-c '}, and also for export.}. The edited version will
8842 then replace the old version in the Org buffer. Fixed-width regions
8843 (where each line starts with a colon followed by a space) will be edited
8844 using @code{artist-mode}@footnote{You may select a different-mode with the
8845 variable @code{org-edit-fixed-width-region-mode}.} to allow creating ASCII
8846 drawings easily. Using this command in an empty line will create a new
8850 Calling @code{org-store-link} while editing a source code example in a
8851 temporary buffer created with @kbd{C-c '} will prompt for a label. Make sure
8852 that it is unique in the current buffer, and insert it with the proper
8853 formatting like @samp{(ref:label)} at the end of the current line. Then the
8854 label is stored as a link @samp{(label)}, for retrieval with @kbd{C-c C-l}.
8858 @node Include files, Index entries, Literal examples, Markup
8859 @section Include files
8860 @cindex include files, markup rules
8862 During export, you can include the content of another file. For example, to
8863 include your @file{.emacs} file, you could use:
8867 #+INCLUDE: "~/.emacs" src emacs-lisp
8870 The optional second and third parameter are the markup (e.g. @samp{quote},
8871 @samp{example}, or @samp{src}), and, if the markup is @samp{src}, the
8872 language for formatting the contents. The markup is optional; if it is not
8873 given, the text will be assumed to be in Org-mode format and will be
8874 processed normally. The include line will also allow additional keyword
8875 parameters @code{:prefix1} and @code{:prefix} to specify prefixes for the
8876 first line and for each following line, @code{:minlevel} in order to get
8877 org-mode content demoted to a specified level, as well as any options
8878 accepted by the selected markup. For example, to include a file as an item,
8882 #+INCLUDE: "~/snippets/xx" :prefix1 " + " :prefix " "
8888 Visit the include file at point.
8891 @node Index entries, Macro replacement, Include files, Markup
8892 @section Index entries
8893 @cindex index entries, for publishing
8895 You can specify entries that will be used for generating an index during
8896 publishing. This is done by lines starting with @code{#+INDEX}. An entry
8897 the contains an exclamation mark will create a sub item. See @ref{Generating
8898 an index} for more information.
8903 #+INDEX: Application!CV
8909 @node Macro replacement, Embedded LaTeX, Index entries, Markup
8910 @section Macro replacement
8911 @cindex macro replacement, during export
8914 You can define text snippets with
8917 #+MACRO: name replacement text $1, $2 are arguments
8920 @noindent which can be referenced anywhere in the document (even in
8921 code examples) with @code{@{@{@{name(arg1,arg2)@}@}@}}. In addition to
8922 defined macros, @code{@{@{@{title@}@}@}}, @code{@{@{@{author@}@}@}}, etc.,
8923 will reference information set by the @code{#+TITLE:}, @code{#+AUTHOR:}, and
8924 similar lines. Also, @code{@{@{@{date(@var{FORMAT})@}@}@}} and
8925 @code{@{@{@{modification-time(@var{FORMAT})@}@}@}} refer to current date time
8926 and to the modification time of the file being exported, respectively.
8927 @var{FORMAT} should be a format string understood by
8928 @code{format-time-string}.
8930 Macro expansion takes place during export, and some people use it to
8931 construct complex HTML code.
8934 @node Embedded LaTeX, , Macro replacement, Markup
8935 @section Embedded @LaTeX{}
8936 @cindex @TeX{} interpretation
8937 @cindex @LaTeX{} interpretation
8939 Plain ASCII is normally sufficient for almost all note taking. Exceptions
8940 include scientific notes, which often require mathematical symbols and the
8941 occasional formula. @LaTeX{}@footnote{@LaTeX{} is a macro system based on
8942 Donald E. Knuth's @TeX{} system. Many of the features described here as
8943 ``@LaTeX{}'' are really from @TeX{}, but for simplicity I am blurring this
8944 distinction.} is widely used to typeset scientific documents. Org-mode
8945 supports embedding @LaTeX{} code into its files, because many academics are
8946 used to writing and reading @LaTeX{} source code, and because it can be
8947 readily processed to produce pretty output for a number of export backends.
8950 * Special symbols:: Greek letters and other symbols
8951 * Subscripts and superscripts:: Simple syntax for raising/lowering text
8952 * LaTeX fragments:: Complex formulas made easy
8953 * Previewing LaTeX fragments:: What will this snippet look like?
8954 * CDLaTeX mode:: Speed up entering of formulas
8957 @node Special symbols, Subscripts and superscripts, Embedded LaTeX, Embedded LaTeX
8958 @subsection Special symbols
8959 @cindex math symbols
8960 @cindex special symbols
8961 @cindex @TeX{} macros
8962 @cindex @LaTeX{} fragments, markup rules
8963 @cindex HTML entities
8964 @cindex @LaTeX{} entities
8966 You can use @LaTeX{} macros to insert special symbols like @samp{\alpha} to
8967 indicate the Greek letter, or @samp{\to} to indicate an arrow. Completion
8968 for these macros is available, just type @samp{\} and maybe a few letters,
8969 and press @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} to see possible completions. Unlike @LaTeX{}
8970 code, Org-mode allows these macros to be present without surrounding math
8971 delimiters, for example:
8974 Angles are written as Greek letters \alpha, \beta and \gamma.
8977 @vindex org-entities
8978 During export, these symbols will be transformed into the native format of
8979 the exporter backend. Strings like @code{\alpha} will be exported as
8980 @code{α} in the HTML output, and as @code{$\alpha$} in the @LaTeX{}
8981 output. Similarly, @code{\nbsp} will become @code{ } in HTML and
8982 @code{~} in @LaTeX{}. If you need such a symbol inside a word, terminate it
8983 like this: @samp{\Aacute@{@}stor}.
8985 A large number of entities is provided, with names taken from both HTML and
8986 @LaTeX{}; see the variable @code{org-entities} for the complete list.
8987 @samp{\-} is treated as a shy hyphen, and @samp{--}, @samp{---}, and
8988 @samp{...} are all converted into special commands creating hyphens of
8989 different lengths or a compact set of dots.
8991 If you would like to see entities displayed as UTF8 characters, use the
8992 following command@footnote{You can turn this on by default by setting the
8993 variable @code{org-pretty-entities}, or on a per-file base with the
8994 @code{#+STARTUP} option @code{entitiespretty}.}:
8999 Toggle display of entities as UTF-8 characters. This does not change the
9000 buffer content which remains plain ASCII, but it overlays the UTF-8 character
9001 for display purposes only.
9004 @node Subscripts and superscripts, LaTeX fragments, Special symbols, Embedded LaTeX
9005 @subsection Subscripts and superscripts
9009 Just like in @LaTeX{}, @samp{^} and @samp{_} are used to indicate super-
9010 and subscripts. Again, these can be used without embedding them in
9011 math-mode delimiters. To increase the readability of ASCII text, it is
9012 not necessary (but OK) to surround multi-character sub- and superscripts
9013 with curly braces. For example
9016 The mass of the sun is M_sun = 1.989 x 10^30 kg. The radius of
9017 the sun is R_@{sun@} = 6.96 x 10^8 m.
9020 @vindex org-export-with-sub-superscripts
9021 To avoid interpretation as raised or lowered text, you can quote @samp{^} and
9022 @samp{_} with a backslash: @samp{\^} and @samp{\_}. If you write a text
9023 where the underscore is often used in a different context, Org's convention
9024 to always interpret these as subscripts can get in your way. Configure the
9025 variable @code{org-export-with-sub-superscripts} to globally change this
9026 convention, or use, on a per-file basis:
9032 @noindent With this setting, @samp{a_b} will not be interpreted as a
9033 subscript, but @samp{a_@{b@}} will.
9038 In addition to showing entities as UTF-8 characters, this command will also
9039 format sub- and superscripts in a WYSIWYM way.
9042 @node LaTeX fragments, Previewing LaTeX fragments, Subscripts and superscripts, Embedded LaTeX
9043 @subsection @LaTeX{} fragments
9044 @cindex @LaTeX{} fragments
9046 @vindex org-format-latex-header
9047 Going beyond symbols and sub- and superscripts, a full formula language is
9048 needed. Org-mode can contain @LaTeX{} math fragments, and it supports ways
9049 to process these for several export backends. When exporting to @LaTeX{},
9050 the code is obviously left as it is. When exporting to HTML, Org invokes the
9051 @uref{http://www.mathjax.org, MathJax library} (@pxref{Math formatting in
9052 HTML export}) to process and display the math@footnote{If you plan to use
9053 this regularly or on pages with significant page views, you should install
9054 @file{MathJax} on your own
9055 server in order to limit the load of our server.}. Finally, it can also
9056 process the mathematical expressions into images@footnote{For this to work
9057 you need to be on a system with a working @LaTeX{} installation. You also
9058 need the @file{dvipng} program, available at
9059 @url{http://sourceforge.net/projects/dvipng/}. The @LaTeX{} header that will
9060 be used when processing a fragment can be configured with the variable
9061 @code{org-format-latex-header}.} that can be displayed in a browser or in
9064 @LaTeX{} fragments don't need any special marking at all. The following
9065 snippets will be identified as @LaTeX{} source code:
9068 Environments of any kind@footnote{When @file{MathJax} is used, only the
9069 environment recognized by @file{MathJax} will be processed. When
9070 @file{dvipng} is used to create images, any @LaTeX{} environments will be
9071 handled.}. The only requirement is that the @code{\begin} statement appears
9072 on a new line, preceded by only whitespace.
9074 Text within the usual @LaTeX{} math delimiters. To avoid conflicts with
9075 currency specifications, single @samp{$} characters are only recognized as
9076 math delimiters if the enclosed text contains at most two line breaks, is
9077 directly attached to the @samp{$} characters with no whitespace in between,
9078 and if the closing @samp{$} is followed by whitespace, punctuation or a dash.
9079 For the other delimiters, there is no such restriction, so when in doubt, use
9080 @samp{\(...\)} as inline math delimiters.
9083 @noindent For example:
9086 \begin@{equation@} % arbitrary environments,
9087 x=\sqrt@{b@} % even tables, figures
9088 \end@{equation@} % etc
9090 If $a^2=b$ and \( b=2 \), then the solution must be
9091 either $$ a=+\sqrt@{2@} $$ or \[ a=-\sqrt@{2@} \].
9095 @vindex org-format-latex-options
9096 If you need any of the delimiter ASCII sequences for other purposes, you
9097 can configure the option @code{org-format-latex-options} to deselect the
9098 ones you do not wish to have interpreted by the @LaTeX{} converter.
9100 @vindex org-export-with-LaTeX-fragments
9101 LaTeX processing can be configured with the variable
9102 @code{org-export-with-LaTeX-fragments}. The default setting is @code{t}
9103 which means @file{MathJax} for HTML, and no processing for DocBook, ASCII and
9104 LaTeX backends. You can also set this variable on a per-file basis using one
9108 #+OPTIONS: LaTeX:t @r{Do the right thing automatically (MathJax)}
9109 #+OPTIONS: LaTeX:dvipng @r{Force using dvipng images}
9110 #+OPTIONS: LaTeX:nil @r{Do not process @LaTeX{} fragments at all}
9111 #+OPTIONS: LaTeX:verbatim @r{Verbatim export, for jsMath or so}
9114 @node Previewing LaTeX fragments, CDLaTeX mode, LaTeX fragments, Embedded LaTeX
9115 @subsection Previewing LaTeX fragments
9116 @cindex LaTeX fragments, preview
9118 If you have @file{dvipng} installed, @LaTeX{} fragments can be processed to
9119 produce preview images of the typeset expressions:
9124 Produce a preview image of the @LaTeX{} fragment at point and overlay it
9125 over the source code. If there is no fragment at point, process all
9126 fragments in the current entry (between two headlines). When called
9127 with a prefix argument, process the entire subtree. When called with
9128 two prefix arguments, or when the cursor is before the first headline,
9129 process the entire buffer.
9132 Remove the overlay preview images.
9135 @vindex org-format-latex-options
9136 You can customize the variable @code{org-format-latex-options} to influence
9137 some aspects of the preview. In particular, the @code{:scale} (and for HTML
9138 export, @code{:html-scale}) property can be used to adjust the size of the
9141 @node CDLaTeX mode, , Previewing LaTeX fragments, Embedded LaTeX
9142 @subsection Using CDLa@TeX{} to enter math
9145 CDLa@TeX{} mode is a minor mode that is normally used in combination with a
9146 major @LaTeX{} mode like AUC@TeX{} in order to speed-up insertion of
9147 environments and math templates. Inside Org-mode, you can make use of
9148 some of the features of CDLa@TeX{} mode. You need to install
9149 @file{cdlatex.el} and @file{texmathp.el} (the latter comes also with
9150 AUC@TeX{}) from @url{http://www.astro.uva.nl/~dominik/Tools/cdlatex}.
9151 Don't use CDLa@TeX{} mode itself under Org-mode, but use the light
9152 version @code{org-cdlatex-mode} that comes as part of Org-mode. Turn it
9153 on for the current buffer with @code{M-x org-cdlatex-mode}, or for all
9157 (add-hook 'org-mode-hook 'turn-on-org-cdlatex)
9160 When this mode is enabled, the following features are present (for more
9161 details see the documentation of CDLa@TeX{} mode):
9165 Environment templates can be inserted with @kbd{C-c @{}.
9168 The @key{TAB} key will do template expansion if the cursor is inside a
9169 @LaTeX{} fragment@footnote{Org-mode has a method to test if the cursor is
9170 inside such a fragment, see the documentation of the function
9171 @code{org-inside-LaTeX-fragment-p}.}. For example, @key{TAB} will
9172 expand @code{fr} to @code{\frac@{@}@{@}} and position the cursor
9173 correctly inside the first brace. Another @key{TAB} will get you into
9174 the second brace. Even outside fragments, @key{TAB} will expand
9175 environment abbreviations at the beginning of a line. For example, if
9176 you write @samp{equ} at the beginning of a line and press @key{TAB},
9177 this abbreviation will be expanded to an @code{equation} environment.
9178 To get a list of all abbreviations, type @kbd{M-x cdlatex-command-help}.
9182 @vindex cdlatex-simplify-sub-super-scripts
9183 Pressing @kbd{_} and @kbd{^} inside a @LaTeX{} fragment will insert these
9184 characters together with a pair of braces. If you use @key{TAB} to move
9185 out of the braces, and if the braces surround only a single character or
9186 macro, they are removed again (depending on the variable
9187 @code{cdlatex-simplify-sub-super-scripts}).
9190 Pressing the backquote @kbd{`} followed by a character inserts math
9191 macros, also outside @LaTeX{} fragments. If you wait more than 1.5 seconds
9192 after the backquote, a help window will pop up.
9195 Pressing the single-quote @kbd{'} followed by another character modifies
9196 the symbol before point with an accent or a font. If you wait more than
9197 1.5 seconds after the single-quote, a help window will pop up. Character
9198 modification will work only inside @LaTeX{} fragments; outside the quote
9202 @node Exporting, Publishing, Markup, Top
9206 Org-mode documents can be exported into a variety of other formats. For
9207 printing and sharing of notes, ASCII export produces a readable and simple
9208 version of an Org file. HTML export allows you to publish a notes file on
9209 the web, while the XOXO format provides a solid base for exchange with a
9210 broad range of other applications. @LaTeX{} export lets you use Org-mode and
9211 its structured editing functions to easily create @LaTeX{} files. DocBook
9212 export makes it possible to convert Org files to many other formats using
9213 DocBook tools. For project management you can create gantt and resource
9214 charts by using TaskJuggler export. To incorporate entries with associated
9215 times like deadlines or appointments into a desktop calendar program like
9216 iCal, Org-mode can also produce extracts in the iCalendar format. Currently
9217 Org-mode only supports export, not import of these different formats.
9219 Org supports export of selected regions when @code{transient-mark-mode} is
9220 enabled (default in Emacs 23).
9223 * Selective export:: Using tags to select and exclude trees
9224 * Export options:: Per-file export settings
9225 * The export dispatcher:: How to access exporter commands
9226 * ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export:: Exporting to flat files with encoding
9227 * HTML export:: Exporting to HTML
9228 * LaTeX and PDF export:: Exporting to @LaTeX{}, and processing to PDF
9229 * DocBook export:: Exporting to DocBook
9230 * TaskJuggler export:: Exporting to TaskJuggler
9231 * Freemind export:: Exporting to Freemind mind maps
9232 * XOXO export:: Exporting to XOXO
9233 * iCalendar export:: Exporting in iCalendar format
9236 @node Selective export, Export options, Exporting, Exporting
9237 @section Selective export
9238 @cindex export, selective by tags
9240 @vindex org-export-select-tags
9241 @vindex org-export-exclude-tags
9242 You may use tags to select the parts of a document that should be exported,
9243 or to exclude parts from export. This behavior is governed by two variables:
9244 @code{org-export-select-tags} and @code{org-export-exclude-tags}.
9246 Org first checks if any of the @emph{select} tags is present in the buffer.
9247 If yes, all trees that do not carry one of these tags will be excluded. If a
9248 selected tree is a subtree, the heading hierarchy above it will also be
9249 selected for export, but not the text below those headings.
9252 If none of the select tags is found, the whole buffer will be selected for
9256 Finally, all subtrees that are marked by any of the @emph{exclude} tags will
9257 be removed from the export buffer.
9259 @node Export options, The export dispatcher, Selective export, Exporting
9260 @section Export options
9261 @cindex options, for export
9263 @cindex completion, of option keywords
9264 The exporter recognizes special lines in the buffer which provide
9265 additional information. These lines may be put anywhere in the file.
9266 The whole set of lines can be inserted into the buffer with @kbd{C-c
9267 C-e t}. For individual lines, a good way to make sure the keyword is
9268 correct is to type @samp{#+} and then use @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} completion
9269 (@pxref{Completion}). For a summary of other in-buffer settings not
9270 specifically related to export, see @ref{In-buffer settings}.
9271 In particular, note that you can place commonly-used (export) options in
9272 a separate file which can be included using @code{#+SETUPFILE}.
9275 @orgcmd{C-c C-e t,org-insert-export-options-template}
9276 Insert template with export options, see example below.
9283 @cindex #+DESCRIPTION
9291 @cindex #+EXPORT_SELECT_TAGS
9292 @cindex #+EXPORT_EXCLUDE_TAGS
9294 @cindex #+LATEX_HEADER
9295 @vindex user-full-name
9296 @vindex user-mail-address
9297 @vindex org-export-default-language
9299 #+TITLE: the title to be shown (default is the buffer name)
9300 #+AUTHOR: the author (default taken from @code{user-full-name})
9301 #+DATE: a date, fixed, or a format string for @code{format-time-string}
9302 #+EMAIL: his/her email address (default from @code{user-mail-address})
9303 #+DESCRIPTION: the page description, e.g. for the XHTML meta tag
9304 #+KEYWORDS: the page keywords, e.g. for the XHTML meta tag
9305 #+LANGUAGE: language for HTML, e.g. @samp{en} (@code{org-export-default-language})
9306 #+TEXT: Some descriptive text to be inserted at the beginning.
9307 #+TEXT: Several lines may be given.
9308 #+OPTIONS: H:2 num:t toc:t \n:nil @@:t ::t |:t ^:t f:t TeX:t ...
9309 #+BIND: lisp-var lisp-val, e.g.: org-export-latex-low-levels itemize
9310 @r{You need to confirm using these, or configure @code{org-export-allow-BIND}}
9311 #+LINK_UP: the ``up'' link of an exported page
9312 #+LINK_HOME: the ``home'' link of an exported page
9313 #+LATEX_HEADER: extra line(s) for the LaTeX header, like \usepackage@{xyz@}
9314 #+EXPORT_SELECT_TAGS: Tags that select a tree for export
9315 #+EXPORT_EXCLUDE_TAGS: Tags that exclude a tree from export
9316 #+XSLT: the XSLT stylesheet used by DocBook exporter to generate FO file
9320 The OPTIONS line is a compact@footnote{If you want to configure many options
9321 this way, you can use several OPTIONS lines.} form to specify export
9322 settings. Here you can:
9323 @cindex headline levels
9324 @cindex section-numbers
9325 @cindex table of contents
9326 @cindex line-break preservation
9327 @cindex quoted HTML tags
9328 @cindex fixed-width sections
9330 @cindex @TeX{}-like syntax for sub- and superscripts
9332 @cindex special strings
9333 @cindex emphasized text
9334 @cindex @TeX{} macros
9335 @cindex @LaTeX{} fragments
9336 @cindex author info, in export
9337 @cindex time info, in export
9339 H: @r{set the number of headline levels for export}
9340 num: @r{turn on/off section-numbers}
9341 toc: @r{turn on/off table of contents, or set level limit (integer)}
9342 \n: @r{turn on/off line-break-preservation (DOES NOT WORK)}
9343 @@: @r{turn on/off quoted HTML tags}
9344 :: @r{turn on/off fixed-width sections}
9345 |: @r{turn on/off tables}
9346 ^: @r{turn on/off @TeX{}-like syntax for sub- and superscripts. If}
9347 @r{you write "^:@{@}", @code{a_@{b@}} will be interpreted, but}
9348 @r{the simple @code{a_b} will be left as it is.}
9349 -: @r{turn on/off conversion of special strings.}
9350 f: @r{turn on/off footnotes like this[1].}
9351 todo: @r{turn on/off inclusion of TODO keywords into exported text}
9352 pri: @r{turn on/off priority cookies}
9353 tags: @r{turn on/off inclusion of tags, may also be @code{not-in-toc}}
9354 <: @r{turn on/off inclusion of any time/date stamps like DEADLINES}
9355 *: @r{turn on/off emphasized text (bold, italic, underlined)}
9356 TeX: @r{turn on/off simple @TeX{} macros in plain text}
9357 LaTeX: @r{configure export of @LaTeX{} fragments. Default @code{auto}}
9358 skip: @r{turn on/off skipping the text before the first heading}
9359 author: @r{turn on/off inclusion of author name/email into exported file}
9360 email: @r{turn on/off inclusion of author email into exported file}
9361 creator: @r{turn on/off inclusion of creator info into exported file}
9362 timestamp: @r{turn on/off inclusion creation time into exported file}
9363 d: @r{turn on/off inclusion of drawers}
9366 These options take effect in both the HTML and @LaTeX{} export, except for
9367 @code{TeX} and @code{LaTeX}, which are respectively @code{t} and @code{nil}
9368 for the @LaTeX{} export. The default values for these and many other options
9369 are given by a set of variables. For a list of such variables, the
9370 corresponding OPTIONS keys and also the publishing keys (@pxref{Project
9371 alist}), see the constant @code{org-export-plist-vars}.
9373 When exporting only a single subtree by selecting it with @kbd{C-c @@} before
9374 calling an export command, the subtree can overrule some of the file's export
9375 settings with properties @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME}, @code{EXPORT_TITLE},
9376 @code{EXPORT_TEXT}, @code{EXPORT_AUTHOR}, @code{EXPORT_DATE}, and
9377 @code{EXPORT_OPTIONS}.
9379 @node The export dispatcher, ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export, Export options, Exporting
9380 @section The export dispatcher
9381 @cindex dispatcher, for export commands
9383 All export commands can be reached using the export dispatcher, which is a
9384 prefix key that prompts for an additional key specifying the command.
9385 Normally the entire file is exported, but if there is an active region that
9386 contains one outline tree, the first heading is used as document title and
9387 the subtrees are exported.
9390 @orgcmd{C-c C-e,org-export}
9391 @vindex org-export-run-in-background
9392 Dispatcher for export and publishing commands. Displays a help-window
9393 listing the additional key(s) needed to launch an export or publishing
9394 command. The prefix arg is passed through to the exporter. A double prefix
9395 @kbd{C-u C-u} causes most commands to be executed in the background, in a
9396 separate Emacs process@footnote{To make this behavior the default, customize
9397 the variable @code{org-export-run-in-background}.}.
9398 @orgcmd{C-c C-e v,org-export-visible}
9399 Like @kbd{C-c C-e}, but only export the text that is currently visible
9400 (i.e. not hidden by outline visibility).
9401 @orgcmd{C-u C-u C-c C-e,org-export}
9402 @vindex org-export-run-in-background
9403 Call the exporter, but reverse the setting of
9404 @code{org-export-run-in-background}, i.e. request background processing if
9405 not set, or force processing in the current Emacs process if set.
9408 @node ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export, HTML export, The export dispatcher, Exporting
9409 @section ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export
9410 @cindex ASCII export
9411 @cindex Latin-1 export
9412 @cindex UTF-8 export
9414 ASCII export produces a simple and very readable version of an Org-mode
9415 file, containing only plain ASCII. Latin-1 and UTF-8 export augment the file
9416 with special characters and symbols available in these encodings.
9418 @cindex region, active
9419 @cindex active region
9420 @cindex transient-mark-mode
9422 @orgcmd{C-c C-e a,org-export-as-ascii}
9423 @cindex property, EXPORT_FILE_NAME
9424 Export as ASCII file. For an Org file, @file{myfile.org}, the ASCII file
9425 will be @file{myfile.txt}. The file will be overwritten without
9426 warning. If there is an active region@footnote{This requires
9427 @code{transient-mark-mode} be turned on.}, only the region will be
9428 exported. If the selected region is a single tree@footnote{To select the
9429 current subtree, use @kbd{C-c @@}.}, the tree head will
9430 become the document title. If the tree head entry has or inherits an
9431 @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME} property, that name will be used for the
9433 @orgcmd{C-c C-e A,org-export-as-ascii-to-buffer}
9434 Export to a temporary buffer. Do not create a file.
9435 @orgcmd{C-c C-e n,org-export-as-latin1}
9436 @xorgcmd{C-c C-e N,org-export-as-latin1-to-buffer}
9437 Like the above commands, but use Latin-1 encoding.
9438 @orgcmd{C-c C-e u,org-export-as-utf8}
9439 @xorgcmd{C-c C-e U,org-export-as-utf8-to-buffer}
9440 Like the above commands, but use UTF-8 encoding.
9441 @item C-c C-e v a/n/u
9442 Export only the visible part of the document.
9445 @cindex headline levels, for exporting
9446 In the exported version, the first 3 outline levels will become
9447 headlines, defining a general document structure. Additional levels
9448 will be exported as itemized lists. If you want that transition to occur
9449 at a different level, specify it with a prefix argument. For example,
9456 creates only top level headlines and does the rest as items. When
9457 headlines are converted to items, the indentation of the text following
9458 the headline is changed to fit nicely under the item. This is done with
9459 the assumption that the first body line indicates the base indentation of
9460 the body text. Any indentation larger than this is adjusted to preserve
9461 the layout relative to the first line. Should there be lines with less
9462 indentation than the first, these are left alone.
9464 @vindex org-export-ascii-links-to-notes
9465 Links will be exported in a footnote-like style, with the descriptive part in
9466 the text and the link in a note before the next heading. See the variable
9467 @code{org-export-ascii-links-to-notes} for details and other options.
9469 @node HTML export, LaTeX and PDF export, ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export, Exporting
9470 @section HTML export
9473 Org-mode contains an HTML (XHTML 1.0 strict) exporter with extensive
9474 HTML formatting, in ways similar to John Gruber's @emph{markdown}
9475 language, but with additional support for tables.
9478 * HTML Export commands:: How to invoke HTML export
9479 * Quoting HTML tags:: Using direct HTML in Org-mode
9480 * Links in HTML export:: How links will be interpreted and formatted
9481 * Tables in HTML export:: How to modify the formatting of tables
9482 * Images in HTML export:: How to insert figures into HTML output
9483 * Math formatting in HTML export:: Beautiful math also on the web
9484 * Text areas in HTML export:: An alternative way to show an example
9485 * CSS support:: Changing the appearance of the output
9486 * JavaScript support:: Info and Folding in a web browser
9489 @node HTML Export commands, Quoting HTML tags, HTML export, HTML export
9490 @subsection HTML export commands
9492 @cindex region, active
9493 @cindex active region
9494 @cindex transient-mark-mode
9496 @orgcmd{C-c C-e h,org-export-as-html}
9497 @cindex property, EXPORT_FILE_NAME
9498 Export as HTML file @file{myfile.html}. For an Org file @file{myfile.org},
9499 the ASCII file will be @file{myfile.html}. The file will be overwritten
9500 without warning. If there is an active region@footnote{This requires
9501 @code{transient-mark-mode} be turned on.}, only the region will be
9502 exported. If the selected region is a single tree@footnote{To select the
9503 current subtree, use @kbd{C-c @@}.}, the tree head will become the document
9504 title. If the tree head entry has, or inherits, an @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME}
9505 property, that name will be used for the export.
9506 @orgcmd{C-c C-e b,org-export-as-html-and-open}
9507 Export as HTML file and immediately open it with a browser.
9508 @orgcmd{C-c C-e H,org-export-as-html-to-buffer}
9509 Export to a temporary buffer. Do not create a file.
9510 @orgcmd{C-c C-e R,org-export-region-as-html}
9511 Export the active region to a temporary buffer. With a prefix argument, do
9512 not produce the file header and footer, but just the plain HTML section for
9513 the region. This is good for cut-and-paste operations.
9514 @item C-c C-e v h/b/H/R
9515 Export only the visible part of the document.
9516 @item M-x org-export-region-as-html
9517 Convert the region to HTML under the assumption that it was Org-mode
9518 syntax before. This is a global command that can be invoked in any
9520 @item M-x org-replace-region-by-HTML
9521 Replace the active region (assumed to be in Org-mode syntax) by HTML
9525 @cindex headline levels, for exporting
9526 In the exported version, the first 3 outline levels will become headlines,
9527 defining a general document structure. Additional levels will be exported as
9528 itemized lists. If you want that transition to occur at a different level,
9529 specify it with a numeric prefix argument. For example,
9536 creates two levels of headings and does the rest as items.
9538 @node Quoting HTML tags, Links in HTML export, HTML Export commands, HTML export
9539 @subsection Quoting HTML tags
9541 Plain @samp{<} and @samp{>} are always transformed to @samp{<} and
9542 @samp{>} in HTML export. If you want to include simple HTML tags
9543 which should be interpreted as such, mark them with @samp{@@} as in
9544 @samp{@@<b>bold text@@</b>}. Note that this really works only for
9545 simple tags. For more extensive HTML that should be copied verbatim to
9546 the exported file use either
9549 @cindex #+BEGIN_HTML
9551 #+HTML: Literal HTML code for export
9555 @cindex #+BEGIN_HTML
9559 All lines between these markers are exported literally
9564 @node Links in HTML export, Tables in HTML export, Quoting HTML tags, HTML export
9565 @subsection Links in HTML export
9567 @cindex links, in HTML export
9568 @cindex internal links, in HTML export
9569 @cindex external links, in HTML export
9570 Internal links (@pxref{Internal links}) will continue to work in HTML. This
9571 includes automatic links created by radio targets (@pxref{Radio
9572 targets}). Links to external files will still work if the target file is on
9573 the same @i{relative} path as the published Org file. Links to other
9574 @file{.org} files will be translated into HTML links under the assumption
9575 that an HTML version also exists of the linked file, at the same relative
9576 path. @samp{id:} links can then be used to jump to specific entries across
9577 files. For information related to linking files while publishing them to a
9578 publishing directory see @ref{Publishing links}.
9580 If you want to specify attributes for links, you can do so using a special
9581 @code{#+ATTR_HTML} line to define attributes that will be added to the
9582 @code{<a>} or @code{<img>} tags. Here is an example that sets @code{title}
9583 and @code{style} attributes for a link:
9587 #+ATTR_HTML: title="The Org-mode homepage" style="color:red;"
9588 [[http://orgmode.org]]
9591 @node Tables in HTML export, Images in HTML export, Links in HTML export, HTML export
9593 @cindex tables, in HTML
9594 @vindex org-export-html-table-tag
9596 Org-mode tables are exported to HTML using the table tag defined in
9597 @code{org-export-html-table-tag}. The default setting makes tables without
9598 cell borders and frame. If you would like to change this for individual
9599 tables, place something like the following before the table:
9604 #+CAPTION: This is a table with lines around and between cells
9605 #+ATTR_HTML: border="2" rules="all" frame="all"
9608 @node Images in HTML export, Math formatting in HTML export, Tables in HTML export, HTML export
9609 @subsection Images in HTML export
9611 @cindex images, inline in HTML
9612 @cindex inlining images in HTML
9613 @vindex org-export-html-inline-images
9614 HTML export can inline images given as links in the Org file, and
9615 it can make an image the clickable part of a link. By
9616 default@footnote{But see the variable
9617 @code{org-export-html-inline-images}.}, images are inlined if a link does
9618 not have a description. So @samp{[[file:myimg.jpg]]} will be inlined,
9619 while @samp{[[file:myimg.jpg][the image]]} will just produce a link
9620 @samp{the image} that points to the image. If the description part
9621 itself is a @code{file:} link or a @code{http:} URL pointing to an
9622 image, this image will be inlined and activated so that clicking on the
9623 image will activate the link. For example, to include a thumbnail that
9624 will link to a high resolution version of the image, you could use:
9627 [[file:highres.jpg][file:thumb.jpg]]
9630 If you need to add attributes to an inlined image, use a @code{#+ATTR_HTML}.
9631 In the example below we specify the @code{alt} and @code{title} attributes to
9632 support text viewers and accessibility, and align it to the right.
9637 #+CAPTION: A black cat stalking a spider
9638 #+ATTR_HTML: alt="cat/spider image" title="Action!" align="right"
9643 and you could use @code{http} addresses just as well.
9645 @node Math formatting in HTML export, Text areas in HTML export, Images in HTML export, HTML export
9646 @subsection Math formatting in HTML export
9650 @LaTeX{} math snippets (@pxref{LaTeX fragments}) can be displayed in two
9651 different ways on HTML pages. The default is to use the
9652 @uref{http://www.mathjax.org, MathJax system} which should work out of the
9653 box with Org mode installation because @code{http://orgmode.org} serves
9654 @file{MathJax} for Org-mode users for small applications and for testing
9655 purposes. @b{If you plan to use this regularly or on pages with significant
9656 page views, you should install@footnote{Installation instructions can be
9657 found on the MathJax website, see
9658 @uref{http://www.mathjax.org/resources/docs/?installation.html}.} MathJax on
9659 your own server in order to limit the load of our server.} To configure
9660 @file{MathJax}, use the variable @code{org-export-html-mathjax-options} or
9661 insert something like the following into the buffer:
9664 #+MATHJAX: align:"left" mathml:t path:"/MathJax/MathJax.js"
9667 @noindent See the docstring of the variable
9668 @code{org-export-html-mathjax-options} for the meaning of the parameters in
9671 If you prefer, you can also request that @LaTeX{} fragments are processed
9672 into small images that will be inserted into the browser page. Before the
9673 availability of MathJax, this was the default method for Org files. This
9674 method requires that the @file{dvipng} program is available on your system.
9675 You can still get this processing with
9678 #+OPTIONS: LaTeX:dvipng
9681 @node Text areas in HTML export, CSS support, Math formatting in HTML export, HTML export
9682 @subsection Text areas in HTML export
9684 @cindex text areas, in HTML
9685 An alternative way to publish literal code examples in HTML is to use text
9686 areas, where the example can even be edited before pasting it into an
9687 application. It is triggered by a @code{-t} switch at an @code{example} or
9688 @code{src} block. Using this switch disables any options for syntax and
9689 label highlighting, and line numbering, which may be present. You may also
9690 use @code{-h} and @code{-w} switches to specify the height and width of the
9691 text area, which default to the number of lines in the example, and 80,
9692 respectively. For example
9695 #+BEGIN_EXAMPLE -t -w 40
9696 (defun org-xor (a b)
9703 @node CSS support, JavaScript support, Text areas in HTML export, HTML export
9704 @subsection CSS support
9705 @cindex CSS, for HTML export
9706 @cindex HTML export, CSS
9708 @vindex org-export-html-todo-kwd-class-prefix
9709 @vindex org-export-html-tag-class-prefix
9710 You can also give style information for the exported file. The HTML exporter
9711 assigns the following special CSS classes@footnote{If the classes on TODO
9712 keywords and tags lead to conflicts, use the variables
9713 @code{org-export-html-todo-kwd-class-prefix} and
9714 @code{org-export-html-tag-class-prefix} to make them unique.} to appropriate
9715 parts of the document---your style specifications may change these, in
9716 addition to any of the standard classes like for headlines, tables, etc.
9718 p.author @r{author information, including email}
9719 p.date @r{publishing date}
9720 p.creator @r{creator info, about org-mode version}
9721 .title @r{document title}
9722 .todo @r{TODO keywords, all not-done states}
9723 .done @r{the DONE keywords, all stated the count as done}
9724 .WAITING @r{each TODO keyword also uses a class named after itself}
9725 .timestamp @r{timestamp}
9726 .timestamp-kwd @r{keyword associated with a timestamp, like SCHEDULED}
9727 .timestamp-wrapper @r{span around keyword plus timestamp}
9728 .tag @r{tag in a headline}
9729 ._HOME @r{each tag uses itself as a class, "@@" replaced by "_"}
9730 .target @r{target for links}
9731 .linenr @r{the line number in a code example}
9732 .code-highlighted @r{for highlighting referenced code lines}
9733 div.outline-N @r{div for outline level N (headline plus text))}
9734 div.outline-text-N @r{extra div for text at outline level N}
9735 .section-number-N @r{section number in headlines, different for each level}
9736 div.figure @r{how to format an inlined image}
9737 pre.src @r{formatted source code}
9738 pre.example @r{normal example}
9739 p.verse @r{verse paragraph}
9740 div.footnotes @r{footnote section headline}
9741 p.footnote @r{footnote definition paragraph, containing a footnote}
9742 .footref @r{a footnote reference number (always a <sup>)}
9743 .footnum @r{footnote number in footnote definition (always <sup>)}
9746 @vindex org-export-html-style-default
9747 @vindex org-export-html-style-include-default
9748 @vindex org-export-html-style
9749 @vindex org-export-html-extra
9750 @vindex org-export-html-style-default
9751 Each exported file contains a compact default style that defines these
9752 classes in a basic way@footnote{This style is defined in the constant
9753 @code{org-export-html-style-default}, which you should not modify. To turn
9754 inclusion of these defaults off, customize
9755 @code{org-export-html-style-include-default}}. You may overwrite these
9756 settings, or add to them by using the variables @code{org-export-html-style}
9757 (for Org-wide settings) and @code{org-export-html-style-extra} (for more
9758 fine-grained settings, like file-local settings). To set the latter variable
9759 individually for each file, you can use
9763 #+STYLE: <link rel="stylesheet" type="text/css" href="stylesheet.css" />
9767 For longer style definitions, you can use several such lines. You could also
9768 directly write a @code{<style>} @code{</style>} section in this way, without
9769 referring to an external file.
9771 In order to add styles to a subtree, use the @code{:HTML_CONTAINER_CLASS:}
9772 property to assign a class to the tree. In order to specify CSS styles for a
9773 particular headline, you can use the id specified in a @code{:CUSTOM_ID:}
9776 @c FIXME: More about header and footer styles
9777 @c FIXME: Talk about links and targets.
9779 @node JavaScript support, , CSS support, HTML export
9780 @subsection JavaScript supported display of web pages
9782 @cindex Rose, Sebastian
9783 Sebastian Rose has written a JavaScript program especially designed to
9784 enhance the web viewing experience of HTML files created with Org. This
9785 program allows you to view large files in two different ways. The first one
9786 is an @emph{Info}-like mode where each section is displayed separately and
9787 navigation can be done with the @kbd{n} and @kbd{p} keys (and some other keys
9788 as well, press @kbd{?} for an overview of the available keys). The second
9789 view type is a @emph{folding} view much like Org provides inside Emacs. The
9790 script is available at @url{http://orgmode.org/org-info.js} and you can find
9791 the documentation for it at @url{http://orgmode.org/worg/code/org-info-js/}.
9792 We host the script at our site, but if you use it a lot, you might
9793 not want to be dependent on @url{orgmode.org} and prefer to install a local
9794 copy on your own web server.
9796 To use the script, you need to make sure that the @file{org-jsinfo.el} module
9797 gets loaded. It should be loaded by default, but you can try @kbd{M-x
9798 customize-variable @key{RET} org-modules @key{RET}} to convince yourself that
9799 this is indeed the case. All it then takes to make use of the program is
9800 adding a single line to the Org file:
9802 @cindex #+INFOJS_OPT
9804 #+INFOJS_OPT: view:info toc:nil
9808 If this line is found, the HTML header will automatically contain the code
9809 needed to invoke the script. Using the line above, you can set the following
9813 path: @r{The path to the script. The default is to grab the script from}
9814 @r{@url{http://orgmode.org/org-info.js}, but you might want to have}
9815 @r{a local copy and use a path like @samp{../scripts/org-info.js}.}
9816 view: @r{Initial view when website is first shown. Possible values are:}
9817 info @r{Info-like interface with one section per page.}
9818 overview @r{Folding interface, initially showing only top-level.}
9819 content @r{Folding interface, starting with all headlines visible.}
9820 showall @r{Folding interface, all headlines and text visible.}
9821 sdepth: @r{Maximum headline level that will still become an independent}
9822 @r{section for info and folding modes. The default is taken from}
9823 @r{@code{org-export-headline-levels} (= the @code{H} switch in @code{#+OPTIONS}).}
9824 @r{If this is smaller than in @code{org-export-headline-levels}, each}
9825 @r{info/folding section can still contain child headlines.}
9826 toc: @r{Should the table of contents @emph{initially} be visible?}
9827 @r{Even when @code{nil}, you can always get to the "toc" with @kbd{i}.}
9828 tdepth: @r{The depth of the table of contents. The defaults are taken from}
9829 @r{the variables @code{org-export-headline-levels} and @code{org-export-with-toc}.}
9830 ftoc: @r{Does the CSS of the page specify a fixed position for the "toc"?}
9831 @r{If yes, the toc will never be displayed as a section.}
9832 ltoc: @r{Should there be short contents (children) in each section?}
9833 @r{Make this @code{above} if the section should be above initial text.}
9834 mouse: @r{Headings are highlighted when the mouse is over them. Should be}
9835 @r{@samp{underline} (default) or a background color like @samp{#cccccc}.}
9836 buttons: @r{Should view-toggle buttons be everywhere? When @code{nil} (the}
9837 @r{default), only one such button will be present.}
9840 @vindex org-infojs-options
9841 @vindex org-export-html-use-infojs
9842 You can choose default values for these options by customizing the variable
9843 @code{org-infojs-options}. If you always want to apply the script to your
9844 pages, configure the variable @code{org-export-html-use-infojs}.
9846 @node LaTeX and PDF export, DocBook export, HTML export, Exporting
9847 @section @LaTeX{} and PDF export
9848 @cindex @LaTeX{} export
9850 @cindex Guerry, Bastien
9852 Org-mode contains a @LaTeX{} exporter written by Bastien Guerry. With
9853 further processing@footnote{The default LaTeX output is designed for
9854 processing with pdftex or latex. It includes packages that are not
9855 compatible with xetex and possibly luatex. See the variables
9856 @code{org-export-latex-default-packages-alist} and
9857 @code{org-export-latex-packages-alist}.}, this backend is also used to
9858 produce PDF output. Since the @LaTeX{} output uses @file{hyperref} to
9859 implement links and cross references, the PDF output file will be fully
9863 * LaTeX/PDF export commands:: Which key invokes which commands
9864 * Header and sectioning:: Setting up the export file structure
9865 * Quoting LaTeX code:: Incorporating literal @LaTeX{} code
9866 * Tables in LaTeX export:: Options for exporting tables to @LaTeX{}
9867 * Images in LaTeX export:: How to insert figures into @LaTeX{} output
9868 * Beamer class export:: Turning the file into a presentation
9871 @node LaTeX/PDF export commands, Header and sectioning, LaTeX and PDF export, LaTeX and PDF export
9872 @subsection @LaTeX{} export commands
9874 @cindex region, active
9875 @cindex active region
9876 @cindex transient-mark-mode
9878 @orgcmd{C-c C-e l,org-export-as-latex}
9879 @cindex property EXPORT_FILE_NAME
9880 Export as @LaTeX{} file @file{myfile.tex}. For an Org file
9881 @file{myfile.org}, the ASCII file will be @file{myfile.tex}. The file will
9882 be overwritten without warning. If there is an active region@footnote{This
9883 requires @code{transient-mark-mode} be turned on.}, only the region will be
9884 exported. If the selected region is a single tree@footnote{To select the
9885 current subtree, use @kbd{C-c @@}.}, the tree head will become the document
9886 title. If the tree head entry has or inherits an @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME}
9887 property, that name will be used for the export.
9888 @orgcmd{C-c C-e L,org-export-as-latex-to-buffer}
9889 Export to a temporary buffer. Do not create a file.
9891 Export only the visible part of the document.
9892 @item M-x org-export-region-as-latex
9893 Convert the region to @LaTeX{} under the assumption that it was Org-mode
9894 syntax before. This is a global command that can be invoked in any
9896 @item M-x org-replace-region-by-latex
9897 Replace the active region (assumed to be in Org-mode syntax) by @LaTeX{}
9899 @orgcmd{C-c C-e p,org-export-as-pdf}
9900 Export as @LaTeX{} and then process to PDF.
9901 @orgcmd{C-c C-e d,org-export-as-pdf-and-open}
9902 Export as @LaTeX{} and then process to PDF, then open the resulting PDF file.
9905 @cindex headline levels, for exporting
9906 @vindex org-latex-low-levels
9907 In the exported version, the first 3 outline levels will become
9908 headlines, defining a general document structure. Additional levels
9909 will be exported as description lists. The exporter can ignore them or
9910 convert them to a custom string depending on
9911 @code{org-latex-low-levels}.
9913 If you want that transition to occur at a different level, specify it
9914 with a numeric prefix argument. For example,
9921 creates two levels of headings and does the rest as items.
9923 @node Header and sectioning, Quoting LaTeX code, LaTeX/PDF export commands, LaTeX and PDF export
9924 @subsection Header and sectioning structure
9925 @cindex @LaTeX{} class
9926 @cindex @LaTeX{} sectioning structure
9927 @cindex @LaTeX{} header
9928 @cindex header, for LaTeX files
9929 @cindex sectioning structure, for LaTeX export
9931 By default, the @LaTeX{} output uses the class @code{article}.
9933 @vindex org-export-latex-default-class
9934 @vindex org-export-latex-classes
9935 @vindex org-export-latex-default-packages-alist
9936 @vindex org-export-latex-packages-alist
9937 @cindex #+LATEX_HEADER
9938 @cindex #+LATEX_CLASS
9939 @cindex #+LATEX_CLASS_OPTIONS
9940 @cindex property, LATEX_CLASS
9941 @cindex property, LATEX_CLASS_OPTIONS
9942 You can change this globally by setting a different value for
9943 @code{org-export-latex-default-class} or locally by adding an option like
9944 @code{#+LaTeX_CLASS: myclass} in your file, or with a @code{:LaTeX_CLASS:}
9945 property that applies when exporting a region containing only this (sub)tree.
9946 The class must be listed in @code{org-export-latex-classes}. This variable
9947 defines a header template for each class@footnote{Into which the values of
9948 @code{org-export-latex-default-packages-alist} and
9949 @code{org-export-latex-packages-alist} are spliced.}, and allows you to
9950 define the sectioning structure for each class. You can also define your own
9951 classes there. @code{#+LaTeX_CLASS_OPTIONS} or a @code{LaTeX_CLASS_OPTIONS}
9952 property can specify the options for the @code{\documentclass} macro. You
9953 can also use @code{#+LATEX_HEADER: \usepackage@{xyz@}} to add lines to the
9954 header. See the docstring of @code{org-export-latex-classes} for more
9957 @node Quoting LaTeX code, Tables in LaTeX export, Header and sectioning, LaTeX and PDF export
9958 @subsection Quoting @LaTeX{} code
9960 Embedded @LaTeX{} as described in @ref{Embedded LaTeX}, will be correctly
9961 inserted into the @LaTeX{} file. This includes simple macros like
9962 @samp{\ref@{LABEL@}} to create a cross reference to a figure. Furthermore,
9963 you can add special code that should only be present in @LaTeX{} export with
9964 the following constructs:
9967 @cindex #+BEGIN_LaTeX
9969 #+LaTeX: Literal LaTeX code for export
9973 @cindex #+BEGIN_LaTeX
9977 All lines between these markers are exported literally
9982 @node Tables in LaTeX export, Images in LaTeX export, Quoting LaTeX code, LaTeX and PDF export
9983 @subsection Tables in @LaTeX{} export
9984 @cindex tables, in @LaTeX{} export
9986 For @LaTeX{} export of a table, you can specify a label and a caption
9987 (@pxref{Images and tables}). You can also use the @code{ATTR_LaTeX} line to
9988 request a @code{longtable} environment for the table, so that it may span
9989 several pages, or to change the default table environment from @code{table}
9990 to @code{table*} or to change the default inner tabular environment to
9991 @code{tabularx} or @code{tabulary}. Finally, you can set the alignment
9992 string, and (with @code{tabularx} or @code{tabulary}) the width:
9996 @cindex #+ATTR_LaTeX
9998 #+CAPTION: A long table
10000 #+ATTR_LaTeX: longtable align=l|lp@{3cm@}r|l
10005 or to specify a multicolumn table with @code{tabulary}
10009 @cindex #+ATTR_LaTeX
10011 #+CAPTION: A wide table with tabulary
10013 #+ATTR_LaTeX: table* tabulary width=\textwidth
10018 @node Images in LaTeX export, Beamer class export, Tables in LaTeX export, LaTeX and PDF export
10019 @subsection Images in @LaTeX{} export
10020 @cindex images, inline in @LaTeX{}
10021 @cindex inlining images in @LaTeX{}
10023 Images that are linked to without a description part in the link, like
10024 @samp{[[file:img.jpg]]} or @samp{[[./img.jpg]]} will be inserted into the PDF
10025 output file resulting from @LaTeX{} processing. Org will use an
10026 @code{\includegraphics} macro to insert the image. If you have specified a
10027 caption and/or a label as described in @ref{Images and tables}, the figure
10028 will be wrapped into a @code{figure} environment and thus become a floating
10029 element. You can use an @code{#+ATTR_LaTeX:} line to specify the various
10030 options that can be used in the optional argument of the
10031 @code{\includegraphics} macro. To modify the placement option of the
10032 @code{figure} environment, add something like @samp{placement=[h!]} to the
10035 If you would like to let text flow around the image, add the word @samp{wrap}
10036 to the @code{#+ATTR_LaTeX:} line, which will make the figure occupy the left
10037 half of the page. To fine-tune, the @code{placement} field will be the set
10038 of additional arguments needed by the @code{wrapfigure} environment. Note
10039 that if you change the size of the image, you need to use compatible settings
10040 for @code{\includegraphics} and @code{wrapfigure}.
10044 @cindex #+ATTR_LaTeX
10046 #+CAPTION: The black-body emission of the disk around HR 4049
10047 #+LABEL: fig:SED-HR4049
10048 #+ATTR_LaTeX: width=5cm,angle=90
10049 [[./img/sed-hr4049.pdf]]
10051 #+ATTR_LaTeX: width=0.38\textwidth wrap placement=@{r@}@{0.4\textwidth@}
10055 If you need references to a label created in this way, write
10056 @samp{\ref@{fig:SED-HR4049@}} just like in @LaTeX{}.
10058 @node Beamer class export, , Images in LaTeX export, LaTeX and PDF export
10059 @subsection Beamer class export
10061 The LaTeX class @file{beamer} allows production of high quality presentations
10062 using LaTeX and pdf processing. Org-mode has special support for turning an
10063 Org-mode file or tree into a @file{beamer} presentation.
10065 When the LaTeX class for the current buffer (as set with @code{#+LaTeX_CLASS:
10066 beamer}) or subtree (set with a @code{LaTeX_CLASS} property) is
10067 @code{beamer}, a special export mode will turn the file or tree into a beamer
10068 presentation. Any tree with not-too-deep level nesting should in principle be
10069 exportable as a beamer presentation. By default, the top-level entries (or
10070 the first level below the selected subtree heading) will be turned into
10071 frames, and the outline structure below this level will become itemize lists.
10072 You can also configure the variable @code{org-beamer-frame-level} to a
10073 different level---then the hierarchy above frames will produce the sectioning
10074 structure of the presentation.
10076 A template for useful in-buffer settings or properties can be inserted into
10077 the buffer with @kbd{M-x org-insert-beamer-options-template}. Among other
10078 things, this will install a column view format which is very handy for
10079 editing special properties used by beamer.
10081 You can influence the structure of the presentation using the following
10086 The environment that should be used to format this entry. Valid environments
10087 are defined in the constant @code{org-beamer-environments-default}, and you
10088 can define more in @code{org-beamer-environments-extra}. If this property is
10089 set, the entry will also get a @code{:B_environment:} tag to make this
10090 visible. This tag has no semantic meaning, it is only a visual aid.
10091 @item BEAMER_envargs
10092 The beamer-special arguments that should be used for the environment, like
10093 @code{[t]} or @code{[<+->]} of @code{<2-3>}. If the @code{BEAMER_col}
10094 property is also set, something like @code{C[t]} can be added here as well to
10095 set an options argument for the implied @code{columns} environment.
10096 @code{c[t]} or @code{c<2->} will set an options for the implied @code{column}
10099 The width of a column that should start with this entry. If this property is
10100 set, the entry will also get a @code{:BMCOL:} property to make this visible.
10101 Also this tag is only a visual aid. When this is a plain number, it will be
10102 interpreted as a fraction of @code{\textwidth}. Otherwise it will be assumed
10103 that you have specified the units, like @samp{3cm}. The first such property
10104 in a frame will start a @code{columns} environment to surround the columns.
10105 This environment is closed when an entry has a @code{BEAMER_col} property
10106 with value 0 or 1, or automatically at the end of the frame.
10108 Additional commands that should be inserted after the environment has been
10109 opened. For example, when creating a frame, this can be used to specify
10113 Frames will automatically receive a @code{fragile} option if they contain
10114 source code that uses the verbatim environment. Special @file{beamer}
10115 specific code can be inserted using @code{#+BEAMER:} and
10116 @code{#+BEGIN_beamer...#+end_beamer} constructs, similar to other export
10117 backends, but with the difference that @code{#+LaTeX:} stuff will be included
10118 in the presentation as well.
10120 Outline nodes with @code{BEAMER_env} property value @samp{note} or
10121 @samp{noteNH} will be formatted as beamer notes, i,e, they will be wrapped
10122 into @code{\note@{...@}}. The former will include the heading as part of the
10123 note text, the latter will ignore the heading of that node. To simplify note
10124 generation, it is actually enough to mark the note with a @emph{tag} (either
10125 @code{:B_note:} or @code{:B_noteNH:}) instead of creating the
10126 @code{BEAMER_env} property.
10128 You can turn on a special minor mode @code{org-beamer-mode} for editing
10136 @orgcmd{C-c C-b,org-beamer-select-environment}
10137 In @code{org-beamer-mode}, this key offers fast selection of a beamer
10138 environment or the @code{BEAMER_col} property.
10141 Column view provides a great way to set the environment of a node and other
10142 important parameters. Make sure you are using a COLUMN format that is geared
10143 toward this special purpose. The command @kbd{M-x
10144 org-insert-beamer-options-template} defines such a format.
10146 Here is a simple example Org document that is intended for beamer export.
10149 #+LaTeX_CLASS: beamer
10150 #+TITLE: Example Presentation
10151 #+AUTHOR: Carsten Dominik
10152 #+LaTeX_CLASS_OPTIONS: [presentation]
10153 #+BEAMER_FRAME_LEVEL: 2
10154 #+BEAMER_HEADER_EXTRA: \usetheme@{Madrid@}\usecolortheme@{default@}
10155 #+COLUMNS: %35ITEM %10BEAMER_env(Env) %10BEAMER_envargs(Args) %4BEAMER_col(Col) %8BEAMER_extra(Ex)
10157 * This is the first structural section
10159 ** Frame 1 \\ with a subtitle
10160 *** Thanks to Eric Fraga :BMCOL:B_block:
10163 :BEAMER_envargs: C[t]
10166 for the first viable beamer setup in Org
10167 *** Thanks to everyone else :BMCOL:B_block:
10171 :BEAMER_envargs: <2->
10173 for contributing to the discussion
10174 **** This will be formatted as a beamer note :B_note:
10175 ** Frame 2 \\ where we will not use columns
10176 *** Request :B_block:
10177 Please test this stuff!
10183 For more information, see the documentation on Worg.
10185 @node DocBook export, TaskJuggler export, LaTeX and PDF export, Exporting
10186 @section DocBook export
10187 @cindex DocBook export
10189 @cindex Cui, Baoqiu
10191 Org contains a DocBook exporter written by Baoqiu Cui. Once an Org file is
10192 exported to DocBook format, it can be further processed to produce other
10193 formats, including PDF, HTML, man pages, etc., using many available DocBook
10194 tools and stylesheets.
10196 Currently DocBook exporter only supports DocBook V5.0.
10199 * DocBook export commands:: How to invoke DocBook export
10200 * Quoting DocBook code:: Incorporating DocBook code in Org files
10201 * Recursive sections:: Recursive sections in DocBook
10202 * Tables in DocBook export:: Tables are exported as HTML tables
10203 * Images in DocBook export:: How to insert figures into DocBook output
10204 * Special characters:: How to handle special characters
10207 @node DocBook export commands, Quoting DocBook code, DocBook export, DocBook export
10208 @subsection DocBook export commands
10210 @cindex region, active
10211 @cindex active region
10212 @cindex transient-mark-mode
10214 @orgcmd{C-c C-e D,org-export-as-docbook}
10215 @cindex property EXPORT_FILE_NAME
10216 Export as DocBook file. For an Org file, @file{myfile.org}, the DocBook XML
10217 file will be @file{myfile.xml}. The file will be overwritten without
10218 warning. If there is an active region@footnote{This requires
10219 @code{transient-mark-mode} to be turned on}, only the region will be
10220 exported. If the selected region is a single tree@footnote{To select the
10221 current subtree, use @kbd{C-c @@}.}, the tree head will become the document
10222 title. If the tree head entry has, or inherits, an @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME}
10223 property, that name will be used for the export.
10224 @orgcmd{C-c C-e V,org-export-as-docbook-pdf-and-open}
10225 Export as DocBook file, process to PDF, then open the resulting PDF file.
10227 @vindex org-export-docbook-xslt-proc-command
10228 @vindex org-export-docbook-xsl-fo-proc-command
10229 Note that, in order to produce PDF output based on exported DocBook file, you
10230 need to have XSLT processor and XSL-FO processor software installed on your
10231 system. Check variables @code{org-export-docbook-xslt-proc-command} and
10232 @code{org-export-docbook-xsl-fo-proc-command}.
10234 @vindex org-export-docbook-xslt-stylesheet
10235 The stylesheet argument @code{%s} in variable
10236 @code{org-export-docbook-xslt-proc-command} is replaced by the value of
10237 variable @code{org-export-docbook-xslt-stylesheet}, which needs to be set by
10238 the user. You can also overrule this global setting on a per-file basis by
10239 adding an in-buffer setting @code{#+XSLT:} to the Org file.
10241 @orgkey{C-c C-e v D}
10242 Export only the visible part of the document.
10245 @node Quoting DocBook code, Recursive sections, DocBook export commands, DocBook export
10246 @subsection Quoting DocBook code
10248 You can quote DocBook code in Org files and copy it verbatim into exported
10249 DocBook file with the following constructs:
10252 @cindex #+BEGIN_DOCBOOK
10254 #+DOCBOOK: Literal DocBook code for export
10258 @cindex #+BEGIN_DOCBOOK
10262 All lines between these markers are exported by DocBook exporter
10267 For example, you can use the following lines to include a DocBook warning
10268 admonition. As to what this warning says, you should pay attention to the
10269 document context when quoting DocBook code in Org files. You may make
10270 exported DocBook XML files invalid by not quoting DocBook code correctly.
10275 <para>You should know what you are doing when quoting DocBook XML code
10276 in your Org file. Invalid DocBook XML may be generated by
10277 DocBook exporter if you are not careful!</para>
10282 @node Recursive sections, Tables in DocBook export, Quoting DocBook code, DocBook export
10283 @subsection Recursive sections
10284 @cindex DocBook recursive sections
10286 DocBook exporter exports Org files as articles using the @code{article}
10287 element in DocBook. Recursive sections, i.e. @code{section} elements, are
10288 used in exported articles. Top level headlines in Org files are exported as
10289 top level sections, and lower level headlines are exported as nested
10290 sections. The entire structure of Org files will be exported completely, no
10291 matter how many nested levels of headlines there are.
10293 Using recursive sections makes it easy to port and reuse exported DocBook
10294 code in other DocBook document types like @code{book} or @code{set}.
10296 @node Tables in DocBook export, Images in DocBook export, Recursive sections, DocBook export
10297 @subsection Tables in DocBook export
10298 @cindex tables, in DocBook export
10300 Tables in Org files are exported as HTML tables, which have been supported since
10303 If a table does not have a caption, an informal table is generated using the
10304 @code{informaltable} element; otherwise, a formal table will be generated
10305 using the @code{table} element.
10307 @node Images in DocBook export, Special characters, Tables in DocBook export, DocBook export
10308 @subsection Images in DocBook export
10309 @cindex images, inline in DocBook
10310 @cindex inlining images in DocBook
10312 Images that are linked to without a description part in the link, like
10313 @samp{[[file:img.jpg]]} or @samp{[[./img.jpg]]}, will be exported to DocBook
10314 using @code{mediaobject} elements. Each @code{mediaobject} element contains
10315 an @code{imageobject} that wraps an @code{imagedata} element. If you have
10316 specified a caption for an image as described in @ref{Images and tables}, a
10317 @code{caption} element will be added in @code{mediaobject}. If a label is
10318 also specified, it will be exported as an @code{xml:id} attribute of the
10319 @code{mediaobject} element.
10321 @vindex org-export-docbook-default-image-attributes
10322 Image attributes supported by the @code{imagedata} element, like @code{align}
10323 or @code{width}, can be specified in two ways: you can either customize
10324 variable @code{org-export-docbook-default-image-attributes} or use the
10325 @code{#+ATTR_DOCBOOK:} line. Attributes specified in variable
10326 @code{org-export-docbook-default-image-attributes} are applied to all inline
10327 images in the Org file to be exported (unless they are overridden by image
10328 attributes specified in @code{#+ATTR_DOCBOOK:} lines).
10330 The @code{#+ATTR_DOCBOOK:} line can be used to specify additional image
10331 attributes or override default image attributes for individual images. If
10332 the same attribute appears in both the @code{#+ATTR_DOCBOOK:} line and
10333 variable @code{org-export-docbook-default-image-attributes}, the former
10334 takes precedence. Here is an example about how image attributes can be
10339 @cindex #+ATTR_DOCBOOK
10341 #+CAPTION: The logo of Org-mode
10342 #+LABEL: unicorn-svg
10343 #+ATTR_DOCBOOK: scalefit="1" width="100%" depth="100%"
10344 [[./img/org-mode-unicorn.svg]]
10347 @vindex org-export-docbook-inline-image-extensions
10348 By default, DocBook exporter recognizes the following image file types:
10349 @file{jpeg}, @file{jpg}, @file{png}, @file{gif}, and @file{svg}. You can
10350 customize variable @code{org-export-docbook-inline-image-extensions} to add
10351 more types to this list as long as DocBook supports them.
10353 @node Special characters, , Images in DocBook export, DocBook export
10354 @subsection Special characters in DocBook export
10355 @cindex Special characters in DocBook export
10357 @vindex org-export-docbook-doctype
10358 @vindex org-entities
10359 Special characters that are written in @TeX{}-like syntax, such as @code{\alpha},
10360 @code{\Gamma}, and @code{\Zeta}, are supported by DocBook exporter. These
10361 characters are rewritten to XML entities, like @code{α},
10362 @code{Γ}, and @code{Ζ}, based on the list saved in variable
10363 @code{org-entities}. As long as the generated DocBook file includes the
10364 corresponding entities, these special characters are recognized.
10366 You can customize variable @code{org-export-docbook-doctype} to include the
10367 entities you need. For example, you can set variable
10368 @code{org-export-docbook-doctype} to the following value to recognize all
10369 special characters included in XHTML entities:
10372 "<!DOCTYPE article [
10373 <!ENTITY % xhtml1-symbol PUBLIC
10374 \"-//W3C//ENTITIES Symbol for HTML//EN//XML\"
10375 \"http://www.w3.org/2003/entities/2007/xhtml1-symbol.ent\"
10382 @node TaskJuggler export, Freemind export, DocBook export, Exporting
10383 @section TaskJuggler export
10384 @cindex TaskJuggler export
10385 @cindex Project management
10387 @uref{http://www.taskjuggler.org/, TaskJuggler} is a project management tool.
10388 It provides an optimizing scheduler that computes your project time lines and
10389 resource assignments based on the project outline and the constraints that
10392 The TaskJuggler exporter is a bit different from other exporters, such as the
10393 HTML and LaTeX exporters for example, in that it does not export all the
10394 nodes of a document or strictly follow the order of the nodes in the
10397 Instead the TaskJuggler exporter looks for a tree that defines the tasks and
10398 a optionally tree that defines the resources for this project. It then
10399 creates a TaskJuggler file based on these trees and the attributes defined in
10402 @subsection TaskJuggler export commands
10405 @orgcmd{C-c C-e j,org-export-as-taskjuggler}
10406 Export as TaskJuggler file.
10408 @orgcmd{C-c C-e J,org-export-as-taskjuggler-and-open}
10409 Export as TaskJuggler file and then open the file with TaskJugglerUI.
10414 @vindex org-export-taskjuggler-project-tag
10415 Create your tasks as you usually do with Org-mode. Assign efforts to each
10416 task using properties (it's easiest to do this in the column view). You
10417 should end up with something similar to the example by Peter Jones in
10418 @url{http://www.contextualdevelopment.com/static/artifacts/articles/2008/project-planning/project-planning.org}.
10419 Now mark the top node of your tasks with a tag named
10420 @code{:taskjuggler_project:} (or whatever you customized
10421 @code{org-export-taskjuggler-project-tag} to). You are now ready to export
10422 the project plan with @kbd{C-c C-e J} which will export the project plan and
10423 open a gantt chart in TaskJugglerUI.
10425 @subsection Resources
10427 @vindex org-export-taskjuggler-resource-tag
10428 Next you can define resources and assign those to work on specific tasks. You
10429 can group your resources hierarchically. Tag the top node of the resources
10430 with @code{:taskjuggler_resource:} (or whatever you customized
10431 @code{org-export-taskjuggler-resource-tag} to). You can optionally assign an
10432 identifier (named @samp{resource_id}) to the resources (using the standard
10433 Org properties commands, @pxref{Property syntax}) or you can let the exporter
10434 generate identifiers automatically (the exporter picks the first word of the
10435 headline as the identifier as long as it is unique---see the documentation of
10436 @code{org-taskjuggler-get-unique-id}). Using that identifier you can then
10437 allocate resources to tasks. This is again done with the @samp{allocate}
10438 property on the tasks. Do this in column view or when on the task type
10439 @kbd{C-c C-x p allocate @key{RET} <resource_id> @key{RET}}.
10441 Once the allocations are done you can again export to TaskJuggler and check
10442 in the Resource Allocation Graph which person is working on what task at what
10445 @subsection Export of properties
10447 The exporter also takes TODO state information into consideration, i.e. if a
10448 task is marked as done it will have the corresponding attribute in
10449 TaskJuggler (@samp{complete 100}). Also it will export any property on a task
10450 resource or resource node which is known to TaskJuggler, such as
10451 @samp{limits}, @samp{vacation}, @samp{shift}, @samp{booking},
10452 @samp{efficiency}, @samp{journalentry}, @samp{rate} for resources or
10453 @samp{account}, @samp{start}, @samp{note}, @samp{duration}, @samp{end},
10454 @samp{journalentry}, @samp{milestone}, @samp{reference}, @samp{responsible},
10455 @samp{scheduling}, etc for tasks.
10457 @subsection Dependencies
10459 The exporter will handle dependencies that are defined in the tasks either
10460 with the @samp{ORDERED} attribute (@pxref{TODO dependencies}), with the
10461 @samp{BLOCKER} attribute (see @file{org-depend.el}) or alternatively with a
10462 @samp{depends} attribute. Both the @samp{BLOCKER} and the @samp{depends}
10463 attribute can be either @samp{previous-sibling} or a reference to an
10464 identifier (named @samp{task_id}) which is defined for another task in the
10465 project. @samp{BLOCKER} and the @samp{depends} attribute can define multiple
10466 dependencies separated by either space or comma. You can also specify
10467 optional attributes on the dependency by simply appending it. The following
10468 examples should illustrate this:
10473 :task_id: preparation
10476 * Training material
10478 :task_id: training_material
10481 ** Markup Guidelines
10485 ** Workflow Guidelines
10492 :BLOCKER: training_material @{ gapduration 1d @} preparation
10496 @subsection Reports
10498 @vindex org-export-taskjuggler-default-reports
10499 TaskJuggler can produce many kinds of reports (e.g. gantt chart, resource
10500 allocation, etc). The user defines what kind of reports should be generated
10501 for a project in the TaskJuggler file. The exporter will automatically insert
10502 some default reports in the file. These defaults are defined in
10503 @code{org-export-taskjuggler-default-reports}. They can be modified using
10504 customize along with a number of other options. For a more complete list, see
10505 @kbd{M-x customize-group @key{RET} org-export-taskjuggler @key{RET}}.
10507 For more information and examples see the Org-taskjuggler tutorial at
10508 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-tutorials/org-taskjuggler.php}.
10510 @node Freemind export, XOXO export, TaskJuggler export, Exporting
10511 @section Freemind export
10512 @cindex Freemind export
10515 The Freemind exporter was written by Lennart Borgman.
10518 @orgcmd{C-c C-e m,org-export-as-freemind}
10519 Export as Freemind mind map @file{myfile.mm}.
10522 @node XOXO export, iCalendar export, Freemind export, Exporting
10523 @section XOXO export
10524 @cindex XOXO export
10526 Org-mode contains an exporter that produces XOXO-style output.
10527 Currently, this exporter only handles the general outline structure and
10528 does not interpret any additional Org-mode features.
10531 @orgcmd{C-c C-e x,org-export-as-xoxo}
10532 Export as XOXO file @file{myfile.html}.
10533 @orgkey{C-c C-e v x}
10534 Export only the visible part of the document.
10537 @node iCalendar export, , XOXO export, Exporting
10538 @section iCalendar export
10539 @cindex iCalendar export
10541 @vindex org-icalendar-include-todo
10542 @vindex org-icalendar-use-deadline
10543 @vindex org-icalendar-use-scheduled
10544 @vindex org-icalendar-categories
10545 @vindex org-icalendar-alarm-time
10546 Some people use Org-mode for keeping track of projects, but still prefer a
10547 standard calendar application for anniversaries and appointments. In this
10548 case it can be useful to show deadlines and other time-stamped items in Org
10549 files in the calendar application. Org-mode can export calendar information
10550 in the standard iCalendar format. If you also want to have TODO entries
10551 included in the export, configure the variable
10552 @code{org-icalendar-include-todo}. Plain timestamps are exported as VEVENT,
10553 and TODO items as VTODO. It will also create events from deadlines that are
10554 in non-TODO items. Deadlines and scheduling dates in TODO items will be used
10555 to set the start and due dates for the TODO entry@footnote{See the variables
10556 @code{org-icalendar-use-deadline} and @code{org-icalendar-use-scheduled}.}.
10557 As categories, it will use the tags locally defined in the heading, and the
10558 file/tree category@footnote{To add inherited tags or the TODO state,
10559 configure the variable @code{org-icalendar-categories}.}. See the variable
10560 @code{org-icalendar-alarm-time} for a way to assign alarms to entries with a
10563 @vindex org-icalendar-store-UID
10564 @cindex property, ID
10565 The iCalendar standard requires each entry to have a globally unique
10566 identifier (UID). Org creates these identifiers during export. If you set
10567 the variable @code{org-icalendar-store-UID}, the UID will be stored in the
10568 @code{:ID:} property of the entry and re-used next time you report this
10569 entry. Since a single entry can give rise to multiple iCalendar entries (as
10570 a timestamp, a deadline, a scheduled item, and as a TODO item), Org adds
10571 prefixes to the UID, depending on what triggered the inclusion of the entry.
10572 In this way the UID remains unique, but a synchronization program can still
10573 figure out from which entry all the different instances originate.
10576 @orgcmd{C-c C-e i,org-export-icalendar-this-file}
10577 Create iCalendar entries for the current file and store them in the same
10578 directory, using a file extension @file{.ics}.
10579 @orgcmd{C-c C-e I, org-export-icalendar-all-agenda-files}
10580 @vindex org-agenda-files
10581 Like @kbd{C-c C-e i}, but do this for all files in
10582 @code{org-agenda-files}. For each of these files, a separate iCalendar
10583 file will be written.
10584 @orgcmd{C-c C-e c,org-export-icalendar-combine-agenda-files}
10585 @vindex org-combined-agenda-icalendar-file
10586 Create a single large iCalendar file from all files in
10587 @code{org-agenda-files} and write it to the file given by
10588 @code{org-combined-agenda-icalendar-file}.
10591 @vindex org-use-property-inheritance
10592 @vindex org-icalendar-include-body
10593 @cindex property, SUMMARY
10594 @cindex property, DESCRIPTION
10595 @cindex property, LOCATION
10596 The export will honor SUMMARY, DESCRIPTION and LOCATION@footnote{The LOCATION
10597 property can be inherited from higher in the hierarchy if you configure
10598 @code{org-use-property-inheritance} accordingly.} properties if the selected
10599 entries have them. If not, the summary will be derived from the headline,
10600 and the description from the body (limited to
10601 @code{org-icalendar-include-body} characters).
10603 How this calendar is best read and updated, depends on the application
10604 you are using. The FAQ covers this issue.
10606 @node Publishing, Working With Source Code, Exporting, Top
10607 @chapter Publishing
10610 Org includes a publishing management system that allows you to configure
10611 automatic HTML conversion of @emph{projects} composed of interlinked org
10612 files. You can also configure Org to automatically upload your exported HTML
10613 pages and related attachments, such as images and source code files, to a web
10616 You can also use Org to convert files into PDF, or even combine HTML and PDF
10617 conversion so that files are available in both formats on the server.
10619 Publishing has been contributed to Org by David O'Toole.
10622 * Configuration:: Defining projects
10623 * Uploading files:: How to get files up on the server
10624 * Sample configuration:: Example projects
10625 * Triggering publication:: Publication commands
10628 @node Configuration, Uploading files, Publishing, Publishing
10629 @section Configuration
10631 Publishing needs significant configuration to specify files, destination
10632 and many other properties of a project.
10635 * Project alist:: The central configuration variable
10636 * Sources and destinations:: From here to there
10637 * Selecting files:: What files are part of the project?
10638 * Publishing action:: Setting the function doing the publishing
10639 * Publishing options:: Tweaking HTML export
10640 * Publishing links:: Which links keep working after publishing?
10641 * Sitemap:: Generating a list of all pages
10642 * Generating an index:: An index that reaches across pages
10645 @node Project alist, Sources and destinations, Configuration, Configuration
10646 @subsection The variable @code{org-publish-project-alist}
10647 @cindex org-publish-project-alist
10648 @cindex projects, for publishing
10650 @vindex org-publish-project-alist
10651 Publishing is configured almost entirely through setting the value of one
10652 variable, called @code{org-publish-project-alist}. Each element of the list
10653 configures one project, and may be in one of the two following forms:
10656 ("project-name" :property value :property value ...)
10657 @r{i.e. a well-formed property list with alternating keys and values}
10659 ("project-name" :components ("project-name" "project-name" ...))
10663 In both cases, projects are configured by specifying property values. A
10664 project defines the set of files that will be published, as well as the
10665 publishing configuration to use when publishing those files. When a project
10666 takes the second form listed above, the individual members of the
10667 @code{:components} property are taken to be sub-projects, which group
10668 together files requiring different publishing options. When you publish such
10669 a ``meta-project'', all the components will also be published, in the
10672 @node Sources and destinations, Selecting files, Project alist, Configuration
10673 @subsection Sources and destinations for files
10674 @cindex directories, for publishing
10676 Most properties are optional, but some should always be set. In
10677 particular, Org needs to know where to look for source files,
10678 and where to put published files.
10680 @multitable @columnfractions 0.3 0.7
10681 @item @code{:base-directory}
10682 @tab Directory containing publishing source files
10683 @item @code{:publishing-directory}
10684 @tab Directory where output files will be published. You can directly
10685 publish to a webserver using a file name syntax appropriate for
10686 the Emacs @file{tramp} package. Or you can publish to a local directory and
10687 use external tools to upload your website (@pxref{Uploading files}).
10688 @item @code{:preparation-function}
10689 @tab Function or list of functions to be called before starting the
10690 publishing process, for example, to run @code{make} for updating files to be
10691 published. The project property list is scoped into this call as the
10692 variable @code{project-plist}.
10693 @item @code{:completion-function}
10694 @tab Function or list of functions called after finishing the publishing
10695 process, for example, to change permissions of the resulting files. The
10696 project property list is scoped into this call as the variable
10697 @code{project-plist}.
10701 @node Selecting files, Publishing action, Sources and destinations, Configuration
10702 @subsection Selecting files
10703 @cindex files, selecting for publishing
10705 By default, all files with extension @file{.org} in the base directory
10706 are considered part of the project. This can be modified by setting the
10708 @multitable @columnfractions 0.25 0.75
10709 @item @code{:base-extension}
10710 @tab Extension (without the dot!) of source files. This actually is a
10711 regular expression. Set this to the symbol @code{any} if you want to get all
10712 files in @code{:base-directory}, even without extension.
10714 @item @code{:exclude}
10715 @tab Regular expression to match file names that should not be
10716 published, even though they have been selected on the basis of their
10719 @item @code{:include}
10720 @tab List of files to be included regardless of @code{:base-extension}
10721 and @code{:exclude}.
10723 @item @code{:recursive}
10724 @tab Non-nil means, check base-directory recursively for files to publish.
10727 @node Publishing action, Publishing options, Selecting files, Configuration
10728 @subsection Publishing action
10729 @cindex action, for publishing
10731 Publishing means that a file is copied to the destination directory and
10732 possibly transformed in the process. The default transformation is to export
10733 Org files as HTML files, and this is done by the function
10734 @code{org-publish-org-to-html} which calls the HTML exporter (@pxref{HTML
10735 export}). But you also can publish your content as PDF files using
10736 @code{org-publish-org-to-pdf}, or as @code{ascii}, @code{latin1} or
10737 @code{utf8} encoded files using the corresponding functions. If you want to
10738 publish the Org file itself, but with @i{archived}, @i{commented}, and
10739 @i{tag-excluded} trees removed, use @code{org-publish-org-to-org} and set the
10740 parameters @code{:plain-source} and/or @code{:htmlized-source}. This will
10741 produce @file{file.org} and @file{file.org.html} in the publishing
10742 directory@footnote{@file{file-source.org} and @file{file-source.org.html} if
10743 source and publishing directories are equal. Note that with this kind of
10744 setup, you need to add @code{:exclude "-source\\.org"} to the project
10745 definition in @code{org-publish-project-alist} to prevent the published
10746 source files from being considered as new org files the next time the project
10747 is published.}. Other files like images only need to be copied to the
10748 publishing destination; for this you may use @code{org-publish-attachment}.
10749 For non-Org files, you always need to specify the publishing function:
10751 @multitable @columnfractions 0.3 0.7
10752 @item @code{:publishing-function}
10753 @tab Function executing the publication of a file. This may also be a
10754 list of functions, which will all be called in turn.
10755 @item @code{:plain-source}
10756 @tab Non-nil means, publish plain source.
10757 @item @code{:htmlized-source}
10758 @tab Non-nil means, publish htmlized source.
10761 The function must accept three arguments: a property list containing at least
10762 a @code{:publishing-directory} property, the name of the file to be
10763 published, and the path to the publishing directory of the output file. It
10764 should take the specified file, make the necessary transformation (if any)
10765 and place the result into the destination folder.
10767 @node Publishing options, Publishing links, Publishing action, Configuration
10768 @subsection Options for the HTML/@LaTeX{} exporters
10769 @cindex options, for publishing
10771 The property list can be used to set many export options for the HTML
10772 and @LaTeX{} exporters. In most cases, these properties correspond to user
10773 variables in Org. The table below lists these properties along
10774 with the variable they belong to. See the documentation string for the
10775 respective variable for details.
10777 @vindex org-export-html-link-up
10778 @vindex org-export-html-link-home
10779 @vindex org-export-default-language
10780 @vindex org-display-custom-times
10781 @vindex org-export-headline-levels
10782 @vindex org-export-with-section-numbers
10783 @vindex org-export-section-number-format
10784 @vindex org-export-with-toc
10785 @vindex org-export-preserve-breaks
10786 @vindex org-export-with-archived-trees
10787 @vindex org-export-with-emphasize
10788 @vindex org-export-with-sub-superscripts
10789 @vindex org-export-with-special-strings
10790 @vindex org-export-with-footnotes
10791 @vindex org-export-with-drawers
10792 @vindex org-export-with-tags
10793 @vindex org-export-with-todo-keywords
10794 @vindex org-export-with-priority
10795 @vindex org-export-with-TeX-macros
10796 @vindex org-export-with-LaTeX-fragments
10797 @vindex org-export-skip-text-before-1st-heading
10798 @vindex org-export-with-fixed-width
10799 @vindex org-export-with-timestamps
10800 @vindex org-export-author-info
10801 @vindex org-export-email
10802 @vindex org-export-creator-info
10803 @vindex org-export-with-tables
10804 @vindex org-export-highlight-first-table-line
10805 @vindex org-export-html-style-include-default
10806 @vindex org-export-html-style
10807 @vindex org-export-html-style-extra
10808 @vindex org-export-html-link-org-files-as-html
10809 @vindex org-export-html-inline-images
10810 @vindex org-export-html-extension
10811 @vindex org-export-html-table-tag
10812 @vindex org-export-html-expand
10813 @vindex org-export-html-with-timestamp
10814 @vindex org-export-publishing-directory
10815 @vindex org-export-html-preamble
10816 @vindex org-export-html-postamble
10817 @vindex org-export-html-auto-preamble
10818 @vindex org-export-html-auto-postamble
10819 @vindex user-full-name
10820 @vindex user-mail-address
10821 @vindex org-export-select-tags
10822 @vindex org-export-exclude-tags
10824 @multitable @columnfractions 0.32 0.68
10825 @item @code{:link-up} @tab @code{org-export-html-link-up}
10826 @item @code{:link-home} @tab @code{org-export-html-link-home}
10827 @item @code{:language} @tab @code{org-export-default-language}
10828 @item @code{:customtime} @tab @code{org-display-custom-times}
10829 @item @code{:headline-levels} @tab @code{org-export-headline-levels}
10830 @item @code{:section-numbers} @tab @code{org-export-with-section-numbers}
10831 @item @code{:section-number-format} @tab @code{org-export-section-number-format}
10832 @item @code{:table-of-contents} @tab @code{org-export-with-toc}
10833 @item @code{:preserve-breaks} @tab @code{org-export-preserve-breaks}
10834 @item @code{:archived-trees} @tab @code{org-export-with-archived-trees}
10835 @item @code{:emphasize} @tab @code{org-export-with-emphasize}
10836 @item @code{:sub-superscript} @tab @code{org-export-with-sub-superscripts}
10837 @item @code{:special-strings} @tab @code{org-export-with-special-strings}
10838 @item @code{:footnotes} @tab @code{org-export-with-footnotes}
10839 @item @code{:drawers} @tab @code{org-export-with-drawers}
10840 @item @code{:tags} @tab @code{org-export-with-tags}
10841 @item @code{:todo-keywords} @tab @code{org-export-with-todo-keywords}
10842 @item @code{:priority} @tab @code{org-export-with-priority}
10843 @item @code{:TeX-macros} @tab @code{org-export-with-TeX-macros}
10844 @item @code{:LaTeX-fragments} @tab @code{org-export-with-LaTeX-fragments}
10845 @item @code{:latex-listings} @tab @code{org-export-latex-listings}
10846 @item @code{:skip-before-1st-heading} @tab @code{org-export-skip-text-before-1st-heading}
10847 @item @code{:fixed-width} @tab @code{org-export-with-fixed-width}
10848 @item @code{:timestamps} @tab @code{org-export-with-timestamps}
10849 @item @code{:author-info} @tab @code{org-export-author-info}
10850 @item @code{:email-info} @tab @code{org-export-email-info}
10851 @item @code{:creator-info} @tab @code{org-export-creator-info}
10852 @item @code{:tables} @tab @code{org-export-with-tables}
10853 @item @code{:table-auto-headline} @tab @code{org-export-highlight-first-table-line}
10854 @item @code{:style-include-default} @tab @code{org-export-html-style-include-default}
10855 @item @code{:style} @tab @code{org-export-html-style}
10856 @item @code{:style-extra} @tab @code{org-export-html-style-extra}
10857 @item @code{:convert-org-links} @tab @code{org-export-html-link-org-files-as-html}
10858 @item @code{:inline-images} @tab @code{org-export-html-inline-images}
10859 @item @code{:html-extension} @tab @code{org-export-html-extension}
10860 @item @code{:xml-declaration} @tab @code{org-export-html-xml-declaration}
10861 @item @code{:html-table-tag} @tab @code{org-export-html-table-tag}
10862 @item @code{:expand-quoted-html} @tab @code{org-export-html-expand}
10863 @item @code{:timestamp} @tab @code{org-export-html-with-timestamp}
10864 @item @code{:publishing-directory} @tab @code{org-export-publishing-directory}
10865 @item @code{:preamble} @tab @code{org-export-html-preamble}
10866 @item @code{:postamble} @tab @code{org-export-html-postamble}
10867 @item @code{:auto-preamble} @tab @code{org-export-html-auto-preamble}
10868 @item @code{:auto-postamble} @tab @code{org-export-html-auto-postamble}
10869 @item @code{:author} @tab @code{user-full-name}
10870 @item @code{:email} @tab @code{user-mail-address} : @code{addr;addr;..}
10871 @item @code{:select-tags} @tab @code{org-export-select-tags}
10872 @item @code{:exclude-tags} @tab @code{org-export-exclude-tags}
10873 @item @code{:latex-image-options} @tab @code{org-export-latex-image-default-option}
10876 Most of the @code{org-export-with-*} variables have the same effect in
10877 both HTML and @LaTeX{} exporters, except for @code{:TeX-macros} and
10878 @code{:LaTeX-fragments}, respectively @code{nil} and @code{t} in the
10881 @vindex org-publish-project-alist
10882 When a property is given a value in @code{org-publish-project-alist},
10883 its setting overrides the value of the corresponding user variable (if
10884 any) during publishing. Options set within a file (@pxref{Export
10885 options}), however, override everything.
10887 @node Publishing links, Sitemap, Publishing options, Configuration
10888 @subsection Links between published files
10889 @cindex links, publishing
10891 To create a link from one Org file to another, you would use
10892 something like @samp{[[file:foo.org][The foo]]} or simply
10893 @samp{file:foo.org.} (@pxref{Hyperlinks}). When published, this link
10894 becomes a link to @file{foo.html}. In this way, you can interlink the
10895 pages of your "org web" project and the links will work as expected when
10896 you publish them to HTML. If you also publish the Org source file and want
10897 to link to that, use an @code{http:} link instead of a @code{file:} link,
10898 because @code{file:} links are converted to link to the corresponding
10901 You may also link to related files, such as images. Provided you are careful
10902 with relative file names, and provided you have also configured Org to upload
10903 the related files, these links will work too. See @ref{Complex example}, for
10904 an example of this usage.
10906 Sometimes an Org file to be published may contain links that are
10907 only valid in your production environment, but not in the publishing
10908 location. In this case, use the property
10910 @multitable @columnfractions 0.4 0.6
10911 @item @code{:link-validation-function}
10912 @tab Function to validate links
10916 to define a function for checking link validity. This function must
10917 accept two arguments, the file name and a directory relative to which
10918 the file name is interpreted in the production environment. If this
10919 function returns @code{nil}, then the HTML generator will only insert a
10920 description into the HTML file, but no link. One option for this
10921 function is @code{org-publish-validate-link} which checks if the given
10922 file is part of any project in @code{org-publish-project-alist}.
10924 @node Sitemap, Generating an index, Publishing links, Configuration
10925 @subsection Generating a sitemap
10926 @cindex sitemap, of published pages
10928 The following properties may be used to control publishing of
10929 a map of files for a given project.
10931 @multitable @columnfractions 0.35 0.65
10932 @item @code{:auto-sitemap}
10933 @tab When non-nil, publish a sitemap during @code{org-publish-current-project}
10934 or @code{org-publish-all}.
10936 @item @code{:sitemap-filename}
10937 @tab Filename for output of sitemap. Defaults to @file{sitemap.org} (which
10938 becomes @file{sitemap.html}).
10940 @item @code{:sitemap-title}
10941 @tab Title of sitemap page. Defaults to name of file.
10943 @item @code{:sitemap-function}
10944 @tab Plug-in function to use for generation of the sitemap.
10945 Defaults to @code{org-publish-org-sitemap}, which generates a plain list
10946 of links to all files in the project.
10948 @item @code{:sitemap-sort-folders}
10949 @tab Where folders should appear in the sitemap. Set this to @code{first}
10950 (default) or @code{last} to display folders first or last,
10951 respectively. Any other value will mix files and folders.
10953 @item @code{:sitemap-alphabetically}
10954 @tab The site map is normally sorted alphabetically. Set this explicitly to
10955 @code{nil} to turn off sorting.
10957 @item @code{:sitemap-ignore-case}
10958 @tab Should sorting be case-sensitive? Default @code{nil}.
10962 @node Generating an index, , Sitemap, Configuration
10963 @subsection Generating an index
10964 @cindex index, in a publishing project
10966 Org-mode can generate an index across the files of a publishing project.
10968 @multitable @columnfractions 0.25 0.75
10969 @item @code{:makeindex}
10970 @tab When non-nil, generate in index in the file @file{theindex.org} and
10971 publish it as @file{theindex.html}.
10974 The file will be create when first publishing a project with the
10975 @code{:makeindex} set. The file only contains a statement @code{#+include:
10976 "theindex.inc"}. You can then built around this include statement by adding
10977 a title, style information etc.
10979 @node Uploading files, Sample configuration, Configuration, Publishing
10980 @section Uploading files
10984 For those people already utilizing third party sync tools such as
10985 @command{rsync} or @command{unison}, it might be preferable not to use the built in
10986 @i{remote} publishing facilities of Org-mode which rely heavily on
10987 Tramp. Tramp, while very useful and powerful, tends not to be
10988 so efficient for multiple file transfer and has been known to cause problems
10991 Specialized synchronization utilities offer several advantages. In addition
10992 to timestamp comparison, they also do content and permissions/attribute
10993 checks. For this reason you might prefer to publish your web to a local
10994 directory (possibly even @i{in place} with your Org files) and then use
10995 @file{unison} or @file{rsync} to do the synchronization with the remote host.
10997 Since Unison (for example) can be configured as to which files to transfer to
10998 a certain remote destination, it can greatly simplify the project publishing
10999 definition. Simply keep all files in the correct location, process your Org
11000 files with @code{org-publish} and let the synchronization tool do the rest.
11001 You do not need, in this scenario, to include attachments such as @file{jpg},
11002 @file{css} or @file{gif} files in the project definition since the 3rd party
11005 Publishing to a local directory is also much faster than to a remote one, so
11006 that you can afford more easily to republish entire projects. If you set
11007 @code{org-publish-use-timestamps-flag} to @code{nil}, you gain the main
11008 benefit of re-including any changed external files such as source example
11009 files you might include with @code{#+INCLUDE}. The timestamp mechanism in
11010 Org is not smart enough to detect if included files have been modified.
11012 @node Sample configuration, Triggering publication, Uploading files, Publishing
11013 @section Sample configuration
11015 Below we provide two example configurations. The first one is a simple
11016 project publishing only a set of Org files. The second example is
11017 more complex, with a multi-component project.
11020 * Simple example:: One-component publishing
11021 * Complex example:: A multi-component publishing example
11024 @node Simple example, Complex example, Sample configuration, Sample configuration
11025 @subsection Example: simple publishing configuration
11027 This example publishes a set of Org files to the @file{public_html}
11028 directory on the local machine.
11031 (setq org-publish-project-alist
11033 :base-directory "~/org/"
11034 :publishing-directory "~/public_html"
11035 :section-numbers nil
11036 :table-of-contents nil
11037 :style "<link rel=\"stylesheet\"
11038 href=\"../other/mystyle.css\"
11039 type=\"text/css\"/>")))
11042 @node Complex example, , Simple example, Sample configuration
11043 @subsection Example: complex publishing configuration
11045 This more complicated example publishes an entire website, including
11046 Org files converted to HTML, image files, Emacs Lisp source code, and
11047 style sheets. The publishing directory is remote and private files are
11050 To ensure that links are preserved, care should be taken to replicate
11051 your directory structure on the web server, and to use relative file
11052 paths. For example, if your Org files are kept in @file{~/org} and your
11053 publishable images in @file{~/images}, you would link to an image with
11056 file:../images/myimage.png
11059 On the web server, the relative path to the image should be the
11060 same. You can accomplish this by setting up an "images" folder in the
11061 right place on the web server, and publishing images to it.
11064 (setq org-publish-project-alist
11066 :base-directory "~/org/"
11067 :base-extension "org"
11068 :publishing-directory "/ssh:user@@host:~/html/notebook/"
11069 :publishing-function org-publish-org-to-html
11070 :exclude "PrivatePage.org" ;; regexp
11072 :section-numbers nil
11073 :table-of-contents nil
11074 :style "<link rel=\"stylesheet\"
11075 href=\"../other/mystyle.css\" type=\"text/css\"/>"
11077 :auto-postamble nil)
11080 :base-directory "~/images/"
11081 :base-extension "jpg\\|gif\\|png"
11082 :publishing-directory "/ssh:user@@host:~/html/images/"
11083 :publishing-function org-publish-attachment)
11086 :base-directory "~/other/"
11087 :base-extension "css\\|el"
11088 :publishing-directory "/ssh:user@@host:~/html/other/"
11089 :publishing-function org-publish-attachment)
11090 ("website" :components ("orgfiles" "images" "other"))))
11093 @node Triggering publication, , Sample configuration, Publishing
11094 @section Triggering publication
11096 Once properly configured, Org can publish with the following commands:
11099 @orgcmd{C-c C-e X,org-publish}
11100 Prompt for a specific project and publish all files that belong to it.
11101 @orgcmd{C-c C-e P,org-publish-current-project}
11102 Publish the project containing the current file.
11103 @orgcmd{C-c C-e F,org-publish-current-file}
11104 Publish only the current file.
11105 @orgcmd{C-c C-e E,org-publish-all}
11106 Publish every project.
11109 @vindex org-publish-use-timestamps-flag
11110 Org uses timestamps to track when a file has changed. The above functions
11111 normally only publish changed files. You can override this and force
11112 publishing of all files by giving a prefix argument to any of the commands
11113 above, or by customizing the variable @code{org-publish-use-timestamps-flag}.
11114 This may be necessary in particular if files include other files via
11115 @code{#+SETUPFILE:} or @code{#+INCLUDE:}.
11117 @comment node-name, next, previous, up
11118 @comment Working With Source Code, Miscellaneous, Publishing, Top
11120 @node Working With Source Code, Miscellaneous, Publishing, Top
11121 @chapter Working with source code
11122 @cindex Schulte, Eric
11123 @cindex Davison, Dan
11124 @cindex source code, working with
11126 Source code can be included in Org-mode documents using a @samp{src} block,
11130 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp
11131 (defun org-xor (a b)
11137 Org-mode provides a number of features for working with live source code,
11138 including editing of code blocks in their native major-mode, evaluation of
11139 code blocks, tangling of code blocks, and exporting code blocks and their
11140 results in several formats. This functionality was contributed by Eric
11141 Schulte and Dan Davison, and was originally named Org-babel.
11143 The following sections describe Org-mode's code block handling facilities.
11146 * Structure of code blocks:: Code block syntax described
11147 * Editing source code:: Language major-mode editing
11148 * Exporting code blocks:: Export contents and/or results
11149 * Extracting source code:: Create pure source code files
11150 * Evaluating code blocks:: Place results of evaluation in the Org-mode buffer
11151 * Library of Babel:: Use and contribute to a library of useful code blocks
11152 * Languages:: List of supported code block languages
11153 * Header arguments:: Configure code block functionality
11154 * Results of evaluation:: How evaluation results are handled
11155 * Noweb reference syntax:: Literate programming in Org-mode
11156 * Key bindings and useful functions:: Work quickly with code blocks
11157 * Batch execution:: Call functions from the command line
11160 @comment node-name, next, previous, up
11161 @comment Structure of code blocks, Editing source code, Working With Source Code, Working With Source Code
11163 @node Structure of code blocks, Editing source code, Working With Source Code, Working With Source Code
11164 @section Structure of code blocks
11165 @cindex code block, structure
11166 @cindex source code, block structure
11168 The structure of code blocks is as follows:
11172 #+begin_src <language> <switches> <header arguments>
11177 Switches and header arguments are optional. Code can also be embedded in text
11181 src_<language>@{<body>@}
11187 src_<language>[<header arguments>]@{<body>@}
11192 This name is associated with the code block. This is similar to the
11193 @samp{#+tblname} lines that can be used to name tables in Org-mode files.
11194 Referencing the name of a code block makes it possible to evaluate the
11195 block from other places in the file, other files, or from Org-mode table
11196 formulas (see @ref{The spreadsheet}).
11198 The language of the code in the block.
11200 Optional switches controlling exportation of the code block (see switches discussion in
11201 @ref{Literal examples})
11202 @item <header arguments>
11203 Optional header arguments control many aspects of evaluation, export and
11204 tangling of code blocks. See the @ref{Header arguments}
11205 section. Header arguments can also be set on a per-buffer or per-subtree
11206 basis using properties.
11211 @comment node-name, next, previous, up
11212 @comment Editing source code, Exporting code blocks, Structure of code blocks, Working With Source Code
11214 @node Editing source code, Exporting code blocks, Structure of code blocks, Working With Source Code
11215 @section Editing source code
11216 @cindex code block, editing
11217 @cindex source code, editing
11220 Use @kbd{C-c '} to edit the current code block. This brings up
11221 a language major-mode edit buffer containing the body of the code
11222 block. Saving this buffer will write the new contents back to the Org
11223 buffer. Use @kbd{C-c '} again to exit.
11225 The @code{org-src-mode} minor mode will be active in the edit buffer. The
11226 following variables can be used to configure the behavior of the edit
11227 buffer. See also the customization group @code{org-edit-structure} for
11228 further configuration options.
11231 @item org-src-lang-modes
11232 If an Emacs major-mode named @code{<lang>-mode} exists, where
11233 @code{<lang>} is the language named in the header line of the code block,
11234 then the edit buffer will be placed in that major-mode. This variable
11235 can be used to map arbitrary language names to existing major modes.
11236 @item org-src-window-setup
11237 Controls the way Emacs windows are rearranged when the edit buffer is created.
11238 @item org-src-preserve-indentation
11239 This variable is especially useful for tangling languages such as
11240 Python, in which whitespace indentation in the output is critical.
11241 @item org-src-ask-before-returning-to-edit-buffer
11242 By default, Org will ask before returning to an open edit buffer. Set
11243 this variable to nil to switch without asking.
11246 To turn on native code fontification in the @emph{Org} buffer, configure the
11247 variable @code{org-src-fontify-natively}.
11249 @comment node-name, next, previous, up
11250 @comment Exporting code blocks, Extracting source code, Editing source code, Working With Source Code
11252 @node Exporting code blocks, Extracting source code, Editing source code, Working With Source Code
11253 @section Exporting code blocks
11254 @cindex code block, exporting
11255 @cindex source code, exporting
11257 It is possible to export the @emph{contents} of code blocks, the
11258 @emph{results} of code block evaluation, @emph{neither}, or @emph{both}. For
11259 most languages, the default exports the contents of code blocks. However, for
11260 some languages (e.g. @code{ditaa}) the default exports the results of code
11261 block evaluation. For information on exporting code block bodies, see
11262 @ref{Literal examples}.
11264 The @code{:exports} header argument can be used to specify export
11267 @subsubheading Header arguments:
11269 @item :exports code
11270 The default in most languages. The body of the code block is exported, as
11271 described in @ref{Literal examples}.
11272 @item :exports results
11273 The code block will be evaluated and the results will be placed in the
11274 Org-mode buffer for export, either updating previous results of the code
11275 block located anywhere in the buffer or, if no previous results exist,
11276 placing the results immediately after the code block. The body of the code
11277 block will not be exported.
11278 @item :exports both
11279 Both the code block and its results will be exported.
11280 @item :exports none
11281 Neither the code block nor its results will be exported.
11284 It is possible to inhibit the evaluation of code blocks during export.
11285 Setting the @code{org-export-babel-evaluate} variable to @code{nil} will
11286 ensure that no code blocks are evaluated as part of the export process. This
11287 can be useful in situations where potentially untrusted Org-mode files are
11288 exported in an automated fashion, for example when Org-mode is used as the
11289 markup language for a wiki.
11291 @comment node-name, next, previous, up
11292 @comment Extracting source code, Evaluating code blocks, Exporting code blocks, Working With Source Code
11293 @node Extracting source code, Evaluating code blocks, Exporting code blocks, Working With Source Code
11294 @section Extracting source code
11295 @cindex source code, extracting
11296 @cindex code block, extracting source code
11298 Creating pure source code files by extracting code from source blocks is
11299 referred to as ``tangling''---a term adopted from the literate programming
11300 community. During ``tangling'' of code blocks their bodies are expanded
11301 using @code{org-babel-expand-src-block} which can expand both variable and
11302 ``noweb'' style references (see @ref{Noweb reference syntax}).
11304 @subsubheading Header arguments
11307 The default. The code block is not included in the tangled output.
11309 Include the code block in the tangled output. The output file name is the
11310 name of the org file with the extension @samp{.org} replaced by the extension
11311 for the block language.
11312 @item :tangle filename
11313 Include the code block in the tangled output to file @samp{filename}.
11317 @subsubheading Functions
11319 @item org-babel-tangle
11320 Tangle the current file. Bound to @kbd{C-c C-v t}.
11321 @item org-babel-tangle-file
11322 Choose a file to tangle. Bound to @kbd{C-c C-v f}.
11325 @subsubheading Hooks
11327 @item org-babel-post-tangle-hook
11328 This hook is run from within code files tangled by @code{org-babel-tangle}.
11329 Example applications could include post-processing, compilation or evaluation
11330 of tangled code files.
11333 @node Evaluating code blocks, Library of Babel, Extracting source code, Working With Source Code
11334 @section Evaluating code blocks
11335 @cindex code block, evaluating
11336 @cindex source code, evaluating
11338 Code blocks can be evaluated@footnote{Whenever code is evaluated there is a
11339 potential for that code to do harm. Org-mode provides a number of safeguards
11340 to ensure that it only evaluates code with explicit confirmation from the
11341 user. For information on these safeguards (and on how to disable them) see
11342 @ref{Code evaluation security}.} and the results placed in the Org-mode
11343 buffer. By default, evaluation is only turned on for @code{emacs-lisp} code
11344 blocks, however support exists for evaluating blocks in many languages. See
11345 @ref{Languages} for a list of supported languages. See @ref{Structure of
11346 code blocks} for information on the syntax used to define a code block.
11349 There are a number of ways to evaluate code blocks. The simplest is to press
11350 @kbd{C-c C-c} or @kbd{C-c C-v e} with the point on a code block@footnote{The
11351 @code{org-babel-no-eval-on-ctrl-c-ctrl-c} variable can be used to remove code
11352 evaluation from the @kbd{C-c C-c} key binding.}. This will call the
11353 @code{org-babel-execute-src-block} function to evaluate the block and insert
11354 its results into the Org-mode buffer.
11356 It is also possible to evaluate named code blocks from anywhere in an
11357 Org-mode buffer or an Org-mode table. @code{#+call} (or synonymously
11358 @code{#+function} or @code{#+lob}) lines can be used to remotely execute code
11359 blocks located in the current Org-mode buffer or in the ``Library of Babel''
11360 (see @ref{Library of Babel}). These lines use the following syntax.
11363 #+call: <name>(<arguments>) <header arguments>
11364 #+function: <name>(<arguments>) <header arguments>
11365 #+lob: <name>(<arguments>) <header arguments>
11370 The name of the code block to be evaluated.
11372 Arguments specified in this section will be passed to the code block.
11373 @item <header arguments>
11374 Header arguments can be placed after the function invocation. See
11375 @ref{Header arguments} for more information on header arguments.
11379 @node Library of Babel, Languages, Evaluating code blocks, Working With Source Code
11380 @section Library of Babel
11381 @cindex babel, library of
11382 @cindex source code, library
11383 @cindex code block, library
11385 The ``Library of Babel'' is a library of code blocks
11386 that can be called from any Org-mode file. The library is housed in an
11387 Org-mode file located in the @samp{contrib} directory of Org-mode.
11388 Org-mode users can deposit functions they believe to be generally
11389 useful in the library.
11391 Code blocks defined in the ``Library of Babel'' can be called remotely as if
11392 they were in the current Org-mode buffer (see @ref{Evaluating code blocks}
11393 for information on the syntax of remote code block evaluation).
11396 Code blocks located in any Org-mode file can be loaded into the ``Library of
11397 Babel'' with the @code{org-babel-lob-ingest} function, bound to @kbd{C-c C-v
11400 @node Languages, Header arguments, Library of Babel, Working With Source Code
11402 @cindex babel, languages
11403 @cindex source code, languages
11404 @cindex code block, languages
11406 Code blocks in the following languages are supported.
11408 @multitable @columnfractions 0.28 0.3 0.22 0.2
11409 @item @b{Language} @tab @b{Identifier} @tab @b{Language} @tab @b{Identifier}
11410 @item Asymptote @tab asymptote @tab C @tab C
11411 @item C++ @tab C++ @tab Clojure @tab clojure
11412 @item CSS @tab css @tab ditaa @tab ditaa
11413 @item Graphviz @tab dot @tab Emacs Lisp @tab emacs-lisp
11414 @item gnuplot @tab gnuplot @tab Haskell @tab haskell
11415 @item LaTeX @tab latex @tab MATLAB @tab matlab
11416 @item Mscgen @tab mscgen @tab Objective Caml @tab ocaml
11417 @item Octave @tab octave @tab Oz @tab oz
11418 @item Perl @tab perl @tab Python @tab python
11419 @item R @tab R @tab Ruby @tab ruby
11420 @item Sass @tab sass @tab GNU Screen @tab screen
11421 @item shell @tab sh @tab SQL @tab sql
11422 @item SQLite @tab sqlite
11425 Language-specific documentation is available for some languages. If
11426 available, it can be found at
11427 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-contrib/babel/languages}.
11429 The @code{org-babel-load-languages} controls which languages are enabled for
11430 evaluation (by default only @code{emacs-lisp} is enabled). This variable can
11431 be set using the customization interface or by adding code like the following
11432 to your emacs configuration.
11435 The following disables @code{emacs-lisp} evaluation and enables evaluation of
11436 @code{R} code blocks.
11440 (org-babel-do-load-languages
11441 'org-babel-load-languages
11442 '((emacs-lisp . nil)
11446 It is also possible to enable support for a language by loading the related
11447 elisp file with @code{require}.
11450 The following adds support for evaluating @code{clojure} code blocks.
11454 (require 'ob-clojure)
11457 @node Header arguments, Results of evaluation, Languages, Working With Source Code
11458 @section Header arguments
11459 @cindex code block, header arguments
11460 @cindex source code, block header arguments
11462 Code block functionality can be configured with header arguments. This
11463 section provides an overview of the use of header arguments, and then
11464 describes each header argument in detail.
11467 * Using header arguments:: Different ways to set header arguments
11468 * Specific header arguments:: List of header arguments
11471 @node Using header arguments, Specific header arguments, Header arguments, Header arguments
11472 @subsection Using header arguments
11474 The values of header arguments can be set in six different ways, each more
11475 specific (and having higher priority) than the last.
11477 * System-wide header arguments:: Set global default values
11478 * Language-specific header arguments:: Set default values by language
11479 * Buffer-wide header arguments:: Set default values for a specific buffer
11480 * Header arguments in Org-mode properties:: Set default values for a buffer or heading
11481 * Code block specific header arguments:: The most common way to set values
11482 * Header arguments in function calls:: The most specific level
11486 @node System-wide header arguments, Language-specific header arguments, Using header arguments, Using header arguments
11487 @subsubheading System-wide header arguments
11488 @vindex org-babel-default-header-args
11489 System-wide values of header arguments can be specified by customizing the
11490 @code{org-babel-default-header-args} variable:
11494 :results => "replace"
11501 @c org-babel-default-header-args is a variable defined in `org-babel.el'.
11503 @c ((:session . "none")
11504 @c (:results . "replace")
11505 @c (:exports . "code")
11507 @c (:noweb . "no"))
11511 @c Default arguments to use when evaluating a code block.
11514 For example, the following example could be used to set the default value of
11515 @code{:noweb} header arguments to @code{yes}. This would have the effect of
11516 expanding @code{:noweb} references by default when evaluating source code
11520 (setq org-babel-default-header-args
11521 (cons '(:noweb . "yes")
11522 (assq-delete-all :noweb org-babel-default-header-args)))
11525 @node Language-specific header arguments, Buffer-wide header arguments, System-wide header arguments, Using header arguments
11526 @subsubheading Language-specific header arguments
11527 Each language can define its own set of default header arguments. See the
11528 language-specific documentation available online at
11529 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-contrib/babel}.
11531 @node Buffer-wide header arguments, Header arguments in Org-mode properties, Language-specific header arguments, Using header arguments
11532 @subsubheading Buffer-wide header arguments
11533 Buffer-wide header arguments may be specified through the use of a special
11534 line placed anywhere in an Org-mode file. The line consists of the
11535 @code{#+BABEL:} keyword followed by a series of header arguments which may be
11536 specified using the standard header argument syntax.
11538 For example the following would set @code{session} to @code{*R*}, and
11539 @code{results} to @code{silent} for every code block in the buffer, ensuring
11540 that all execution took place in the same session, and no results would be
11541 inserted into the buffer.
11544 #+BABEL: :session *R* :results silent
11547 @node Header arguments in Org-mode properties, Code block specific header arguments, Buffer-wide header arguments, Using header arguments
11548 @subsubheading Header arguments in Org-mode properties
11550 Header arguments are also read from Org-mode properties (see @ref{Property
11551 syntax}), which can be set on a buffer-wide or per-heading basis. An example
11552 of setting a header argument for all code blocks in a buffer is
11555 #+property: tangle yes
11558 When properties are used to set default header arguments, they are looked up
11559 with inheritance, so the value of the @code{:cache} header argument will default
11560 to @code{yes} in all code blocks in the subtree rooted at the following
11571 @vindex org-babel-default-header-args
11572 Properties defined in this way override the properties set in
11573 @code{org-babel-default-header-args}. It is convenient to use the
11574 @code{org-set-property} function bound to @kbd{C-c C-x p} to set properties
11575 in Org-mode documents.
11577 @node Code block specific header arguments, Header arguments in function calls, Header arguments in Org-mode properties, Using header arguments
11578 @subsubheading Code block specific header arguments
11580 The most common way to assign values to header arguments is at the
11581 code block level. This can be done by listing a sequence of header
11582 arguments and their values as part of the @code{#+begin_src} line.
11583 Properties set in this way override both the values of
11584 @code{org-babel-default-header-args} and header arguments specified as
11585 properties. In the following example, the @code{:results} header argument
11586 is set to @code{silent}, meaning the results of execution will not be
11587 inserted in the buffer, and the @code{:exports} header argument is set to
11588 @code{code}, meaning only the body of the code block will be
11589 preserved on export to HTML or LaTeX.
11592 #+source: factorial
11593 #+begin_src haskell :results silent :exports code :var n=0
11595 fac n = n * fac (n-1)
11598 Similarly, it is possible to set header arguments for inline code blocks:
11601 src_haskell[:exports both]@{fac 5@}
11604 @node Header arguments in function calls, , Code block specific header arguments, Using header arguments
11605 @comment node-name, next, previous, up
11606 @subsubheading Header arguments in function calls
11608 At the most specific level, header arguments for ``Library of Babel'' or
11609 function call lines can be set as shown below:
11612 #+call: factorial(n=5) :exports results
11615 @node Specific header arguments, , Using header arguments, Header arguments
11616 @subsection Specific header arguments
11617 The following header arguments are defined:
11620 * var:: Pass arguments to code blocks
11621 * results:: Specify the type of results and how they will
11622 be collected and handled
11623 * file:: Specify a path for file output
11624 * dir:: Specify the default (possibly remote)
11625 directory for code block execution
11626 * exports:: Export code and/or results
11627 * tangle:: Toggle tangling and specify file name
11628 * comments:: Toggle insertion of comments in tangled
11630 * no-expand:: Turn off variable assignment and noweb
11631 expansion during tangling
11632 * session:: Preserve the state of code evaluation
11633 * noweb:: Toggle expansion of noweb references
11634 * cache:: Avoid re-evaluating unchanged code blocks
11635 * sep:: Delimiter for writing tabular results outside Org
11636 * hlines:: Handle horizontal lines in tables
11637 * colnames:: Handle column names in tables
11638 * rownames:: Handle row names in tables
11639 * shebang:: Make tangled files executable
11640 * eval:: Limit evaluation of specific code blocks
11643 @node var, results, Specific header arguments, Specific header arguments
11644 @subsubsection @code{:var}
11645 The @code{:var} header argument is used to pass arguments to code blocks.
11646 The specifics of how arguments are included in a code block vary by language;
11647 these are addressed in the language-specific documentation. However, the
11648 syntax used to specify arguments is the same across all languages. The
11649 values passed to arguments can be literal values, values from org-mode tables
11650 and literal example blocks, or the results of other code blocks.
11652 These values can be indexed in a manner similar to arrays---see the
11653 ``indexable variable values'' heading below.
11655 The following syntax is used to pass arguments to code blocks using the
11656 @code{:var} header argument.
11662 where @code{assign} can take one of the following forms
11665 @item literal value
11666 either a string @code{"string"} or a number @code{9}.
11671 #+tblname: example-table
11677 #+source: table-length
11678 #+begin_src emacs-lisp :var table=example-table
11682 #+results: table-length
11686 a code block name, as assigned by @code{#+srcname:}, followed by
11690 #+begin_src emacs-lisp :var length=table-length()
11698 In addition, an argument can be passed to the code block referenced
11699 by @code{:var}. The argument is passed within the parentheses following the
11704 #+begin_src emacs-lisp :var input=8
11712 #+begin_src emacs-lisp :var input=double(input=1)
11721 @subsubheading Alternate argument syntax
11722 It is also possible to specify arguments in a potentially more natural way
11723 using the @code{#+source:} line of a code block. As in the following
11724 example arguments can be packed inside of parenthesis, separated by commas,
11725 following the source name.
11728 #+source: double(input=0, x=2)
11729 #+begin_src emacs-lisp
11734 @subsubheading Indexable variable values
11735 It is possible to reference portions of variable values by ``indexing'' into
11736 the variables. Indexes are 0 based with negative values counting back from
11737 the end. If an index is separated by @code{,}s then each subsequent section
11738 will index into the next deepest nesting or dimension of the value. The
11739 following example assigns the last cell of the first row the table
11740 @code{example-table} to the variable @code{data}:
11743 #+results: example-table
11749 #+begin_src emacs-lisp :var data=example-table[0,-1]
11757 Ranges of variable values can be referenced using two integers separated by a
11758 @code{:}, in which case the entire inclusive range is referenced. For
11759 example the following assigns the middle three rows of @code{example-table}
11763 #+results: example-table
11770 #+begin_src emacs-lisp :var data=example-table[1:3]
11780 Additionally, an empty index, or the single character @code{*}, are both
11781 interpreted to mean the entire range and as such are equivalent to
11782 @code{0:-1}, as shown in the following example in which the entire first
11783 column is referenced.
11786 #+results: example-table
11792 #+begin_src emacs-lisp :var data=example-table[,0]
11800 It is possible to index into the results of code blocks as well as tables.
11801 Any number of dimensions can be indexed. Dimensions are separated from one
11802 another by commas, as shown in the following example.
11806 #+begin_src emacs-lisp
11807 '(((1 2 3) (4 5 6) (7 8 9))
11808 ((10 11 12) (13 14 15) (16 17 18))
11809 ((19 20 21) (22 23 24) (25 26 27)))
11812 #+begin_src emacs-lisp :var data=3D[1,,1]
11820 @node results, file, var, Specific header arguments
11821 @subsubsection @code{:results}
11823 There are three classes of @code{:results} header argument. Only one option
11824 per class may be supplied per code block.
11828 @b{collection} header arguments specify how the results should be collected
11829 from the code block
11831 @b{type} header arguments specify what type of result the code block will
11832 return---which has implications for how they will be inserted into the
11835 @b{handling} header arguments specify how the results of evaluating the code
11836 block should be handled.
11839 @subsubheading Collection
11840 The following options are mutually exclusive, and specify how the results
11841 should be collected from the code block.
11845 This is the default. The result is the value of the last statement in the
11846 code block. This header argument places the evaluation in functional
11847 mode. Note that in some languages, e.g., Python, use of this result type
11848 requires that a @code{return} statement be included in the body of the source
11849 code block. E.g., @code{:results value}.
11850 @item @code{output}
11851 The result is the collection of everything printed to STDOUT during the
11852 execution of the code block. This header argument places the
11853 evaluation in scripting mode. E.g., @code{:results output}.
11856 @subsubheading Type
11858 The following options are mutually exclusive and specify what type of results
11859 the code block will return. By default, results are inserted as either a
11860 table or scalar depending on their value.
11863 @item @code{table}, @code{vector}
11864 The results should be interpreted as an Org-mode table. If a single value is
11865 returned, it will be converted into a table with one row and one column.
11866 E.g., @code{:results value table}.
11868 The results should be interpreted as an Org-mode list. If a single scalar
11869 value is returned it will be converted into a list with only one element.
11870 @item @code{scalar}, @code{verbatim}
11871 The results should be interpreted literally---they will not be
11872 converted into a table. The results will be inserted into the Org-mode
11873 buffer as quoted text. E.g., @code{:results value verbatim}.
11875 The results will be interpreted as the path to a file, and will be inserted
11876 into the Org-mode buffer as a file link. E.g., @code{:results value file}.
11877 @item @code{raw}, @code{org}
11878 The results are interpreted as raw Org-mode code and are inserted directly
11879 into the buffer. If the results look like a table they will be aligned as
11880 such by Org-mode. E.g., @code{:results value raw}.
11882 Results are assumed to be HTML and will be enclosed in a @code{begin_html}
11883 block. E.g., @code{:results value html}.
11885 Results assumed to be LaTeX and are enclosed in a @code{begin_latex} block.
11886 E.g., @code{:results value latex}.
11888 Result are assumed to be parseable code and are enclosed in a code block.
11889 E.g., @code{:results value code}.
11891 The result is converted to pretty-printed code and is enclosed in a code
11892 block. This option currently supports Emacs Lisp, Python, and Ruby. E.g.,
11893 @code{:results value pp}.
11896 @subsubheading Handling
11897 The following results options indicate what happens with the
11898 results once they are collected.
11901 @item @code{silent}
11902 The results will be echoed in the minibuffer but will not be inserted into
11903 the Org-mode buffer. E.g., @code{:results output silent}.
11904 @item @code{replace}
11905 The default value. Any existing results will be removed, and the new results
11906 will be inserted into the Org-mode buffer in their place. E.g.,
11907 @code{:results output replace}.
11908 @item @code{append}
11909 If there are pre-existing results of the code block then the new results will
11910 be appended to the existing results. Otherwise the new results will be
11911 inserted as with @code{replace}.
11912 @item @code{prepend}
11913 If there are pre-existing results of the code block then the new results will
11914 be prepended to the existing results. Otherwise the new results will be
11915 inserted as with @code{replace}.
11918 @node file, dir, results, Specific header arguments
11919 @subsubsection @code{:file}
11921 The header argument @code{:file} is used to specify an external file in which
11922 to save code block results. After code block evaluation an Org-mode style
11923 @code{[[file:]]} link (see @ref{Link format}) to the file will be inserted
11924 into the Org-mode buffer. Some languages including R, gnuplot, dot, and
11925 ditaa provide special handling of the @code{:file} header argument
11926 automatically wrapping the code block body in the boilerplate code required
11927 to save output to the specified file. This is often useful for saving
11928 graphical output of a code block to the specified file.
11930 The argument to @code{:file} should be either a string specifying the path to
11931 a file, or a list of two strings in which case the first element of the list
11932 should be the path to a file and the second a description for the link.
11934 @node dir, exports, file, Specific header arguments
11935 @subsubsection @code{:dir} and remote execution
11937 While the @code{:file} header argument can be used to specify the path to the
11938 output file, @code{:dir} specifies the default directory during code block
11939 execution. If it is absent, then the directory associated with the current
11940 buffer is used. In other words, supplying @code{:dir path} temporarily has
11941 the same effect as changing the current directory with @kbd{M-x cd path}, and
11942 then not supplying @code{:dir}. Under the surface, @code{:dir} simply sets
11943 the value of the Emacs variable @code{default-directory}.
11945 When using @code{:dir}, you should supply a relative path for file output
11946 (e.g. @code{:file myfile.jpg} or @code{:file results/myfile.jpg}) in which
11947 case that path will be interpreted relative to the default directory.
11949 In other words, if you want your plot to go into a folder called @file{Work}
11950 in your home directory, you could use
11953 #+begin_src R :file myplot.png :dir ~/Work
11954 matplot(matrix(rnorm(100), 10), type="l")
11958 @subsubheading Remote execution
11959 A directory on a remote machine can be specified using tramp file syntax, in
11960 which case the code will be evaluated on the remote machine. An example is
11963 #+begin_src R :file plot.png :dir /dand@@yakuba.princeton.edu:
11964 plot(1:10, main=system("hostname", intern=TRUE))
11968 Text results will be returned to the local Org-mode buffer as usual, and file
11969 output will be created on the remote machine with relative paths interpreted
11970 relative to the remote directory. An Org-mode link to the remote file will be
11973 So, in the above example a plot will be created on the remote machine,
11974 and a link of the following form will be inserted in the org buffer:
11977 [[file:/scp:dand@@yakuba.princeton.edu:/home/dand/plot.png][plot.png]]
11980 Most of this functionality follows immediately from the fact that @code{:dir}
11981 sets the value of the Emacs variable @code{default-directory}, thanks to
11982 tramp. Those using XEmacs, or GNU Emacs prior to version 23 may need to
11983 install tramp separately in order for these features to work correctly.
11985 @subsubheading Further points
11989 If @code{:dir} is used in conjunction with @code{:session}, although it will
11990 determine the starting directory for a new session as expected, no attempt is
11991 currently made to alter the directory associated with an existing session.
11993 @code{:dir} should typically not be used to create files during export with
11994 @code{:exports results} or @code{:exports both}. The reason is that, in order
11995 to retain portability of exported material between machines, during export
11996 links inserted into the buffer will *not* be expanded against @code{default
11997 directory}. Therefore, if @code{default-directory} is altered using
11998 @code{:dir}, it is probable that the file will be created in a location to
11999 which the link does not point.
12002 @node exports, tangle, dir, Specific header arguments
12003 @subsubsection @code{:exports}
12005 The @code{:exports} header argument specifies what should be included in HTML
12006 or LaTeX exports of the Org-mode file.
12010 The default. The body of code is included into the exported file. E.g.,
12011 @code{:exports code}.
12012 @item @code{results}
12013 The result of evaluating the code is included in the exported file. E.g.,
12014 @code{:exports results}.
12016 Both the code and results are included in the exported file. E.g.,
12017 @code{:exports both}.
12019 Nothing is included in the exported file. E.g., @code{:exports none}.
12022 @node tangle, comments, exports, Specific header arguments
12023 @subsubsection @code{:tangle}
12025 The @code{:tangle} header argument specifies whether or not the code
12026 block should be included in tangled extraction of source code files.
12029 @item @code{tangle}
12030 The code block is exported to a source code file named after the
12031 basename (name w/o extension) of the Org-mode file. E.g., @code{:tangle
12034 The default. The code block is not exported to a source code file.
12035 E.g., @code{:tangle no}.
12037 Any other string passed to the @code{:tangle} header argument is interpreted
12038 as a file basename to which the block will be exported. E.g., @code{:tangle
12042 @node comments, no-expand, tangle, Specific header arguments
12043 @subsubsection @code{:comments}
12044 By default code blocks are tangled to source-code files without any insertion
12045 of comments beyond those which may already exist in the body of the code
12046 block. The @code{:comments} header argument can be set as follows to control
12047 the insertion of extra comments into the tangled code file.
12051 The default. No extra comments are inserted during tangling.
12053 The code block is wrapped in comments which contain pointers back to the
12054 original Org file from which the code was tangled.
12056 A synonym for ``link'' to maintain backwards compatibility.
12058 Include text from the org-mode file as a comment.
12060 The text is picked from the leading context of the tangled code and is
12061 limited by the nearest headline or source block as the case may be.
12063 Turns on both the ``link'' and ``org'' comment options.
12066 @node no-expand, session, comments, Specific header arguments
12067 @subsubsection @code{:no-expand}
12069 By default, code blocks are expanded with @code{org-babel-expand-src-block}
12070 during tangling. This has the effect of assigning values to variables
12071 specified with @code{:var} (see @ref{var}), and of replacing ``noweb''
12072 references (see @ref{Noweb reference syntax}) with their targets. The
12073 @code{:no-expand} header argument can be used to turn off this behavior.
12075 @node session, noweb, no-expand, Specific header arguments
12076 @subsubsection @code{:session}
12078 The @code{:session} header argument starts a session for an interpreted
12079 language where state is preserved.
12081 By default, a session is not started.
12083 A string passed to the @code{:session} header argument will give the session
12084 a name. This makes it possible to run concurrent sessions for each
12085 interpreted language.
12087 @node noweb, cache, session, Specific header arguments
12088 @subsubsection @code{:noweb}
12090 The @code{:noweb} header argument controls expansion of ``noweb'' style (see
12091 @ref{Noweb reference syntax}) references in a code block. This header
12092 argument can have one of three values: @code{yes} @code{no} or @code{tangle}.
12096 All ``noweb'' syntax references in the body of the code block will be
12097 expanded before the block is evaluated, tangled or exported.
12099 The default. No ``noweb'' syntax specific action is taken on evaluating
12100 code blocks, However, noweb references will still be expanded during
12102 @item @code{tangle}
12103 All ``noweb'' syntax references in the body of the code block will be
12104 expanded before the block is tangled, however ``noweb'' references will not
12105 be expanded when the block is evaluated or exported.
12108 @subsubheading Noweb prefix lines
12109 Noweb insertions are now placed behind the line prefix of the
12110 @code{<<reference>>}.
12111 This behavior is illustrated in the following example. Because the
12112 @code{<<example>>} noweb reference appears behind the SQL comment syntax,
12113 each line of the expanded noweb reference will be commented.
12126 -- multi-line body of example
12129 Note that noweb replacement text that does not contain any newlines will not
12130 be affected by this change, so it is still possible to use inline noweb
12133 @node cache, sep, noweb, Specific header arguments
12134 @subsubsection @code{:cache}
12136 The @code{:cache} header argument controls the use of in-buffer caching of
12137 the results of evaluating code blocks. It can be used to avoid re-evaluating
12138 unchanged code blocks. This header argument can have one of two
12139 values: @code{yes} or @code{no}.
12143 The default. No caching takes place, and the code block will be evaluated
12144 every time it is called.
12146 Every time the code block is run a SHA1 hash of the code and arguments
12147 passed to the block will be generated. This hash is packed into the
12148 @code{#+results:} line and will be checked on subsequent
12149 executions of the code block. If the code block has not
12150 changed since the last time it was evaluated, it will not be re-evaluated.
12153 @node sep, hlines, cache, Specific header arguments
12154 @subsubsection @code{:sep}
12156 The @code{:sep} header argument can be used to control the delimiter used
12157 when writing tabular results out to files external to Org-mode. This is used
12158 either when opening tabular results of a code block by calling the
12159 @code{org-open-at-point} function bound to @kbd{C-c C-o} on the code block,
12160 or when writing code block results to an external file (see @ref{file})
12163 By default, when @code{:sep} is not specified output tables are tab
12166 @node hlines, colnames, sep, Specific header arguments
12167 @subsubsection @code{:hlines}
12169 Tables are frequently represented with one or more horizontal lines, or
12170 hlines. The @code{:hlines} argument to a code block accepts the
12171 values @code{yes} or @code{no}, with a default value of @code{no}.
12175 Strips horizontal lines from the input table. In most languages this is the
12176 desired effect because an @code{hline} symbol is interpreted as an unbound
12177 variable and raises an error. Setting @code{:hlines no} or relying on the
12178 default value yields the following results.
12181 #+tblname: many-cols
12188 #+source: echo-table
12189 #+begin_src python :var tab=many-cols
12193 #+results: echo-table
12200 Leaves hlines in the table. Setting @code{:hlines yes} has this effect.
12203 #+tblname: many-cols
12210 #+source: echo-table
12211 #+begin_src python :var tab=many-cols :hlines yes
12215 #+results: echo-table
12224 @node colnames, rownames, hlines, Specific header arguments
12225 @subsubsection @code{:colnames}
12227 The @code{:colnames} header argument accepts the values @code{yes},
12228 @code{no}, or @code{nil} for unassigned. The default value is @code{nil}.
12232 If an input table looks like it has column names
12233 (because its second row is an hline), then the column
12234 names will be removed from the table before
12235 processing, then reapplied to the results.
12238 #+tblname: less-cols
12244 #+srcname: echo-table-again
12245 #+begin_src python :var tab=less-cols
12246 return [[val + '*' for val in row] for row in tab]
12249 #+results: echo-table-again
12257 No column name pre-processing takes place
12260 Column names are removed and reapplied as with @code{nil} even if the table
12261 does not ``look like'' it has column names (i.e. the second row is not an
12265 @node rownames, shebang, colnames, Specific header arguments
12266 @subsubsection @code{:rownames}
12268 The @code{:rownames} header argument can take on the values @code{yes}
12269 or @code{no}, with a default value of @code{no}.
12273 No row name pre-processing will take place.
12276 The first column of the table is removed from the table before processing,
12277 and is then reapplied to the results.
12280 #+tblname: with-rownames
12281 | one | 1 | 2 | 3 | 4 | 5 |
12282 | two | 6 | 7 | 8 | 9 | 10 |
12284 #+srcname: echo-table-once-again
12285 #+begin_src python :var tab=with-rownames :rownames yes
12286 return [[val + 10 for val in row] for row in tab]
12289 #+results: echo-table-once-again
12290 | one | 11 | 12 | 13 | 14 | 15 |
12291 | two | 16 | 17 | 18 | 19 | 20 |
12295 @node shebang, eval, rownames, Specific header arguments
12296 @subsubsection @code{:shebang}
12298 Setting the @code{:shebang} header argument to a string value
12299 (e.g. @code{:shebang "#!/bin/bash"}) causes the string to be inserted as the
12300 first line of any tangled file holding the code block, and the file
12301 permissions of the tangled file are set to make it executable.
12303 @node eval, , shebang, Specific header arguments
12304 @subsubsection @code{:eval}
12305 The @code{:eval} header argument can be used to limit the evaluation of
12306 specific code blocks. @code{:eval} accepts two arguments ``never'' and
12307 ``query''. @code{:eval never} will ensure that a code block is never
12308 evaluated, this can be useful for protecting against the evaluation of
12309 dangerous code blocks. @code{:eval query} will require a query for every
12310 execution of a code block regardless of the value of the
12311 @code{org-confirm-babel-evaluate} variable.
12313 @node Results of evaluation, Noweb reference syntax, Header arguments, Working With Source Code
12314 @section Results of evaluation
12315 @cindex code block, results of evaluation
12316 @cindex source code, results of evaluation
12318 The way in which results are handled depends on whether a session is invoked,
12319 as well as on whether @code{:results value} or @code{:results output} is
12320 used. The following table shows the possibilities:
12322 @multitable @columnfractions 0.26 0.33 0.41
12323 @item @tab @b{Non-session} @tab @b{Session}
12324 @item @code{:results value} @tab value of last expression @tab value of last expression
12325 @item @code{:results output} @tab contents of STDOUT @tab concatenation of interpreter output
12328 Note: With @code{:results value}, the result in both @code{:session} and
12329 non-session is returned to Org-mode as a table (a one- or two-dimensional
12330 vector of strings or numbers) when appropriate.
12332 @subsection Non-session
12333 @subsubsection @code{:results value}
12334 This is the default. Internally, the value is obtained by wrapping the code
12335 in a function definition in the external language, and evaluating that
12336 function. Therefore, code should be written as if it were the body of such a
12337 function. In particular, note that Python does not automatically return a
12338 value from a function unless a @code{return} statement is present, and so a
12339 @samp{return} statement will usually be required in Python.
12341 This is the only one of the four evaluation contexts in which the code is
12342 automatically wrapped in a function definition.
12344 @subsubsection @code{:results output}
12345 The code is passed to the interpreter as an external process, and the
12346 contents of the standard output stream are returned as text. (In certain
12347 languages this also contains the error output stream; this is an area for
12350 @subsection Session
12351 @subsubsection @code{:results value}
12352 The code is passed to the interpreter running as an interactive Emacs
12353 inferior process. The result returned is the result of the last evaluation
12354 performed by the interpreter. (This is obtained in a language-specific
12355 manner: the value of the variable @code{_} in Python and Ruby, and the value
12356 of @code{.Last.value} in R).
12358 @subsubsection @code{:results output}
12359 The code is passed to the interpreter running as an interactive Emacs
12360 inferior process. The result returned is the concatenation of the sequence of
12361 (text) output from the interactive interpreter. Notice that this is not
12362 necessarily the same as what would be sent to @code{STDOUT} if the same code
12363 were passed to a non-interactive interpreter running as an external
12364 process. For example, compare the following two blocks:
12367 #+begin_src python :results output
12378 In non-session mode, the `2' is not printed and does not appear.
12380 #+begin_src python :results output :session
12392 But in @code{:session} mode, the interactive interpreter receives input `2'
12393 and prints out its value, `2'. (Indeed, the other print statements are
12396 @node Noweb reference syntax, Key bindings and useful functions, Results of evaluation, Working With Source Code
12397 @section Noweb reference syntax
12398 @cindex code block, noweb reference
12399 @cindex syntax, noweb
12400 @cindex source code, noweb reference
12402 The ``noweb'' (see @uref{http://www.cs.tufts.edu/~nr/noweb/}) Literate
12403 Programming system allows named blocks of code to be referenced by using the
12404 familiar Noweb syntax:
12407 <<code-block-name>>
12410 When a code block is tangled or evaluated, whether or not ``noweb''
12411 references are expanded depends upon the value of the @code{:noweb} header
12412 argument. If @code{:noweb yes}, then a Noweb reference is expanded before
12413 evaluation. If @code{:noweb no}, the default, then the reference is not
12414 expanded before evaluation.
12416 Note: the default value, @code{:noweb no}, was chosen to ensure that
12417 correct code is not broken in a language, such as Ruby, where
12418 @code{<<arg>>} is a syntactically valid construct. If @code{<<arg>>} is not
12419 syntactically valid in languages that you use, then please consider setting
12422 @node Key bindings and useful functions, Batch execution, Noweb reference syntax, Working With Source Code
12423 @section Key bindings and useful functions
12424 @cindex code block, key bindings
12426 Many common Org-mode key sequences are re-bound depending on
12429 Within a code block, the following key bindings
12432 @multitable @columnfractions 0.25 0.75
12434 @item @kbd{C-c C-c} @tab org-babel-execute-src-block
12436 @item @kbd{C-c C-o} @tab org-babel-open-src-block-result
12438 @item @kbd{C-@key{up}} @tab org-babel-load-in-session
12440 @item @kbd{M-@key{down}} @tab org-babel-pop-to-session
12443 In an Org-mode buffer, the following key bindings are active:
12445 @multitable @columnfractions 0.45 0.55
12447 @kindex C-c C-v C-a
12448 @item @kbd{C-c C-v a} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-a} @tab org-babel-sha1-hash
12450 @kindex C-c C-v C-b
12451 @item @kbd{C-c C-v b} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-b} @tab org-babel-execute-buffer
12453 @kindex C-c C-v C-f
12454 @item @kbd{C-c C-v f} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-f} @tab org-babel-tangle-file
12456 @item @kbd{C-c C-v g} @tab org-babel-goto-named-source-block
12458 @item @kbd{C-c C-v h} @tab org-babel-describe-bindings
12460 @kindex C-c C-v C-l
12461 @item @kbd{C-c C-v l} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-l} @tab org-babel-lob-ingest
12463 @kindex C-c C-v C-p
12464 @item @kbd{C-c C-v p} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-p} @tab org-babel-expand-src-block
12466 @kindex C-c C-v C-s
12467 @item @kbd{C-c C-v s} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-s} @tab org-babel-execute-subtree
12469 @kindex C-c C-v C-t
12470 @item @kbd{C-c C-v t} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-t} @tab org-babel-tangle
12472 @kindex C-c C-v C-z
12473 @item @kbd{C-c C-v z} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-z} @tab org-babel-switch-to-session
12476 @c When possible these keybindings were extended to work when the control key is
12477 @c kept pressed, resulting in the following additional keybindings.
12479 @c @multitable @columnfractions 0.25 0.75
12480 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-a} @tab org-babel-sha1-hash
12481 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-b} @tab org-babel-execute-buffer
12482 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-f} @tab org-babel-tangle-file
12483 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-l} @tab org-babel-lob-ingest
12484 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-p} @tab org-babel-expand-src-block
12485 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-s} @tab org-babel-execute-subtree
12486 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-t} @tab org-babel-tangle
12487 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-z} @tab org-babel-switch-to-session
12490 @node Batch execution, , Key bindings and useful functions, Working With Source Code
12491 @section Batch execution
12492 @cindex code block, batch execution
12493 @cindex source code, batch execution
12495 It is possible to call functions from the command line. This shell
12496 script calls @code{org-babel-tangle} on every one of its arguments.
12498 Be sure to adjust the paths to fit your system.
12502 # -*- mode: shell-script -*-
12504 # tangle files with org-mode
12508 ORGINSTALL="~/src/org/lisp/org-install.el"
12510 # wrap each argument in the code required to call tangle on it
12512 FILES="$FILES \"$i\""
12515 emacs -Q --batch -l $ORGINSTALL \
12517 (add-to-list 'load-path (expand-file-name \"~/src/org/lisp/\"))
12518 (add-to-list 'load-path (expand-file-name \"~/src/org/contrib/lisp/\"))
12519 (require 'org)(require 'org-exp)(require 'ob)(require 'ob-tangle)
12520 (mapc (lambda (file)
12521 (find-file (expand-file-name file \"$DIR\"))
12523 (kill-buffer)) '($FILES)))" 2>&1 |grep tangled
12526 @node Miscellaneous, Hacking, Working With Source Code, Top
12527 @chapter Miscellaneous
12530 * Completion:: M-TAB knows what you need
12531 * Easy Templates:: Quick insertion of structural elements
12532 * Speed keys:: Electric commands at the beginning of a headline
12533 * Code evaluation security:: Org mode files evaluate inline code
12534 * Customization:: Adapting Org to your taste
12535 * In-buffer settings:: Overview of the #+KEYWORDS
12536 * The very busy C-c C-c key:: When in doubt, press C-c C-c
12537 * Clean view:: Getting rid of leading stars in the outline
12538 * TTY keys:: Using Org on a tty
12539 * Interaction:: Other Emacs packages
12543 @node Completion, Easy Templates, Miscellaneous, Miscellaneous
12544 @section Completion
12545 @cindex completion, of @TeX{} symbols
12546 @cindex completion, of TODO keywords
12547 @cindex completion, of dictionary words
12548 @cindex completion, of option keywords
12549 @cindex completion, of tags
12550 @cindex completion, of property keys
12551 @cindex completion, of link abbreviations
12552 @cindex @TeX{} symbol completion
12553 @cindex TODO keywords completion
12554 @cindex dictionary word completion
12555 @cindex option keyword completion
12556 @cindex tag completion
12557 @cindex link abbreviations, completion of
12559 Emacs would not be Emacs without completion, and Org-mode uses it whenever it
12560 makes sense. If you prefer an @i{iswitchb}- or @i{ido}-like interface for
12561 some of the completion prompts, you can specify your preference by setting at
12562 most one of the variables @code{org-completion-use-iswitchb}
12563 @code{org-completion-use-ido}.
12565 Org supports in-buffer completion. This type of completion does
12566 not make use of the minibuffer. You simply type a few letters into
12567 the buffer and use the key to complete text right there.
12570 @kindex M-@key{TAB}
12572 Complete word at point
12575 At the beginning of a headline, complete TODO keywords.
12577 After @samp{\}, complete @TeX{} symbols supported by the exporter.
12579 After @samp{*}, complete headlines in the current buffer so that they
12580 can be used in search links like @samp{[[*find this headline]]}.
12582 After @samp{:} in a headline, complete tags. The list of tags is taken
12583 from the variable @code{org-tag-alist} (possibly set through the
12584 @samp{#+TAGS} in-buffer option, @pxref{Setting tags}), or it is created
12585 dynamically from all tags used in the current buffer.
12587 After @samp{:} and not in a headline, complete property keys. The list
12588 of keys is constructed dynamically from all keys used in the current
12591 After @samp{[}, complete link abbreviations (@pxref{Link abbreviations}).
12593 After @samp{#+}, complete the special keywords like @samp{TYP_TODO} or
12594 @samp{OPTIONS} which set file-specific options for Org-mode. When the
12595 option keyword is already complete, pressing @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} again
12596 will insert example settings for this keyword.
12598 In the line after @samp{#+STARTUP: }, complete startup keywords,
12599 i.e. valid keys for this line.
12601 Elsewhere, complete dictionary words using Ispell.
12605 @node Easy Templates, Speed keys, Completion, Miscellaneous
12606 @section Easy Templates
12607 @cindex template insertion
12608 @cindex insertion, of templates
12610 Org-mode supports insertion of empty structural elements (like
12611 @code{#+BEGIN_SRC} and @code{#+END_SRC} pairs) with just a few key
12612 strokes. This is achieved through a native template expansion mechanism.
12613 Note that Emacs has several other template mechanisms which could be used in
12614 a similar way, for example @file{yasnippet}.
12616 To insert a structural element, type a @samp{<}, followed by a template
12617 selector and @kbd{@key{TAB}}. Completion takes effect only when the above
12618 keystrokes are typed on a line by itself.
12620 The following template selectors are currently supported.
12622 @multitable @columnfractions 0.1 0.9
12623 @item @kbd{s} @tab @code{#+begin_src ... #+end_src}
12624 @item @kbd{e} @tab @code{#+begin_example ... #+end_example}
12625 @item @kbd{q} @tab @code{#+begin_quote ... #+end_quote}
12626 @item @kbd{v} @tab @code{#+begin_verse ... #+end_verse}
12627 @item @kbd{c} @tab @code{#+begin_center ... #+end_center}
12628 @item @kbd{l} @tab @code{#+begin_latex ... #+end_latex}
12629 @item @kbd{L} @tab @code{#+latex:}
12630 @item @kbd{h} @tab @code{#+begin_html ... #+end_html}
12631 @item @kbd{H} @tab @code{#+html:}
12632 @item @kbd{a} @tab @code{#+begin_ascii ... #+end_ascii}
12633 @item @kbd{A} @tab @code{#+ascii:}
12634 @item @kbd{i} @tab @code{#+include:} line
12637 For example, on an empty line, typing "<e" and then pressing TAB, will expand
12638 into a complete EXAMPLE template.
12640 You can install additional templates by customizing the variable
12641 @code{org-structure-template-alist}. See the docstring of the variable for
12642 additional details.
12644 @node Speed keys, Code evaluation security, Easy Templates, Miscellaneous
12645 @section Speed keys
12647 @vindex org-use-speed-commands
12648 @vindex org-speed-commands-user
12650 Single keys can be made to execute commands when the cursor is at the
12651 beginning of a headline, i.e. before the first star. Configure the variable
12652 @code{org-use-speed-commands} to activate this feature. There is a
12653 pre-defined list of commands, and you can add more such commands using the
12654 variable @code{org-speed-commands-user}. Speed keys do not only speed up
12655 navigation and other commands, but they also provide an alternative way to
12656 execute commands bound to keys that are not or not easily available on a TTY,
12657 or on a small mobile device with a limited keyboard.
12659 To see which commands are available, activate the feature and press @kbd{?}
12660 with the cursor at the beginning of a headline.
12662 @node Code evaluation security, Customization, Speed keys, Miscellaneous
12663 @section Code evaluation and security issues
12665 Org provides tools to work with the code snippets, including evaluating them.
12667 Running code on your machine always comes with a security risk. Badly
12668 written or malicious code can be executed on purpose or by accident. Org has
12669 default settings which will only evaluate such code if you give explicit
12670 permission to do so, and as a casual user of these features you should leave
12671 these precautions intact.
12673 For people who regularly work with such code, the confirmation prompts can
12674 become annoying, and you might want to turn them off. This can be done, but
12675 you must be aware of the risks that are involved.
12677 Code evaluation can happen under the following circumstances:
12680 @item Source code blocks
12681 Source code blocks can be evaluated during export, or when pressing @kbd{C-c
12682 C-c} in the block. The most important thing to realize here is that Org mode
12683 files which contain code snippets are, in a certain sense, like executable
12684 files. So you should accept them and load them into Emacs only from trusted
12685 sources---just like you would do with a program you install on your computer.
12687 Make sure you know what you are doing before customizing the variables
12688 which take off the default security brakes.
12690 @defopt org-confirm-babel-evaluate
12691 When t (the default), the user is asked before every code block evaluation.
12692 When nil, the user is not asked. When set to a function, it is called with
12693 two arguments (language and body of the code block) and should return t to
12694 ask and nil not to ask.
12697 For example, here is how to execute "ditaa" code (which is considered safe)
12700 (defun my-org-confirm-babel-evaluate (lang body)
12701 (not (string= lang "ditaa"))) ; don't ask for ditaa
12702 (setq org-confirm-babel-evaluate 'my-org-confirm-babel-evaluate)
12705 @item Following @code{shell} and @code{elisp} links
12706 Org has two link types that can directly evaluate code (@pxref{External
12707 links}). These links can be problematic because the code to be evaluated is
12710 @defopt org-confirm-shell-link-function
12711 Function to queries user about shell link execution.
12713 @defopt org-confirm-elisp-link-function
12714 Functions to query user for Emacs Lisp link execution.
12717 @item Formulas in tables
12718 Formulas in tables (@pxref{The spreadsheet}) are code that is evaluated
12719 either by the @i{calc} interpreter, or by the @i{Emacs Lisp} interpreter.
12722 @node Customization, In-buffer settings, Code evaluation security, Miscellaneous
12723 @section Customization
12724 @cindex customization
12725 @cindex options, for customization
12726 @cindex variables, for customization
12728 There are more than 180 variables that can be used to customize
12729 Org. For the sake of compactness of the manual, I am not
12730 describing the variables here. A structured overview of customization
12731 variables is available with @kbd{M-x org-customize}. Or select
12732 @code{Browse Org Group} from the @code{Org->Customization} menu. Many
12733 settings can also be activated on a per-file basis, by putting special
12734 lines into the buffer (@pxref{In-buffer settings}).
12736 @node In-buffer settings, The very busy C-c C-c key, Customization, Miscellaneous
12737 @section Summary of in-buffer settings
12738 @cindex in-buffer settings
12739 @cindex special keywords
12741 Org-mode uses special lines in the buffer to define settings on a
12742 per-file basis. These lines start with a @samp{#+} followed by a
12743 keyword, a colon, and then individual words defining a setting. Several
12744 setting words can be in the same line, but you can also have multiple
12745 lines for the keyword. While these settings are described throughout
12746 the manual, here is a summary. After changing any of those lines in the
12747 buffer, press @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor still in the line to
12748 activate the changes immediately. Otherwise they become effective only
12749 when the file is visited again in a new Emacs session.
12751 @vindex org-archive-location
12753 @item #+ARCHIVE: %s_done::
12754 This line sets the archive location for the agenda file. It applies for
12755 all subsequent lines until the next @samp{#+ARCHIVE} line, or the end
12756 of the file. The first such line also applies to any entries before it.
12757 The corresponding variable is @code{org-archive-location}.
12759 This line sets the category for the agenda file. The category applies
12760 for all subsequent lines until the next @samp{#+CATEGORY} line, or the
12761 end of the file. The first such line also applies to any entries before it.
12762 @item #+COLUMNS: %25ITEM .....
12763 @cindex property, COLUMNS
12764 Set the default format for columns view. This format applies when
12765 columns view is invoked in locations where no @code{COLUMNS} property
12767 @item #+CONSTANTS: name1=value1 ...
12768 @vindex org-table-formula-constants
12769 @vindex org-table-formula
12770 Set file-local values for constants to be used in table formulas. This
12771 line sets the local variable @code{org-table-formula-constants-local}.
12772 The global version of this variable is
12773 @code{org-table-formula-constants}.
12774 @item #+FILETAGS: :tag1:tag2:tag3:
12775 Set tags that can be inherited by any entry in the file, including the
12777 @item #+DRAWERS: NAME1 .....
12778 @vindex org-drawers
12779 Set the file-local set of drawers. The corresponding global variable is
12780 @code{org-drawers}.
12781 @item #+LINK: linkword replace
12782 @vindex org-link-abbrev-alist
12783 These lines (several are allowed) specify link abbreviations.
12784 @xref{Link abbreviations}. The corresponding variable is
12785 @code{org-link-abbrev-alist}.
12786 @item #+PRIORITIES: highest lowest default
12787 @vindex org-highest-priority
12788 @vindex org-lowest-priority
12789 @vindex org-default-priority
12790 This line sets the limits and the default for the priorities. All three
12791 must be either letters A-Z or numbers 0-9. The highest priority must
12792 have a lower ASCII number than the lowest priority.
12793 @item #+PROPERTY: Property_Name Value
12794 This line sets a default inheritance value for entries in the current
12795 buffer, most useful for specifying the allowed values of a property.
12796 @cindex #+SETUPFILE
12797 @item #+SETUPFILE: file
12798 This line defines a file that holds more in-buffer setup. Normally this is
12799 entirely ignored. Only when the buffer is parsed for option-setting lines
12800 (i.e. when starting Org-mode for a file, when pressing @kbd{C-c C-c} in a
12801 settings line, or when exporting), then the contents of this file are parsed
12802 as if they had been included in the buffer. In particular, the file can be
12803 any other Org-mode file with internal setup. You can visit the file the
12804 cursor is in the line with @kbd{C-c '}.
12807 This line sets options to be used at startup of Org-mode, when an
12808 Org file is being visited.
12810 The first set of options deals with the initial visibility of the outline
12811 tree. The corresponding variable for global default settings is
12812 @code{org-startup-folded}, with a default value @code{t}, which means
12814 @vindex org-startup-folded
12815 @cindex @code{overview}, STARTUP keyword
12816 @cindex @code{content}, STARTUP keyword
12817 @cindex @code{showall}, STARTUP keyword
12818 @cindex @code{showeverything}, STARTUP keyword
12820 overview @r{top-level headlines only}
12821 content @r{all headlines}
12822 showall @r{no folding of any entries}
12823 showeverything @r{show even drawer contents}
12826 @vindex org-startup-indented
12827 @cindex @code{indent}, STARTUP keyword
12828 @cindex @code{noindent}, STARTUP keyword
12829 Dynamic virtual indentation is controlled by the variable
12830 @code{org-startup-indented}@footnote{Emacs 23 and Org-mode 6.29 are required}
12832 indent @r{start with @code{org-indent-mode} turned on}
12833 noindent @r{start with @code{org-indent-mode} turned off}
12836 @vindex org-startup-align-all-tables
12837 Then there are options for aligning tables upon visiting a file. This
12838 is useful in files containing narrowed table columns. The corresponding
12839 variable is @code{org-startup-align-all-tables}, with a default value
12841 @cindex @code{align}, STARTUP keyword
12842 @cindex @code{noalign}, STARTUP keyword
12844 align @r{align all tables}
12845 noalign @r{don't align tables on startup}
12848 @vindex org-startup-with-inline-images
12849 When visiting a file, inline images can be automatically displayed. The
12850 corresponding variable is @code{org-startup-with-inline-images}, with a
12851 default value @code{nil} to avoid delays when visiting a file.
12852 @cindex @code{inlineimages}, STARTUP keyword
12853 @cindex @code{noinlineimages}, STARTUP keyword
12855 inlineimages @r{show inline images}
12856 noinlineimages @r{don't show inline images on startup}
12859 @vindex org-log-done
12860 @vindex org-log-note-clock-out
12861 @vindex org-log-repeat
12862 Logging the closing and reopening of TODO items and clock intervals can be
12863 configured using these options (see variables @code{org-log-done},
12864 @code{org-log-note-clock-out} and @code{org-log-repeat})
12865 @cindex @code{logdone}, STARTUP keyword
12866 @cindex @code{lognotedone}, STARTUP keyword
12867 @cindex @code{nologdone}, STARTUP keyword
12868 @cindex @code{lognoteclock-out}, STARTUP keyword
12869 @cindex @code{nolognoteclock-out}, STARTUP keyword
12870 @cindex @code{logrepeat}, STARTUP keyword
12871 @cindex @code{lognoterepeat}, STARTUP keyword
12872 @cindex @code{nologrepeat}, STARTUP keyword
12873 @cindex @code{logreschedule}, STARTUP keyword
12874 @cindex @code{lognotereschedule}, STARTUP keyword
12875 @cindex @code{nologreschedule}, STARTUP keyword
12876 @cindex @code{logredeadline}, STARTUP keyword
12877 @cindex @code{lognoteredeadline}, STARTUP keyword
12878 @cindex @code{nologredeadline}, STARTUP keyword
12879 @cindex @code{logrefile}, STARTUP keyword
12880 @cindex @code{lognoterefile}, STARTUP keyword
12881 @cindex @code{nologrefile}, STARTUP keyword
12883 logdone @r{record a timestamp when an item is marked DONE}
12884 lognotedone @r{record timestamp and a note when DONE}
12885 nologdone @r{don't record when items are marked DONE}
12886 logrepeat @r{record a time when reinstating a repeating item}
12887 lognoterepeat @r{record a note when reinstating a repeating item}
12888 nologrepeat @r{do not record when reinstating repeating item}
12889 lognoteclock-out @r{record a note when clocking out}
12890 nolognoteclock-out @r{don't record a note when clocking out}
12891 logreschedule @r{record a timestamp when scheduling time changes}
12892 lognotereschedule @r{record a note when scheduling time changes}
12893 nologreschedule @r{do not record when a scheduling date changes}
12894 logredeadline @r{record a timestamp when deadline changes}
12895 lognoteredeadline @r{record a note when deadline changes}
12896 nologredeadline @r{do not record when a deadline date changes}
12897 logrefile @r{record a timestamp when refiling}
12898 lognoterefile @r{record a note when refiling}
12899 nologrefile @r{do not record when refiling}
12901 @vindex org-hide-leading-stars
12902 @vindex org-odd-levels-only
12903 Here are the options for hiding leading stars in outline headings, and for
12904 indenting outlines. The corresponding variables are
12905 @code{org-hide-leading-stars} and @code{org-odd-levels-only}, both with a
12906 default setting @code{nil} (meaning @code{showstars} and @code{oddeven}).
12907 @cindex @code{hidestars}, STARTUP keyword
12908 @cindex @code{showstars}, STARTUP keyword
12909 @cindex @code{odd}, STARTUP keyword
12910 @cindex @code{even}, STARTUP keyword
12912 hidestars @r{make all but one of the stars starting a headline invisible.}
12913 showstars @r{show all stars starting a headline}
12914 indent @r{virtual indentation according to outline level}
12915 noindent @r{no virtual indentation according to outline level}
12916 odd @r{allow only odd outline levels (1,3,...)}
12917 oddeven @r{allow all outline levels}
12919 @vindex org-put-time-stamp-overlays
12920 @vindex org-time-stamp-overlay-formats
12921 To turn on custom format overlays over timestamps (variables
12922 @code{org-put-time-stamp-overlays} and
12923 @code{org-time-stamp-overlay-formats}), use
12924 @cindex @code{customtime}, STARTUP keyword
12926 customtime @r{overlay custom time format}
12928 @vindex constants-unit-system
12929 The following options influence the table spreadsheet (variable
12930 @code{constants-unit-system}).
12931 @cindex @code{constcgs}, STARTUP keyword
12932 @cindex @code{constSI}, STARTUP keyword
12934 constcgs @r{@file{constants.el} should use the c-g-s unit system}
12935 constSI @r{@file{constants.el} should use the SI unit system}
12937 @vindex org-footnote-define-inline
12938 @vindex org-footnote-auto-label
12939 @vindex org-footnote-auto-adjust
12940 To influence footnote settings, use the following keywords. The
12941 corresponding variables are @code{org-footnote-define-inline},
12942 @code{org-footnote-auto-label}, and @code{org-footnote-auto-adjust}.
12943 @cindex @code{fninline}, STARTUP keyword
12944 @cindex @code{nofninline}, STARTUP keyword
12945 @cindex @code{fnlocal}, STARTUP keyword
12946 @cindex @code{fnprompt}, STARTUP keyword
12947 @cindex @code{fnauto}, STARTUP keyword
12948 @cindex @code{fnconfirm}, STARTUP keyword
12949 @cindex @code{fnplain}, STARTUP keyword
12950 @cindex @code{fnadjust}, STARTUP keyword
12951 @cindex @code{nofnadjust}, STARTUP keyword
12953 fninline @r{define footnotes inline}
12954 fnnoinline @r{define footnotes in separate section}
12955 fnlocal @r{define footnotes near first reference, but not inline}
12956 fnprompt @r{prompt for footnote labels}
12957 fnauto @r{create [fn:1]-like labels automatically (default)}
12958 fnconfirm @r{offer automatic label for editing or confirmation}
12959 fnplain @r{create [1]-like labels automatically}
12960 fnadjust @r{automatically renumber and sort footnotes}
12961 nofnadjust @r{do not renumber and sort automatically}
12963 @cindex org-hide-block-startup
12964 To hide blocks on startup, use these keywords. The corresponding variable is
12965 @code{org-hide-block-startup}.
12966 @cindex @code{hideblocks}, STARTUP keyword
12967 @cindex @code{nohideblocks}, STARTUP keyword
12969 hideblocks @r{Hide all begin/end blocks on startup}
12970 nohideblocks @r{Do not hide blocks on startup}
12972 @cindex org-pretty-entities
12973 The display of entities as UTF-8 characters is governed by the variable
12974 @code{org-pretty-entities} and the keywords
12975 @cindex @code{entitiespretty}, STARTUP keyword
12976 @cindex @code{entitiesplain}, STARTUP keyword
12978 entitiespretty @r{Show entities as UTF-8 characters where possible}
12979 entitiesplain @r{Leave entities plain}
12981 @item #+TAGS: TAG1(c1) TAG2(c2)
12982 @vindex org-tag-alist
12983 These lines (several such lines are allowed) specify the valid tags in
12984 this file, and (potentially) the corresponding @emph{fast tag selection}
12985 keys. The corresponding variable is @code{org-tag-alist}.
12987 This line contains the formulas for the table directly above the line.
12988 @item #+TITLE:, #+AUTHOR:, #+EMAIL:, #+LANGUAGE:, #+TEXT:, #+DATE:,
12989 @itemx #+OPTIONS:, #+BIND:, #+XSLT:,
12990 @itemx #+DESCRIPTION:, #+KEYWORDS:,
12991 @itemx #+LATEX_HEADER:, #+STYLE:, #+LINK_UP:, #+LINK_HOME:,
12992 @itemx #+EXPORT_SELECT_TAGS:, #+EXPORT_EXCLUDE_TAGS:
12993 These lines provide settings for exporting files. For more details see
12994 @ref{Export options}.
12995 @item #+TODO: #+SEQ_TODO: #+TYP_TODO:
12996 @vindex org-todo-keywords
12997 These lines set the TODO keywords and their interpretation in the
12998 current file. The corresponding variable is @code{org-todo-keywords}.
13001 @node The very busy C-c C-c key, Clean view, In-buffer settings, Miscellaneous
13002 @section The very busy C-c C-c key
13004 @cindex C-c C-c, overview
13006 The key @kbd{C-c C-c} has many purposes in Org, which are all
13007 mentioned scattered throughout this manual. One specific function of
13008 this key is to add @emph{tags} to a headline (@pxref{Tags}). In many
13009 other circumstances it means something like @emph{``Hey Org, look
13010 here and update according to what you see here''}. Here is a summary of
13011 what this means in different contexts.
13015 If there are highlights in the buffer from the creation of a sparse
13016 tree, or from clock display, remove these highlights.
13018 If the cursor is in one of the special @code{#+KEYWORD} lines, this
13019 triggers scanning the buffer for these lines and updating the
13022 If the cursor is inside a table, realign the table. This command
13023 works even if the automatic table editor has been turned off.
13025 If the cursor is on a @code{#+TBLFM} line, re-apply the formulas to
13028 If the current buffer is a capture buffer, close the note and file it.
13029 With a prefix argument, file it, without further interaction, to the
13032 If the cursor is on a @code{<<<target>>>}, update radio targets and
13033 corresponding links in this buffer.
13035 If the cursor is in a property line or at the start or end of a property
13036 drawer, offer property commands.
13038 If the cursor is at a footnote reference, go to the corresponding
13039 definition, and vice versa.
13041 If the cursor is on a statistics cookie, update it.
13043 If the cursor is in a plain list item with a checkbox, toggle the status
13046 If the cursor is on a numbered item in a plain list, renumber the
13049 If the cursor is on the @code{#+BEGIN} line of a dynamic block, the
13053 @node Clean view, TTY keys, The very busy C-c C-c key, Miscellaneous
13054 @section A cleaner outline view
13055 @cindex hiding leading stars
13056 @cindex dynamic indentation
13057 @cindex odd-levels-only outlines
13058 @cindex clean outline view
13060 Some people find it noisy and distracting that the Org headlines start with a
13061 potentially large number of stars, and that text below the headlines is not
13062 indented. While this is no problem when writing a @emph{book-like} document
13063 where the outline headings are really section headings, in a more
13064 @emph{list-oriented} outline, indented structure is a lot cleaner:
13068 * Top level headline | * Top level headline
13069 ** Second level | * Second level
13070 *** 3rd level | * 3rd level
13071 some text | some text
13072 *** 3rd level | * 3rd level
13073 more text | more text
13074 * Another top level headline | * Another top level headline
13080 If you are using at least Emacs 23.2@footnote{Emacs 23.1 can actually crash
13081 with @code{org-indent-mode}} and version 6.29 of Org, this kind of view can
13082 be achieved dynamically at display time using @code{org-indent-mode}. In
13083 this minor mode, all lines are prefixed for display with the necessary amount
13084 of space@footnote{@code{org-indent-mode} also sets the @code{wrap-prefix}
13085 property, such that @code{visual-line-mode} (or purely setting
13086 @code{word-wrap}) wraps long lines (including headlines) correctly indented.
13087 }. Also headlines are prefixed with additional stars, so that the amount of
13088 indentation shifts by two@footnote{See the variable
13089 @code{org-indent-indentation-per-level}.} spaces per level. All headline
13090 stars but the last one are made invisible using the @code{org-hide}
13091 face@footnote{Turning on @code{org-indent-mode} sets
13092 @code{org-hide-leading-stars} to @code{t} and @code{org-adapt-indentation} to
13093 @code{nil}.} - see below under @samp{2.} for more information on how this
13094 works. You can turn on @code{org-indent-mode} for all files by customizing
13095 the variable @code{org-startup-indented}, or you can turn it on for
13096 individual files using
13102 If you want a similar effect in an earlier version of Emacs and/or Org, or if
13103 you want the indentation to be hard space characters so that the plain text
13104 file looks as similar as possible to the Emacs display, Org supports you in
13109 @emph{Indentation of text below headlines}@*
13110 You may indent text below each headline to make the left boundary line up
13111 with the headline, like
13115 more text, now indented
13118 @vindex org-adapt-indentation
13119 Org supports this with paragraph filling, line wrapping, and structure
13120 editing@footnote{See also the variable @code{org-adapt-indentation}.},
13121 preserving or adapting the indentation as appropriate.
13124 @vindex org-hide-leading-stars
13125 @emph{Hiding leading stars}@* You can modify the display in such a way that
13126 all leading stars become invisible. To do this in a global way, configure
13127 the variable @code{org-hide-leading-stars} or change this on a per-file basis
13131 #+STARTUP: hidestars
13132 #+STARTUP: showstars
13135 With hidden stars, the tree becomes:
13139 * Top level headline
13147 @vindex org-hide @r{(face)}
13148 The leading stars are not truly replaced by whitespace, they are only
13149 fontified with the face @code{org-hide} that uses the background color as
13150 font color. If you are not using either white or black background, you may
13151 have to customize this face to get the wanted effect. Another possibility is
13152 to set this font such that the extra stars are @i{almost} invisible, for
13153 example using the color @code{grey90} on a white background.
13156 @vindex org-odd-levels-only
13157 Things become cleaner still if you skip all the even levels and use only odd
13158 levels 1, 3, 5..., effectively adding two stars to go from one outline level
13159 to the next@footnote{When you need to specify a level for a property search
13160 or refile targets, @samp{LEVEL=2} will correspond to 3 stars, etc@.}. In this
13161 way we get the outline view shown at the beginning of this section. In order
13162 to make the structure editing and export commands handle this convention
13163 correctly, configure the variable @code{org-odd-levels-only}, or set this on
13164 a per-file basis with one of the following lines:
13171 You can convert an Org file from single-star-per-level to the
13172 double-star-per-level convention with @kbd{M-x org-convert-to-odd-levels
13173 RET} in that file. The reverse operation is @kbd{M-x
13174 org-convert-to-oddeven-levels}.
13177 @node TTY keys, Interaction, Clean view, Miscellaneous
13178 @section Using Org on a tty
13179 @cindex tty key bindings
13181 Because Org contains a large number of commands, by default many of
13182 Org's core commands are bound to keys that are generally not
13183 accessible on a tty, such as the cursor keys (@key{left}, @key{right},
13184 @key{up}, @key{down}), @key{TAB} and @key{RET}, in particular when used
13185 together with modifiers like @key{Meta} and/or @key{Shift}. To access
13186 these commands on a tty when special keys are unavailable, the following
13187 alternative bindings can be used. The tty bindings below will likely be
13188 more cumbersome; you may find for some of the bindings below that a
13189 customized workaround suits you better. For example, changing a timestamp
13190 is really only fun with @kbd{S-@key{cursor}} keys, whereas on a
13191 tty you would rather use @kbd{C-c .} to re-insert the timestamp.
13193 @multitable @columnfractions 0.15 0.2 0.1 0.2
13194 @item @b{Default} @tab @b{Alternative 1} @tab @b{Speed key} @tab @b{Alternative 2}
13195 @item @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} @tab @kbd{C-u @key{TAB}} @tab @kbd{C} @tab
13196 @item @kbd{M-@key{left}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x l} @tab @kbd{l} @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{left}}
13197 @item @kbd{M-S-@key{left}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x L} @tab @kbd{L} @tab
13198 @item @kbd{M-@key{right}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x r} @tab @kbd{r} @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{right}}
13199 @item @kbd{M-S-@key{right}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x R} @tab @kbd{R} @tab
13200 @item @kbd{M-@key{up}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x u} @tab @kbd{ } @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{up}}
13201 @item @kbd{M-S-@key{up}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x U} @tab @kbd{U} @tab
13202 @item @kbd{M-@key{down}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x d} @tab @kbd{ } @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{down}}
13203 @item @kbd{M-S-@key{down}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x D} @tab @kbd{D} @tab
13204 @item @kbd{S-@key{RET}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x c} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
13205 @item @kbd{M-@key{RET}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x m} @tab @kbd{ } @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{RET}}
13206 @item @kbd{M-S-@key{RET}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x M} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
13207 @item @kbd{S-@key{left}} @tab @kbd{C-c @key{left}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
13208 @item @kbd{S-@key{right}} @tab @kbd{C-c @key{right}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
13209 @item @kbd{S-@key{up}} @tab @kbd{C-c @key{up}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
13210 @item @kbd{S-@key{down}} @tab @kbd{C-c @key{down}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
13211 @item @kbd{C-S-@key{left}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x @key{left}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
13212 @item @kbd{C-S-@key{right}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x @key{right}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
13216 @node Interaction, , TTY keys, Miscellaneous
13217 @section Interaction with other packages
13218 @cindex packages, interaction with other
13219 Org lives in the world of GNU Emacs and interacts in various ways
13220 with other code out there.
13223 * Cooperation:: Packages Org cooperates with
13224 * Conflicts:: Packages that lead to conflicts
13227 @node Cooperation, Conflicts, Interaction, Interaction
13228 @subsection Packages that Org cooperates with
13231 @cindex @file{calc.el}
13232 @cindex Gillespie, Dave
13233 @item @file{calc.el} by Dave Gillespie
13234 Org uses the Calc package for implementing spreadsheet
13235 functionality in its tables (@pxref{The spreadsheet}). Org
13236 checks for the availability of Calc by looking for the function
13237 @code{calc-eval} which will have been autoloaded during setup if Calc has
13238 been installed properly. As of Emacs 22, Calc is part of the Emacs
13239 distribution. Another possibility for interaction between the two
13240 packages is using Calc for embedded calculations. @xref{Embedded Mode,
13241 , Embedded Mode, Calc, GNU Emacs Calc Manual}.
13242 @item @file{constants.el} by Carsten Dominik
13243 @cindex @file{constants.el}
13244 @cindex Dominik, Carsten
13245 @vindex org-table-formula-constants
13246 In a table formula (@pxref{The spreadsheet}), it is possible to use
13247 names for natural constants or units. Instead of defining your own
13248 constants in the variable @code{org-table-formula-constants}, install
13249 the @file{constants} package which defines a large number of constants
13250 and units, and lets you use unit prefixes like @samp{M} for
13251 @samp{Mega}, etc@. You will need version 2.0 of this package, available
13252 at @url{http://www.astro.uva.nl/~dominik/Tools}. Org checks for
13253 the function @code{constants-get}, which has to be autoloaded in your
13254 setup. See the installation instructions in the file
13255 @file{constants.el}.
13256 @item @file{cdlatex.el} by Carsten Dominik
13257 @cindex @file{cdlatex.el}
13258 @cindex Dominik, Carsten
13259 Org-mode can make use of the CDLa@TeX{} package to efficiently enter
13260 @LaTeX{} fragments into Org files. See @ref{CDLaTeX mode}.
13261 @item @file{imenu.el} by Ake Stenhoff and Lars Lindberg
13262 @cindex @file{imenu.el}
13263 Imenu allows menu access to an index of items in a file. Org-mode
13264 supports Imenu---all you need to do to get the index is the following:
13266 (add-hook 'org-mode-hook
13267 (lambda () (imenu-add-to-menubar "Imenu")))
13269 @vindex org-imenu-depth
13270 By default the index is two levels deep---you can modify the depth using
13271 the option @code{org-imenu-depth}.
13272 @item @file{remember.el} by John Wiegley
13273 @cindex @file{remember.el}
13274 @cindex Wiegley, John
13275 Org used to use this package for capture, but no longer does.
13276 @item @file{speedbar.el} by Eric M. Ludlam
13277 @cindex @file{speedbar.el}
13278 @cindex Ludlam, Eric M.
13279 Speedbar is a package that creates a special frame displaying files and
13280 index items in files. Org-mode supports Speedbar and allows you to
13281 drill into Org files directly from the Speedbar. It also allows you to
13282 restrict the scope of agenda commands to a file or a subtree by using
13283 the command @kbd{<} in the Speedbar frame.
13284 @cindex @file{table.el}
13285 @item @file{table.el} by Takaaki Ota
13287 @cindex table editor, @file{table.el}
13288 @cindex @file{table.el}
13289 @cindex Ota, Takaaki
13291 Complex ASCII tables with automatic line wrapping, column- and row-spanning,
13292 and alignment can be created using the Emacs table package by Takaaki Ota
13293 (@uref{http://sourceforge.net/projects/table}, and also part of Emacs 22).
13294 Org-mode will recognize these tables and export them properly. Because of
13295 interference with other Org-mode functionality, you unfortunately cannot edit
13296 these tables directly in the buffer. Instead, you need to use the command
13297 @kbd{C-c '} to edit them, similar to source code snippets.
13300 @orgcmd{C-c ',org-edit-special}
13301 Edit a @file{table.el} table. Works when the cursor is in a table.el table.
13303 @orgcmd{C-c ~,org-table-create-with-table.el}
13304 Insert a @file{table.el} table. If there is already a table at point, this
13305 command converts it between the @file{table.el} format and the Org-mode
13306 format. See the documentation string of the command
13307 @code{org-convert-table} for the restrictions under which this is
13310 @file{table.el} is part of Emacs since Emacs 22.
13311 @item @file{footnote.el} by Steven L. Baur
13312 @cindex @file{footnote.el}
13313 @cindex Baur, Steven L.
13314 Org-mode recognizes numerical footnotes as provided by this package.
13315 However, Org-mode also has its own footnote support (@pxref{Footnotes}),
13316 which makes using @file{footnote.el} unnecessary.
13319 @node Conflicts, , Cooperation, Interaction
13320 @subsection Packages that lead to conflicts with Org-mode
13324 @cindex @code{shift-selection-mode}
13325 @vindex org-support-shift-select
13326 In Emacs 23, @code{shift-selection-mode} is on by default, meaning that
13327 cursor motions combined with the shift key should start or enlarge regions.
13328 This conflicts with the use of @kbd{S-@key{cursor}} commands in Org to change
13329 timestamps, TODO keywords, priorities, and item bullet types if the cursor is
13330 at such a location. By default, @kbd{S-@key{cursor}} commands outside
13331 special contexts don't do anything, but you can customize the variable
13332 @code{org-support-shift-select}. Org-mode then tries to accommodate shift
13333 selection by (i) using it outside of the special contexts where special
13334 commands apply, and by (ii) extending an existing active region even if the
13335 cursor moves across a special context.
13337 @item @file{CUA.el} by Kim. F. Storm
13338 @cindex @file{CUA.el}
13339 @cindex Storm, Kim. F.
13340 @vindex org-replace-disputed-keys
13341 Key bindings in Org conflict with the @kbd{S-<cursor>} keys used by CUA mode
13342 (as well as @code{pc-select-mode} and @code{s-region-mode}) to select and extend the
13343 region. In fact, Emacs 23 has this built-in in the form of
13344 @code{shift-selection-mode}, see previous paragraph. If you are using Emacs
13345 23, you probably don't want to use another package for this purpose. However,
13346 if you prefer to leave these keys to a different package while working in
13347 Org-mode, configure the variable @code{org-replace-disputed-keys}. When set,
13348 Org will move the following key bindings in Org files, and in the agenda
13349 buffer (but not during date selection).
13352 S-UP -> M-p S-DOWN -> M-n
13353 S-LEFT -> M-- S-RIGHT -> M-+
13354 C-S-LEFT -> M-S-- C-S-RIGHT -> M-S-+
13357 @vindex org-disputed-keys
13358 Yes, these are unfortunately more difficult to remember. If you want
13359 to have other replacement keys, look at the variable
13360 @code{org-disputed-keys}.
13362 @item @file{yasnippet.el}
13363 @cindex @file{yasnippet.el}
13364 The way Org-mode binds the TAB key (binding to @code{[tab]} instead of
13365 @code{"\t"}) overrules YASnippet's access to this key. The following code
13366 fixed this problem:
13369 (add-hook 'org-mode-hook
13371 (org-set-local 'yas/trigger-key [tab])
13372 (define-key yas/keymap [tab] 'yas/next-field-group)))
13375 @item @file{windmove.el} by Hovav Shacham
13376 @cindex @file{windmove.el}
13377 This package also uses the @kbd{S-<cursor>} keys, so everything written
13378 in the paragraph above about CUA mode also applies here. If you want make
13379 the windmove function active in locations where Org-mode does not have
13380 special functionality on @kbd{S-@key{cursor}}, add this to your
13384 ;; Make windmove work in org-mode:
13385 (add-hook 'org-shiftup-final-hook 'windmove-up)
13386 (add-hook 'org-shiftleft-final-hook 'windmove-left)
13387 (add-hook 'org-shiftdown-final-hook 'windmove-down)
13388 (add-hook 'org-shiftright-final-hook 'windmove-right)
13391 @item @file{viper.el} by Michael Kifer
13392 @cindex @file{viper.el}
13394 Viper uses @kbd{C-c /} and therefore makes this key not access the
13395 corresponding Org-mode command @code{org-sparse-tree}. You need to find
13396 another key for this command, or override the key in
13397 @code{viper-vi-global-user-map} with
13400 (define-key viper-vi-global-user-map "C-c /" 'org-sparse-tree)
13406 @node Hacking, MobileOrg, Miscellaneous, Top
13410 This appendix covers some aspects where users can extend the functionality of
13414 * Hooks:: Who to reach into Org's internals
13415 * Add-on packages:: Available extensions
13416 * Adding hyperlink types:: New custom link types
13417 * Context-sensitive commands:: How to add functionality to such commands
13418 * Tables in arbitrary syntax:: Orgtbl for @LaTeX{} and other programs
13419 * Dynamic blocks:: Automatically filled blocks
13420 * Special agenda views:: Customized views
13421 * Extracting agenda information:: Postprocessing of agenda information
13422 * Using the property API:: Writing programs that use entry properties
13423 * Using the mapping API:: Mapping over all or selected entries
13426 @node Hooks, Add-on packages, Hacking, Hacking
13430 Org has a large number of hook variables that can be used to add
13431 functionality. This appendix about hacking is going to illustrate the
13432 use of some of them. A complete list of all hooks with documentation is
13433 maintained by the Worg project and can be found at
13434 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-configs/org-hooks.php}.
13436 @node Add-on packages, Adding hyperlink types, Hooks, Hacking
13437 @section Add-on packages
13438 @cindex add-on packages
13440 A large number of add-on packages have been written by various authors.
13441 These packages are not part of Emacs, but they are distributed as contributed
13442 packages with the separate release available at the Org-mode home page at
13443 @uref{http://orgmode.org}. The list of contributed packages, along with
13444 documentation about each package, is maintained by the Worg project at
13445 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-contrib/}.
13449 @node Adding hyperlink types, Context-sensitive commands, Add-on packages, Hacking
13450 @section Adding hyperlink types
13451 @cindex hyperlinks, adding new types
13453 Org has a large number of hyperlink types built-in
13454 (@pxref{Hyperlinks}). If you would like to add new link types, Org
13455 provides an interface for doing so. Let's look at an example file,
13456 @file{org-man.el}, that will add support for creating links like
13457 @samp{[[man:printf][The printf manpage]]} to show Unix manual pages inside
13461 ;;; org-man.el - Support for links to manpages in Org
13465 (org-add-link-type "man" 'org-man-open)
13466 (add-hook 'org-store-link-functions 'org-man-store-link)
13468 (defcustom org-man-command 'man
13469 "The Emacs command to be used to display a man page."
13471 :type '(choice (const man) (const woman)))
13473 (defun org-man-open (path)
13474 "Visit the manpage on PATH.
13475 PATH should be a topic that can be thrown at the man command."
13476 (funcall org-man-command path))
13478 (defun org-man-store-link ()
13479 "Store a link to a manpage."
13480 (when (memq major-mode '(Man-mode woman-mode))
13481 ;; This is a man page, we do make this link
13482 (let* ((page (org-man-get-page-name))
13483 (link (concat "man:" page))
13484 (description (format "Manpage for %s" page)))
13485 (org-store-link-props
13488 :description description))))
13490 (defun org-man-get-page-name ()
13491 "Extract the page name from the buffer name."
13492 ;; This works for both `Man-mode' and `woman-mode'.
13493 (if (string-match " \\(\\S-+\\)\\*" (buffer-name))
13494 (match-string 1 (buffer-name))
13495 (error "Cannot create link to this man page")))
13499 ;;; org-man.el ends here
13503 You would activate this new link type in @file{.emacs} with
13510 Let's go through the file and see what it does.
13513 It does @code{(require 'org)} to make sure that @file{org.el} has been
13516 The next line calls @code{org-add-link-type} to define a new link type
13517 with prefix @samp{man}. The call also contains the name of a function
13518 that will be called to follow such a link.
13520 @vindex org-store-link-functions
13521 The next line adds a function to @code{org-store-link-functions}, in
13522 order to allow the command @kbd{C-c l} to record a useful link in a
13523 buffer displaying a man page.
13526 The rest of the file defines the necessary variables and functions.
13527 First there is a customization variable that determines which Emacs
13528 command should be used to display man pages. There are two options,
13529 @code{man} and @code{woman}. Then the function to follow a link is
13530 defined. It gets the link path as an argument---in this case the link
13531 path is just a topic for the manual command. The function calls the
13532 value of @code{org-man-command} to display the man page.
13534 Finally the function @code{org-man-store-link} is defined. When you try
13535 to store a link with @kbd{C-c l}, this function will be called to
13536 try to make a link. The function must first decide if it is supposed to
13537 create the link for this buffer type; we do this by checking the value
13538 of the variable @code{major-mode}. If not, the function must exit and
13539 return the value @code{nil}. If yes, the link is created by getting the
13540 manual topic from the buffer name and prefixing it with the string
13541 @samp{man:}. Then it must call the command @code{org-store-link-props}
13542 and set the @code{:type} and @code{:link} properties. Optionally you
13543 can also set the @code{:description} property to provide a default for
13544 the link description when the link is later inserted into an Org
13545 buffer with @kbd{C-c C-l}.
13547 When it makes sense for your new link type, you may also define a function
13548 @code{org-PREFIX-complete-link} that implements special (e.g. completion)
13549 support for inserting such a link with @kbd{C-c C-l}. Such a function should
13550 not accept any arguments, and return the full link with prefix.
13552 @node Context-sensitive commands, Tables in arbitrary syntax, Adding hyperlink types, Hacking
13553 @section Context-sensitive commands
13554 @cindex context-sensitive commands, hooks
13555 @cindex add-ons, context-sensitive commands
13556 @vindex org-ctrl-c-ctrl-c-hook
13558 Org has several commands that act differently depending on context. The most
13559 important example it the @kbd{C-c C-c} (@pxref{The very busy C-c C-c key}).
13560 Also the @kbd{M-cursor} and @kbd{M-S-cursor} keys have this property.
13562 Add-ons can tap into this functionality by providing a function that detects
13563 special context for that add-on and executes functionality appropriate for
13564 the context. Here is an example from Dan Davison's @file{org-R.el} which
13565 allows you to evaluate commands based on the @file{R} programming language
13566 @footnote{@file{org-R.el} has been replaced by the org-mode functionality
13567 described in @ref{Working With Source Code} and is now obsolete.}. For this
13568 package, special contexts are lines that start with @code{#+R:} or
13572 (defun org-R-apply-maybe ()
13573 "Detect if this is context for org-R and execute R commands."
13574 (if (save-excursion
13575 (beginning-of-line 1)
13576 (looking-at "#\\+RR?:"))
13577 (progn (call-interactively 'org-R-apply)
13578 t) ;; to signal that we took action
13579 nil)) ;; to signal that we did not
13581 (add-hook 'org-ctrl-c-ctrl-c-hook 'org-R-apply-maybe)
13584 The function first checks if the cursor is in such a line. If that is the
13585 case, @code{org-R-apply} is called and the function returns @code{t} to
13586 signal that action was taken, and @kbd{C-c C-c} will stop looking for other
13587 contexts. If the function finds it should do nothing locally, it returns @code{nil} so that other, similar functions can have a try.
13590 @node Tables in arbitrary syntax, Dynamic blocks, Context-sensitive commands, Hacking
13591 @section Tables and lists in arbitrary syntax
13592 @cindex tables, in other modes
13593 @cindex lists, in other modes
13594 @cindex Orgtbl mode
13596 Since Orgtbl mode can be used as a minor mode in arbitrary buffers, a
13597 frequent feature request has been to make it work with native tables in
13598 specific languages, for example @LaTeX{}. However, this is extremely
13599 hard to do in a general way, would lead to a customization nightmare,
13600 and would take away much of the simplicity of the Orgtbl-mode table
13603 This appendix describes a different approach. We keep the Orgtbl mode
13604 table in its native format (the @i{source table}), and use a custom
13605 function to @i{translate} the table to the correct syntax, and to
13606 @i{install} it in the right location (the @i{target table}). This puts
13607 the burden of writing conversion functions on the user, but it allows
13608 for a very flexible system.
13610 Bastien added the ability to do the same with lists, in Orgstruct mode. You
13611 can use Org's facilities to edit and structure lists by turning
13612 @code{orgstruct-mode} on, then locally exporting such lists in another format
13613 (HTML, @LaTeX{} or Texinfo.)
13617 * Radio tables:: Sending and receiving radio tables
13618 * A LaTeX example:: Step by step, almost a tutorial
13619 * Translator functions:: Copy and modify
13620 * Radio lists:: Doing the same for lists
13623 @node Radio tables, A LaTeX example, Tables in arbitrary syntax, Tables in arbitrary syntax
13624 @subsection Radio tables
13625 @cindex radio tables
13627 To define the location of the target table, you first need to create two
13628 lines that are comments in the current mode, but contain magic words for
13629 Orgtbl mode to find. Orgtbl mode will insert the translated table
13630 between these lines, replacing whatever was there before. For example:
13633 /* BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL table_name */
13634 /* END RECEIVE ORGTBL table_name */
13638 Just above the source table, we put a special line that tells
13639 Orgtbl mode how to translate this table and where to install it. For
13643 #+ORGTBL: SEND table_name translation_function arguments....
13647 @code{table_name} is the reference name for the table that is also used
13648 in the receiver lines. @code{translation_function} is the Lisp function
13649 that does the translation. Furthermore, the line can contain a list of
13650 arguments (alternating key and value) at the end. The arguments will be
13651 passed as a property list to the translation function for
13652 interpretation. A few standard parameters are already recognized and
13653 acted upon before the translation function is called:
13657 Skip the first N lines of the table. Hlines do count as separate lines for
13660 @item :skipcols (n1 n2 ...)
13661 List of columns that should be skipped. If the table has a column with
13662 calculation marks, that column is automatically discarded as well.
13663 Please note that the translator function sees the table @emph{after} the
13664 removal of these columns, the function never knows that there have been
13665 additional columns.
13669 The one problem remaining is how to keep the source table in the buffer
13670 without disturbing the normal workings of the file, for example during
13671 compilation of a C file or processing of a @LaTeX{} file. There are a
13672 number of different solutions:
13676 The table could be placed in a block comment if that is supported by the
13677 language. For example, in C mode you could wrap the table between
13678 @samp{/*} and @samp{*/} lines.
13680 Sometimes it is possible to put the table after some kind of @i{END}
13681 statement, for example @samp{\bye} in @TeX{} and @samp{\end@{document@}}
13684 You can just comment the table line-by-line whenever you want to process
13685 the file, and uncomment it whenever you need to edit the table. This
13686 only sounds tedious---the command @kbd{M-x orgtbl-toggle-comment}
13687 makes this comment-toggling very easy, in particular if you bind it to a
13691 @node A LaTeX example, Translator functions, Radio tables, Tables in arbitrary syntax
13692 @subsection A @LaTeX{} example of radio tables
13693 @cindex @LaTeX{}, and Orgtbl mode
13695 The best way to wrap the source table in @LaTeX{} is to use the
13696 @code{comment} environment provided by @file{comment.sty}. It has to be
13697 activated by placing @code{\usepackage@{comment@}} into the document
13698 header. Orgtbl mode can insert a radio table skeleton@footnote{By
13699 default this works only for @LaTeX{}, HTML, and Texinfo. Configure the
13700 variable @code{orgtbl-radio-tables} to install templates for other
13701 modes.} with the command @kbd{M-x orgtbl-insert-radio-table}. You will
13702 be prompted for a table name, let's say we use @samp{salesfigures}. You
13703 will then get the following template:
13705 @cindex #+ORGTBL, SEND
13707 % BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
13708 % END RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
13710 #+ORGTBL: SEND salesfigures orgtbl-to-latex
13716 @vindex @LaTeX{}-verbatim-environments
13717 The @code{#+ORGTBL: SEND} line tells Orgtbl mode to use the function
13718 @code{orgtbl-to-latex} to convert the table into @LaTeX{} and to put it
13719 into the receiver location with name @code{salesfigures}. You may now
13720 fill in the table---feel free to use the spreadsheet features@footnote{If
13721 the @samp{#+TBLFM} line contains an odd number of dollar characters,
13722 this may cause problems with font-lock in @LaTeX{} mode. As shown in the
13723 example you can fix this by adding an extra line inside the
13724 @code{comment} environment that is used to balance the dollar
13725 expressions. If you are using AUC@TeX{} with the font-latex library, a
13726 much better solution is to add the @code{comment} environment to the
13727 variable @code{LaTeX-verbatim-environments}.}:
13730 % BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
13731 % END RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
13733 #+ORGTBL: SEND salesfigures orgtbl-to-latex
13734 | Month | Days | Nr sold | per day |
13735 |-------+------+---------+---------|
13736 | Jan | 23 | 55 | 2.4 |
13737 | Feb | 21 | 16 | 0.8 |
13738 | March | 22 | 278 | 12.6 |
13739 #+TBLFM: $4=$3/$2;%.1f
13740 % $ (optional extra dollar to keep font-lock happy, see footnote)
13745 When you are done, press @kbd{C-c C-c} in the table to get the converted
13746 table inserted between the two marker lines.
13748 Now let's assume you want to make the table header by hand, because you
13749 want to control how columns are aligned, etc@. In this case we make sure
13750 that the table translator skips the first 2 lines of the source
13751 table, and tell the command to work as a @i{splice}, i.e. to not produce
13752 header and footer commands of the target table:
13755 \begin@{tabular@}@{lrrr@}
13756 Month & \multicolumn@{1@}@{c@}@{Days@} & Nr.\ sold & per day\\
13757 % BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
13758 % END RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
13762 #+ORGTBL: SEND salesfigures orgtbl-to-latex :splice t :skip 2
13763 | Month | Days | Nr sold | per day |
13764 |-------+------+---------+---------|
13765 | Jan | 23 | 55 | 2.4 |
13766 | Feb | 21 | 16 | 0.8 |
13767 | March | 22 | 278 | 12.6 |
13768 #+TBLFM: $4=$3/$2;%.1f
13772 The @LaTeX{} translator function @code{orgtbl-to-latex} is already part of
13773 Orgtbl mode. It uses a @code{tabular} environment to typeset the table
13774 and marks horizontal lines with @code{\hline}. Furthermore, it
13775 interprets the following parameters (see also @pxref{Translator functions}):
13778 @item :splice nil/t
13779 When set to t, return only table body lines, don't wrap them into a
13780 tabular environment. Default is nil.
13783 A format to be used to wrap each field, it should contain @code{%s} for the
13784 original field value. For example, to wrap each field value in dollars,
13785 you could use @code{:fmt "$%s$"}. This may also be a property list with
13786 column numbers and formats. for example @code{:fmt (2 "$%s$" 4 "%s\\%%")}.
13787 A function of one argument can be used in place of the strings; the
13788 function must return a formatted string.
13791 Use this format to print numbers with exponentials. The format should
13792 have @code{%s} twice for inserting mantissa and exponent, for example
13793 @code{"%s\\times10^@{%s@}"}. The default is @code{"%s\\,(%s)"}. This
13794 may also be a property list with column numbers and formats, for example
13795 @code{:efmt (2 "$%s\\times10^@{%s@}$" 4 "$%s\\cdot10^@{%s@}$")}. After
13796 @code{efmt} has been applied to a value, @code{fmt} will also be
13797 applied. Similar to @code{fmt}, functions of two arguments can be
13798 supplied instead of strings.
13801 @node Translator functions, Radio lists, A LaTeX example, Tables in arbitrary syntax
13802 @subsection Translator functions
13803 @cindex HTML, and Orgtbl mode
13804 @cindex translator function
13806 Orgtbl mode has several translator functions built-in: @code{orgtbl-to-csv}
13807 (comma-separated values), @code{orgtbl-to-tsv} (TAB-separated values)
13808 @code{orgtbl-to-latex}, @code{orgtbl-to-html}, and @code{orgtbl-to-texinfo}.
13809 Except for @code{orgtbl-to-html}@footnote{The HTML translator uses the same
13810 code that produces tables during HTML export.}, these all use a generic
13811 translator, @code{orgtbl-to-generic}. For example, @code{orgtbl-to-latex}
13812 itself is a very short function that computes the column definitions for the
13813 @code{tabular} environment, defines a few field and line separators and then
13814 hands processing over to the generic translator. Here is the entire code:
13818 (defun orgtbl-to-latex (table params)
13819 "Convert the Orgtbl mode TABLE to LaTeX."
13820 (let* ((alignment (mapconcat (lambda (x) (if x "r" "l"))
13821 org-table-last-alignment ""))
13824 :tstart (concat "\\begin@{tabular@}@{" alignment "@}")
13825 :tend "\\end@{tabular@}"
13826 :lstart "" :lend " \\\\" :sep " & "
13827 :efmt "%s\\,(%s)" :hline "\\hline")))
13828 (orgtbl-to-generic table (org-combine-plists params2 params))))
13832 As you can see, the properties passed into the function (variable
13833 @var{PARAMS}) are combined with the ones newly defined in the function
13834 (variable @var{PARAMS2}). The ones passed into the function (i.e. the
13835 ones set by the @samp{ORGTBL SEND} line) take precedence. So if you
13836 would like to use the @LaTeX{} translator, but wanted the line endings to
13837 be @samp{\\[2mm]} instead of the default @samp{\\}, you could just
13838 overrule the default with
13841 #+ORGTBL: SEND test orgtbl-to-latex :lend " \\\\[2mm]"
13844 For a new language, you can either write your own converter function in
13845 analogy with the @LaTeX{} translator, or you can use the generic function
13846 directly. For example, if you have a language where a table is started
13847 with @samp{!BTBL!}, ended with @samp{!ETBL!}, and where table lines are
13848 started with @samp{!BL!}, ended with @samp{!EL!}, and where the field
13849 separator is a TAB, you could call the generic translator like this (on
13853 #+ORGTBL: SEND test orgtbl-to-generic :tstart "!BTBL!" :tend "!ETBL!"
13854 :lstart "!BL! " :lend " !EL!" :sep "\t"
13858 Please check the documentation string of the function
13859 @code{orgtbl-to-generic} for a full list of parameters understood by
13860 that function, and remember that you can pass each of them into
13861 @code{orgtbl-to-latex}, @code{orgtbl-to-texinfo}, and any other function
13862 using the generic function.
13864 Of course you can also write a completely new function doing complicated
13865 things the generic translator cannot do. A translator function takes
13866 two arguments. The first argument is the table, a list of lines, each
13867 line either the symbol @code{hline} or a list of fields. The second
13868 argument is the property list containing all parameters specified in the
13869 @samp{#+ORGTBL: SEND} line. The function must return a single string
13870 containing the formatted table. If you write a generally useful
13871 translator, please post it on @email{emacs-orgmode@@gnu.org} so that
13872 others can benefit from your work.
13874 @node Radio lists, , Translator functions, Tables in arbitrary syntax
13875 @subsection Radio lists
13876 @cindex radio lists
13877 @cindex org-list-insert-radio-list
13879 Sending and receiving radio lists works exactly the same way as sending and
13880 receiving radio tables (@pxref{Radio tables}). As for radio tables, you can
13881 insert radio list templates in HTML, @LaTeX{} and Texinfo modes by calling
13882 @code{org-list-insert-radio-list}.
13884 Here are the differences with radio tables:
13888 Orgstruct mode must be active.
13890 Use the @code{ORGLST} keyword instead of @code{ORGTBL}.
13892 The available translation functions for radio lists don't take
13895 @kbd{C-c C-c} will work when pressed on the first item of the list.
13898 Here is a @LaTeX{} example. Let's say that you have this in your
13903 % BEGIN RECEIVE ORGLST to-buy
13904 % END RECEIVE ORGLST to-buy
13906 #+ORGLST: SEND to-buy org-list-to-latex
13915 Pressing `C-c C-c' on @code{a new house} and will insert the converted
13916 @LaTeX{} list between the two marker lines.
13918 @node Dynamic blocks, Special agenda views, Tables in arbitrary syntax, Hacking
13919 @section Dynamic blocks
13920 @cindex dynamic blocks
13922 Org documents can contain @emph{dynamic blocks}. These are
13923 specially marked regions that are updated by some user-written function.
13924 A good example for such a block is the clock table inserted by the
13925 command @kbd{C-c C-x C-r} (@pxref{Clocking work time}).
13927 Dynamic blocks are enclosed by a BEGIN-END structure that assigns a name
13928 to the block and can also specify parameters for the function producing
13929 the content of the block.
13931 @cindex #+BEGIN:dynamic block
13933 #+BEGIN: myblock :parameter1 value1 :parameter2 value2 ...
13938 Dynamic blocks are updated with the following commands
13941 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-u,org-dblock-update}
13942 Update dynamic block at point.
13943 @orgkey{C-u C-c C-x C-u}
13944 Update all dynamic blocks in the current file.
13947 Updating a dynamic block means to remove all the text between BEGIN and
13948 END, parse the BEGIN line for parameters and then call the specific
13949 writer function for this block to insert the new content. If you want
13950 to use the original content in the writer function, you can use the
13951 extra parameter @code{:content}.
13953 For a block with name @code{myblock}, the writer function is
13954 @code{org-dblock-write:myblock} with as only parameter a property list
13955 with the parameters given in the begin line. Here is a trivial example
13956 of a block that keeps track of when the block update function was last
13960 #+BEGIN: block-update-time :format "on %m/%d/%Y at %H:%M"
13966 The corresponding block writer function could look like this:
13969 (defun org-dblock-write:block-update-time (params)
13970 (let ((fmt (or (plist-get params :format) "%d. %m. %Y")))
13971 (insert "Last block update at: "
13972 (format-time-string fmt (current-time)))))
13975 If you want to make sure that all dynamic blocks are always up-to-date,
13976 you could add the function @code{org-update-all-dblocks} to a hook, for
13977 example @code{before-save-hook}. @code{org-update-all-dblocks} is
13978 written in a way such that it does nothing in buffers that are not in
13981 @node Special agenda views, Extracting agenda information, Dynamic blocks, Hacking
13982 @section Special agenda views
13983 @cindex agenda views, user-defined
13985 Org provides a special hook that can be used to narrow down the selection
13986 made by these agenda views: @code{todo}, @code{alltodo}, @code{tags}, @code{tags-todo},
13987 @code{tags-tree}. You may specify a function that is used at each match to verify
13988 if the match should indeed be part of the agenda view, and if not, how
13989 much should be skipped.
13991 Let's say you want to produce a list of projects that contain a WAITING
13992 tag anywhere in the project tree. Let's further assume that you have
13993 marked all tree headings that define a project with the TODO keyword
13994 PROJECT. In this case you would run a TODO search for the keyword
13995 PROJECT, but skip the match unless there is a WAITING tag anywhere in
13996 the subtree belonging to the project line.
13998 To achieve this, you must write a function that searches the subtree for
13999 the tag. If the tag is found, the function must return @code{nil} to
14000 indicate that this match should not be skipped. If there is no such
14001 tag, return the location of the end of the subtree, to indicate that
14002 search should continue from there.
14005 (defun my-skip-unless-waiting ()
14006 "Skip trees that are not waiting"
14007 (let ((subtree-end (save-excursion (org-end-of-subtree t))))
14008 (if (re-search-forward ":waiting:" subtree-end t)
14009 nil ; tag found, do not skip
14010 subtree-end))) ; tag not found, continue after end of subtree
14013 Now you may use this function in an agenda custom command, for example
14017 (org-add-agenda-custom-command
14018 '("b" todo "PROJECT"
14019 ((org-agenda-skip-function 'my-skip-unless-waiting)
14020 (org-agenda-overriding-header "Projects waiting for something: "))))
14023 @vindex org-agenda-overriding-header
14024 Note that this also binds @code{org-agenda-overriding-header} to get a
14025 meaningful header in the agenda view.
14027 @vindex org-odd-levels-only
14028 @vindex org-agenda-skip-function
14029 A general way to create custom searches is to base them on a search for
14030 entries with a certain level limit. If you want to study all entries with
14031 your custom search function, simply do a search for
14032 @samp{LEVEL>0}@footnote{Note that, when using @code{org-odd-levels-only}, a
14033 level number corresponds to order in the hierarchy, not to the number of
14034 stars.}, and then use @code{org-agenda-skip-function} to select the entries
14035 you really want to have.
14037 You may also put a Lisp form into @code{org-agenda-skip-function}. In
14038 particular, you may use the functions @code{org-agenda-skip-entry-if}
14039 and @code{org-agenda-skip-subtree-if} in this form, for example:
14042 @item '(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'scheduled)
14043 Skip current entry if it has been scheduled.
14044 @item '(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'notscheduled)
14045 Skip current entry if it has not been scheduled.
14046 @item '(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'deadline)
14047 Skip current entry if it has a deadline.
14048 @item '(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'scheduled 'deadline)
14049 Skip current entry if it has a deadline, or if it is scheduled.
14050 @item '(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'todo '("TODO" "WAITING"))
14051 Skip current entry if the TODO keyword is TODO or WAITING.
14052 @item '(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'todo 'done)
14053 Skip current entry if the TODO keyword marks a DONE state.
14054 @item '(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'timestamp)
14055 Skip current entry if it has any timestamp, may also be deadline or scheduled.
14056 @item '(org-agenda-skip-entry 'regexp "regular expression")
14057 Skip current entry if the regular expression matches in the entry.
14058 @item '(org-agenda-skip-entry 'notregexp "regular expression")
14059 Skip current entry unless the regular expression matches.
14060 @item '(org-agenda-skip-subtree-if 'regexp "regular expression")
14061 Same as above, but check and skip the entire subtree.
14064 Therefore we could also have written the search for WAITING projects
14065 like this, even without defining a special function:
14068 (org-add-agenda-custom-command
14069 '("b" todo "PROJECT"
14070 ((org-agenda-skip-function '(org-agenda-skip-subtree-if
14071 'regexp ":waiting:"))
14072 (org-agenda-overriding-header "Projects waiting for something: "))))
14075 @node Extracting agenda information, Using the property API, Special agenda views, Hacking
14076 @section Extracting agenda information
14077 @cindex agenda, pipe
14078 @cindex Scripts, for agenda processing
14080 @vindex org-agenda-custom-commands
14081 Org provides commands to access agenda information for the command
14082 line in Emacs batch mode. This extracted information can be sent
14083 directly to a printer, or it can be read by a program that does further
14084 processing of the data. The first of these commands is the function
14085 @code{org-batch-agenda}, that produces an agenda view and sends it as
14086 ASCII text to STDOUT. The command takes a single string as parameter.
14087 If the string has length 1, it is used as a key to one of the commands
14088 you have configured in @code{org-agenda-custom-commands}, basically any
14089 key you can use after @kbd{C-c a}. For example, to directly print the
14090 current TODO list, you could use
14093 emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -eval '(org-batch-agenda "t")' | lpr
14096 If the parameter is a string with 2 or more characters, it is used as a
14097 tags/TODO match string. For example, to print your local shopping list
14098 (all items with the tag @samp{shop}, but excluding the tag
14099 @samp{NewYork}), you could use
14102 emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs \
14103 -eval '(org-batch-agenda "+shop-NewYork")' | lpr
14107 You may also modify parameters on the fly like this:
14110 emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs \
14111 -eval '(org-batch-agenda "a" \
14112 org-agenda-span month \
14113 org-agenda-include-diary nil \
14114 org-agenda-files (quote ("~/org/project.org")))' \
14119 which will produce a 30-day agenda, fully restricted to the Org file
14120 @file{~/org/projects.org}, not even including the diary.
14122 If you want to process the agenda data in more sophisticated ways, you
14123 can use the command @code{org-batch-agenda-csv} to get a comma-separated
14124 list of values for each agenda item. Each line in the output will
14125 contain a number of fields separated by commas. The fields in a line
14129 category @r{The category of the item}
14130 head @r{The headline, without TODO keyword, TAGS and PRIORITY}
14131 type @r{The type of the agenda entry, can be}
14132 todo @r{selected in TODO match}
14133 tagsmatch @r{selected in tags match}
14134 diary @r{imported from diary}
14135 deadline @r{a deadline}
14136 scheduled @r{scheduled}
14137 timestamp @r{appointment, selected by timestamp}
14138 closed @r{entry was closed on date}
14139 upcoming-deadline @r{warning about nearing deadline}
14140 past-scheduled @r{forwarded scheduled item}
14141 block @r{entry has date block including date}
14142 todo @r{The TODO keyword, if any}
14143 tags @r{All tags including inherited ones, separated by colons}
14144 date @r{The relevant date, like 2007-2-14}
14145 time @r{The time, like 15:00-16:50}
14146 extra @r{String with extra planning info}
14147 priority-l @r{The priority letter if any was given}
14148 priority-n @r{The computed numerical priority}
14152 Time and date will only be given if a timestamp (or deadline/scheduled)
14153 led to the selection of the item.
14155 A CSV list like this is very easy to use in a post-processing script.
14156 For example, here is a Perl program that gets the TODO list from
14157 Emacs/Org and prints all the items, preceded by a checkbox:
14162 # define the Emacs command to run
14163 $cmd = "emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -eval '(org-batch-agenda-csv \"t\")'";
14165 # run it and capture the output
14166 $agenda = qx@{$cmd 2>/dev/null@};
14168 # loop over all lines
14169 foreach $line (split(/\n/,$agenda)) @{
14170 # get the individual values
14171 ($category,$head,$type,$todo,$tags,$date,$time,$extra,
14172 $priority_l,$priority_n) = split(/,/,$line);
14173 # process and print
14174 print "[ ] $head\n";
14178 @node Using the property API, Using the mapping API, Extracting agenda information, Hacking
14179 @section Using the property API
14180 @cindex API, for properties
14181 @cindex properties, API
14183 Here is a description of the functions that can be used to work with
14186 @defun org-entry-properties &optional pom which
14187 Get all properties of the entry at point-or-marker POM.@*
14188 This includes the TODO keyword, the tags, time strings for deadline,
14189 scheduled, and clocking, and any additional properties defined in the
14190 entry. The return value is an alist. Keys may occur multiple times
14191 if the property key was used several times.@*
14192 POM may also be nil, in which case the current entry is used.
14193 If WHICH is nil or `all', get all properties. If WHICH is
14194 `special' or `standard', only get that subclass.
14196 @vindex org-use-property-inheritance
14197 @defun org-entry-get pom property &optional inherit
14198 Get value of PROPERTY for entry at point-or-marker POM. By default,
14199 this only looks at properties defined locally in the entry. If INHERIT
14200 is non-nil and the entry does not have the property, then also check
14201 higher levels of the hierarchy. If INHERIT is the symbol
14202 @code{selective}, use inheritance if and only if the setting of
14203 @code{org-use-property-inheritance} selects PROPERTY for inheritance.
14206 @defun org-entry-delete pom property
14207 Delete the property PROPERTY from entry at point-or-marker POM.
14210 @defun org-entry-put pom property value
14211 Set PROPERTY to VALUE for entry at point-or-marker POM.
14214 @defun org-buffer-property-keys &optional include-specials
14215 Get all property keys in the current buffer.
14218 @defun org-insert-property-drawer
14219 Insert a property drawer at point.
14222 @defun org-entry-put-multivalued-property pom property &rest values
14223 Set PROPERTY at point-or-marker POM to VALUES. VALUES should be a list of
14224 strings. They will be concatenated, with spaces as separators.
14227 @defun org-entry-get-multivalued-property pom property
14228 Treat the value of the property PROPERTY as a whitespace-separated list of
14229 values and return the values as a list of strings.
14232 @defun org-entry-add-to-multivalued-property pom property value
14233 Treat the value of the property PROPERTY as a whitespace-separated list of
14234 values and make sure that VALUE is in this list.
14237 @defun org-entry-remove-from-multivalued-property pom property value
14238 Treat the value of the property PROPERTY as a whitespace-separated list of
14239 values and make sure that VALUE is @emph{not} in this list.
14242 @defun org-entry-member-in-multivalued-property pom property value
14243 Treat the value of the property PROPERTY as a whitespace-separated list of
14244 values and check if VALUE is in this list.
14247 @defopt org-property-allowed-value-functions
14248 Hook for functions supplying allowed values for a specific property.
14249 The functions must take a single argument, the name of the property, and
14250 return a flat list of allowed values. If @samp{:ETC} is one of
14251 the values, use the values as completion help, but allow also other values
14252 to be entered. The functions must return @code{nil} if they are not
14253 responsible for this property.
14256 @node Using the mapping API, , Using the property API, Hacking
14257 @section Using the mapping API
14258 @cindex API, for mapping
14259 @cindex mapping entries, API
14261 Org has sophisticated mapping capabilities to find all entries satisfying
14262 certain criteria. Internally, this functionality is used to produce agenda
14263 views, but there is also an API that can be used to execute arbitrary
14264 functions for each or selected entries. The main entry point for this API
14267 @defun org-map-entries func &optional match scope &rest skip
14268 Call FUNC at each headline selected by MATCH in SCOPE.
14270 FUNC is a function or a Lisp form. The function will be called without
14271 arguments, with the cursor positioned at the beginning of the headline.
14272 The return values of all calls to the function will be collected and
14273 returned as a list.
14275 The call to FUNC will be wrapped into a save-excursion form, so FUNC
14276 does not need to preserve point. After evaluation, the cursor will be
14277 moved to the end of the line (presumably of the headline of the
14278 processed entry) and search continues from there. Under some
14279 circumstances, this may not produce the wanted results. For example,
14280 if you have removed (e.g. archived) the current (sub)tree it could
14281 mean that the next entry will be skipped entirely. In such cases, you
14282 can specify the position from where search should continue by making
14283 FUNC set the variable `org-map-continue-from' to the desired buffer
14286 MATCH is a tags/property/todo match as it is used in the agenda match view.
14287 Only headlines that are matched by this query will be considered during
14288 the iteration. When MATCH is nil or t, all headlines will be
14289 visited by the iteration.
14291 SCOPE determines the scope of this command. It can be any of:
14294 nil @r{the current buffer, respecting the restriction if any}
14295 tree @r{the subtree started with the entry at point}
14296 file @r{the current buffer, without restriction}
14298 @r{the current buffer, and any archives associated with it}
14299 agenda @r{all agenda files}
14300 agenda-with-archives
14301 @r{all agenda files with any archive files associated with them}
14303 @r{if this is a list, all files in the list will be scanned}
14306 The remaining args are treated as settings for the skipping facilities of
14307 the scanner. The following items can be given here:
14309 @vindex org-agenda-skip-function
14311 archive @r{skip trees with the archive tag}
14312 comment @r{skip trees with the COMMENT keyword}
14313 function or Lisp form
14314 @r{will be used as value for @code{org-agenda-skip-function},}
14315 @r{so whenever the function returns t, FUNC}
14316 @r{will not be called for that entry and search will}
14317 @r{continue from the point where the function leaves it}
14321 The function given to that mapping routine can really do anything you like.
14322 It can use the property API (@pxref{Using the property API}) to gather more
14323 information about the entry, or in order to change metadata in the entry.
14324 Here are a couple of functions that might be handy:
14326 @defun org-todo &optional arg
14327 Change the TODO state of the entry. See the docstring of the functions for
14328 the many possible values for the argument ARG.
14331 @defun org-priority &optional action
14332 Change the priority of the entry. See the docstring of this function for the
14333 possible values for ACTION.
14336 @defun org-toggle-tag tag &optional onoff
14337 Toggle the tag TAG in the current entry. Setting ONOFF to either @code{on}
14338 or @code{off} will not toggle tag, but ensure that it is either on or off.
14342 Promote the current entry.
14346 Demote the current entry.
14349 Here is a simple example that will turn all entries in the current file with
14350 a tag @code{TOMORROW} into TODO entries with the keyword @code{UPCOMING}.
14351 Entries in comment trees and in archive trees will be ignored.
14355 '(org-todo "UPCOMING")
14356 "+TOMORROW" 'file 'archive 'comment)
14359 The following example counts the number of entries with TODO keyword
14360 @code{WAITING}, in all agenda files.
14363 (length (org-map-entries t "/+WAITING" 'agenda))
14366 @node MobileOrg, History and Acknowledgments, Hacking, Top
14367 @appendix MobileOrg
14371 @uref{http://mobileorg.ncogni.to/, MobileOrg} is an application for the
14372 @i{iPhone/iPod Touch} series of devices, developed by Richard Moreland.
14373 @i{MobileOrg} offers offline viewing and capture support for an Org-mode
14374 system rooted on a ``real'' computer. It does also allow you to record
14375 changes to existing entries. Android users should check out
14376 @uref{http://wiki.github.com/matburt/mobileorg-android/, MobileOrg Android}
14379 This appendix describes the support Org has for creating agenda views in a
14380 format that can be displayed by @i{MobileOrg}, and for integrating notes
14381 captured and changes made by @i{MobileOrg} into the main system.
14383 For changing tags and TODO states in MobileOrg, you should have set up the
14384 customization variables @code{org-todo-keywords} and @code{org-tags-alist} to
14385 cover all important tags and TODO keywords, even if individual files use only
14386 part of these. MobileOrg will also offer you states and tags set up with
14387 in-buffer settings, but it will understand the logistics of TODO state
14388 @i{sets} (@pxref{Per-file keywords}) and @i{mutually exclusive} tags
14389 (@pxref{Setting tags}) only for those set in these variables.
14392 * Setting up the staging area:: Where to interact with the mobile device
14393 * Pushing to MobileOrg:: Uploading Org files and agendas
14394 * Pulling from MobileOrg:: Integrating captured and flagged items
14397 @node Setting up the staging area, Pushing to MobileOrg, MobileOrg, MobileOrg
14398 @section Setting up the staging area
14400 MobileOrg needs to interact with Emacs through a directory on a server. If you
14401 are using a public server, you should consider to encrypt the files that are
14402 uploaded to the server. This can be done with Org-mode 7.02 and with
14403 @i{MobileOrg 1.5} (iPhone version), and you need an @file{openssl}
14404 installation on your system. To turn on encryption, set a password in
14405 @i{MobileOrg} and, on the Emacs side, configure the variable
14406 @code{org-mobile-use-encryption}@footnote{If you can safely store the
14407 password in your Emacs setup, you might also want to configure
14408 @code{org-mobile-encryption-password}. Please read the docstring of that
14409 variable. Note that encryption will apply only to the contents of the
14410 @file{.org} files. The file names themselves will remain visible.}.
14412 The easiest way to create that directory is to use a free
14413 @uref{http://dropbox.com,Dropbox.com} account@footnote{If you cannot use
14414 Dropbox, or if your version of MobileOrg does not support it, you can use a
14415 webdav server. For more information, check out the documentation of MobileOrg and also this
14416 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-faq.php#mobileorg_webdav, FAQ entry}.}.
14417 When MobileOrg first connects to your Dropbox, it will create a directory
14418 @i{MobileOrg} inside the Dropbox. After the directory has been created, tell
14422 (setq org-mobile-directory "~/Dropbox/MobileOrg")
14425 Org-mode has commands to put files for @i{MobileOrg} into that directory,
14426 and to read captured notes from there.
14428 @node Pushing to MobileOrg, Pulling from MobileOrg, Setting up the staging area, MobileOrg
14429 @section Pushing to MobileOrg
14431 This operation copies all files currently listed in @code{org-mobile-files}
14432 to the directory @code{org-mobile-directory}. By default this list contains
14433 all agenda files (as listed in @code{org-agenda-files}), but additional files
14434 can be included by customizing @code{org-mobiles-files}. File names will be
14435 staged with paths relative to @code{org-directory}, so all files should be
14436 inside this directory. The push operation also creates a special Org file
14437 @file{agendas.org} with all custom agenda view defined by the
14438 user@footnote{While creating the agendas, Org-mode will force ID properties
14439 on all referenced entries, so that these entries can be uniquely identified
14440 if @i{MobileOrg} flags them for further action. If you do not want to get
14441 these properties in so many entries, you can set the variable
14442 @code{org-mobile-force-id-on-agenda-items} to @code{nil}. Org mode will then
14443 rely on outline paths, in the hope that these will be unique enough.}.
14444 Finally, Org writes the file @file{index.org}, containing links to all other
14445 files. @i{MobileOrg} first reads this file from the server, and then
14446 downloads all agendas and Org files listed in it. To speed up the download,
14447 MobileOrg will only read files whose checksums@footnote{stored automatically
14448 in the file @file{checksums.dat}} have changed.
14450 @node Pulling from MobileOrg, , Pushing to MobileOrg, MobileOrg
14451 @section Pulling from MobileOrg
14453 When @i{MobileOrg} synchronizes with the server, it not only pulls the Org
14454 files for viewing. It also appends captured entries and pointers to flagged
14455 and changed entries to the file @file{mobileorg.org} on the server. Org has
14456 a @emph{pull} operation that integrates this information into an inbox file
14457 and operates on the pointers to flagged entries. Here is how it works:
14461 Org moves all entries found in
14462 @file{mobileorg.org}@footnote{@file{mobileorg.org} will be empty after this
14463 operation.} and appends them to the file pointed to by the variable
14464 @code{org-mobile-inbox-for-pull}. Each captured entry and each editing event
14465 will be a top-level entry in the inbox file.
14467 After moving the entries, Org will attempt to implement the changes made in
14468 @i{MobileOrg}. Some changes are applied directly and without user
14469 interaction. Examples are all changes to tags, TODO state, headline and body
14470 text that can be cleanly applied. Entries that have been flagged for further
14471 action will receive a tag @code{:FLAGGED:}, so that they can be easily found
14472 again. When there is a problem finding an entry or applying the change, the
14473 pointer entry will remain in the inbox and will be marked with an error
14474 message. You need to later resolve these issues by hand.
14476 Org will then generate an agenda view with all flagged entries. The user
14477 should then go through these entries and do whatever actions are necessary.
14478 If a note has been stored while flagging an entry in @i{MobileOrg}, that note
14479 will be displayed in the echo area when the cursor is on the corresponding
14484 Pressing @kbd{?} in that special agenda will display the full flagging note in
14485 another window and also push it onto the kill ring. So you could use @kbd{?
14486 z C-y C-c C-c} to store that flagging note as a normal note in the entry.
14487 Pressing @kbd{?} twice in succession will offer to remove the
14488 @code{:FLAGGED:} tag along with the recorded flagging note (which is stored
14489 in a property). In this way you indicate that the intended processing for
14490 this flagged entry is finished.
14495 If you are not able to process all flagged entries directly, you can always
14496 return to this agenda view@footnote{Note, however, that there is a subtle
14497 difference. The view created automatically by @kbd{M-x org-mobile-pull
14498 @key{RET}} is guaranteed to search all files that have been addressed by the
14499 last pull. This might include a file that is not currently in your list of
14500 agenda files. If you later use @kbd{C-c a ?} to regenerate the view, only
14501 the current agenda files will be searched.} using @kbd{C-c a ?}.
14503 @node History and Acknowledgments, Main Index, MobileOrg, Top
14504 @appendix History and acknowledgments
14505 @cindex acknowledgments
14509 Org was born in 2003, out of frustration over the user interface of the Emacs
14510 Outline mode. I was trying to organize my notes and projects, and using
14511 Emacs seemed to be the natural way to go. However, having to remember eleven
14512 different commands with two or three keys per command, only to hide and show
14513 parts of the outline tree, that seemed entirely unacceptable to me. Also,
14514 when using outlines to take notes, I constantly wanted to restructure the
14515 tree, organizing it parallel to my thoughts and plans. @emph{Visibility
14516 cycling} and @emph{structure editing} were originally implemented in the
14517 package @file{outline-magic.el}, but quickly moved to the more general
14518 @file{org.el}. As this environment became comfortable for project planning,
14519 the next step was adding @emph{TODO entries}, basic @emph{timestamps}, and
14520 @emph{table support}. These areas highlighted the two main goals that Org
14521 still has today: to be a new, outline-based, plain text mode with innovative
14522 and intuitive editing features, and to incorporate project planning
14523 functionality directly into a notes file.
14525 Since the first release, literally thousands of emails to me or to
14526 @email{emacs-orgmode@@gnu.org} have provided a constant stream of bug
14527 reports, feedback, new ideas, and sometimes patches and add-on code.
14528 Many thanks to everyone who has helped to improve this package. I am
14529 trying to keep here a list of the people who had significant influence
14530 in shaping one or more aspects of Org. The list may not be
14531 complete, if I have forgotten someone, please accept my apologies and
14534 Before I get to this list, a few special mentions are in order:
14537 @item Bastien Guerry
14538 Bastien has written a large number of extensions to Org (most of them
14539 integrated into the core by now), including the LaTeX exporter and the plain
14540 list parser. His support during the early days, when he basically acted as
14541 co-maintainer, was central to the success of this project. Bastien also
14542 invented Worg, helped establishing the Web presence of Org, and sponsors
14543 hosting costs for the orgmode.org website.
14544 @item Eric Schulte and Dan Davison
14545 Eric and Dan are jointly responsible for the Org-babel system, which turns
14546 Org into a multi-language environment for evaluating code and doing literate
14547 programming and reproducible research.
14549 John has contributed a number of great ideas and patches directly to Org,
14550 including the attachment system (@file{org-attach.el}), integration with
14551 Apple Mail (@file{org-mac-message.el}), hierarchical dependencies of TODO
14552 items, habit tracking (@file{org-habits.el}), and encryption
14553 (@file{org-crypt.el}). Also, the capture system is really an extended copy
14554 of his great @file{remember.el}.
14555 @item Sebastian Rose
14556 Without Sebastian, the HTML/XHTML publishing of Org would be the pitiful work
14557 of an ignorant amateur. Sebastian has pushed this part of Org onto a much
14558 higher level. He also wrote @file{org-info.js}, a Java script for displaying
14559 webpages derived from Org using an Info-like or a folding interface with
14560 single-key navigation.
14563 @noindent OK, now to the full list of contributions! Again, please let me
14564 know what I am missing here!
14569 @i{Russel Adams} came up with the idea for drawers.
14571 @i{Thomas Baumann} wrote @file{org-bbdb.el} and @file{org-mhe.el}.
14573 @i{Christophe Bataillon} created the great unicorn logo that we use on the
14576 @i{Alex Bochannek} provided a patch for rounding timestamps.
14578 @i{Jan Böcker} wrote @file{org-docview.el}.
14580 @i{Brad Bozarth} showed how to pull RSS feed data into Org-mode files.
14582 @i{Tom Breton} wrote @file{org-choose.el}.
14584 @i{Charles Cave}'s suggestion sparked the implementation of templates
14585 for Remember, which are now templates for capture.
14587 @i{Pavel Chalmoviansky} influenced the agenda treatment of items with
14590 @i{Gregory Chernov} patched support for Lisp forms into table
14591 calculations and improved XEmacs compatibility, in particular by porting
14592 @file{nouline.el} to XEmacs.
14594 @i{Sacha Chua} suggested copying some linking code from Planner.
14596 @i{Baoqiu Cui} contributed the DocBook exporter.
14598 @i{Eddward DeVilla} proposed and tested checkbox statistics. He also
14599 came up with the idea of properties, and that there should be an API for
14602 @i{Nick Dokos} tracked down several nasty bugs.
14604 @i{Kees Dullemond} used to edit projects lists directly in HTML and so
14605 inspired some of the early development, including HTML export. He also
14606 asked for a way to narrow wide table columns.
14608 @i{Thomas S. Dye} contributed documentation on Worg and helped integrating
14609 the Org-Babel documentation into the manual.
14611 @i{Christian Egli} converted the documentation into Texinfo format, inspired
14612 the agenda, patched CSS formatting into the HTML exporter, and wrote
14613 @file{org-taskjuggler.el}.
14615 @i{David Emery} provided a patch for custom CSS support in exported
14618 @i{Nic Ferrier} contributed mailcap and XOXO support.
14620 @i{Miguel A. Figueroa-Villanueva} implemented hierarchical checkboxes.
14622 @i{John Foerch} figured out how to make incremental search show context
14623 around a match in a hidden outline tree.
14625 @i{Raimar Finken} wrote @file{org-git-line.el}.
14627 @i{Mikael Fornius} works as a mailing list moderator.
14629 @i{Austin Frank} works as a mailing list moderator.
14631 @i{Eric Fraga} drove the development of BEAMER export with ideas and
14634 @i{Barry Gidden} did proofreading the manual in preparation for the book
14635 publication through Network Theory Ltd.
14637 @i{Niels Giesen} had the idea to automatically archive DONE trees.
14639 @i{Nicolas Goaziou} rewrote much of the plain list code.
14641 @i{Kai Grossjohann} pointed out key-binding conflicts with other packages.
14643 @i{Brian Gough} of Network Theory Ltd publishes the Org mode manual as a
14646 @i{Bernt Hansen} has driven much of the support for auto-repeating tasks,
14647 task state change logging, and the clocktable. His clear explanations have
14648 been critical when we started to adopt the Git version control system.
14650 @i{Manuel Hermenegildo} has contributed various ideas, small fixes and
14653 @i{Phil Jackson} wrote @file{org-irc.el}.
14655 @i{Scott Jaderholm} proposed footnotes, control over whitespace between
14656 folded entries, and column view for properties.
14658 @i{Matt Jones} wrote @i{MobileOrg Android}.
14660 @i{Tokuya Kameshima} wrote @file{org-wl.el} and @file{org-mew.el}.
14662 @i{Shidai Liu} ("Leo") asked for embedded @LaTeX{} and tested it. He also
14663 provided frequent feedback and some patches.
14665 @i{Matt Lundin} has proposed last-row references for table formulas and named
14666 invisible anchors. He has also worked a lot on the FAQ.
14668 @i{David Maus} wrote @file{org-atom.el}, maintains the issues file for Org,
14669 and is a prolific contributor on the mailing list with competent replies,
14670 small fixes and patches.
14672 @i{Jason F. McBrayer} suggested agenda export to CSV format.
14674 @i{Max Mikhanosha} came up with the idea of refiling.
14676 @i{Dmitri Minaev} sent a patch to set priority limits on a per-file
14679 @i{Stefan Monnier} provided a patch to keep the Emacs-Lisp compiler
14682 @i{Richard Moreland} wrote @i{MobileOrg} for the iPhone.
14684 @i{Rick Moynihan} proposed allowing multiple TODO sequences in a file
14685 and being able to quickly restrict the agenda to a subtree.
14687 @i{Todd Neal} provided patches for links to Info files and Elisp forms.
14689 @i{Greg Newman} refreshed the unicorn logo into its current form.
14691 @i{Tim O'Callaghan} suggested in-file links, search options for general
14692 file links, and TAGS.
14694 @i{Osamu Okano} wrote @file{orgcard2ref.pl}, a Perl program to create a text
14695 version of the reference card.
14697 @i{Takeshi Okano} translated the manual and David O'Toole's tutorial
14700 @i{Oliver Oppitz} suggested multi-state TODO items.
14702 @i{Scott Otterson} sparked the introduction of descriptive text for
14703 links, among other things.
14705 @i{Pete Phillips} helped during the development of the TAGS feature, and
14706 provided frequent feedback.
14708 @i{Martin Pohlack} provided the code snippet to bundle character insertion
14709 into bundles of 20 for undo.
14711 @i{T.V. Raman} reported bugs and suggested improvements.
14713 @i{Matthias Rempe} (Oelde) provided ideas, Windows support, and quality
14716 @i{Paul Rivier} provided the basic implementation of named footnotes. He
14717 also acted as mailing list moderator for some time.
14719 @i{Kevin Rogers} contributed code to access VM files on remote hosts.
14721 @i{Frank Ruell} solved the mystery of the @code{keymapp nil} bug, a
14722 conflict with @file{allout.el}.
14724 @i{Jason Riedy} generalized the send-receive mechanism for Orgtbl tables with
14727 @i{Philip Rooke} created the Org reference card, provided lots
14728 of feedback, developed and applied standards to the Org documentation.
14730 @i{Christian Schlauer} proposed angular brackets around links, among
14733 @i{Paul Sexton} wrote @file{org-ctags.el}.
14735 Linking to VM/BBDB/Gnus was first inspired by @i{Tom Shannon}'s
14736 @file{organizer-mode.el}.
14738 @i{Ilya Shlyakhter} proposed the Archive Sibling, line numbering in literal
14739 examples, and remote highlighting for referenced code lines.
14741 @i{Stathis Sideris} wrote the @file{ditaa.jar} ASCII to PNG converter that is
14742 now packaged into Org's @file{contrib} directory.
14744 @i{Daniel Sinder} came up with the idea of internal archiving by locking
14747 @i{Dale Smith} proposed link abbreviations.
14749 @i{James TD Smith} has contributed a large number of patches for useful
14750 tweaks and features.
14752 @i{Adam Spiers} asked for global linking commands, inspired the link
14753 extension system, added support for mairix, and proposed the mapping API.
14755 @i{Ulf Stegemann} created the table to translate special symbols to HTML,
14756 LaTeX, UTF-8, Latin-1 and ASCII.
14758 @i{Andy Stewart} contributed code to @file{org-w3m.el}, to copy HTML content
14759 with links transformation to Org syntax.
14761 @i{David O'Toole} wrote @file{org-publish.el} and drafted the manual
14762 chapter about publishing.
14764 @i{Sebastien Vauban} reported many issues with LaTeX and BEAMER export and
14765 enabled source code highlighling in Gnus.
14767 @i{Stefan Vollmar} organized a video-recorded talk at the
14768 Max-Planck-Institute for Neurology. He also inspired the creation of a
14769 concept index for HTML export.
14771 @i{J@"urgen Vollmer} contributed code generating the table of contents
14774 @i{Samuel Wales} has provided important feedback and bug reports.
14776 @i{Chris Wallace} provided a patch implementing the @samp{QUOTE}
14779 @i{David Wainberg} suggested archiving, and improvements to the linking
14782 @i{Carsten Wimmer} suggested some changes and helped fix a bug in
14785 @i{Roland Winkler} requested additional key bindings to make Org
14788 @i{Piotr Zielinski} wrote @file{org-mouse.el}, proposed agenda blocks
14789 and contributed various ideas and code snippets.
14793 @node Main Index, Key Index, History and Acknowledgments, Top
14794 @unnumbered Concept index
14798 @node Key Index, Command and Function Index, Main Index, Top
14799 @unnumbered Key index
14803 @node Command and Function Index, Variable Index, Key Index, Top
14804 @unnumbered Command and function index
14808 @node Variable Index, , Command and Function Index, Top
14809 @unnumbered Variable index
14811 This is not a complete index of variables and faces, only the ones that are
14812 mentioned in the manual. For a more complete list, use @kbd{M-x
14813 org-customize @key{RET}} and then click yourself through the tree.
14820 arch-tag: 7893d1Fe-cc57-4d13-b5e5-f494a1CBC7ac
14823 @c Local variables:
14825 @c indent-tabs-mode: nil
14826 @c paragraph-start: "
\b\\|^@[a-zA-Z]*[ \n]\\|^@x?org\\(key\\|cmd\\)\\|\f\\|[ ]*$"
14827 @c paragraph-separate: "
\b\\|^@[a-zA-Z]*[ \n]\\|^@x?org\\(key\\|cmd\\)\\|[ \f]*$"
14831 @c LocalWords: webdavhost pre